Sen. Kimberly A. Lightford

Filed: 1/5/2021

 

 


 

 


 
10100HB2170sam001LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1
AMENDMENT TO HOUSE BILL 2170

2    AMENDMENT NO. ______. Amend House Bill 2170 by replacing
3everything after the enacting clause with the following:
 
4
"Article 5.

 
5    Section 5-5. The School Code is amended by adding Section
62-3.64a-10 and by changing Section 27A-5 as follows:
 
7    (105 ILCS 5/2-3.64a-10 new)
8    Sec. 2-3.64a-10. Kindergarten assessment.
9    (a) For the purposes of this Section, "kindergarten"
10includes both full-day and half-day kindergarten programs.
11    (b) Beginning no later than the 2021-2022 school year, the
12State Board of Education shall annually assess all public
13school students entering kindergarten using a common
14assessment tool, unless the State Board determines that a
15student is otherwise exempt. The common assessment tool must

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 2 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1assess multiple developmental domains, including literacy,
2language, mathematics, and social and emotional development.
3The assessment must be valid, reliable, and developmentally
4appropriate to formatively assess a child's development and
5readiness for kindergarten.
6    (c) Results from the assessment may be used by the school
7to understand the child's development and readiness for
8kindergarten, to tailor instruction, and to measure the child's
9progress over time. Assessment results may also be used to
10identify a need for the professional development of teachers
11and early childhood educators and to inform State-level and
12district-level policies and resource allocation.
13    The school shall make the assessment results available to
14the child's parent or guardian.
15    The assessment results may not be used (i) to prevent a
16child from enrolling in kindergarten or (ii) as the sole
17measure used in determining the grade promotion or retention of
18a student.
19    (d) On an annual basis, the State Board shall report
20publicly, at a minimum, data from the assessment for the State
21overall and for each school district. The State Board's report
22must disaggregate data by race and ethnicity, household income,
23students who are English learners, and students who have an
24individualized education program.
25    (e) The State Superintendent of Education shall appoint a
26committee of no more than 21 members, consisting of parents,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 3 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1teachers, school administrators, assessment experts, regional
2superintendents of schools, and citizens, to review, on an
3ongoing basis, the content and design of the assessment, the
4collective results of the assessment as measured against
5kindergarten-readiness standards, and other issues involving
6the assessment as identified by the committee.
7    The committee shall make periodic recommendations to the
8State Superintendent of Education and the General Assembly
9concerning the assessments.
10    (f) The State Board may adopt rules to implement and
11administer this Section.
 
12    (105 ILCS 5/27A-5)
13    Sec. 27A-5. Charter school; legal entity; requirements.
14    (a) A charter school shall be a public, nonsectarian,
15nonreligious, non-home based, and non-profit school. A charter
16school shall be organized and operated as a nonprofit
17corporation or other discrete, legal, nonprofit entity
18authorized under the laws of the State of Illinois.
19    (b) A charter school may be established under this Article
20by creating a new school or by converting an existing public
21school or attendance center to charter school status. Beginning
22on April 16, 2003 (the effective date of Public Act 93-3), in
23all new applications to establish a charter school in a city
24having a population exceeding 500,000, operation of the charter
25school shall be limited to one campus. The changes made to this

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 4 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1Section by Public Act 93-3 do not apply to charter schools
2existing or approved on or before April 16, 2003 (the effective
3date of Public Act 93-3).
4    (b-5) In this subsection (b-5), "virtual-schooling" means
5a cyber school where students engage in online curriculum and
6instruction via the Internet and electronic communication with
7their teachers at remote locations and with students
8participating at different times.
9    From April 1, 2013 through December 31, 2016, there is a
10moratorium on the establishment of charter schools with
11virtual-schooling components in school districts other than a
12school district organized under Article 34 of this Code. This
13moratorium does not apply to a charter school with
14virtual-schooling components existing or approved prior to
15April 1, 2013 or to the renewal of the charter of a charter
16school with virtual-schooling components already approved
17prior to April 1, 2013.
18    (c) A charter school shall be administered and governed by
19its board of directors or other governing body in the manner
20provided in its charter. The governing body of a charter school
21shall be subject to the Freedom of Information Act and the Open
22Meetings Act. No later than January 1, 2021 (one year after the
23effective date of Public Act 101-291) this amendatory Act of
24the 101st General Assembly, a charter school's board of
25directors or other governing body must include at least one
26parent or guardian of a pupil currently enrolled in the charter

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 5 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1school who may be selected through the charter school or a
2charter network election, appointment by the charter school's
3board of directors or other governing body, or by the charter
4school's Parent Teacher Organization or its equivalent.
5    (c-5) No later than January 1, 2021 (one year after the
6effective date of Public Act 101-291) this amendatory Act of
7the 101st General Assembly or within the first year of his or
8her first term, every voting member of a charter school's board
9of directors or other governing body shall complete a minimum
10of 4 hours of professional development leadership training to
11ensure that each member has sufficient familiarity with the
12board's or governing body's role and responsibilities,
13including financial oversight and accountability of the
14school, evaluating the principal's and school's performance,
15adherence to the Freedom of Information Act and the Open
16Meetings Act Acts, and compliance with education and labor law.
17In each subsequent year of his or her term, a voting member of
18a charter school's board of directors or other governing body
19shall complete a minimum of 2 hours of professional development
20training in these same areas. The training under this
21subsection may be provided or certified by a statewide charter
22school membership association or may be provided or certified
23by other qualified providers approved by the State Board of
24Education.
25    (d) For purposes of this subsection (d), "non-curricular
26health and safety requirement" means any health and safety

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 6 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1requirement created by statute or rule to provide, maintain,
2preserve, or safeguard safe or healthful conditions for
3students and school personnel or to eliminate, reduce, or
4prevent threats to the health and safety of students and school
5personnel. "Non-curricular health and safety requirement" does
6not include any course of study or specialized instructional
7requirement for which the State Board has established goals and
8learning standards or which is designed primarily to impart
9knowledge and skills for students to master and apply as an
10outcome of their education.
11    A charter school shall comply with all non-curricular
12health and safety requirements applicable to public schools
13under the laws of the State of Illinois. On or before September
141, 2015, the State Board shall promulgate and post on its
15Internet website a list of non-curricular health and safety
16requirements that a charter school must meet. The list shall be
17updated annually no later than September 1. Any charter
18contract between a charter school and its authorizer must
19contain a provision that requires the charter school to follow
20the list of all non-curricular health and safety requirements
21promulgated by the State Board and any non-curricular health
22and safety requirements added by the State Board to such list
23during the term of the charter. Nothing in this subsection (d)
24precludes an authorizer from including non-curricular health
25and safety requirements in a charter school contract that are
26not contained in the list promulgated by the State Board,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 7 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1including non-curricular health and safety requirements of the
2authorizing local school board.
3    (e) Except as otherwise provided in the School Code, a
4charter school shall not charge tuition; provided that a
5charter school may charge reasonable fees for textbooks,
6instructional materials, and student activities.
7    (f) A charter school shall be responsible for the
8management and operation of its fiscal affairs including, but
9not limited to, the preparation of its budget. An audit of each
10charter school's finances shall be conducted annually by an
11outside, independent contractor retained by the charter
12school. To ensure financial accountability for the use of
13public funds, on or before December 1 of every year of
14operation, each charter school shall submit to its authorizer
15and the State Board a copy of its audit and a copy of the Form
16990 the charter school filed that year with the federal
17Internal Revenue Service. In addition, if deemed necessary for
18proper financial oversight of the charter school, an authorizer
19may require quarterly financial statements from each charter
20school.
21    (g) A charter school shall comply with all provisions of
22this Article, the Illinois Educational Labor Relations Act, all
23federal and State laws and rules applicable to public schools
24that pertain to special education and the instruction of
25English learners, and its charter. A charter school is exempt
26from all other State laws and regulations in this Code

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 8 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1governing public schools and local school board policies;
2however, a charter school is not exempt from the following:
3        (1) Sections 10-21.9 and 34-18.5 of this Code regarding
4    criminal history records checks and checks of the Statewide
5    Sex Offender Database and Statewide Murderer and Violent
6    Offender Against Youth Database of applicants for
7    employment;
8        (2) Sections 10-20.14, 10-22.6, 24-24, 34-19, and
9    34-84a of this Code regarding discipline of students;
10        (3) the Local Governmental and Governmental Employees
11    Tort Immunity Act;
12        (4) Section 108.75 of the General Not For Profit
13    Corporation Act of 1986 regarding indemnification of
14    officers, directors, employees, and agents;
15        (5) the Abused and Neglected Child Reporting Act;
16        (5.5) subsection (b) of Section 10-23.12 and
17    subsection (b) of Section 34-18.6 of this Code;
18        (6) the Illinois School Student Records Act;
19        (7) Section 10-17a of this Code regarding school report
20    cards;
21        (8) the P-20 Longitudinal Education Data System Act;
22        (9) Section 27-23.7 of this Code regarding bullying
23    prevention;
24        (10) Section 2-3.162 of this Code regarding student
25    discipline reporting;
26        (11) Sections 22-80 and 27-8.1 of this Code;

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 9 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (12) Sections 10-20.60 and 34-18.53 of this Code;
2        (13) Sections 10-20.63 and 34-18.56 of this Code;
3        (14) Section 26-18 of this Code;
4        (15) Section 22-30 of this Code; and
5        (16) Sections 24-12 and 34-85 of this Code; .
6        (17) the (16) The Seizure Smart School Act; and .
7        (18) Section 2-3.64a-10 of this Code.
8    The change made by Public Act 96-104 to this subsection (g)
9is declaratory of existing law.
10    (h) A charter school may negotiate and contract with a
11school district, the governing body of a State college or
12university or public community college, or any other public or
13for-profit or nonprofit private entity for: (i) the use of a
14school building and grounds or any other real property or
15facilities that the charter school desires to use or convert
16for use as a charter school site, (ii) the operation and
17maintenance thereof, and (iii) the provision of any service,
18activity, or undertaking that the charter school is required to
19perform in order to carry out the terms of its charter.
20However, a charter school that is established on or after April
2116, 2003 (the effective date of Public Act 93-3) and that
22operates in a city having a population exceeding 500,000 may
23not contract with a for-profit entity to manage or operate the
24school during the period that commences on April 16, 2003 (the
25effective date of Public Act 93-3) and concludes at the end of
26the 2004-2005 school year. Except as provided in subsection (i)

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 10 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1of this Section, a school district may charge a charter school
2reasonable rent for the use of the district's buildings,
3grounds, and facilities. Any services for which a charter
4school contracts with a school district shall be provided by
5the district at cost. Any services for which a charter school
6contracts with a local school board or with the governing body
7of a State college or university or public community college
8shall be provided by the public entity at cost.
9    (i) In no event shall a charter school that is established
10by converting an existing school or attendance center to
11charter school status be required to pay rent for space that is
12deemed available, as negotiated and provided in the charter
13agreement, in school district facilities. However, all other
14costs for the operation and maintenance of school district
15facilities that are used by the charter school shall be subject
16to negotiation between the charter school and the local school
17board and shall be set forth in the charter.
18    (j) A charter school may limit student enrollment by age or
19grade level.
20    (k) If the charter school is approved by the State Board or
21Commission, then the charter school is its own local education
22agency.
23(Source: P.A. 100-29, eff. 1-1-18; 100-156, eff. 1-1-18;
24100-163, eff. 1-1-18; 100-413, eff. 1-1-18; 100-468, eff.
256-1-18; 100-726, eff. 1-1-19; 100-863, eff. 8-14-18; 101-50,
26eff. 7-1-20; 101-81, eff. 7-12-19; 101-291, eff. 1-1-20;

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 11 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1101-531, eff. 8-23-19; 101-543, eff. 8-23-19; revised 8-4-20.)
 
2
Article 10.

 
3    Section 10-5. The Early Intervention Services System Act is
4amended by changing Section 11 as follows:
 
5    (325 ILCS 20/11)  (from Ch. 23, par. 4161)
6    Sec. 11. Individualized Family Service Plans.
7    (a) Each eligible infant or toddler and that infant's or
8toddler's family shall receive:
9        (1) timely, comprehensive, multidisciplinary
10    assessment of the unique strengths and needs of each
11    eligible infant and toddler, and assessment of the concerns
12    and priorities of the families to appropriately assist them
13    in meeting their needs and identify supports and services
14    to meet those needs; and
15        (2) a written Individualized Family Service Plan
16    developed by a multidisciplinary team which includes the
17    parent or guardian. The individualized family service plan
18    shall be based on the multidisciplinary team's assessment
19    of the resources, priorities, and concerns of the family
20    and its identification of the supports and services
21    necessary to enhance the family's capacity to meet the
22    developmental needs of the infant or toddler, and shall
23    include the identification of services appropriate to meet

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 12 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    those needs, including the frequency, intensity, and
2    method of delivering services. During and as part of the
3    initial development of the individualized family services
4    plan, and any periodic reviews of the plan, the
5    multidisciplinary team may seek consultation from the lead
6    agency's designated experts, if any, to help determine
7    appropriate services and the frequency and intensity of
8    those services. All services in the individualized family
9    services plan must be justified by the multidisciplinary
10    assessment of the unique strengths and needs of the infant
11    or toddler and must be appropriate to meet those needs. At
12    the periodic reviews, the team shall determine whether
13    modification or revision of the outcomes or services is
14    necessary.
15    (b) The Individualized Family Service Plan shall be
16evaluated once a year and the family shall be provided a review
17of the Plan at 6 month intervals or more often where
18appropriate based on infant or toddler and family needs. The
19lead agency shall create a quality review process regarding
20Individualized Family Service Plan development and changes
21thereto, to monitor and help assure that resources are being
22used to provide appropriate early intervention services.
23    (c) The initial evaluation and initial assessment and
24initial Plan meeting must be held within 45 days after the
25initial contact with the early intervention services system.
26The 45-day timeline does not apply for any period when the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 13 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1child or parent is unavailable to complete the initial
2evaluation, the initial assessments of the child and family, or
3the initial Plan meeting, due to exceptional family
4circumstances that are documented in the child's early
5intervention records, or when the parent has not provided
6consent for the initial evaluation or the initial assessment of
7the child despite documented, repeated attempts to obtain
8parental consent. As soon as exceptional family circumstances
9no longer exist or parental consent has been obtained, the
10initial evaluation, the initial assessment, and the initial
11Plan meeting must be completed as soon as possible. With
12parental consent, early intervention services may commence
13before the completion of the comprehensive assessment and
14development of the Plan.
15    (d) Parents must be informed that early intervention
16services shall be provided to each eligible infant and toddler,
17to the maximum extent appropriate, in the natural environment,
18which may include the home or other community settings. Parents
19shall make the final decision to accept or decline early
20intervention services. A decision to decline such services
21shall not be a basis for administrative determination of
22parental fitness, or other findings or sanctions against the
23parents. Parameters of the Plan shall be set forth in rules.
24    (e) The regional intake offices shall explain to each
25family, orally and in writing, all of the following:
26        (1) That the early intervention program will pay for

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 14 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    all early intervention services set forth in the
2    individualized family service plan that are not covered or
3    paid under the family's public or private insurance plan or
4    policy and not eligible for payment through any other third
5    party payor.
6        (2) That services will not be delayed due to any rules
7    or restrictions under the family's insurance plan or
8    policy.
9        (3) That the family may request, with appropriate
10    documentation supporting the request, a determination of
11    an exemption from private insurance use under Section
12    13.25.
13        (4) That responsibility for co-payments or
14    co-insurance under a family's private insurance plan or
15    policy will be transferred to the lead agency's central
16    billing office.
17        (5) That families will be responsible for payments of
18    family fees, which will be based on a sliding scale
19    according to the State's definition of ability to pay which
20    is comparing household size and income to the sliding scale
21    and considering out-of-pocket medical or disaster
22    expenses, and that these fees are payable to the central
23    billing office. Families who fail to provide income
24    information shall be charged the maximum amount on the
25    sliding scale.
26    (f) The individualized family service plan must state

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 15 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1whether the family has private insurance coverage and, if the
2family has such coverage, must have attached to it a copy of
3the family's insurance identification card or otherwise
4include all of the following information:
5        (1) The name, address, and telephone number of the
6    insurance carrier.
7        (2) The contract number and policy number of the
8    insurance plan.
9        (3) The name, address, and social security number of
10    the primary insured.
11        (4) The beginning date of the insurance benefit year.
12    (g) A copy of the individualized family service plan must
13be provided to each enrolled provider who is providing early
14intervention services to the child who is the subject of that
15plan.
16    (h) Children receiving services under this Act shall
17receive a smooth and effective transition by their third
18birthday consistent with federal regulations adopted pursuant
19to Sections 1431 through 1444 of Title 20 of the United States
20Code. Children who receive early intervention services prior to
21their third birthday and are found eligible for an
22individualized education program under the Individuals with
23Disabilities Education Act, 20 U.S.C. 1414(d)(1)(A), and under
24Section 14-8.02 of the School Code may continue to receive
25early intervention services until the beginning of the school
26year following their third birthday in order to minimize gaps

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 16 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1in services, ensure better continuity of care, and align
2practices for the enrollment of preschool children with special
3needs to the enrollment practices of typically developing
4preschool children.
5(Source: P.A. 97-902, eff. 8-6-12; 98-41, eff. 6-28-13.)
 
6
Article 15.

 
7    Section 15-1. Short title. This Article may be cited as the
8Equitable Early Childhood Education and Care Act. References in
9this Article to "this Act" mean this Article.
 
10    Section 15-5. Findings; policies.
11    (a) The General Assembly finds the following:
12        (1) Long-standing research shows that high-quality
13    early childhood experiences have an impact on children's
14    short-term and long-term outcomes, such as educational
15    attainment, health, and lifetime income, particularly for
16    children from low-income families.
17        (2) Early childhood education and care programs
18    provide child care so parents can maintain stable
19    employment, provide for themselves and their families, and
20    advance their career or educational goals.
21        (3) Illinois has a vigorous early childhood education
22    and care industry composed of programs that serve children
23    under the age of 6, including preschool and child care in

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 17 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    schools, centers, and homes; these programs also include
2    home visiting and services for young children with special
3    needs.
4        (4) A significant portion of the early childhood
5    workforce and of family child care providers are Black and
6    Latinx women.
7        (5) Illinois was among the first states in the nation
8    to enact the Pre-K At-Risk program and services for infants
9    and toddlers in the 1980s and reaffirmed this commitment to
10    early childhood education in 2006 by creating Preschool for
11    All to offer State-funded, high-quality preschool to
12    3-year-olds and 4-year-olds.
13        (6) Illinois was one of the first states in the nation
14    to commit education funding to very young children and to
15    have a statutory commitment to grow funding for
16    infant-toddler services as it grows preschool services,
17    including prenatal supports like home visitors and doulas.
18        (7) Countless children and families have benefitted
19    from these services over these decades and have had the
20    opportunity to enter school ready to learn and succeed.
21        (8) Despite progress made by the State, too few
22    children, particularly those from Black, Latinx, and
23    low-income households and child care deserts, have access
24    to high-quality early childhood education and care
25    services, due to both the availability and affordability of
26    quality services.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 18 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (9) In 2019, only 29% of all children in Illinois
2    entered kindergarten "ready"; only 21% of Black children,
3    17% of Latinx children, 14% of English Learners, 14% of
4    children with IEPs, and 20% of children on free and reduced
5    lunch demonstrated readiness, highlighting the critical
6    work Illinois must do to close gaps in opportunity and
7    outcomes.
8        (10) The State's early childhood education and care
9    programs are maintained across 3 state agencies, which
10    leads to inefficiencies, lack of alignment, challenges to
11    collecting comprehensive data around services and needs of
12    children and families, and obstacles for both children and
13    families and the early childhood education and care
14    providers to navigate the fragmented system and ensure
15    children receive high-quality services that meet their
16    needs.
17        (11) The State's current mechanisms for payment to
18    early childhood education and care providers may not
19    incentivize quality services and can lead to payment
20    delays, lack of stability of providers, and the inability
21    of providers to provide appropriate compensation to the
22    workforce and support quality programming.
23        (12) Illinois must advance a just system for early
24    childhood education and care that ensures racially and
25    economically equitable opportunities and outcomes for all
26    children.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 19 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (13) In 2017, Illinois became a national leader in
2    passing the K-12 Evidence-Based Funding formula for public
3    schools, creating a mechanism to adequately fund and
4    equitably disburse resources throughout the State and
5    prioritize funding for school districts that need it most.
6    (b) The General Assembly supports the following goals of
7the Illinois Commission on Equitable Early Childhood Education
8and Care Funding:
9        (1) To create a more equitable, efficient, and
10    effective system and thereby increase access to
11    high-quality services, particularly to serve more Black
12    and Latinx children and populations of children where
13    children of color may be disproportionately represented,
14    such as children from low-income households, with
15    disabilities, experiencing homelessness, and participating
16    in the child welfare system.
17        (2) To ensure a more equitable system, we support the
18    Commission's goal of consolidating programs and services
19    into a single, adequately staffed State agency to align and
20    coordinate services, to decrease barriers to access for
21    families and make it easier for them to navigate the
22    system, and to better collect, use, and report
23    comprehensive data to ensure disparities in services are
24    addressed.
25        (3) To ensure equitable and adequate funding to expand
26    access to high-quality services and increase compensation

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 20 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    of this vital workforce, a significant proportion of which
2    are Black and Latinx women. The General Assembly encourages
3    the State to commit to a multi-year plan designed to move
4    the State toward adequate funding over time.
5        (4) To redesign the mechanisms by which the State pays
6    providers of early childhood education and care services to
7    ensure provider stability, capacity, and quality and to
8    make sure providers and services are available to families
9    throughout the State, including in areas of child care
10    deserts and concentrated poverty.
11        (5) To ensure comprehensive data on children and
12    families' access to and participation in programs and
13    resulting outcomes, including, but not limited to,
14    kindergarten readiness, to understand and address the
15    degree to which the State is reaching children and families
16    and ensuring equitable opportunity and outcomes.
17    (c) The General Assembly encourages the State to create a
18planning process and timeline, with a designated body
19accountable for implementing the Commission's recommendations,
20that includes engagement of parents, providers, communities,
21experts, and other stakeholders and to regularly evaluate the
22impact of the implementation of the Commission's
23recommendations to ensure they impact children, families, and
24communities as intended and lead to a more equitable early
25childhood education and care system for Illinois.
 

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 21 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1
Article 20.

 
2    Section 20-5. The Illinois Act on the Aging is amended by
3adding Section 4.01b as follows:
 
4    (20 ILCS 105/4.01b new)
5    Sec. 4.01b. Uniform demographic data collection.
6    (a) The Department shall collect and publicly report
7statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics of
8program participants for each program administered by the
9Department. Except as provided in subsection (b), when
10collecting the data required under this Section, the Department
11shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each
12program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the
13following:
14        (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone.
15        (2) Asian alone.
16        (3) Black or African American alone.
17        (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race.
18        (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone.
19        (6) White alone.
20        (7) Some other race alone.
21        (8) Two or more races.
22    The Department may further define, by rule, the racial and
23ethnic classifications provided in this Section.
24    (b) If a program administered by the Department is subject

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 22 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1to federal reporting requirements that include the collection
2and public reporting of statistical data on the racial and
3ethnic demographics of program participants, the Department
4may maintain the same racial and ethnic classifications used
5under the federal requirements if such classifications differ
6from the classifications listed in subsection (a).
7    (c) The Department shall make all demographic information
8collected under this Section available to the public which at a
9minimum shall include posting the information for each program
10in a timely manner on the Department's official website. If the
11Department already has a mechanism or process in place to
12report information about program participation for any program
13administered by the Department, then the Department shall use
14that mechanism or process to include the demographic
15information collected under this Section. If the Department
16does not have a mechanism or process in place to report
17information about program participation for any program
18administered by the Department, then the Department shall
19create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic
20information collected under this Section.
21    (d) The Department shall submit to the General Assembly on
22or before December 1 of each year preceding a new General
23Assembly a report that contains the following:
24        (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program
25    participants for each program administered by the
26    Department, as required under this Section, during the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 23 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    prior 2 fiscal years.
2        (2) The most recent demographic information, including
3    racial and ethnic data, of inmates and parolees eligible
4    for each of the programs detailed under paragraph (1)
5    according to either eligibility guidelines or the best
6    available information.
7        (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial
8    and ethnic disparities in program participation for each
9    program administered by the Department as indicated by the
10    demographic information collected under paragraphs (1) and
11    (2).
12    (e) If the Department is unable to provide any item
13specified under subsection (d), the Department shall submit to
14the General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year
15preceding a new General Assembly the reason for the delay and
16the estimated date by which the Department will provide the
17specified information.
18    (f) The Governor may require the Department and other
19relevant State agencies that are required to report demographic
20information as provided by this amendatory Act of the 101st
21General Assembly to consolidate into a single report each
22agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of
23subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each
24agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and
25ethnic disparities within any program administered by the
26agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 24 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1the State Board of Education.
 
2    Section 20-10. The Department of Central Management
3Services Law of the Civil Administrative Code of Illinois is
4amended by adding Section 405-535 as follows:
 
5    (20 ILCS 405/405-535 new)
6    Sec. 405-535. Uniform demographic data collection.
7    (a) The Department shall collect and publicly report
8statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics of
9program participants for each program administered by the
10Department. Except as provided in subsection (b), when
11collecting the data required under this Section, the Department
12shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each
13program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the
14following:
15        (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone.
16        (2) Asian alone.
17        (3) Black or African American alone.
18        (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race.
19        (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone.
20        (6) White alone.
21        (7) Some other race alone.
22        (8) Two or more races.
23    The Department may further define, by rule, the racial and
24ethnic classifications provided in this Section.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 25 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (b) If a program administered by the Department is subject
2to federal reporting requirements that include the collection
3and public reporting of statistical data on the racial and
4ethnic demographics of program participants, the Department
5may maintain the same racial and ethnic classifications used
6under the federal requirements if such classifications differ
7from the classifications listed in subsection (a).
8    (c) The Department shall make all demographic information
9collected under this Section available to the public which at a
10minimum shall include posting the information for each program
11in a timely manner on the Department's official website. If the
12Department already has a mechanism or process in place to
13report information about program participation for any program
14administered by the Department, then the Department shall use
15that mechanism or process to include the demographic
16information collected under this Section. If the Department
17does not have a mechanism or process in place to report
18information about program participation for any program
19administered by the Department, then the Department shall
20create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic
21information collected under this Section.
22    (d) The Department shall submit to the General Assembly on
23or before December 1 of each year preceding a new General
24Assembly a report that contains the following:
25        (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program
26    participants for each program administered by the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 26 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Department, as required under this Section, during the
2    prior 2 fiscal years.
3        (2) The most recent demographic information, including
4    racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in Illinois
5    who are in need of or eligible for each of the programs
6    detailed under paragraph (1) according to either
7    eligibility guidelines or the best available information.
8        (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial
9    and ethnic disparities in program participation for each
10    program administered by the Department as indicated by the
11    demographic information collected under paragraphs (1) and
12    (2).
13    (e) If the Department is unable to provide any item
14specified under subsection (d), the Department shall submit to
15the General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year
16preceding a new General Assembly the reason for the delay and
17the estimated date by which the Department will provide the
18specified information.
19    (f) The Governor may require the Department and other
20relevant State agencies that are required to report demographic
21information as provided by this amendatory Act of the 101st
22General Assembly to consolidate into a single report each
23agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of
24subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each
25agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and
26ethnic disparities within any program administered by the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 27 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to
2the State Board of Education.
 
3    Section 20-15. The Children and Family Services Act is
4amended by adding Section 44 as follows:
 
5    (20 ILCS 505/44 new)
6    Sec. 44. Uniform demographic data collection.
7    (a) The Department shall collect and publicly report
8statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics of
9program participants for each program administered by the
10Department. Except as provided in subsection (b), when
11collecting the data required under this Section, the Department
12shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each
13program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the
14following:
15        (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone.
16        (2) Asian alone.
17        (3) Black or African American alone.
18        (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race.
19        (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone.
20        (6) White alone.
21        (7) Some other race alone.
22        (8) Two or more races.
23    The Department may further define, by rule, the racial and
24ethnic classifications provided in this Section.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 28 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (b) If a program administered by the Department is subject
2to federal reporting requirements that include the collection
3and public reporting of statistical data on the racial and
4ethnic demographics of program participants, the Department
5may maintain the same racial and ethnic classifications used
6under the federal requirements if such classifications differ
7from the classifications listed in subsection (a).
8    (c) The Department shall make all demographic information
9collected under this Section available to the public which at a
10minimum shall include posting the information for each program
11in a timely manner on the Department's official website. If the
12Department already has a mechanism or process in place to
13report information about program participation for any program
14administered by the Department, then the Department shall use
15that mechanism or process to include the demographic
16information collected under this Section. If the Department
17does not have a mechanism or process in place to report
18information about program participation for any program
19administered by the Department, then the Department shall
20create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic
21information collected under this Section.
22    (d) The Department shall submit to the General Assembly on
23or before December 1 of each year preceding a new General
24Assembly a report that contains the following:
25        (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program
26    participants for each program administered by the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 29 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Department, as required under this Section, during the
2    prior 2 fiscal years.
3        (2) The most recent demographic information, including
4    racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in Illinois
5    who are in need of or eligible for each of the programs
6    detailed under paragraph (1) according to either
7    eligibility guidelines or the best available information.
8        (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial
9    and ethnic disparities in program participation for each
10    program administered by the Department as indicated by the
11    demographic information collected under paragraphs (1) and
12    (2).
13    (e) If the Department is unable to provide any item
14specified under subsection (d), the Department shall submit to
15the General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year
16preceding a new General Assembly the reason for the delay and
17the estimated date by which the Department will provide the
18specified information.
19    (f) The Governor may require the Department and other
20relevant State agencies that are required to report demographic
21information as provided by this amendatory Act of the 101st
22General Assembly to consolidate into a single report each
23agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of
24subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each
25agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and
26ethnic disparities within any program administered by the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 30 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to
2the State Board of Education.
 
3    Section 20-20. The Department of Human Services Act is
4amended by changing Section 1-70 as follows:
 
5    (20 ILCS 1305/1-70)
6    Sec. 1-70. Uniform demographic data collection.
7    (a) The Department shall collect and publicly report
8statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics of
9program participants for each program administered by the
10Department. Except as provided in subsection (b), when
11collecting the data required under this Section, the Department
12shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each
13program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the
14following:
15        (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone.
16        (2) Asian alone.
17        (3) Black or African American alone.
18        (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race.
19        (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone.
20        (6) White alone.
21        (7) Some other race alone.
22        (8) Two or more races.
23    The Department may further define, by rule, the racial and
24ethnic classifications provided in this Section.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 31 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (b) If a program administered by the Department is subject
2to federal reporting requirements that include the collection
3and public reporting of statistical data on the racial and
4ethnic demographics of program participants, the Department
5may maintain the same racial and ethnic classifications used
6under the federal requirements if such classifications differ
7from the classifications listed in subsection (a).
8    (c) The Department shall make all demographic information
9collected under this Section available to the public which at a
10minimum shall include posting the information for each program
11in a timely manner on the Department's official website. If the
12Department already has a mechanism or process in place to
13report information about program participation for any program
14administered by the Department, then the Department shall use
15that mechanism or process to include the demographic
16information collected under this Section. If the Department
17does not have a mechanism or process in place to report
18information about program participation for any program
19administered by the Department, then the Department shall
20create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic
21information collected under this Section.
22    (d) The Department shall submit to the General Assembly on
23or before December 1 of each year preceding a new General
24Assembly a report that contains the following:
25        (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program
26    participants for each program administered by the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 32 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Department, as required under this Section, during the
2    prior 2 fiscal years.
3        (2) The most recent demographic information, including
4    racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in Illinois
5    who are in need of or eligible for each of the programs
6    detailed under paragraph (1) according to either
7    eligibility guidelines or the best available information.
8        (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial
9    and ethnic disparities in program participation for each
10    program administered by the Department as indicated by the
11    demographic information collected under paragraphs (1) and
12    (2).
13    (e) If the Department is unable to provide any item
14specified under subsection (d), the Department shall submit to
15the General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year
16preceding a new General Assembly the reason for the delay and
17the estimated date by which the Department will provide the
18specified information.
19    (f) The Governor may require the Department and other
20relevant State agencies that are required to report demographic
21information as provided by this amendatory Act of the 101st
22General Assembly to consolidate into a single report each
23agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of
24subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each
25agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and
26ethnic disparities within any program administered by the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 33 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to
2the State Board of Education.
3(Source: P.A. 100-275, eff. 1-1-18; 100-863, eff. 8-14-18.)
 
4    Section 20-25. The Department of Labor Law is amended by
5adding Section 1505-220 as follows:
 
6    (20 ILCS 1505/1505-220 new)
7    Sec. 1505-220. Uniform demographic data collection.
8    (a) The Department shall collect and publicly report
9statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics of
10program participants for each program administered by the
11Department. Except as provided in subsection (b), when
12collecting the data required under this Section, the Department
13shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each
14program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the
15following:
16        (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone.
17        (2) Asian alone.
18        (3) Black or African American alone.
19        (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race.
20        (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone.
21        (6) White alone.
22        (7) Some other race alone.
23        (8) Two or more races.
24    The Department may further define, by rule, the racial and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 34 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1ethnic classifications provided in this Section.
2    (b) If a program administered by the Department is subject
3to federal reporting requirements that include the collection
4and public reporting of statistical data on the racial and
5ethnic demographics of program participants, the Department
6may maintain the same racial and ethnic classifications used
7under the federal requirements if such classifications differ
8from the classifications listed in subsection (a).
9    (c) The Department shall make all demographic information
10collected under this Section available to the public which at a
11minimum shall include posting the information for each program
12in a timely manner on the Department's official website. If the
13Department already has a mechanism or process in place to
14report information about program participation for any program
15administered by the Department, then the Department shall use
16that mechanism or process to include the demographic
17information collected under this Section. If the Department
18does not have a mechanism or process in place to report
19information about program participation for any program
20administered by the Department, then the Department shall
21create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic
22information collected under this Section.
23    (d) The Department shall submit to the General Assembly on
24or before December 1 of each year preceding a new General
25Assembly a report that contains the following:
26        (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 35 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    participants for each program administered by the
2    Department, as required under this Section, during the
3    prior 2 fiscal years.
4        (2) The most recent demographic information, including
5    racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in Illinois
6    who are in need of or eligible for each of the programs
7    detailed under paragraph (1) according to either
8    eligibility guidelines or the best available information.
9        (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial
10    and ethnic disparities in program participation for each
11    program administered by the Department as indicated by the
12    demographic information collected under paragraphs (1) and
13    (2).
14    (e) If the Department is unable to provide any item
15specified under subsection (d), the Department shall submit to
16the General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year
17preceding a new General Assembly the reason for the delay and
18the estimated date by which the Department will provide the
19specified information.
20    (f) The Governor may require the Department and other
21relevant State agencies that are required to report demographic
22information as provided by this amendatory Act of the 101st
23General Assembly to consolidate into a single report each
24agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of
25subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each
26agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 36 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1ethnic disparities within any program administered by the
2agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to
3the State Board of Education.
 
4    Section 20-30. The Department of Healthcare and Family
5Services Law is amended by adding Section 2205-35 as follows:
 
6    (20 ILCS 2205/2205-35 new)
7    Sec. 2205-35. Uniform demographic data collection.
8    (a) The Department shall collect and publicly report
9statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics of
10program participants for each program administered by the
11Department. Except as provided in subsection (b), when
12collecting the data required under this Section, the Department
13shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each
14program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the
15following:
16        (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone.
17        (2) Asian alone.
18        (3) Black or African American alone.
19        (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race.
20        (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone.
21        (6) White alone.
22        (7) Some other race alone.
23        (8) Two or more races.
24    The Department may further define, by rule, the racial and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 37 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1ethnic classifications provided in this Section.
2    (b) If a program administered by the Department is subject
3to federal reporting requirements that include the collection
4and public reporting of statistical data on the racial and
5ethnic demographics of program participants, the Department
6may maintain the same racial and ethnic classifications used
7under the federal requirements if such classifications differ
8from the classifications listed in subsection (a).
9    (c) The Department shall make all demographic information
10collected under this Section available to the public which at a
11minimum shall include posting the information for each program
12in a timely manner on the Department's official website. If the
13Department already has a mechanism or process in place to
14report information about program participation for any program
15administered by the Department, then the Department shall use
16that mechanism or process to include the demographic
17information collected under this Section. If the Department
18does not have a mechanism or process in place to report
19information about program participation for any program
20administered by the Department, then the Department shall
21create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic
22information collected under this Section.
23    (d) The Department shall submit to the General Assembly on
24or before December 1 of each year preceding a new General
25Assembly a report that contains the following:
26        (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 38 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    participants for each program administered by the
2    Department, as required under this Section, during the
3    prior 2 fiscal years.
4        (2) The most recent demographic information, including
5    racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in Illinois
6    who are in need of or eligible for each of the programs
7    detailed under paragraph (1) according to either
8    eligibility guidelines or the best available information.
9        (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial
10    and ethnic disparities in program participation for each
11    program administered by the Department as indicated by the
12    demographic information collected under paragraphs (1) and
13    (2).
14    (e) If the Department is unable to provide any item
15specified under subsection (d), the Department shall submit to
16the General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year
17preceding a new General Assembly the reason for the delay and
18the estimated date by which the Department will provide the
19specified information.
20    (e) The Governor may require the Department and other
21relevant State agencies that are required to report demographic
22information as provided by this amendatory Act of the 101st
23General Assembly to consolidate into a single report each
24agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of
25subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each
26agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 39 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1ethnic disparities within any program administered by the
2agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to
3the State Board of Education.
 
4    Section 20-35. The Department of Public Health Powers and
5Duties Law is amended by adding Section 2310-61 as follows:
 
6    (20 ILCS 2310/2310-61 new)
7    Sec. 2310-61. Uniform demographic data collection.
8    (a) The Department shall collect and publicly report
9statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics of
10program participants for each program administered by the
11Department. Except as provided in subsection (b), when
12collecting the data required under this Section, the Department
13shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each
14program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the
15following:
16        (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone.
17        (2) Asian alone.
18        (3) Black or African American alone.
19        (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race.
20        (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone.
21        (6) White alone.
22        (7) Some other race alone.
23        (8) Two or more races.
24    The Department may further define, by rule, the racial and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 40 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1ethnic classifications provided in this Section.
2    (b) If a program administered by the Department is subject
3to federal reporting requirements that include the collection
4and public reporting of statistical data on the racial and
5ethnic demographics of program participants, the Department
6may maintain the same racial and ethnic classifications used
7under the federal requirements if such classifications differ
8from the classifications listed in subsection (a).
9    (c) The Department shall make all demographic information
10collected under this Section available to the public which at a
11minimum shall include posting the information for each program
12in a timely manner on the Department's official website. If the
13Department already has a mechanism or process in place to
14report information about program participation for any program
15administered by the Department, then the Department shall use
16that mechanism or process to include the demographic
17information collected under this Section. If the Department
18does not have a mechanism or process in place to report
19information about program participation for any program
20administered by the Department, then the Department shall
21create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic
22information collected under this Section.
23    (d) The Department shall submit to the General Assembly on
24or before December 1 of each year preceding a new General
25Assembly a report that contains the following:
26        (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 41 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    participants for each program administered by the
2    Department, as required under this Section, during the
3    prior 2 fiscal years.
4        (2) The most recent demographic information, including
5    racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in Illinois
6    who are in need of or eligible for each of the programs
7    detailed under paragraph (1) according to either
8    eligibility guidelines or the best available information.
9        (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial
10    and ethnic disparities in program participation for each
11    program administered by the Department as indicated by the
12    demographic information collected under paragraphs (1) and
13    (2).
14    (e) If the Department is unable to provide any item
15specified under subsection (d), the Department shall submit to
16the General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year
17preceding a new General Assembly the reason for the delay and
18the estimated date by which the Department will provide the
19specified information.
20    (f) The Governor may require the Department and other
21relevant State agencies that are required to report demographic
22information as provided by this amendatory Act of the 101st
23General Assembly to consolidate into a single report each
24agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of
25subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each
26agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 42 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1ethnic disparities within any program administered by the
2agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to
3the State Board of Education.
 
4    Section 20-40. The Department of Transportation Law of the
5Civil Administrative Code of Illinois is amended by adding
6Section 2705-620 as follows:
 
7    (20 ILCS 2705/2705-620 new)
8    Sec. 2705-620. Uniform demographic data collection.
9    (a) The Department shall collect and publicly report
10statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics of
11program participants for each program administered by the
12Department. Except as provided in subsection (b), when
13collecting the data required under this Section, the Department
14shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each
15program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the
16following:
17        (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone.
18        (2) Asian alone.
19        (3) Black or African American alone.
20        (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race.
21        (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone.
22        (6) White alone.
23        (7) Some other race alone.
24        (8) Two or more races.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 43 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    The Department may further define, by rule, the racial and
2ethnic classifications provided in this Section.
3    (b) If a program administered by the Department is subject
4to federal reporting requirements that include the collection
5and public reporting of statistical data on the racial and
6ethnic demographics of program participants, the Department
7may maintain the same racial and ethnic classifications used
8under the federal requirements if such classifications differ
9from the classifications listed in subsection (a).
10    (c) The Department shall make all demographic information
11collected under this Section available to the public which at a
12minimum shall include posting the information for each program
13in a timely manner on the Department's official website. If the
14Department already has a mechanism or process in place to
15report information about program participation for any program
16administered by the Department, then the Department shall use
17that mechanism or process to include the demographic
18information collected under this Section. If the Department
19does not have a mechanism or process in place to report
20information about program participation for any program
21administered by the Department, then the Department shall
22create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic
23information collected under this Section.
24    (d) The Department shall submit to the General Assembly on
25or before December 1 of each year preceding a new General
26Assembly a report that contains the following:

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 44 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program
2    participants for each program administered by the
3    Department, as required under this Section, during the
4    prior 2 fiscal years.
5        (2) The most recent demographic information, including
6    racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in Illinois
7    who are in need of or eligible for each of the programs
8    detailed under paragraph (1) according to either
9    eligibility guidelines or the best available information.
10        (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial
11    and ethnic disparities in program participation for each
12    program administered by the Department as indicated by the
13    demographic information collected under paragraphs (1) and
14    (2).
15    (e) If the Department is unable to provide any item
16specified under subsection (d), the Department shall submit to
17the General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year
18preceding a new General Assembly the reason for the delay and
19the estimated date by which the Department will provide the
20specified information.
21    (f) The Governor may require the Department and other
22relevant State agencies that are required to report demographic
23information as provided by this amendatory Act of the 101st
24General Assembly to consolidate into a single report each
25agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of
26subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 45 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and
2ethnic disparities within any program administered by the
3agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to
4the State Board of Education.
 
5    Section 20-45. The School Code is amended by adding Section
62-3.11e as follows:
 
7    (105 ILCS 5/2-3.11e new)
8    Sec. 2-3.11e. Uniform demographic data collection.
9    (a) The State Board of Education shall collect and publicly
10report statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics
11of program participants for each program administered by the
12State Board of Education. Except as provided in subsection (b),
13when collecting the data required under this Section, the State
14Board of Education shall use the same racial and ethnic
15classifications for each program, which shall include, but not
16be limited to, the following:
17        (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone.
18        (2) Asian alone.
19        (3) Black or African American alone.
20        (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race.
21        (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone.
22        (6) White alone.
23        (7) Some other race alone.
24        (8) Two or more races.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 46 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    The State Board of Education may further define, by rule,
2the racial and ethnic classifications provided in this Section.
3    (b) If a program administered by the State Board of
4Education is subject to federal reporting requirements that
5include the collection and public reporting of statistical data
6on the racial and ethnic demographics of program participants,
7the State Board of Education may maintain the same racial and
8ethnic classifications used under the federal requirements if
9such classifications differ from the classifications listed in
10subsection (a).
11    (c) The State Board of Education shall make all demographic
12information collected under this Section available to the
13public which at a minimum shall include posting the information
14for each program in a timely manner on the State Board of
15Education's official website. If the State Board of Education
16already has a mechanism or process in place to report
17information about program participation for any program
18administered by the State Board of Education, then the State
19Board of Education shall use that mechanism or process to
20include the demographic information collected under this
21Section. If the State Board of Education does not have a
22mechanism or process in place to report information about
23program participation for any program administered by the State
24Board of Education, then the State Board of Education shall
25create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic
26information collected under this Section.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 47 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (d) The State Board of Education shall submit to the
2General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year preceding
3a new General Assembly a report that contains the following:
4        (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program
5    participants for each program administered by the State
6    Board of Education, as required under this Section, during
7    the prior 2 fiscal years.
8        (2) The most recent demographic information, including
9    racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in Illinois
10    who are in need of or eligible for each of the programs
11    detailed under paragraph (1) according to either
12    eligibility guidelines or the best available information.
13        (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial
14    and ethnic disparities in program participation for each
15    program administered by the State Board of Education as
16    indicated by the demographic information collected under
17    paragraphs (1) and (2).
18    (e) If the State Board of Education is unable to provide
19any item specified under subsection (d), the State Board of
20Education shall submit to the General Assembly on or before
21December 1 of each year preceding a new General Assembly the
22reason for the delay and the estimated date by which the
23Department will provide the specified information.
 
24    Section 20-50. The Unified Code of Corrections is amended
25by adding Sections 3-2-2.5 and 3-2.5-62 as follows:
 

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 48 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (730 ILCS 5/3-2-2.5 new)
2    Sec. 3-2-2.5. Uniform demographic data collection.
3    (a) The Department of Corrections shall collect and
4publicly report statistical data on the racial and ethnic
5demographics of program participants for each program
6administered by the Department for inmates or parolees. Except
7as provided in subsection (b), when collecting the data
8required under this Section, the Department of Corrections
9shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each
10program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the
11following:
12        (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone.
13        (2) Asian alone.
14        (3) Black or African American alone.
15        (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race.
16        (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone.
17        (6) White alone.
18        (7) Some other race alone.
19        (8) Two or more races.
20    The Department of Corrections may further define, by rule,
21the racial and ethnic classifications provided in this Section.
22    (b) If a program administered by the Department of
23Corrections is subject to federal reporting requirements that
24include the collection and public reporting of statistical data
25on the racial and ethnic demographics of program participants,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 49 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1the Department may maintain the same racial and ethnic
2classifications used under the federal requirements if such
3classifications differ from the classifications listed in
4subsection (a).
5    (c) The Department of Corrections shall make all
6demographic information collected under this Section available
7to the public which at a minimum shall include posting the
8information for each program in a timely manner on the
9Department's official website. If the Department of
10Corrections already has a mechanism or process in place to
11report information about program participation for any program
12administered by the Department, then the Department shall use
13that mechanism or process to include the demographic
14information collected under this Section. If the Department of
15Corrections does not have a mechanism or process in place to
16report information about program participation for any program
17administered by the Department, then the Department shall
18create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic
19information collected under this Section.
20    (d) The Department of Corrections shall submit to the
21General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year preceding
22a new General Assembly a report that contains the following:
23        (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program
24    participants for each program administered by the
25    Department of Corrections, as required under this Section,
26    during the prior 2 fiscal years.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 50 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (2) The most recent demographic information, including
2    racial and ethnic data, of inmates and parolees eligible
3    for each of the programs detailed under paragraph (1)
4    according to either eligibility guidelines or the best
5    available information.
6        (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial
7    and ethnic disparities in program participation for each
8    program administered by the Department of Corrections as
9    indicated by the demographic information collected under
10    paragraphs (1) and (2).
11    (e) If the Department of Corrections is unable to provide
12any item specified under subsection (d), the Department of
13Corrections shall submit to the General Assembly on or before
14December 1 of each year preceding a new General Assembly the
15reason for the delay and the estimated date by which the
16Department of Corrections will provide the specified
17information.
18    (f) The Governor may require the Department of Corrections
19and other relevant State agencies that are required to report
20demographic information as provided by this amendatory Act of
21the 101st General Assembly to consolidate into a single report
22each agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of
23subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each
24agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and
25ethnic disparities within any program administered by the
26agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 51 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1the State Board of Education.
 
2    (730 ILCS 5/3-2.5-62 new)
3    Sec. 3-2.5-62. Uniform demographic data collection.
4    (a) The Department of Juvenile Justice shall collect and
5publicly report statistical data on the racial and ethnic
6demographics of program participants for each program
7administered by the Department for youths in each of the
8Department's facilities and youths on aftercare. Except as
9provided in subsection (b), when collecting the data required
10under this Section, the Department of Juvenile Justice shall
11use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each
12program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the
13following:
14        (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone.
15        (2) Asian alone.
16        (3) Black or African American alone.
17        (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race.
18        (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone.
19        (6) White alone.
20        (7) Some other race alone.
21        (8) Two or more races.
22    The Department of Juvenile Justice may further define, by
23rule, the racial and ethnic classifications provided in this
24Section.
25    (b) If a program administered by the Department of Juvenile

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 52 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1Justice is subject to federal reporting requirements that
2include the collection and public reporting of statistical data
3on the racial and ethnic demographics of program participants,
4the Department may maintain the same racial and ethnic
5classifications used under the federal requirements if such
6classifications differ from the classifications listed in
7subsection (a).
8    (c) The Department of Juvenile Justice shall make all
9demographic information collected under this Section available
10to the public which at a minimum shall include posting the
11information for each program in a timely manner on the
12Department's official website. If the Department of Juvenile
13Justice already has a mechanism or process in place to report
14information about program participation for any program
15administered by the Department, then the Department shall use
16that mechanism or process to include the demographic
17information collected under this Section. If the Department of
18Juvenile Justice does not have a mechanism or process in place
19to report information about program participation for any
20program administered by the Department, then the Department
21shall create a mechanism or process to disseminate the
22demographic information collected under this Section.
23    (d) The Department of Juvenile Justice shall submit to the
24General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year preceding
25a new General Assembly a report that contains the following:
26        (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 53 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    participants for each program administered by the
2    Department of Juvenile Justice, as required under this
3    Section, during the prior 2 fiscal years.
4        (2) The most recent demographic information, including
5    racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in
6    Department facilities or who are in aftercare and who are
7    in need of or eligible for each of the programs detailed
8    under paragraph (1) according to either eligibility
9    guidelines or the best available information.
10        (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial
11    and ethnic disparities in program participation for each
12    program administered by the Department of Juvenile Justice
13    as indicated by the demographic information collected
14    under paragraphs (1) and (2).
15    (e) If the Department of Juvenile Justice is unable to
16provide any item specified under subsection (d), the Department
17of Juvenile Justice shall submit to the General Assembly on or
18before December 1 of each year preceding a new General Assembly
19the reason for the delay and the estimated date by which the
20Department of Juvenile Justice will provide the specified
21information.
22    (f) The Governor may require the Department of Juvenile
23Justice and other relevant State agencies that are required to
24report demographic information as provided by this amendatory
25Act of the 101st General Assembly to consolidate into a single
26report each agency's recommendations provided under paragraph

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 54 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1(3) of subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures
2each agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and
3ethnic disparities within any program administered by the
4agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to
5the State Board of Education.
 
6
Article 25.

 
7    Section 22-5. The School Code is amended by adding Section
822-90 as follows:
 
9    (105 ILCS 5/22-90 new)
10    Sec. 22-90. Whole Child Task Force.
11    (a) The General Assembly makes all of the following
12findings:
13        (1) The COVID-19 pandemic has exposed systemic
14    inequities in American society. Students, educators, and
15    families throughout this State have been deeply affected by
16    the pandemic, and the impact of the pandemic will be felt
17    for years to come. The negative consequences of the
18    pandemic have impacted students and communities
19    differently along the lines of race, income, language, and
20    special needs. However, students in this State faced
21    significant unmet physical health, mental health, and
22    social and emotional needs even prior to the pandemic.
23        (2) The path to recovery requires a commitment from

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 55 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    adults in this State to address our students cultural,
2    physical, emotional, and mental health needs and to provide
3    them with stronger and increased systemic support and
4    intervention.
5        (3) It is well documented that trauma and toxic stress
6    diminish a child's ability to thrive. Forms of childhood
7    trauma and toxic stress include adverse childhood
8    experiences, systemic racism, poverty, and insecurity. The
9    COVID-19 pandemic has exacerbated these issues and brought
10    them into focus.
11        (4) It is estimated that, overall, approximately 40% of
12    children in this State have experienced at least one
13    adverse childhood experience and approximately 10% have
14    experienced 3 or more adverse childhood experiences.
15    However, the number of adverse childhood experiences is
16    higher for Black and Hispanic children who are growing up
17    in poverty. The COVID-19 pandemic has amplified the number
18    of students who have experienced childhood trauma. Also,
19    the COVID-19 pandemic has highlighted preexisting
20    inequities in school disciplinary practices that
21    disproportionately impact Black and Brown students.
22        (5) The cumulative effects of trauma and toxic stress
23    adversely impact the physical health of students, as well
24    as their ability to learn, form relationships, and
25    self-regulate. If left unaddressed, these effects increase
26    a student's risk for depression, alcoholism, anxiety,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 56 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    asthma, smoking, and suicide, all of which are risks that
2    disproportionately affect Black youth and may lead to a
3    host of medical diseases as an adult. Access to infant and
4    early childhood mental health services is critical to
5    ensure the social and emotional well-being of this State's
6    youngest children, particularly those children who have
7    experienced trauma.
8        (6) Although this State enacted measures through
9    Public Act -105 to address the high rate of early care and
10    preschool expulsions of infants, toddlers, and
11    preschoolers and the disproportionately higher rate of
12    expulsion for Black and Hispanic children, a recent study
13    found a wide variation in the awareness, understanding, and
14    compliance with the law by providers of early childhood
15    care. Further work is needed to implement the law, which
16    includes providing training to early childhood care
17    providers to increase their understanding of the law,
18    increasing the availability and access to infant and early
19    childhood mental health services, and building aligned
20    data collection systems to better understand expulsion
21    rates and to allow for accurate reporting as required by
22    the law.
23        (7) Many educators and schools in this State have
24    embraced and implemented evidenced-based restorative
25    justice and trauma-responsive and culturally relevant
26    practices and interventions. However, the use of these

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 57 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    interventions on students is often isolated or is
2    implemented occasionally and only if the school has the
3    appropriate leadership, resources, and partners available
4    to engage seriously in this work. It would be malpractice
5    to deny our students access to these practices and
6    interventions, especially in the aftermath of a
7    once-in-a-century pandemic.
8    (b) The Whole Child Task Force is created for the purpose
9of establishing an equitable, inclusive, safe, and supportive
10environment in all schools for every student in this State. The
11task force shall have all of the following goals, which means
12key steps have to be taken to ensure that every child in every
13school in this State has access to teachers, social workers,
14school leaders, support personnel, and others who have been
15trained in evidenced-based interventions and restorative
16practices:
17        (1) To create a common definition of a
18    trauma-responsive school, a trauma-responsive district,
19    and a trauma-responsive community.
20        (2) To outline the training and resources required to
21    create and sustain a system of support for
22    trauma-responsive schools, districts, and communities and
23    to identify this State's role in that work, including
24    recommendations concerning options for redirecting
25    resources from school resource officers to classroom-based
26    support.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 58 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (3) To identify or develop a process to conduct an
2    analysis of the organizations that provide training in
3    restorative practices, implicit bias, and
4    trauma-responsive systems, mental health services, and
5    social and emotional services to schools.
6        (4) To provide recommendations concerning the key data
7    to be collected and reported to ensure that this State has
8    a full and accurate understanding of the progress toward
9    ensuring that all schools employ restorative, anti-racist,
10    and trauma-responsive strategies and practices. The data
11    collected must include information relating to
12    disciplinary practices employed on a student in person or
13    through other means and to support structures in schools,
14    including school resource officers and the funding of other
15    similar police personnel in school programs.
16        (5) To recommend an implementation timeline, including
17    the key roles, responsibilities, and resources to advance
18    this State toward a system in which every school, district,
19    and community is progressing toward becoming
20    trauma-responsive.
21        (6) To seek input and feedback from stakeholders,
22    including parents, students, and educators, who reflect
23    the diversity of this State.
24    (c) Members of the Whole Child Task Force shall be
25appointed by the State Superintendent of Education. Members of
26this task force must represent the diversity of this State and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 59 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1possess the expertise needed to perform the work required to
2meet the goals of the task force set forth under subsection
3(a). Members of the task force shall include all of the
4following:
5        (1) One member of a statewide professional teachers'
6    organization.
7        (2) One member of another statewide professional
8    teachers' organization.
9        (3) One member who represents a school district serving
10    a community with a population of 500,000 or more.
11        (4) One member of a statewide organization
12    representing social workers.
13        (5) One member of an organization that has specific
14    expertise in trauma-responsive school practices and
15    experience in supporting schools in developing
16    trauma-responsive and restorative practices.
17        (6) One member of another organization that has
18    specific expertise in trauma-responsive school practices
19    and experience in supporting schools in developing
20    trauma-responsive and restorative practices.
21        (7) One member of a statewide organization that
22    represents school administrators.
23        (8) One member of a statewide policy organization that
24    works to build a healthy public education system that
25    prepares all students for a successful college, career, and
26    civic life.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 60 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (9) One member of a statewide organization that brings
2    teachers together to identify and address issues critical
3    to student success.
4        (10) One member of the General Assembly recommended by
5    the President of the Senate.
6        (11) One member of the General Assembly recommended by
7    the Speaker of the House of Representatives.
8        (12) One member of the General Assembly recommended by
9    the Minority Leader of the Senate.
10        (13) One member of the General Assembly recommended by
11    the Minority Leader of the House of Representatives.
12        (14) One member of a civil rights organization that
13    works actively on issues regarding student support.
14        (15) One administrator from a school district that has
15    actively worked to develop a system of student support that
16    uses a trauma-informed lens.
17        (16) One educator from a school district that has
18    actively worked to develop a system of student support that
19    uses a trauma-informed lens.
20        (17) One member of a youth-led organization.
21        (18) One member of an organization that has
22    demonstrated expertise in restorative practices.
23        (19) One member of a coalition of mental health and
24    school practitioners who assist schools in developing and
25    implementing trauma-informed and restorative strategies
26    and systems.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 61 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (20) One member of an organization whose mission is to
2    promote the safety, health, and economic success of
3    children, youth, and families in this State.
4        (21) One member who works or has worked as a
5    restorative justice coach or disciplinarian.
6        (22) One member who works or has worked as a social
7    worker.
8        (23) One member of the State Board of Education.
9        (24) One member who represents a statewide principals'
10    organization.
11        (25) One member who represents a statewide
12    organization of school boards.
13    (d) The Whole Child Task Force shall meet initially at the
14call of the State Superintendent of Education, at which time
15the Governor shall select one member who holds a doctorate
16degree in whole-child research as the chairperson. The task
17force shall thereafter meet at the call of the chairperson. The
18State Board of Education shall provide administrative and other
19support to the task force. Members of the task force shall
20serve without compensation.
21    (e) The Whole Child Task Force shall submit a report of its
22findings and recommendations to the General Assembly, the
23Illinois Legislative Black Caucus, the State Board of
24Education, and the Governor on or before February 1, 2022. Upon
25submitting its report, the task force is dissolved.
26    (f) This Section is repealed on February 1, 2023.
 

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 62 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1
Article 30.

 
2    Section 30-1. Short title. This Article may be cited as the
3Equity in Early Education Act. References in this Article to
4"this Act" mean this Article.
 
5    Section 30-5. Findings; legislative intent.
6    (a) The General Assembly makes all of the following
7findings:
8        (1) The 2019 Illinois Assessment of Readiness found
9    that only 37% of students in third grade met or exceeded
10    learning standards in English language arts and only 41% of
11    the students met or exceeded mathematics learning
12    standards.
13        (2) The 2017 National Assessment of Educational
14    Progress similarly showed that only 35% of students in the
15    fourth grade are proficient or advanced in English language
16    arts while only 39% of the students are proficient or
17    advanced in mathematics.
18        (3) Research from the Annie E. Casey Foundation found
19    that students in the third grade who are not proficient
20    readers are 4 times more likely to not finish high school.
21    Moreover, students in the third grade from low-income
22    families who are not proficient readers are more than 6
23    times more likely to not finish high school.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 63 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (4) The Literacy Project Foundation estimates that 60%
2    of individuals who are in prison are illiterate and 85% of
3    juvenile offenders struggle with reading.
4        (5) Strengthening early literacy and numeracy
5    instruction and support for students in this State will pay
6    dividends in the future by empowering and providing
7    students with the skills they need to graduate and the
8    ability to find fulfilling careers and to be productive
9    members of their communities.
10    (b) It is the intent of the General Assembly in enacting
11this Act that:
12        (1) every public school student in this State be
13    provided with the high-quality instruction, support, and
14    intervention he or she needs to become proficient in
15    reading and math;
16        (2) the promotion of every public school student to the
17    next higher grade level be based, in part, upon proficiency
18    in reading and math;
19        (3) school board policies facilitate evidence-based
20    reading instruction, math instruction, and intervention
21    services to address the reading and math needs of students;
22        (4) each public school student's parent or guardian be
23    informed regularly of the student's progress in reading and
24    math; and
25        (5) ultimately, by the third grade, every public school
26    student is able to demonstrate reading and math performance

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 64 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    at or above his or her grade level.
 
2    Section 30-10. Definitions. In this Act:
3    "Level I dyslexia screening" means a process, as determined
4by a school district, for gathering additional information to
5determine if the characteristics of dyslexia are present.
6    "Universal screener" means an assessment used to aid
7educators in understanding the causes for student performance,
8learning strengths, and the needs that underlie student
9performance. The assessment is conducted to identify or predict
10students who may be at risk for poor learning outcomes and is
11typically brief and conducted with all students at a particular
12grade level.
 
13    Section 30-15. Identifying deficiencies in literacy and
14math skills.
15    (a) Beginning no later than the 2022-2023 school year, a
16school district, within 45 days after the beginning of the
17school year, shall administer a valid and reliable universal
18screener to identify any deficiencies in reading or math skills
19to all students in the first and second grades. If a school
20district has been using a universal screener before the
21effective date of this Act that includes, as developmentally
22appropriate, all of the following, then the school district is
23not required to create an assessment process or administer
24different or additional universal screenings under this

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 65 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1Section:
2        (1) Phonological and phonemic awareness.
3        (2) Sound symbol recognition.
4        (3) Alphabet knowledge.
5        (4) Decoding skills.
6        (5) Rapid naming skills.
7        (6) Encoding skills.
8        (7) Oral reading fluency.
9    (b) If a student is determined to be at risk or at some
10risk for dyslexia after the universal screener has been
11administered, the school district must administer a Level 1
12dyslexia screening on the student.
13    (c) The State Board of Education shall create a process for
14reviewing and approving a list of reliable and valid universal
15screeners.
 
16    Section 30-20. Reading and math intervention. A school
17district shall offer appropriate evidence-based reading or
18math intervention using a multi-tiered system of support (MTSS)
19framework to address the needs of each student in grades
20kindergarten through 3 who exhibits a deficiency in reading or
21math skills, including those students who are referred for
22additional screening. A deficiency in reading or math skills
23shall be defined as a student who scores below his or her grade
24level or a student who is determined to be at-risk for reading
25or math failure based upon a screening assessment, a diagnostic

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 66 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1assessment, a standardized summative assessment, or progress
2monitoring. The reading or math intervention shall be provided
3in addition to the core reading or math instruction that is
4provided to all students as part of the general education
5curricula. The reading or math intervention shall:
6        (1) be provided to all students in grades kindergarten
7    through 3 who are identified as having a deficiency in
8    reading or math skills;
9        (2) regularly monitor throughout the school year the
10    progress of all students in grades kindergarten through 3
11    who are identified as having a deficiency in reading or
12    math skills and to adjust instruction according to the
13    needs of the student;
14        (3) provide a student who is identified as having a
15    deficiency in reading with explicit and systematic
16    instruction in each of the 5 essential components of
17    reading, which are phonological awareness, phonics,
18    fluency, vocabulary, and comprehension, in which the
19    student has a deficiency;
20        (4) provide to a student who is identified as having a
21    deficiency in math skills with explicit and systematic
22    instruction in early numeracy skills, as applicable;
23        (5) be offered primarily during regular school hours,
24    although the intervention may also be offered before or
25    after regular school hours;
26        (6) be created in consultation with the student's

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 67 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    parent or guardian;
2        (7) remain in effect until the student is proficient in
3    reading or math or until the student has an individualized
4    education program in place with appropriate goals in
5    reading or math; and
6        (8) provide, subject to appropriation, professional
7    development for teachers in evidence-based practices in
8    literacy and math instruction to students who lack
9    proficiency in reading or math or both.
 
10    Section 30-25. Intervention programs. A school district
11may determine the appropriate intervention program for a
12student under this Act. A program may include any of the
13following:
14        (1) Summer reading and math camps that are available to
15    students who have the most severe deficiencies in reading
16    and math. The camps shall be staffed with highly effective
17    teachers in reading and math who must provide explicit and
18    systematic reading or math intervention services and
19    support to correct a student's identified areas of reading
20    or math deficiency. No less than 90 hours of instructional
21    time in reading, math, or reading and math must be provided
22    to a student.
23        (2) An intensive acceleration class that may be
24    established by a school district for any student who is
25    retained in grade 3 and who previously was retained in any

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 68 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    of grades kindergarten through 2. The intensive
2    acceleration class shall have a reduced teacher-student
3    ratio and shall provide to the student explicit and
4    systematic reading or math instruction and intervention
5    for the majority of the student's class attendance time
6    each day.
7        (3) An extended-time reading and math intervention
8    program that is available to students in grades
9    kindergarten through 3 who lack proficiency in reading or
10    math. The program must provide proven and effective,
11    evidence-based, substantial intervention that includes
12    basic mathematics, phonemic awareness, decoding,
13    vocabulary, comprehension, and fluency, as appropriate for
14    each student, and that is based on a formative assessment
15    designed to, at a minimum, identify weaknesses in those
16    areas of learning. The program may include online or
17    digital instructional materials, programs, or library
18    resources. A minimum of 60 hours of supplemental
19    instruction for students who have severe deficiencies in
20    reading and math may be provided or a minimum of 30 hours
21    of supplemental instruction for students with less severe
22    deficiencies may be provided.
 
23    Section 30-50. Rules; technical assistance.
24    (a) The State Board of Education may adopt any rules
25necessary to implement, administer, and enforce this Act.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 69 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (b) The State Board of Education may provide technical
2assistance to aid school districts in implementing this Act.
 
3    Section 30-90. The School Code is amended by adding
4Sections 2-3.51b, 2-3.161, 2-3.182, 10-20.9b, 10-20.73,
510-20.74, 10-20.75, 34-18.51a, 34-18.67, 34-18.68, and
634-18.69 and by changing Sections 10-20.9a, 21B-20, 21B-35, and
734-18.51 as follows:
 
8    (105 ILCS 5/2-3.51b new)
9    Sec. 2-3.51b. Early literacy and numeracy grants.
10    (a) The State Board of Education shall implement and
11administer an early literacy and numeracy grant program to
12support school districts that serve students with deficiencies
13in reading or math skills or both to redesign school curricula,
14provide professional development for teachers, or hire
15literacy coaches.
16    (b) Subject to appropriation, the State Board shall
17distribute grants under the program to school districts based
18on the number of pupils in grade 3 who have been identified as
19needing reading or math intervention under Section 10-20.9b or
2034-18.51a. Grants shall be awarded on a non-competitive basis,
21but in order to be eligible to receive grant funds, a school
22district must submit to the State Board a high-quality plan
23that demonstrates how the school district intends to utilize
24the funding to improve literacy, numeracy instruction, or both

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 70 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1to students.
2    (c) The plan submitted by a school district under
3subsection (b) must include all of the following information:
4        (1) A description of the methods by which the school
5    district will modify its whole-class instructional
6    practices.
7        (2) The assessment tool or tools that will be used in
8    grades kindergarten through 3.
9        (3) The intervention programs that will be provided to
10    students who are identified as having a reading or math
11    deficiency.
12        (4) The support that will be offered to teachers to
13    implement these changes.
14    (d) If the amount appropriated in a given fiscal year is
15insufficient to provide a grant to all eligible school
16districts that request funding under the grant program, the
17State Board may develop equity-based criteria to determine the
18priority in which school districts receive grants under the
19program.
20    Each fiscal year, the State Board may withhold up to 2% of
21the amount appropriated for the grant program to administer the
22grant program.
23    (e) Three years after the first grants are awarded under
24this Section, the State Board shall submit a report to the
25General Assembly. The report shall include data on the number
26of students served, the change in the rates of proficiency in

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 71 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1reading and math in school districts that received a grant, and
2an assessment of the effectiveness of the grant program.
3    (f) The State Board may adopt any rules necessary to
4implement this Section.
 
5    (105 ILCS 5/2-3.161)
6    Sec. 2-3.161. Definition of dyslexia; reading instruction
7advisory group; handbook; screening rules.
8    (a) The State Board of Education shall incorporate, in both
9general education and special education, the following
10definition of dyslexia:
11        Dyslexia is a specific learning disability that is
12    neurobiological in origin. Dyslexia is characterized by
13    difficulties with accurate and/or fluent word recognition
14    and by poor spelling and decoding abilities. These
15    difficulties typically result from a deficit in the
16    phonological component of language that is often
17    unexpected in relation to other cognitive abilities and the
18    provision of effective classroom instruction. Secondary
19    consequences may include problems in reading comprehension
20    and reduced reading experience that can impede growth of
21    vocabulary and background knowledge.
22    (b) Subject to specific State appropriation or the
23availability of private donations, the State Board of Education
24shall establish an advisory group to develop a training module
25or training modules to provide education and professional

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 72 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1development to teachers, school administrators, and other
2education professionals regarding multi-sensory, systematic,
3and sequential instruction in reading. This advisory group
4shall complete its work before December 15, 2015 and is
5abolished on December 15, 2015. The State Board of Education
6shall reestablish the advisory group abolished on December 15,
72015 to complete the abolished group's work. The reestablished
8advisory group shall complete its work before December 31, 2016
9and is abolished on December 31, 2016. The provisions of this
10subsection (b), other than this sentence, are inoperative after
11December 31, 2016.
12    (c) The State Board of Education shall develop and maintain
13a handbook to be made available on its Internet website that
14provides guidance for pupils, parents or guardians, and
15teachers on the subject of dyslexia. The handbook shall
16include, but is not limited to:
17        (1) guidelines for teachers and parents or guardians on
18    how to identify signs of dyslexia;
19        (2) a description of educational strategies that have
20    been shown to improve the academic performance of pupils
21    with dyslexia; and
22        (3) a description of resources and services available
23    to pupils with dyslexia, parents or guardians of pupils
24    with dyslexia, and teachers; and .
25        (4) guidelines for (i) the administration of a
26    universal screener and Level I dyslexia screening, as

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 73 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    defined in Sections 10-20.73 and 34-18.67, (ii) the
2    interpretation of data from the screener or screening, and
3    (iii) appropriate instruction within a multi-tiered system
4    of support (MTSS) framework.
5    The State Board shall review the handbook once every 4
6years to update, if necessary, the guidelines, educational
7strategies, or resources and services made available in the
8handbook.
9    (d) The State Board of Education shall adopt any rules
10necessary to ensure that a student is screened as provided
11under Section 10-20.73 or 34-18.67 for the risk factors of
12dyslexia using a universal screener if:
13        (1) a student is in first or second grade in a public
14    school;
15        (2) a student in first or second grade transfers to a
16    new public school and has not been screened previously
17    during the school year; and
18        (3) a student from another state enrolls for the first
19    time in first or second grade in a school district in this
20    State, unless the student presents documentation that the
21    student had the dyslexia screening or a similar screening
22    during the school year or is exempt from screening.
23    (e) The State Board of Education shall adopt any rules
24necessary to ensure that (i) a student is screened, as provided
25in Section 10-20.73 or 34-18.67, for the characteristics of
26dyslexia using a Level I dyslexia screening and (ii) a student

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 74 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1receives dyslexia intervention services under Section 10-20.73
2or 34-18.67.
3    (f) The State Board of Education shall provide technical
4assistance for specific learning disabilities to school
5districts, including assistance with universal screeners and
6dyslexia screenings.
7    The State Board shall review the handbook once every 4
8years to update, if necessary, the guidelines, educational
9strategies, or resources and services made available in the
10handbook.
11(Source: P.A. 99-65, eff. 7-16-15; 99-78, eff. 7-20-15; 99-602,
12eff. 7-22-16; 99-603, eff. 7-22-16; 100-201, eff. 8-18-17;
13100-617, eff. 7-20-18.)
 
14    (105 ILCS 5/2-3.182 new)
15    Sec. 2-3.182. Report on reading and math intervention and
16support.
17    (a) The State Board of Education shall establish a uniform
18format for school districts to report the information required
19under subsection (c) of Section 10-20.9b and subsection (c) of
20Section 34-18.51a. The format may be developed with input from
21school boards and shall be provided to each school district no
22later than 90 days prior to the annual reporting due date.
23    (b) The State Board shall annually compile the information
24required under subsection (c) of Section 10-20.9b and
25subsection (c) of Section 34-18.51a, along with State-level

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 75 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1summary information, and publish the information on its
2Internet website. On or before October 31 of each year, the
3State Board shall make a report of its findings and compilation
4of information available to the public, the Governor, and the
5General Assembly, as provided under Section 3.1 of the General
6Assembly Organization Act.
 
7    (105 ILCS 5/10-20.9a)  (from Ch. 122, par. 10-20.9a)
8    Sec. 10-20.9a. Final grade; promotion.
9    (a) Teachers shall administer the approved marking system
10or other approved means of evaluating pupil progress. The
11teacher shall maintain the responsibility and right to
12determine grades and other evaluations of students within the
13grading policies of the district based upon his or her
14professional judgment of available criteria pertinent to any
15given subject area or activity for which he or she is
16responsible. District policy shall provide the procedure and
17reasons by and for which a grade may be changed; provided that
18no grade or evaluation shall be changed without notification to
19the teacher concerning the nature and reasons for such change.
20If such a change is made, the person making the change shall
21assume such responsibility for determining the grade or
22evaluation, and shall initial such change.
23    (b) School districts shall not promote students to the next
24higher grade level based upon age or any other social reasons
25not related to the academic performance of the students. School

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 76 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1On or before September 1, 1998, school boards shall adopt and
2enforce a policy on promotion as they deem necessary to ensure
3that students meet local goals and objectives and can perform
4at the expected grade level prior to promotion. Decisions to
5promote or retain students in any classes shall be based on
6successful completion of the curriculum, attendance,
7performance based on the assessments required under Section
82-3.64a-5 of this Code, the Iowa Test of Basic Skills, or other
9testing, or any other criteria established by the school board.
10Students determined by the local district to not qualify for
11promotion to the next higher grade shall be provided remedial
12assistance, which may include, but shall not be limited to, a
13summer bridge program of no less than 90 hours, tutorial
14sessions, increased or concentrated instructional time,
15modifications to instructional materials, and retention in
16grade. This subsection (b) is subject to Section 10-20.9b.
17(Source: P.A. 98-972, eff. 8-15-14.)
 
18    (105 ILCS 5/10-20.9b new)
19    Sec. 10-20.9b. Reading and math intervention and support.
20    (a) A school board must notify, in writing, the parent or
21guardian of a student in any of grades kindergarten through 3
22who exhibits a deficiency in reading or math skills at any time
23during the school year no later than 30 days after the
24identification of the deficiency in reading or math. The
25written notification provided to the parent or guardian of the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 77 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1student must include all of the following:
2        (1) Notification that the student has been identified
3    as having a deficiency in reading or math and that
4    additional support will be provided to the student.
5        (2) A description of the current services that are
6    provided to the student.
7        (3) A description of the proposed evidence-based
8    reading or math intervention services and supplemental
9    instructional services and support that will be provided to
10    the student and that are designed to remedy the identified
11    areas of deficiency in reading or math.
12        (4) Notification that the parent or guardian will be
13    informed in writing of the student's progress toward
14    grade-level reading or math with each progress report or
15    report card.
16        (5) Strategies for the parent or guardian to use at
17    home to help the student succeed in reading or math.
18        (6) Notification that if the student's deficiency in
19    reading or math is not corrected by the end of grade 3, the
20    school will provide the student with intensive
21    intervention and progress monitoring if the student is
22    promoted to grade 4.
23    (b) Beginning with the 2022-2023 school year, a school
24district must provide to any student retained in a grade
25intensive reading or math intervention to remedy the student's
26specific deficiency in reading or math. The reading or math

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 78 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1intervention services must include effective instructional
2strategies to accelerate student progress. The school district
3may provide any of the following services to the retained
4student:
5        (1) A highly effective teacher of reading or math, as
6    demonstrated by student reading or math performance data
7    and teacher performance evaluations.
8        (2) The use of reading or math intervention services
9    and support to correct the identified areas of deficiency
10    in reading or math, which include, but are not limited to:
11            (A) dedicating more time than in the previous
12        school year to providing to the student evidence-based
13        reading or math instruction and intervention;
14            (B) using reading or math strategies or programs
15        that are evidence-based and have proven results for
16        accelerating student reading or math achievement
17        within the same school year;
18            (C) daily targeted small group reading or math
19        intervention based on student needs;
20            (D) explicit and systematic instruction with more
21        detailed explanations, more extensive opportunities
22        for guided practice, and more opportunities for error
23        correction and feedback; and
24            (E) frequent monitoring of the reading or math
25        progress of the student's reading or math skills
26        throughout the school year and the adjustment of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 79 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        instruction according to the student's needs.
2        (3) Before-school or after-school supplemental
3    evidence-based reading or math intervention delivered by a
4    teacher or tutor with specialized training in reading or
5    math instruction.
6        (4) An at-home plan outlined in a parental contract
7    that includes participation in parent-training workshops
8    or regular parent-guided reading or math activities.
9    (c) On or before October 1 of each year, a school board
10must report, in writing, to the State Board of Education all of
11the following information for the prior school year, by grade
12and disaggregated by demographic group if applicable:
13        (1) The school board's policies and procedures on
14    student grade-level retention and promotion.
15        (2) The number of students who were administered a
16    universal screener, as defined in Section 10-20.73, during
17    the school year.
18        (3) The number of students who were administered a
19    Level I dyslexia screening, as defined in Section 10-20.73.
20        (4) The total number of students identified as having
21    the characteristics of dyslexia during that school year.
22        (5) The number of students receiving reading or math
23    intervention services, including those receiving dyslexia
24    intervention services, under this Section.
25        (6) The number and percentage of all students in
26    kindergarten through grade 3 performing below grade level

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 80 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    on local and statewide assessments.
2        (7) By grade and disaggregated by demographic group,
3    the number and percentage of all students retained in
4    kindergarten through grade 3.
5    (d) The State Board of Education shall provide technical
6assistance to aid school boards in implementing this Section.
 
7    (105 ILCS 5/10-20.73 new)
8    Sec. 10-20.73. Dyslexia screening and support.
9    (a) In this Section:
10    "Level I dyslexia screening" means a process, as determined
11by a school district, for gathering additional information to
12determine if the characteristics of dyslexia are present.
13    "Universal screener" means an assessment used to aid
14educators in understanding the causes for student performance,
15learning strengths, and the needs that underlie student
16performance. The assessment is conducted with all students at a
17particular grade level.
18    (b) Beginning with the 2022-2023 school year, a school
19district must screen students in the first and second grades
20for the risk factors of dyslexia using a universal screener
21appropriately designed for the educational context. Following
22the administration of the universal screener, if a student is
23determined to be at risk or at some risk for dyslexia, the
24school district must administer a Level I dyslexia screening of
25the student. Through the Level I dyslexia screening, the school

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 81 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1district must gather additional information to determine if the
2student has the characteristics of dyslexia. The additional
3information may include, but is not limited to, information
4from progress monitoring data, work samples, additional age and
5grade-appropriate assessments related to dyslexia, teacher
6questionnaires, parent interviews, and speech and language
7assessments and information regarding the student's family
8history related to dyslexia.
9    (c) If the universal screener or the Level I dyslexia
10screening indicates that a student has some risk factors for
11dyslexia or the characteristics of dyslexia, the school must
12use a multi-tiered system of support (MTSS) framework to
13address the needs of the student. A school district is not
14required to administer a Level I dyslexia screening to a
15student if the student is receiving dyslexia intervention
16services. If a student's performance on a Level I dyslexia
17screening indicates a need for dyslexia intervention services,
18the school district must notify the student's parent or
19guardian of the results of all screenings and provide to the
20parent or guardian, in addition to the information contained in
21the handbook developed under Section 2-3.161, all of the
22following information and resource material:
23        (1) The characteristics of dyslexia.
24        (2) The appropriate classroom interventions and
25    accommodations for students with dyslexia.
26        (3) A statement that the parent or guardian may elect

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 82 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    to have the student receive an educational evaluation by
2    the school.
3    (d) If the student's Level I dyslexia screening indicates
4that the student has the characteristics of dyslexia, the
5intervention services provided to the student pursuant to
6Section 10-20.9b must be implemented using diagnostic teaching
7guidelines described in the handbook developed under Section
82-3.161.
 
9    (105 ILCS 5/10-20.74 new)
10    Sec. 10-20.74. Evidence-based reading instruction. By no
11later than the beginning of the 2023-2024 school year, the
12school board of each school district that maintains grades
13kindergarten through 3 shall develop a plan to ensure that
14within 3 school years all classroom teachers, resource
15teachers, and reading interventionists who work with students
16in grades kindergarten through 3 receive professional
17development, in-service training, or coaching in
18evidence-based reading instruction that has a focus on reading
19competency in the areas of phonemic awareness.
20    A teacher who provides satisfactory evidence to the school
21board that he or she has previously received explicit and
22repeated instruction in each of the 5 essential components of
23reading, which are phonemic awareness, phonics, fluency,
24comprehension, and vocabulary, through an educator preparation
25program or other accredited training program is exempt from the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 83 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1requirements of this Section.
 
2    (105 ILCS 5/10-20.75 new)
3    Sec. 10-20.75. Early reading instruction. Each school
4district that maintains grades kindergarten through 3 shall
5provide students with instructional programming and services
6necessary to ensure, to the greatest extent possible, that as a
7student progresses from kindergarten through grade 3, the
8student develops the necessary reading skills to enable him or
9her to master the academic standards and expectations
10applicable to grade 4 and higher grade levels. The
11instructional programming and services for teaching students
12to read must be evidence-based and must focus on reading
13competency in the areas of phonemic awareness, phonics,
14vocabulary development, fluency, and comprehension.
 
15    (105 ILCS 5/21B-20)
16    Sec. 21B-20. Types of licenses. The State Board of
17Education shall implement a system of educator licensure,
18whereby individuals employed in school districts who are
19required to be licensed must have one of the following
20licenses: (i) a professional educator license; (ii) an educator
21license with stipulations; (iii) a substitute teaching
22license; or (iv) until June 30, 2023, a short-term substitute
23teaching license. References in law regarding individuals
24certified or certificated or required to be certified or

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 84 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1certificated under Article 21 of this Code shall also include
2individuals licensed or required to be licensed under this
3Article. The first year of all licenses ends on June 30
4following one full year of the license being issued.
5    The State Board of Education, in consultation with the
6State Educator Preparation and Licensure Board, may adopt such
7rules as may be necessary to govern the requirements for
8licenses and endorsements under this Section.
9        (1) Professional Educator License. Persons who (i)
10    have successfully completed an approved educator
11    preparation program and are recommended for licensure by
12    the Illinois institution offering the educator preparation
13    program, (ii) have successfully completed the required
14    testing under Section 21B-30 of this Code, (iii) have
15    successfully completed coursework on the psychology of,
16    the identification of, and the methods of instruction for
17    the exceptional child, including without limitation
18    children with learning disabilities, (iv) have
19    successfully completed coursework in methods of reading
20    and reading in the content area, and, beginning on July 1,
21    2024, have successfully completed and received explicit
22    and repeated instruction in each of the 5 essential
23    components of reading, which are phonemic awareness,
24    phonics, fluency, comprehension, and vocabulary, and (v)
25    have met all other criteria established by rule of the
26    State Board of Education shall be issued a Professional

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 85 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Educator License. All Professional Educator Licenses are
2    valid until June 30 immediately following 5 years of the
3    license being issued. The Professional Educator License
4    shall be endorsed with specific areas and grade levels in
5    which the individual is eligible to practice. For an early
6    childhood education endorsement, an individual may satisfy
7    the student teaching requirement of his or her early
8    childhood teacher preparation program through placement in
9    a setting with children from birth through grade 2, and the
10    individual may be paid and receive credit while student
11    teaching. The student teaching experience must meet the
12    requirements of and be approved by the individual's early
13    childhood teacher preparation program.
14        Individuals can receive subsequent endorsements on the
15    Professional Educator License. Subsequent endorsements
16    shall require a minimum of 24 semester hours of coursework
17    in the endorsement area and passage of the applicable
18    content area test, unless otherwise specified by rule.
19        (2) Educator License with Stipulations. An Educator
20    License with Stipulations shall be issued an endorsement
21    that limits the license holder to one particular position
22    or does not require completion of an approved educator
23    program or both.
24        An individual with an Educator License with
25    Stipulations must not be employed by a school district or
26    any other entity to replace any presently employed teacher

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 86 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    who otherwise would not be replaced for any reason.
2        An Educator License with Stipulations may be issued
3    with the following endorsements:
4            (A) (Blank).
5            (B) Alternative provisional educator. An
6        alternative provisional educator endorsement on an
7        Educator License with Stipulations may be issued to an
8        applicant who, at the time of applying for the
9        endorsement, has done all of the following:
10                (i) Graduated from a regionally accredited
11            college or university with a minimum of a
12            bachelor's degree.
13                (ii) Successfully completed the first phase of
14            the Alternative Educator Licensure Program for
15            Teachers, as described in Section 21B-50 of this
16            Code.
17                (iii) Passed a content area test, as required
18            under Section 21B-30 of this Code.
19        The alternative provisional educator endorsement is
20    valid for 2 years of teaching and may be renewed for a
21    third year by an individual meeting the requirements set
22    forth in Section 21B-50 of this Code.
23            (C) Alternative provisional superintendent. An
24        alternative provisional superintendent endorsement on
25        an Educator License with Stipulations entitles the
26        holder to serve only as a superintendent or assistant

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 87 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        superintendent in a school district's central office.
2        This endorsement may only be issued to an applicant
3        who, at the time of applying for the endorsement, has
4        done all of the following:
5                (i) Graduated from a regionally accredited
6            college or university with a minimum of a master's
7            degree in a management field other than education.
8                (ii) Been employed for a period of at least 5
9            years in a management level position in a field
10            other than education.
11                (iii) Successfully completed the first phase
12            of an alternative route to superintendent
13            endorsement program, as provided in Section 21B-55
14            of this Code.
15                (iv) Passed a content area test required under
16            Section 21B-30 of this Code.
17            The endorsement is valid for 2 fiscal years in
18        order to complete one full year of serving as a
19        superintendent or assistant superintendent.
20            (D) (Blank).
21            (E) Career and technical educator. A career and
22        technical educator endorsement on an Educator License
23        with Stipulations may be issued to an applicant who has
24        a minimum of 60 semester hours of coursework from a
25        regionally accredited institution of higher education
26        or an accredited trade and technical institution and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 88 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        has a minimum of 2,000 hours of experience outside of
2        education in each area to be taught.
3            The career and technical educator endorsement on
4        an Educator License with Stipulations is valid until
5        June 30 immediately following 5 years of the
6        endorsement being issued and may be renewed.
7            An individual who holds a valid career and
8        technical educator endorsement on an Educator License
9        with Stipulations but does not hold a bachelor's degree
10        may substitute teach in career and technical education
11        classrooms.
12            (F) Part-time provisional career and technical
13        educator or provisional career and technical educator.
14        A part-time provisional career and technical educator
15        endorsement or a provisional career and technical
16        educator endorsement on an Educator License with
17        Stipulations may be issued to an applicant who has a
18        minimum of 8,000 hours of work experience in the skill
19        for which the applicant is seeking the endorsement. It
20        is the responsibility of each employing school board
21        and regional office of education to provide
22        verification, in writing, to the State Superintendent
23        of Education at the time the application is submitted
24        that no qualified teacher holding a Professional
25        Educator License or an Educator License with
26        Stipulations with a career and technical educator

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 89 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        endorsement is available and that actual circumstances
2        require such issuance.
3            The provisional career and technical educator
4        endorsement on an Educator License with Stipulations
5        is valid until June 30 immediately following 5 years of
6        the endorsement being issued and may be renewed for 5
7        years.
8            A part-time provisional career and technical
9        educator endorsement on an Educator License with
10        Stipulations may be issued for teaching no more than 2
11        courses of study for grades 6 through 12. The part-time
12        provisional career and technical educator endorsement
13        on an Educator License with Stipulations is valid until
14        June 30 immediately following 5 years of the
15        endorsement being issued and may be renewed for 5 years
16        if the individual makes application for renewal.
17            An individual who holds a provisional or part-time
18        provisional career and technical educator endorsement
19        on an Educator License with Stipulations but does not
20        hold a bachelor's degree may substitute teach in career
21        and technical education classrooms.
22            (G) Transitional bilingual educator. A
23        transitional bilingual educator endorsement on an
24        Educator License with Stipulations may be issued for
25        the purpose of providing instruction in accordance
26        with Article 14C of this Code to an applicant who

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 90 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        provides satisfactory evidence that he or she meets all
2        of the following requirements:
3                (i) Possesses adequate speaking, reading, and
4            writing ability in the language other than English
5            in which transitional bilingual education is
6            offered.
7                (ii) Has the ability to successfully
8            communicate in English.
9                (iii) Either possessed, within 5 years
10            previous to his or her applying for a transitional
11            bilingual educator endorsement, a valid and
12            comparable teaching certificate or comparable
13            authorization issued by a foreign country or holds
14            a degree from an institution of higher learning in
15            a foreign country that the State Educator
16            Preparation and Licensure Board determines to be
17            the equivalent of a bachelor's degree from a
18            regionally accredited institution of higher
19            learning in the United States.
20            A transitional bilingual educator endorsement
21        shall be valid for prekindergarten through grade 12, is
22        valid until June 30 immediately following 5 years of
23        the endorsement being issued, and shall not be renewed.
24            Persons holding a transitional bilingual educator
25        endorsement shall not be employed to replace any
26        presently employed teacher who otherwise would not be

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 91 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        replaced for any reason.
2            (H) Language endorsement. In an effort to
3        alleviate the shortage of teachers speaking a language
4        other than English in the public schools, an individual
5        who holds an Educator License with Stipulations may
6        also apply for a language endorsement, provided that
7        the applicant provides satisfactory evidence that he
8        or she meets all of the following requirements:
9                (i) Holds a transitional bilingual
10            endorsement.
11                (ii) Has demonstrated proficiency in the
12            language for which the endorsement is to be issued
13            by passing the applicable language content test
14            required by the State Board of Education.
15                (iii) Holds a bachelor's degree or higher from
16            a regionally accredited institution of higher
17            education or, for individuals educated in a
18            country other than the United States, holds a
19            degree from an institution of higher learning in a
20            foreign country that the State Educator
21            Preparation and Licensure Board determines to be
22            the equivalent of a bachelor's degree from a
23            regionally accredited institution of higher
24            learning in the United States.
25                (iv) (Blank).
26            A language endorsement on an Educator License with

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 92 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        Stipulations is valid for prekindergarten through
2        grade 12 for the same validity period as the
3        individual's transitional bilingual educator
4        endorsement on the Educator License with Stipulations
5        and shall not be renewed.
6            (I) Visiting international educator. A visiting
7        international educator endorsement on an Educator
8        License with Stipulations may be issued to an
9        individual who is being recruited by a particular
10        school district that conducts formal recruitment
11        programs outside of the United States to secure the
12        services of qualified teachers and who meets all of the
13        following requirements:
14                (i) Holds the equivalent of a minimum of a
15            bachelor's degree issued in the United States.
16                (ii) Has been prepared as a teacher at the
17            grade level for which he or she will be employed.
18                (iii) Has adequate content knowledge in the
19            subject to be taught.
20                (iv) Has an adequate command of the English
21            language.
22            A holder of a visiting international educator
23        endorsement on an Educator License with Stipulations
24        shall be permitted to teach in bilingual education
25        programs in the language that was the medium of
26        instruction in his or her teacher preparation program,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 93 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        provided that he or she passes the English Language
2        Proficiency Examination or another test of writing
3        skills in English identified by the State Board of
4        Education, in consultation with the State Educator
5        Preparation and Licensure Board.
6            A visiting international educator endorsement on
7        an Educator License with Stipulations is valid for 5
8        years and shall not be renewed.
9            (J) Paraprofessional educator. A paraprofessional
10        educator endorsement on an Educator License with
11        Stipulations may be issued to an applicant who holds a
12        high school diploma or its recognized equivalent and
13        either holds an associate's degree or a minimum of 60
14        semester hours of credit from a regionally accredited
15        institution of higher education or has passed a
16        paraprofessional competency test under subsection
17        (c-5) of Section 21B-30. The paraprofessional educator
18        endorsement is valid until June 30 immediately
19        following 5 years of the endorsement being issued and
20        may be renewed through application and payment of the
21        appropriate fee, as required under Section 21B-40 of
22        this Code. An individual who holds only a
23        paraprofessional educator endorsement is not subject
24        to additional requirements in order to renew the
25        endorsement.
26            (K) Chief school business official. A chief school

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 94 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        business official endorsement on an Educator License
2        with Stipulations may be issued to an applicant who
3        qualifies by having a master's degree or higher, 2
4        years of full-time administrative experience in school
5        business management or 2 years of university-approved
6        practical experience, and a minimum of 24 semester
7        hours of graduate credit in a program approved by the
8        State Board of Education for the preparation of school
9        business administrators and by passage of the
10        applicable State tests, including an applicable
11        content area test.
12            The chief school business official endorsement may
13        also be affixed to the Educator License with
14        Stipulations of any holder who qualifies by having a
15        master's degree in business administration, finance,
16        accounting, or public administration and who completes
17        an additional 6 semester hours of internship in school
18        business management from a regionally accredited
19        institution of higher education and passes the
20        applicable State tests, including an applicable
21        content area test. This endorsement shall be required
22        for any individual employed as a chief school business
23        official.
24            The chief school business official endorsement on
25        an Educator License with Stipulations is valid until
26        June 30 immediately following 5 years of the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 95 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        endorsement being issued and may be renewed if the
2        license holder completes renewal requirements as
3        required for individuals who hold a Professional
4        Educator License endorsed for chief school business
5        official under Section 21B-45 of this Code and such
6        rules as may be adopted by the State Board of
7        Education.
8            The State Board of Education shall adopt any rules
9        necessary to implement Public Act 100-288.
10            (L) Provisional in-state educator. A provisional
11        in-state educator endorsement on an Educator License
12        with Stipulations may be issued to a candidate who has
13        completed an Illinois-approved educator preparation
14        program at an Illinois institution of higher education
15        and who has not successfully completed an
16        evidence-based assessment of teacher effectiveness but
17        who meets all of the following requirements:
18                (i) Holds at least a bachelor's degree.
19                (ii) Has completed an approved educator
20            preparation program at an Illinois institution.
21                (iii) Has passed an applicable content area
22            test, as required by Section 21B-30 of this Code.
23                (iv) Has attempted an evidence-based
24            assessment of teacher effectiveness and received a
25            minimum score on that assessment, as established
26            by the State Board of Education in consultation

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 96 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            with the State Educator Preparation and Licensure
2            Board.
3            A provisional in-state educator endorsement on an
4        Educator License with Stipulations is valid for one
5        full fiscal year after the date of issuance and may not
6        be renewed.
7            (M) (Blank).
8            (N) Specialized services. A specialized services
9        endorsement on an Educator License with Stipulations
10        may be issued as defined and specified by rule.
11        (3) Substitute Teaching License. A Substitute Teaching
12    License may be issued to qualified applicants for
13    substitute teaching in all grades of the public schools,
14    prekindergarten through grade 12. Substitute Teaching
15    Licenses are not eligible for endorsements. Applicants for
16    a Substitute Teaching License must hold a bachelor's degree
17    or higher from a regionally accredited institution of
18    higher education.
19        Substitute Teaching Licenses are valid for 5 years.
20        Substitute Teaching Licenses are valid for substitute
21    teaching in every county of this State. If an individual
22    has had his or her Professional Educator License or
23    Educator License with Stipulations suspended or revoked,
24    then that individual is not eligible to obtain a Substitute
25    Teaching License.
26        A substitute teacher may only teach in the place of a

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 97 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    licensed teacher who is under contract with the employing
2    board. If, however, there is no licensed teacher under
3    contract because of an emergency situation, then a district
4    may employ a substitute teacher for no longer than 30
5    calendar days per each vacant position in the district if
6    the district notifies the appropriate regional office of
7    education within 5 business days after the employment of
8    the substitute teacher in the emergency situation. An
9    emergency situation is one in which an unforeseen vacancy
10    has occurred and (i) a teacher is unable to fulfill his or
11    her contractual duties or (ii) teacher capacity needs of
12    the district exceed previous indications, and the district
13    is actively engaged in advertising to hire a fully licensed
14    teacher for the vacant position.
15        There is no limit on the number of days that a
16    substitute teacher may teach in a single school district,
17    provided that no substitute teacher may teach for longer
18    than 90 school days for any one licensed teacher under
19    contract in the same school year. A substitute teacher who
20    holds a Professional Educator License or Educator License
21    with Stipulations shall not teach for more than 120 school
22    days for any one licensed teacher under contract in the
23    same school year. The limitations in this paragraph (3) on
24    the number of days a substitute teacher may be employed do
25    not apply to any school district operating under Article 34
26    of this Code.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 98 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        A school district may not require an individual who
2    holds a valid Professional Educator License or Educator
3    License with Stipulations to seek or hold a Substitute
4    Teaching License to teach as a substitute teacher.
5        (4) Short-Term Substitute Teaching License. Beginning
6    on July 1, 2018 and until June 30, 2023, the State Board of
7    Education may issue a Short-Term Substitute Teaching
8    License. A Short-Term Substitute Teaching License may be
9    issued to a qualified applicant for substitute teaching in
10    all grades of the public schools, prekindergarten through
11    grade 12. Short-Term Substitute Teaching Licenses are not
12    eligible for endorsements. Applicants for a Short-Term
13    Substitute Teaching License must hold an associate's
14    degree or have completed at least 60 credit hours from a
15    regionally accredited institution of higher education.
16        Short-Term Substitute Teaching Licenses are valid for
17    substitute teaching in every county of this State. If an
18    individual has had his or her Professional Educator License
19    or Educator License with Stipulations suspended or
20    revoked, then that individual is not eligible to obtain a
21    Short-Term Substitute Teaching License.
22        The provisions of Sections 10-21.9 and 34-18.5 of this
23    Code apply to short-term substitute teachers.
24        An individual holding a Short-Term Substitute Teaching
25    License may teach no more than 5 consecutive days per
26    licensed teacher who is under contract. For teacher

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 99 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    absences lasting 6 or more days per licensed teacher who is
2    under contract, a school district may not hire an
3    individual holding a Short-Term Substitute Teaching
4    License. An individual holding a Short-Term Substitute
5    Teaching License must complete the training program under
6    Section 10-20.67 or 34-18.60 of this Code to be eligible to
7    teach at a public school. This paragraph (4) is inoperative
8    on and after July 1, 2023.
9(Source: P.A. 100-8, eff. 7-1-17; 100-13, eff. 7-1-17; 100-288,
10eff. 8-24-17; 100-596, eff. 7-1-18; 100-821, eff. 9-3-18;
11100-863, eff. 8-14-18; 101-81, eff. 7-12-19; 101-220, eff.
128-7-19; 101-594, eff. 12-5-19; 101-643, eff. 6-18-20.)
 
13    (105 ILCS 5/21B-35)
14    Sec. 21B-35. Minimum requirements for educators trained in
15other states or countries.
16    (a) Any applicant who has not been entitled by an
17Illinois-approved educator preparation program at an Illinois
18institution of higher education applying for a Professional
19Educator License endorsed in a teaching field or school support
20personnel area must meet the following requirements:
21        (1) the applicant must:
22            (A) hold a comparable and valid educator license or
23        certificate, as defined by rule, with similar grade
24        level and content area credentials from another state,
25        with the State Board of Education having the authority

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 100 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        to determine what constitutes similar grade level and
2        content area credentials from another state;
3            (B) have a bachelor's degree from a regionally
4        accredited institution of higher education; and
5            (C) have demonstrated proficiency in the English
6        language by either passing the English language
7        proficiency test required by the State Board of
8        Education or providing evidence of completing a
9        postsecondary degree at an institution in which the
10        mode of instruction was English; or
11        (2) the applicant must:
12            (A) have completed a state-approved program for
13        the licensure area sought, including coursework
14        concerning methods of instruction of the exceptional
15        child, methods of reading and reading in the content
16        area, and instructional strategies for English
17        learners, and, beginning on July 1, 2024, have
18        completed and received explicit and repeated
19        instruction in each of the 5 essential components of
20        reading, which are phonemic awareness, phonics,
21        fluency, comprehension, and vocabulary;
22            (B) have a bachelor's degree from a regionally
23        accredited institution of higher education;
24            (C) have successfully met all Illinois examination
25        requirements, except that:
26                (i) (blank);

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 101 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1                (ii) an applicant who has successfully
2            completed a test of content, as defined by rules,
3            at the time of initial licensure in another state
4            is not required to complete a test of content; and
5                (iii) an applicant for a teaching endorsement
6            who has successfully completed an evidence-based
7            assessment of teacher effectiveness, as defined by
8            rules, at the time of initial licensure in another
9            state is not required to complete an
10            evidence-based assessment of teacher
11            effectiveness; and
12            (D) for an applicant for a teaching endorsement,
13        have completed student teaching or an equivalent
14        experience or, for an applicant for a school service
15        personnel endorsement, have completed an internship or
16        an equivalent experience.
17    (b) In order to receive a Professional Educator License
18endorsed in a teaching field or school support personnel area,
19applicants trained in another country must meet all of the
20following requirements:
21        (1) Have completed a comparable education program in
22    another country.
23        (2) Have had transcripts evaluated by an evaluation
24    service approved by the State Superintendent of Education.
25        (3) Have a degree comparable to a degree from a
26    regionally accredited institution of higher education.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 102 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (4) Have completed coursework aligned to standards
2    concerning methods of instruction of the exceptional
3    child, methods of reading and reading in the content area,
4    and instructional strategies for English learners.
5        (5) (Blank).
6        (6) (Blank).
7        (7) Have successfully met all State licensure
8    examination requirements. Applicants who have successfully
9    completed a test of content, as defined by rules, at the
10    time of initial licensure in another country shall not be
11    required to complete a test of content. Applicants for a
12    teaching endorsement who have successfully completed an
13    evidence-based assessment of teacher effectiveness, as
14    defined by rules, at the time of initial licensure in
15    another country shall not be required to complete an
16    evidence-based assessment of teacher effectiveness.
17        (8) Have completed student teaching or an equivalent
18    experience.
19        (9) Have demonstrated proficiency in the English
20    language by either passing the English language
21    proficiency test required by the State Board of Education
22    or providing evidence of completing a postsecondary degree
23    at an institution in which the mode of instruction was
24    English.
25    (b-5) All applicants who have not been entitled by an
26Illinois-approved educator preparation program at an Illinois

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 103 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1institution of higher education and applicants trained in
2another country applying for a Professional Educator License
3endorsed for principal or superintendent must hold a master's
4degree from a regionally accredited institution of higher
5education, pass the English language proficiency test required
6by the State Board of Education, and hold a comparable and
7valid educator license or certificate with similar grade level
8and subject matter credentials, with the State Board of
9Education having the authority to determine what constitutes
10similar grade level and subject matter credentials from another
11state, or must meet all of the following requirements:
12        (1) Have completed an educator preparation program
13    approved by another state or comparable educator program in
14    another country leading to the receipt of a license or
15    certificate for the Illinois endorsement sought.
16        (2) Have successfully met all State licensure
17    examination requirements, as required by Section 21B-30 of
18    this Code. Applicants who have successfully completed a
19    test of content, as defined by rules, at the time of
20    initial licensure in another state or country shall not be
21    required to complete a test of content.
22        (2.5) Have completed an internship, as defined by rule.
23        (3) (Blank).
24        (4) Have completed coursework aligned to standards
25    concerning methods of instruction of the exceptional
26    child, methods of reading and reading in the content area,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 104 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    and instructional strategies for English learners and,
2    beginning on July 1, 2024, have completed and received
3    explicit and repeated instruction in each of the 5
4    essential components of reading, which are phonemic
5    awareness, phonics, fluency, comprehension, and
6    vocabulary.
7        (4.5) Have demonstrated proficiency in the English
8    language by either passing the English language
9    proficiency test required by the State Board of Education
10    or providing evidence of completing a postsecondary degree
11    at an institution in which the mode of instruction was
12    English.
13        (5) Have completed a master's degree.
14        (6) Have successfully completed teaching, school
15    support, or administrative experience as defined by rule.
16    (b-7) All applicants who have not been entitled by an
17Illinois-approved educator preparation program at an Illinois
18institution of higher education applying for a Professional
19Educator License endorsed for Director of Special Education
20must hold a master's degree from a regionally accredited
21institution of higher education and must hold a comparable and
22valid educator license or certificate with similar grade level
23and subject matter credentials, with the State Board of
24Education having the authority to determine what constitutes
25similar grade level and subject matter credentials from another
26state, or must meet all of the following requirements:

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 105 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (1) Have completed a master's degree.
2        (2) Have 2 years of full-time experience providing
3    special education services.
4        (3) Have successfully completed all examination
5    requirements, as required by Section 21B-30 of this Code.
6    Applicants who have successfully completed a test of
7    content, as identified by rules, at the time of initial
8    licensure in another state or country shall not be required
9    to complete a test of content.
10        (4) Have completed coursework aligned to standards
11    concerning methods of instruction of the exceptional
12    child, methods of reading and reading in the content area,
13    and instructional strategies for English learners.
14    (b-10) All applicants who have not been entitled by an
15Illinois-approved educator preparation program at an Illinois
16institution of higher education applying for a Professional
17Educator License endorsed for chief school business official
18must hold a master's degree from a regionally accredited
19institution of higher education and must hold a comparable and
20valid educator license or certificate with similar grade level
21and subject matter credentials, with the State Board of
22Education having the authority to determine what constitutes
23similar grade level and subject matter credentials from another
24state, or must meet all of the following requirements:
25        (1) Have completed a master's degree in school business
26    management, finance, or accounting.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 106 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (2) Have successfully completed an internship in
2    school business management or have 2 years of experience as
3    a school business administrator.
4        (3) Have successfully met all State examination
5    requirements, as required by Section 21B-30 of this Code.
6    Applicants who have successfully completed a test of
7    content, as identified by rules, at the time of initial
8    licensure in another state or country shall not be required
9    to complete a test of content.
10        (4) Have completed modules aligned to standards
11    concerning methods of instruction of the exceptional
12    child, methods of reading and reading in the content area,
13    and instructional strategies for English learners and,
14    beginning on July 1, 2024, have completed and received
15    explicit and repeated instruction in each of the 5
16    essential components of reading, which are phonemic
17    awareness, phonics, fluency, comprehension, and
18    vocabulary.
19    (c) The State Board of Education, in consultation with the
20State Educator Preparation and Licensure Board, may adopt such
21rules as may be necessary to implement this Section.
22(Source: P.A. 100-13, eff. 7-1-17; 100-584, eff. 4-6-18;
23100-596, eff. 7-1-18; 101-220, eff. 8-7-19; 101-643, eff.
246-18-20.)
 
25    (105 ILCS 5/34-18.51)

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 107 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Sec. 34-18.51. Committee on the retention of students.
2    (a) The board may create a committee on the retention of
3students. The committee shall consist of the general
4superintendent of schools or his or her designee, a district
5administrator who directs student instruction and curriculum,
6a principal from a school of the district, and a teacher from a
7school of the district.
8    (b) Prior to retention in a grade, a school may submit, by
9a date as set by the committee on the retention of students,
10the names of all students determined by the school to not
11qualify for promotion to the next higher grade and the reason
12for that determination. Subject to Section 34-18.51a, the The
13committee shall review the school's decision to retain with
14respect to each student and shall make a final decision
15regarding whether or not to retain a particular student. The
16committee shall take into consideration the relevant data and
17evidence gathered during the Response to Intervention process.
18The committee may vote to overturn a retention decision if the
19committee determines that the student should be promoted after
20examining the student's access to remedial assistance,
21performance, attendance, and participation and the resources
22and facilities provided by the school district or due to the
23student having an undiagnosed learning disability.
24(Source: P.A. 99-592, eff. 7-22-16; 100-201, eff. 8-18-17.)
 
25    (105 ILCS 5/34-18.51a new)

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 108 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Sec. 34-18.51a. Reading and math intervention and support.
2    (a) The board must notify, in writing, the parent or
3guardian of a student in any of grades kindergarten through 3
4who exhibits a deficiency in reading or math skills at any time
5during the school year no later than 30 days after the
6identification of the deficiency in reading or math. The
7written notification provided to the parent or guardian of the
8student must include all of the following:
9        (1) Notification that the student has been identified
10    as having a deficiency in reading or math and that
11    additional support will be provided to the student.
12        (2) A description of the current services that are
13    provided to the student.
14        (3) A description of the proposed evidence-based
15    reading or math intervention services and supplemental
16    instructional services and support that will be provided to
17    the student and that are designed to remedy the identified
18    areas of deficiency in reading or math.
19        (4) Notification that the parent or guardian will be
20    informed in writing of the student's progress toward
21    grade-level reading or math with each progress report or
22    report card.
23        (5) Strategies for the parent or guardian to use at
24    home to help the student succeed in reading or math.
25        (6) Notification that if the student's deficiency in
26    reading or math is not corrected by the end of grade 3, the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 109 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    school will provide the student with intensive
2    intervention and progress monitoring if the student is
3    promoted to grade 4.
4    (b) Beginning with the 2022-2023 school year, the school
5district must provide to any student retained in a grade
6intensive reading or math intervention to remedy the student's
7specific deficiency in reading or math. The reading or math
8intervention services must include effective instructional
9strategies to accelerate student progress. The school district
10may provide any of the following services to the retained
11student:
12        (1) A highly effective teacher of reading or math, as
13    demonstrated by student reading or math performance data
14    and teacher performance evaluations.
15        (2) The use of reading or math intervention services
16    and support to correct the identified areas of deficiency
17    in reading or math, which include, but are not limited to:
18            (A) dedicating more time than in the previous
19        school year to providing to the student evidence-based
20        reading or math instruction and intervention;
21            (B) using reading or math strategies or programs
22        that are evidence-based and have proven results for
23        accelerating student reading or math achievement
24        within the same school year;
25            (C) daily targeted small group reading or math
26        intervention based on student needs;

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 110 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (D) explicit and systematic instruction with more
2        detailed explanations, more extensive opportunities
3        for guided practice, and more opportunities for error
4        correction and feedback; and
5            (E) frequent monitoring of the reading or math
6        progress of the student's reading or math skills
7        throughout the school year and the adjustment of
8        instruction according to the student's needs.
9        (3) Before-school or after-school supplemental
10    evidence-based reading or math intervention delivered by a
11    teacher or tutor with specialized training in reading or
12    math instruction.
13        (4) An at-home plan outlined in a parental contract
14    that includes participation in parent-training workshops
15    or regular parent-guided reading or math activities.
16    (c) On or before October 1 of each year, the board must
17report, in writing, to the State Board of Education all of the
18following information for the prior school year, by grade and
19disaggregated by demographic group if applicable:
20        (1) The board's policies and procedures on student
21    grade-level retention and promotion.
22        (2) The number of students who were administered a
23    universal screener, as defined in Section 34-18.67, during
24    the school year.
25        (3) The number of students who were administered a
26    Level I dyslexia screening, as defined in Section 34-18.67.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 111 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (4) The total number of students identified as having
2    the characteristics of dyslexia during that school year.
3        (5) The number of students receiving reading or math
4    intervention services, including those receiving dyslexia
5    intervention services, under this Section.
6        (6) The number and percentage of all students in
7    kindergarten through grade 3 performing below grade level
8    on local and statewide assessments.
9        (7) By grade and disaggregated by demographic group,
10    the number and percentage of all students retained in
11    kindergarten through grade 3.
12    (d) The State Board of Education shall provide technical
13assistance to aid the board in implementing this Section.
 
14    (105 ILCS 5/34-18.67 new)
15    Sec. 34-18.67. Dyslexia screening and support.
16    (a) In this Section:
17    "Level I dyslexia screening" means a process, as determined
18by the school district, for gathering additional information to
19determine if the characteristics of dyslexia are present.
20    "Universal screener" means an assessment used to aid
21educators in understanding the causes for student performance,
22learning strengths, and the needs that underlie student
23performance. The assessment is conducted with all students at a
24particular grade level.
25    (b) Beginning with the 2022-2023 school year, the school

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 112 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1district must screen students in the first and second grades
2for the risk factors of dyslexia using a universal screener
3appropriately designed for the educational context. Following
4the administration of the universal screener, if a student is
5determined to be at risk or at some risk for dyslexia, the
6school district must administer a Level I dyslexia screening of
7the student. Through the Level I dyslexia screening, the school
8district must gather additional information to determine if the
9student has the characteristics of dyslexia. The additional
10information may include, but is not limited to, information
11from progress monitoring data, work samples, additional age and
12grade-appropriate assessments related to dyslexia, teacher
13questionnaires, parent interviews, and speech and language
14assessments and information regarding the student's family
15history related to dyslexia.
16    (c) If the universal screener or the Level I dyslexia
17screening indicates that a student has some risk factors for
18dyslexia or the characteristics of dyslexia, the school must
19use a multi-tiered system of support (MTSS) framework to
20address the needs of the student. The school district is not
21required to administer a Level I dyslexia screening to a
22student if the student is receiving dyslexia intervention
23services. If a student's performance on a Level I dyslexia
24screening indicates a need for dyslexia intervention services,
25the school district must notify the student's parent or
26guardian of the results of all screenings and provide to the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 113 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1parent or guardian, in addition to the information contained in
2the handbook developed under Section 2-3.161, all of the
3following information and resource material:
4        (1) The characteristics of dyslexia.
5        (2) The appropriate classroom interventions and
6    accommodations for students with dyslexia.
7        (3) A statement that the parent or guardian may elect
8    to have the student receive an educational evaluation by
9    the school.
10    (d) If the student's Level I dyslexia screening indicates
11that the student has the characteristics of dyslexia, the
12intervention services provided to the student pursuant to
13Section 34-18.51a must be implemented using diagnostic
14teaching guidelines described in the handbook developed under
15Section 2-3.161.
 
16    (105 ILCS 5/34-18.68 new)
17    Sec. 34-18.68. Evidence-based reading instruction. By no
18later than the beginning of the 2023-2024 school year, the
19board shall develop a plan to ensure that within 3 school years
20all classroom teachers, resource teachers, and reading
21interventionists who work with students in grades kindergarten
22through 3 receive professional development, in-service
23training, or coaching in evidence-based reading instruction
24that has a focus on reading competency in the areas of phonemic
25awareness.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 114 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    A teacher who provides satisfactory evidence to the board
2that he or she has previously received explicit and repeated
3instruction in each of the 5 essential components of reading,
4which are phonemic awareness, phonics, fluency, comprehension,
5and vocabulary, through an educator preparation program or
6other accredited training program is exempt from the
7requirements of this Section.
 
8    (105 ILCS 5/34-18.69 new)
9    Sec. 34-18.69. Early reading instruction. The school
10district shall provide students with instructional programming
11and services necessary to ensure, to the greatest extent
12possible, that as a student progresses from kindergarten
13through grade 3, the student develops the necessary reading
14skills to enable him or her to master the academic standards
15and expectations applicable to grade 4 and higher grade levels.
16The instructional programming and services for teaching
17students to read must be evidence-based and must focus on
18reading competency in the areas of phonemic awareness, phonics,
19vocabulary development, fluency, and comprehension.
 
20
Article 35.

 
21    Section 35-1. Short title. This Article may be cited as the
22Infant/Early Childhood Mental Health Consultations Act.
23References in this Article to "this Act" mean this Article.
 

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 115 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Section 35-5. Findings; policies.
2    (a) The General Assembly finds the following:
3        (1) Social and emotional development is a core
4    developmental domain in young children and is codified in
5    the Illinois Early Learning Standards.
6        (2) Fostering social and emotional development in
7    early childhood means both providing the supportive
8    settings and interactions to maximize healthy social and
9    emotional development for all children, as well as
10    providing communities, programs, and providers with
11    systems of tiered supports with training to respond to more
12    significant social and emotional challenges or where
13    experiences of trauma may be more prevalent.
14        (3) Early care and education programs and providers,
15    across a range of settings, have an important role to play
16    in supporting young children and families, especially
17    those who face greater challenges, such as trauma exposure,
18    social isolation, pervasive poverty, and toxic stress; if
19    programs, teaching staff, caregivers, and providers are
20    not provided with the support, services, and training
21    needed to accomplish these goals, it can lead to children
22    and families being asked to leave programs, particularly
23    without connection to more appropriate services, thereby
24    creating a disruption in learning and social-emotional
25    development; investments in reflective supervision,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 116 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    professional development specific to diversity, equity and
2    inclusion practice, culturally responsive training,
3    implicit bias training, and how trauma experienced during
4    the early years can manifest in challenging behaviors will
5    create systems for serving children that are informed in
6    developmentally appropriate and responsive supports.
7        (4) Studies have shown that the expulsion of infants,
8    toddlers, and young children in early care and education
9    settings is occurring at alarmingly high rates, more than 3
10    times that of students in K-12; further, expulsion occurs
11    more frequently for Black children and Latinx children and
12    more frequently for boys than for girls, with Black boys
13    being most frequently expelled; there is evidence to show
14    that the expulsion of Black girls is occurring with
15    increasing frequency.
16        (5) Illinois took its first steps toward addressing
17    this disparity through Public Act 100-105 to prohibit
18    expulsion due to child behavior in early care and education
19    settings, but further work is needed to implement this law,
20    including strengthening provider understanding of a
21    successful transition and beginning to identify strategies
22    to reduce "soft expulsions" and to ensure more young
23    children and their teachers, providers, and caregivers, in
24    a range of early care and education settings, can benefit
25    from services, such as Infant/Early Childhood Mental
26    Health Consultations (I/ECMHC) and positive behavior

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 117 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    interventions and supports such as the Pyramid Model.
2        (6) I/ECMHC is a critical component needed to align
3    social-emotional well-being with the public health model
4    of promotion, prevention, and intervention across early
5    care and education systems.
6    (b) The General Assembly encourages that all of the
7following actions be taken by:
8        (1) the State to increase the availability of
9    Infant/Early Childhood Mental Health Consultations
10    (I/ECMHC) through increased funding in early childhood
11    programs and sustainable funding for coordination of
12    I/ECMHC and other social and emotional support at the State
13    level;
14        (2) the Department of Human Services (IDHS), the
15    Illinois State Board of Education (ISBE), the Governor's
16    Office of Early Childhood Development (GOECD), and other
17    relevant agencies to develop and promote
18    provider-accessible and parent-accessible materials on the
19    role and value of I/ECMHC, including targeted promotion in
20    underserved communities, and promote the use of existing
21    I/ECMHCs, the I/ECMHC consultant database, or other
22    existing services;
23        (3) the State to increase funding to promote and
24    provide training and implementation support for systems of
25    tiered support, such as the Pyramid Model, across early
26    childhood settings and urge DHS, ISBE, GOECD, and other

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 118 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    relevant State agencies to coordinate efforts and develop
2    strategies to provide outreach to and support providers in
3    underserved communities and communities with fewer
4    programmatic resources; and
5        (4) ISBE and DCFS to provide the data required by
6    Public Act 100-105, even if the data is incomplete at the
7    time due to data system challenges.
 
8
Article 40.

 
9    Section 40-5. The Illinois Public Aid Code is amended by
10adding Section 5-39 as follows:
 
11    (305 ILCS 5/5-39 new)
12    Sec. 5-39. Behavioral health services for children;
13diagnostic assessment system. Beginning on July 1, 2022, if it
14is necessary to provide a diagnostic code for behavioral health
15services for children ages 5 and under, providers shall utilize
16a developmentally appropriate and age-appropriate diagnostic
17assessment system, such as the Diagnostic Classification of
18Mental Health and Developmental Disorders of Infancy and Early
19Childhood-Revised (DC:0-5), for diagnosis and treatment
20planning. If necessary for billing purposes, the provider,
21managed care organization, or Department shall utilize the
22existing crosswalk tool to convert the developmentally
23appropriate and age-appropriate diagnosis code to the relevant

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 119 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1code available in the State system.
2    By no later than July 1, 2021, the Department shall make
3recommendations to the General Assembly on the resources needed
4to integrate developmentally appropriate and age-appropriate
5diagnostic codes into the State system. The Department shall
6have in place all necessary resources needed to integrate
7developmentally appropriate and age-appropriate diagnostic
8codes by no later than January 1, 2023.
 
9
Article 45.

 
10    Section 45-1. Short title. This Article may be cited as the
11Early Childhood Workforce Act. References in this Article to
12"this Act" mean this Article.
 
13    Section 45-5. Findings; policies.
14    (a) The General Assembly finds the following:
15        (1) Research shows that early childhood teacher
16    effectiveness is a predictor for positive developmental
17    and academic outcomes for children.
18        (2) The work of early childhood educators is
19    sophisticated and central to the healthy learning and
20    development of young children and takes place in a range of
21    settings, including schools, community-based centers, and
22    homes.
23        (3) It is critically important for children's outcomes

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 120 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    to have educators that reflect the diversity of the
2    families and communities they serve.
3        (4) The early childhood workforce is more racially
4    diverse than the K-12 workforce, and its members hold
5    degrees, have earned credentials, and have years of
6    experience in the field.
7        (5) The early childhood workforce, particularly those
8    working in community-based settings and those working with
9    infants and toddlers, often are not paid wages aligned to
10    the sophistication of their work and level of education.
11        (6) All regions and settings have difficulty finding
12    qualified teachers.
13        (7) A disproportionate number of Black and Latinx women
14    serve in essential, frontline positions but are
15    underrepresented as lead teachers and in program
16    leadership where credentials and degrees are required.
17        (8) The early childhood workforce faces multiple
18    barriers to additional credential and degree attainment
19    that lead to career advancement and higher levels of
20    compensation.
21    (b) The General Assembly encourages all of the following:
22        (1) The Department of Human Services to undertake an
23    analysis of teacher data in the Gateways Registry to
24    determine those individuals who are close to their next
25    credential or degree, including information where
26    available in the Registry such as their geographic

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 121 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    location, demographics, work setting, and age groups of
2    children for whom they are responsible.
3        (2) The Department of Human Services to conduct
4    outreach and provide targeted coaching and access to
5    financial supports, including, but not limited to,
6    scholarships and debt relief, in a way that prioritizes
7    increasing the diversity of the teacher pipeline, regions
8    of the State with the highest need, and children in age
9    groups with the greatest teacher shortages.
10        (3) The State Board of Education to provide additional
11    financial support to candidates and provide this support to
12    all candidates regardless of the setting in which they work
13    and the credentials they are currently seeking,
14    prioritizing those by greatest need in the early childhood
15    field.
16        (4) The Department of Human Services to provide annual
17    reports on who receives these and other scholarships or
18    other financial support administered by the Department or
19    the State Board of Education by geographic location,
20    demographics, work setting, age groups of children served,
21    and credential/degree attainment as available.
22        (5) The Board of Higher Education, in the course of
23    their strategic planning process, to review the barriers
24    experienced by the early childhood workforce and by
25    teachers of color, in particular in accessing and
26    completing the needed coursework to attain additional

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 122 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    credentials and degrees, and to recommend policy or
2    practice changes to better meet the needs of this
3    workforce, which is largely comprised of non-traditional
4    students and women of color.
5        (6) The State Board of Education and the Department of
6    Human Services to prioritize reducing compensation
7    disparities between the early childhood workforce and
8    their K-12 counterparts and disparities within the early
9    childhood workforce between setting and age groups in which
10    they work, as funding becomes available.
 
11
Article 50.

 
12    Section 50-5. The School Code is amended by adding Section
132-3.183 and by changing Section 27-22 as follows:
 
14    (105 ILCS 5/2-3.183 new)
15    Sec. 2-3.183. Review of university admission coursework.
16    (a) On or before February 1, 2021 and each February 1
17thereafter, the State Board of Education and the Board of
18Higher Education shall jointly compile a review that
19identifies, for each public university in this State, the
20courses the university requires or recommends a high school
21student take to be admitted to the university as an
22undergraduate student. The review shall also include any
23additional coursework requirements or recommendations for

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 123 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1undergraduate admission into a specific academic major,
2college, or department of the university. The courses that are
3identified in the review as recommended must include, at a
4minimum, those courses that the university describes in its
5promotional materials as being recommended.
6    (b) The State Board of Education shall make the review
7compiled under subsection (a) available to the public on its
8Internet website.
9    (c) To ensure that a public high school student is not
10excluded from enrolling in a public university in this State
11because of a lack of access to required or recommended
12coursework, every public high school must provide access to
13each course identified in the review compiled under subsection
14(a) to any of its students who request to enroll in the course.
15If the high school is unable to offer the course through the
16school district, the high school must find an alternative way
17to offer the course to the student, which may include
18partnering with another school district, a community college
19district, or some other course provider, and the student's
20school district shall cover any portion of the cost of the
21course that is not covered by State or other public or private
22funding.
23    (d) To ensure that every public high school student
24understands the course expectations for admission into a public
25university in this State, a school district must make available
26to students in grades 8 through 12 and their parents or

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 124 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1guardians the review compiled under subsection (a) before the
2student's course schedule is finalized for the student's
3particular grade level.
4    (e) The State Board of Education may adopt any rules
5necessary to implement this Section.
 
6    (105 ILCS 5/27-22)  (from Ch. 122, par. 27-22)
7    Sec. 27-22. Required high school courses.
8    (a) (Blank).
9    (b) (Blank).
10    (c) (Blank).
11    (d) (Blank).
12    (e) Through the 2023-2024 school year, as As a prerequisite
13to receiving a high school diploma, each pupil entering the 9th
14grade must, in addition to other course requirements,
15successfully complete all of the following courses:
16        (1) Four years of language arts.
17        (2) Two years of writing intensive courses, one of
18    which must be English and the other of which may be English
19    or any other subject. When applicable, writing-intensive
20    courses may be counted towards the fulfillment of other
21    graduation requirements.
22        (3) Three years of mathematics, one of which must be
23    Algebra I, one of which must include geometry content, and
24    one of which may be an Advanced Placement computer science
25    course. A mathematics course that includes geometry

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 125 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    content may be offered as an integrated, applied,
2    interdisciplinary, or career and technical education
3    course that prepares a student for a career readiness path.
4        (4) Two years of science.
5        (5) Two years of social studies, of which at least one
6    year must be history of the United States or a combination
7    of history of the United States and American government
8    and, beginning with pupils entering the 9th grade in the
9    2016-2017 school year and each school year thereafter, at
10    least one semester must be civics, which shall help young
11    people acquire and learn to use the skills, knowledge, and
12    attitudes that will prepare them to be competent and
13    responsible citizens throughout their lives. Civics course
14    content shall focus on government institutions, the
15    discussion of current and controversial issues, service
16    learning, and simulations of the democratic process.
17    School districts may utilize private funding available for
18    the purposes of offering civics education.
19        (6) One year chosen from (A) music, (B) art, (C)
20    foreign language, which shall be deemed to include American
21    Sign Language, or (D) vocational education.
22    (e-5) Beginning with the 2024-2025 school year, as a
23prerequisite to receiving a high school diploma, each pupil
24entering the 9th grade must, in addition to other course
25requirements, successfully complete all of the following
26courses:

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 126 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (1) Four years of language arts.
2        (2) Two years of writing intensive courses, one of
3    which must be English and the other of which may be English
4    or any other subject. If applicable, writing-intensive
5    courses may be counted toward the fulfillment of other
6    graduation requirements.
7        (3) Three years of mathematics, one of which must be
8    Algebra I, one of which must include geometry content, and
9    one of which may be an Advanced Placement computer science
10    course. A mathematics course that includes geometry
11    content may be offered as an integrated, applied,
12    interdisciplinary, or career and technical education
13    course that prepares a student for a career readiness path.
14        (4) Two years of laboratory science.
15        (5) Two years of social studies, of which at least one
16    year must be history of the United States or a combination
17    of history of the United States and American government and
18    at least one semester must be civics, which shall help
19    young people acquire and learn to use the skills,
20    knowledge, and attitudes that will prepare them to be
21    competent and responsible citizens throughout their lives.
22    Civics course content shall focus on government
23    institutions, the discussion of current and controversial
24    issues, service learning, and simulations of the
25    democratic process. School districts may utilize private
26    funding available for the purposes of offering civics

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 127 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    education.
2        (6) Two years of foreign language, which shall be
3    deemed to include American Sign Language.
4        (7) One year chosen from (A) music, (B) art, (C)
5    foreign language that is in addition to the 2 years under
6    paragraph (6), which shall be deemed to include American
7    Sign Language, or (D) vocational education.
8    (f) The State Board of Education shall develop and inform
9school districts of standards for writing-intensive
10coursework.
11    (f-5) If a school district offers an Advanced Placement
12computer science course to high school students, then the
13school board must designate that course as equivalent to a high
14school mathematics course and must denote on the student's
15transcript that the Advanced Placement computer science course
16qualifies as a mathematics-based, quantitative course for
17students in accordance with subdivision (3) of subsection (e)
18of this Section.
19    (g) This amendatory Act of 1983 does not apply to pupils
20entering the 9th grade in 1983-1984 school year and prior
21school years or to students with disabilities whose course of
22study is determined by an individualized education program.
23    This amendatory Act of the 94th General Assembly does not
24apply to pupils entering the 9th grade in the 2004-2005 school
25year or a prior school year or to students with disabilities
26whose course of study is determined by an individualized

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 128 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1education program.
2    This amendatory Act of the 101st General Assembly does not
3apply to pupils entering the 9th grade in the 2023-2024 school
4year or a prior school year or to students with disabilities
5whose course of study is determined by an individualized
6education program.
7    (h) The provisions of this Section are subject to the
8provisions of Section 27-22.05 of this Code and the
9Postsecondary and Workforce Readiness Act.
10    (i) The State Board of Education may adopt rules to modify
11the requirements of this Section for any students enrolled in
12grades 9 through 12 if the Governor has declared a disaster due
13to a public health emergency pursuant to Section 7 of the
14Illinois Emergency Management Agency Act.
15(Source: P.A. 100-443, eff. 8-25-17; 101-464, eff. 1-1-20;
16101-643, eff. 6-18-20.)
 
17    Section 50-10. The Board of Higher Education Act is amended
18by adding Section 9.40 as follows:
 
19    (110 ILCS 205/9.40 new)
20    Sec. 9.40. Review of university admission coursework.
21    (a) On or before February 1, 2021 and each February 1
22thereafter, the State Board of Education and the Board of
23Higher Education shall jointly compile a review as provided
24under Section 2-3.183 of the School Code.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 129 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (b) The Board of Higher Education may adopt any rules
2necessary to implement this Section.
 
3
Article 55.

 
4    Section 55-5. The School Code is amended by adding Section
52-3.184 and by changing Section 18-8.15 as follows:
 
6    (105 ILCS 5/2-3.184 new)
7    Sec. 2-3.184. Approved anti-racism initiatives;
8anti-racism investment funding.
9    (a) In this Section, "approved anti-racism initiatives"
10means evidence-based or research-based practices approved by
11the State Board of Education that are shown to reduce the gaps
12and disparities experienced by African American students in
13academic achievement and educational performance and includes
14practices that have been shown to reduce disparities in
15disciplinary rates, drop-out rates, graduation rates, college
16matriculation rates, and college completion rates.
17    (b) No later than January 30, 2021, the State Board shall
18create a list of approved anti-racism initiatives that may be
19implemented by school districts to enhance the educational
20performance of African American students. Approved anti-racism
21initiatives may include, but are not limited to, all of the
22following:
23        (1) A reduction in class sizes in grades kindergarten

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 130 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    through 3.
2        (2) The implementation of culturally appropriate
3    curriculum and associated professional development.
4        (3) The implementation of project-based learning and
5    associated professional development.
6        (4) The implementation of a Universal Design for
7    Learning framework and associated professional
8    development.
9        (5) The implementation of research-based and on-going
10    professional development for school faculty,
11    administrators, and staff to identify and counter implicit
12    bias.
13    No later than January 30, 2021, the State Board shall make
14the list available to school districts by posting the list on
15the State Board's Internet website. No later than January 30th
16of each year thereafter, the State Board shall update the list
17and post the updated list on the State Board's Internet
18website.
19    (c) Funding received by a school district pursuant to
20subparagraph (Y) of paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of Section
2118-8.15 of this Code shall be utilized for the implementation
22of one or more approved anti-racism initiatives listed by the
23State Board under subsection (b) of this Section. However, a
24school district may utilize a specified amount of that funding
25for a purpose other than to implement one or more of the
26approved anti-racism initiatives if the school district, upon

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 131 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1application, obtains written consent from the State Board to
2utilize the specified amount for another purpose. The
3application for consent shall be in such form as the State
4Board prescribes. The State Board shall grant or deny consent
5within 60 days after receipt of the application. The granting
6or denial of consent shall be final, binding, and
7non-appealable.
8    (d) For each school year in which a school district
9receives funding pursuant to subparagraph (Y) of paragraph (2)
10of subsection (b) of Section 18-8.15 of this Code, the school
11district shall report to the State Board on how the school
12district utilized all of the funding it received under
13subparagraph (Y) of paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of Section
1418-8.15 of this Code. The report shall be in such form as the
15State Board prescribes on the State Board's website.
 
16    (105 ILCS 5/18-8.15)
17    Sec. 18-8.15. Evidence-Based Funding for student success
18for the 2017-2018 and subsequent school years.
19    (a) General provisions.
20        (1) The purpose of this Section is to ensure that, by
21    June 30, 2027 and beyond, this State has a kindergarten
22    through grade 12 public education system with the capacity
23    to ensure the educational development of all persons to the
24    limits of their capacities in accordance with Section 1 of
25    Article X of the Constitution of the State of Illinois. To

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 132 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    accomplish that objective, this Section creates a method of
2    funding public education that is evidence-based; is
3    sufficient to ensure every student receives a meaningful
4    opportunity to learn irrespective of race, ethnicity,
5    sexual orientation, gender, or community-income level; and
6    is sustainable and predictable. When fully funded under
7    this Section, every school shall have the resources, based
8    on what the evidence indicates is needed, to:
9            (A) provide all students with a high quality
10        education that offers the academic, enrichment, social
11        and emotional support, technical, and career-focused
12        programs that will allow them to become competitive
13        workers, responsible parents, productive citizens of
14        this State, and active members of our national
15        democracy;
16            (B) ensure all students receive the education they
17        need to graduate from high school with the skills
18        required to pursue post-secondary education and
19        training for a rewarding career;
20            (C) reduce, with a goal of eliminating, the
21        achievement gap between at-risk and non-at-risk
22        students by raising the performance of at-risk
23        students and not by reducing standards; and
24            (D) ensure this State satisfies its obligation to
25        assume the primary responsibility to fund public
26        education and simultaneously relieve the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 133 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        disproportionate burden placed on local property taxes
2        to fund schools.
3        (2) The Evidence-Based Funding formula under this
4    Section shall be applied to all Organizational Units in
5    this State. The Evidence-Based Funding formula outlined in
6    this Act is based on the formula outlined in Senate Bill 1
7    of the 100th General Assembly, as passed by both
8    legislative chambers. As further defined and described in
9    this Section, there are 4 major components of the
10    Evidence-Based Funding model:
11            (A) First, the model calculates a unique Adequacy
12        Target for each Organizational Unit in this State that
13        considers the costs to implement research-based
14        activities, the unit's student demographics, and
15        regional wage differences.
16            (B) Second, the model calculates each
17        Organizational Unit's Local Capacity, or the amount
18        each Organizational Unit is assumed to contribute
19        toward its Adequacy Target from local resources.
20            (C) Third, the model calculates how much funding
21        the State currently contributes to the Organizational
22        Unit and adds that to the unit's Local Capacity to
23        determine the unit's overall current adequacy of
24        funding.
25            (D) Finally, the model's distribution method
26        allocates new State funding to those Organizational

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 134 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        Units that are least well-funded, considering both
2        Local Capacity and State funding, in relation to their
3        Adequacy Target.
4        (3) An Organizational Unit receiving any funding under
5    this Section may apply those funds to any fund so received
6    for which that Organizational Unit is authorized to make
7    expenditures by law.
8        (4) As used in this Section, the following terms shall
9    have the meanings ascribed in this paragraph (4):
10        "Adequacy Target" is defined in paragraph (1) of
11    subsection (b) of this Section.
12        "Adjusted EAV" is defined in paragraph (4) of
13    subsection (d) of this Section.
14        "Adjusted Local Capacity Target" is defined in
15    paragraph (3) of subsection (c) of this Section.
16        "Adjusted Operating Tax Rate" means a tax rate for all
17    Organizational Units, for which the State Superintendent
18    shall calculate and subtract for the Operating Tax Rate a
19    transportation rate based on total expenses for
20    transportation services under this Code, as reported on the
21    most recent Annual Financial Report in Pupil
22    Transportation Services, function 2550 in both the
23    Education and Transportation funds and functions 4110 and
24    4120 in the Transportation fund, less any corresponding
25    fiscal year State of Illinois scheduled payments excluding
26    net adjustments for prior years for regular, vocational, or

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 135 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    special education transportation reimbursement pursuant to
2    Section 29-5 or subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of this
3    Code divided by the Adjusted EAV. If an Organizational
4    Unit's corresponding fiscal year State of Illinois
5    scheduled payments excluding net adjustments for prior
6    years for regular, vocational, or special education
7    transportation reimbursement pursuant to Section 29-5 or
8    subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of this Code exceed the
9    total transportation expenses, as defined in this
10    paragraph, no transportation rate shall be subtracted from
11    the Operating Tax Rate.
12        "Allocation Rate" is defined in paragraph (3) of
13    subsection (g) of this Section.
14        "Alternative School" means a public school that is
15    created and operated by a regional superintendent of
16    schools and approved by the State Board.
17        "Applicable Tax Rate" is defined in paragraph (1) of
18    subsection (d) of this Section.
19        "Assessment" means any of those benchmark, progress
20    monitoring, formative, diagnostic, and other assessments,
21    in addition to the State accountability assessment, that
22    assist teachers' needs in understanding the skills and
23    meeting the needs of the students they serve.
24        "Assistant principal" means a school administrator
25    duly endorsed to be employed as an assistant principal in
26    this State.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 136 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        "At-risk student" means a student who is at risk of not
2    meeting the Illinois Learning Standards or not graduating
3    from elementary or high school and who demonstrates a need
4    for vocational support or social services beyond that
5    provided by the regular school program. All students
6    included in an Organizational Unit's Low-Income Count, as
7    well as all English learner and disabled students attending
8    the Organizational Unit, shall be considered at-risk
9    students under this Section.
10        "Average Student Enrollment" or "ASE" for fiscal year
11    2018 means, for an Organizational Unit, the greater of the
12    average number of students (grades K through 12) reported
13    to the State Board as enrolled in the Organizational Unit
14    on October 1 in the immediately preceding school year, plus
15    the pre-kindergarten students who receive special
16    education services of 2 or more hours a day as reported to
17    the State Board on December 1 in the immediately preceding
18    school year, or the average number of students (grades K
19    through 12) reported to the State Board as enrolled in the
20    Organizational Unit on October 1, plus the
21    pre-kindergarten students who receive special education
22    services of 2 or more hours a day as reported to the State
23    Board on December 1, for each of the immediately preceding
24    3 school years. For fiscal year 2019 and each subsequent
25    fiscal year, "Average Student Enrollment" or "ASE" means,
26    for an Organizational Unit, the greater of the average

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 137 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    number of students (grades K through 12) reported to the
2    State Board as enrolled in the Organizational Unit on
3    October 1 and March 1 in the immediately preceding school
4    year, plus the pre-kindergarten students who receive
5    special education services as reported to the State Board
6    on October 1 and March 1 in the immediately preceding
7    school year, or the average number of students (grades K
8    through 12) reported to the State Board as enrolled in the
9    Organizational Unit on October 1 and March 1, plus the
10    pre-kindergarten students who receive special education
11    services as reported to the State Board on October 1 and
12    March 1, for each of the immediately preceding 3 school
13    years. For the purposes of this definition, "enrolled in
14    the Organizational Unit" means the number of students
15    reported to the State Board who are enrolled in schools
16    within the Organizational Unit that the student attends or
17    would attend if not placed or transferred to another school
18    or program to receive needed services. For the purposes of
19    calculating "ASE", all students, grades K through 12,
20    excluding those attending kindergarten for a half day and
21    students attending an alternative education program
22    operated by a regional office of education or intermediate
23    service center, shall be counted as 1.0. All students
24    attending kindergarten for a half day shall be counted as
25    0.5, unless in 2017 by June 15 or by March 1 in subsequent
26    years, the school district reports to the State Board of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 138 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Education the intent to implement full-day kindergarten
2    district-wide for all students, then all students
3    attending kindergarten shall be counted as 1.0. Special
4    education pre-kindergarten students shall be counted as
5    0.5 each. If the State Board does not collect or has not
6    collected both an October 1 and March 1 enrollment count by
7    grade or a December 1 collection of special education
8    pre-kindergarten students as of August 31, 2017 (the
9    effective date of Public Act 100-465), it shall establish
10    such collection for all future years. For any year in which
11    a count by grade level was collected only once, that count
12    shall be used as the single count available for computing a
13    3-year average ASE. Funding for programs operated by a
14    regional office of education or an intermediate service
15    center must be calculated using the Evidence-Based Funding
16    formula under this Section for the 2019-2020 school year
17    and each subsequent school year until separate adequacy
18    formulas are developed and adopted for each type of
19    program. ASE for a program operated by a regional office of
20    education or an intermediate service center must be
21    determined by the March 1 enrollment for the program. For
22    the 2019-2020 school year, the ASE used in the calculation
23    must be the first-year ASE and, in that year only, the
24    assignment of students served by a regional office of
25    education or intermediate service center shall not result
26    in a reduction of the March enrollment for any school

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 139 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    district. For the 2020-2021 school year, the ASE must be
2    the greater of the current-year ASE or the 2-year average
3    ASE. Beginning with the 2021-2022 school year, the ASE must
4    be the greater of the current-year ASE or the 3-year
5    average ASE. School districts shall submit the data for the
6    ASE calculation to the State Board within 45 days of the
7    dates required in this Section for submission of enrollment
8    data in order for it to be included in the ASE calculation.
9    For fiscal year 2018 only, the ASE calculation shall
10    include only enrollment taken on October 1.
11        "Base Funding Guarantee" is defined in paragraph (10)
12    of subsection (g) of this Section.
13        "Base Funding Minimum" is defined in subsection (e) of
14    this Section.
15        "Base Tax Year" means the property tax levy year used
16    to calculate the Budget Year allocation of primary State
17    aid.
18        "Base Tax Year's Extension" means the product of the
19    equalized assessed valuation utilized by the county clerk
20    in the Base Tax Year multiplied by the limiting rate as
21    calculated by the county clerk and defined in PTELL.
22        "Bilingual Education Allocation" means the amount of
23    an Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target
24    attributable to bilingual education divided by the
25    Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target, the product
26    of which shall be multiplied by the amount of new funding

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 140 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    received pursuant to this Section. An Organizational
2    Unit's final Adequacy Target attributable to bilingual
3    education shall include all additional investments in
4    English learner students' adequacy elements.
5        "Budget Year" means the school year for which primary
6    State aid is calculated and awarded under this Section.
7        "Central office" means individual administrators and
8    support service personnel charged with managing the
9    instructional programs, business and operations, and
10    security of the Organizational Unit.
11        "Comparable Wage Index" or "CWI" means a regional cost
12    differentiation metric that measures systemic, regional
13    variations in the salaries of college graduates who are not
14    educators. The CWI utilized for this Section shall, for the
15    first 3 years of Evidence-Based Funding implementation, be
16    the CWI initially developed by the National Center for
17    Education Statistics, as most recently updated by Texas A &
18    M University. In the fourth and subsequent years of
19    Evidence-Based Funding implementation, the State
20    Superintendent shall re-determine the CWI using a similar
21    methodology to that identified in the Texas A & M
22    University study, with adjustments made no less frequently
23    than once every 5 years.
24        "Computer technology and equipment" means computers
25    servers, notebooks, network equipment, copiers, printers,
26    instructional software, security software, curriculum

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 141 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    management courseware, and other similar materials and
2    equipment.
3        "Computer technology and equipment investment
4    allocation" means the final Adequacy Target amount of an
5    Organizational Unit assigned to Tier 1 or Tier 2 in the
6    prior school year attributable to the additional $285.50
7    per student computer technology and equipment investment
8    grant divided by the Organizational Unit's final Adequacy
9    Target, the result of which shall be multiplied by the
10    amount of new funding received pursuant to this Section. An
11    Organizational Unit assigned to a Tier 1 or Tier 2 final
12    Adequacy Target attributable to the received computer
13    technology and equipment investment grant shall include
14    all additional investments in computer technology and
15    equipment adequacy elements.
16        "Core subject" means mathematics; science; reading,
17    English, writing, and language arts; history and social
18    studies; world languages; and subjects taught as Advanced
19    Placement in high schools.
20        "Core teacher" means a regular classroom teacher in
21    elementary schools and teachers of a core subject in middle
22    and high schools.
23        "Core Intervention teacher (tutor)" means a licensed
24    teacher providing one-on-one or small group tutoring to
25    students struggling to meet proficiency in core subjects.
26        "CPPRT" means corporate personal property replacement

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 142 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    tax funds paid to an Organizational Unit during the
2    calendar year one year before the calendar year in which a
3    school year begins, pursuant to "An Act in relation to the
4    abolition of ad valorem personal property tax and the
5    replacement of revenues lost thereby, and amending and
6    repealing certain Acts and parts of Acts in connection
7    therewith", certified August 14, 1979, as amended (Public
8    Act 81-1st S.S.-1).
9        "EAV" means equalized assessed valuation as defined in
10    paragraph (2) of subsection (d) of this Section and
11    calculated in accordance with paragraph (3) of subsection
12    (d) of this Section.
13        "ECI" means the Bureau of Labor Statistics' national
14    employment cost index for civilian workers in educational
15    services in elementary and secondary schools on a
16    cumulative basis for the 12-month calendar year preceding
17    the fiscal year of the Evidence-Based Funding calculation.
18        "EIS Data" means the employment information system
19    data maintained by the State Board on educators within
20    Organizational Units.
21        "Employee benefits" means health, dental, and vision
22    insurance offered to employees of an Organizational Unit,
23    the costs associated with the statutorily required payment
24    of the normal cost of the Organizational Unit's teacher
25    pensions, Social Security employer contributions, and
26    Illinois Municipal Retirement Fund employer contributions.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 143 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        "English learner" or "EL" means a child included in the
2    definition of "English learners" under Section 14C-2 of
3    this Code participating in a program of transitional
4    bilingual education or a transitional program of
5    instruction meeting the requirements and program
6    application procedures of Article 14C of this Code. For the
7    purposes of collecting the number of EL students enrolled,
8    the same collection and calculation methodology as defined
9    above for "ASE" shall apply to English learners, with the
10    exception that EL student enrollment shall include
11    students in grades pre-kindergarten through 12.
12        "Essential Elements" means those elements, resources,
13    and educational programs that have been identified through
14    academic research as necessary to improve student success,
15    improve academic performance, close achievement gaps, and
16    provide for other per student costs related to the delivery
17    and leadership of the Organizational Unit, as well as the
18    maintenance and operations of the unit, and which are
19    specified in paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this
20    Section.
21        "Evidence-Based Funding" means State funding provided
22    to an Organizational Unit pursuant to this Section.
23        "Extended day" means academic and enrichment programs
24    provided to students outside the regular school day before
25    and after school or during non-instructional times during
26    the school day.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 144 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        "Extension Limitation Ratio" means a numerical ratio
2    in which the numerator is the Base Tax Year's Extension and
3    the denominator is the Preceding Tax Year's Extension.
4        "Final Percent of Adequacy" is defined in paragraph (4)
5    of subsection (f) of this Section.
6        "Final Resources" is defined in paragraph (3) of
7    subsection (f) of this Section.
8        "Full-time equivalent" or "FTE" means the full-time
9    equivalency compensation for staffing the relevant
10    position at an Organizational Unit.
11        "Funding Gap" is defined in paragraph (1) of subsection
12    (g).
13        "Guidance counselor" means a licensed guidance
14    counselor who provides guidance and counseling support for
15    students within an Organizational Unit.
16        "Hybrid District" means a partial elementary unit
17    district created pursuant to Article 11E of this Code.
18        "Instructional assistant" means a core or special
19    education, non-licensed employee who assists a teacher in
20    the classroom and provides academic support to students.
21        "Instructional facilitator" means a qualified teacher
22    or licensed teacher leader who facilitates and coaches
23    continuous improvement in classroom instruction; provides
24    instructional support to teachers in the elements of
25    research-based instruction or demonstrates the alignment
26    of instruction with curriculum standards and assessment

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 145 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    tools; develops or coordinates instructional programs or
2    strategies; develops and implements training; chooses
3    standards-based instructional materials; provides teachers
4    with an understanding of current research; serves as a
5    mentor, site coach, curriculum specialist, or lead
6    teacher; or otherwise works with fellow teachers, in
7    collaboration, to use data to improve instructional
8    practice or develop model lessons.
9        "Instructional materials" means relevant instructional
10    materials for student instruction, including, but not
11    limited to, textbooks, consumable workbooks, laboratory
12    equipment, library books, and other similar materials.
13        "Laboratory School" means a public school that is
14    created and operated by a public university and approved by
15    the State Board.
16        "Librarian" means a teacher with an endorsement as a
17    library information specialist or another individual whose
18    primary responsibility is overseeing library resources
19    within an Organizational Unit.
20        "Limiting rate for Hybrid Districts" means the
21    combined elementary school and high school limiting rates.
22        "Local Capacity" is defined in paragraph (1) of
23    subsection (c) of this Section.
24        "Local Capacity Percentage" is defined in subparagraph
25    (A) of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of this Section.
26        "Local Capacity Ratio" is defined in subparagraph (B)

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 146 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of this Section.
2        "Local Capacity Target" is defined in paragraph (2) of
3    subsection (c) of this Section.
4        "Low-Income Count" means, for an Organizational Unit
5    in a fiscal year, the higher of the average number of
6    students for the prior school year or the immediately
7    preceding 3 school years who, as of July 1 of the
8    immediately preceding fiscal year (as determined by the
9    Department of Human Services), are eligible for at least
10    one of the following low-income programs: Medicaid, the
11    Children's Health Insurance Program, Temporary Assistance
12    for Needy Families (TANF), or the Supplemental Nutrition
13    Assistance Program, excluding pupils who are eligible for
14    services provided by the Department of Children and Family
15    Services. Until such time that grade level low-income
16    populations become available, grade level low-income
17    populations shall be determined by applying the low-income
18    percentage to total student enrollments by grade level. The
19    low-income percentage is determined by dividing the
20    Low-Income Count by the Average Student Enrollment. The
21    low-income percentage for programs operated by a regional
22    office of education or an intermediate service center must
23    be set to the weighted average of the low-income
24    percentages of all of the school districts in the service
25    region. The weighted low-income percentage is the result of
26    multiplying the low-income percentage of each school

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 147 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    district served by the regional office of education or
2    intermediate service center by each school district's
3    Average Student Enrollment, summarizing those products and
4    dividing the total by the total Average Student Enrollment
5    for the service region.
6        "Maintenance and operations" means custodial services,
7    facility and ground maintenance, facility operations,
8    facility security, routine facility repairs, and other
9    similar services and functions.
10        "Minimum Funding Level" is defined in paragraph (9) of
11    subsection (g) of this Section.
12        "New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds" means, for any
13    given fiscal year, all State funds appropriated under
14    Section 2-3.170 of this the School Code.
15        "New State Funds" means, for a given school year, all
16    State funds appropriated for Evidence-Based Funding in
17    excess of the amount needed to fund the Base Funding
18    Minimum for all Organizational Units in that school year.
19        "Net State Contribution Target" means, for a given
20    school year, the amount of State funds that would be
21    necessary to fully meet the Adequacy Target of an
22    Operational Unit minus the Preliminary Resources available
23    to each unit.
24        "Nurse" means an individual licensed as a certified
25    school nurse, in accordance with the rules established for
26    nursing services by the State Board, who is an employee of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 148 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    and is available to provide health care-related services
2    for students of an Organizational Unit.
3        "Operating Tax Rate" means the rate utilized in the
4    previous year to extend property taxes for all purposes,
5    except Bond and Interest, Summer School, Rent, Capital
6    Improvement, and Vocational Education Building purposes.
7    For Hybrid Districts, the Operating Tax Rate shall be the
8    combined elementary and high school rates utilized in the
9    previous year to extend property taxes for all purposes,
10    except Bond and Interest, Summer School, Rent, Capital
11    Improvement, and Vocational Education Building purposes.
12        "Organizational Unit" means a Laboratory School or any
13    public school district that is recognized as such by the
14    State Board and that contains elementary schools typically
15    serving kindergarten through 5th grades, middle schools
16    typically serving 6th through 8th grades, high schools
17    typically serving 9th through 12th grades, a program
18    established under Section 2-3.66 or 2-3.41, or a program
19    operated by a regional office of education or an
20    intermediate service center under Article 13A or 13B. The
21    General Assembly acknowledges that the actual grade levels
22    served by a particular Organizational Unit may vary
23    slightly from what is typical.
24        "Organizational Unit CWI" is determined by calculating
25    the CWI in the region and original county in which an
26    Organizational Unit's primary administrative office is

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 149 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    located as set forth in this paragraph, provided that if
2    the Organizational Unit CWI as calculated in accordance
3    with this paragraph is less than 0.9, the Organizational
4    Unit CWI shall be increased to 0.9. Each county's current
5    CWI value shall be adjusted based on the CWI value of that
6    county's neighboring Illinois counties, to create a
7    "weighted adjusted index value". This shall be calculated
8    by summing the CWI values of all of a county's adjacent
9    Illinois counties and dividing by the number of adjacent
10    Illinois counties, then taking the weighted value of the
11    original county's CWI value and the adjacent Illinois
12    county average. To calculate this weighted value, if the
13    number of adjacent Illinois counties is greater than 2, the
14    original county's CWI value will be weighted at 0.25 and
15    the adjacent Illinois county average will be weighted at
16    0.75. If the number of adjacent Illinois counties is 2, the
17    original county's CWI value will be weighted at 0.33 and
18    the adjacent Illinois county average will be weighted at
19    0.66. The greater of the county's current CWI value and its
20    weighted adjusted index value shall be used as the
21    Organizational Unit CWI.
22        "Preceding Tax Year" means the property tax levy year
23    immediately preceding the Base Tax Year.
24        "Preceding Tax Year's Extension" means the product of
25    the equalized assessed valuation utilized by the county
26    clerk in the Preceding Tax Year multiplied by the Operating

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 150 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Tax Rate.
2        "Preliminary Percent of Adequacy" is defined in
3    paragraph (2) of subsection (f) of this Section.
4        "Preliminary Resources" is defined in paragraph (2) of
5    subsection (f) of this Section.
6        "Principal" means a school administrator duly endorsed
7    to be employed as a principal in this State.
8        "Professional development" means training programs for
9    licensed staff in schools, including, but not limited to,
10    programs that assist in implementing new curriculum
11    programs, provide data focused or academic assessment data
12    training to help staff identify a student's weaknesses and
13    strengths, target interventions, improve instruction,
14    encompass instructional strategies for English learner,
15    gifted, or at-risk students, address inclusivity, cultural
16    sensitivity, or implicit bias, or otherwise provide
17    professional support for licensed staff.
18        "Prototypical" means 450 special education
19    pre-kindergarten and kindergarten through grade 5 students
20    for an elementary school, 450 grade 6 through 8 students
21    for a middle school, and 600 grade 9 through 12 students
22    for a high school.
23        "PTELL" means the Property Tax Extension Limitation
24    Law.
25        "PTELL EAV" is defined in paragraph (4) of subsection
26    (d) of this Section.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 151 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        "Pupil support staff" means a nurse, psychologist,
2    social worker, family liaison personnel, or other staff
3    member who provides support to at-risk or struggling
4    students.
5        "Real Receipts" is defined in paragraph (1) of
6    subsection (d) of this Section.
7        "Regionalization Factor" means, for a particular
8    Organizational Unit, the figure derived by dividing the
9    Organizational Unit CWI by the Statewide Weighted CWI.
10        "School site staff" means the primary school secretary
11    and any additional clerical personnel assigned to a school.
12        "Special education" means special educational
13    facilities and services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of
14    this Code.
15        "Special Education Allocation" means the amount of an
16    Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target attributable
17    to special education divided by the Organizational Unit's
18    final Adequacy Target, the product of which shall be
19    multiplied by the amount of new funding received pursuant
20    to this Section. An Organizational Unit's final Adequacy
21    Target attributable to special education shall include all
22    special education investment adequacy elements.
23        "Specialist teacher" means a teacher who provides
24    instruction in subject areas not included in core subjects,
25    including, but not limited to, art, music, physical
26    education, health, driver education, career-technical

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 152 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    education, and such other subject areas as may be mandated
2    by State law or provided by an Organizational Unit.
3        "Specially Funded Unit" means an Alternative School,
4    safe school, Department of Juvenile Justice school,
5    special education cooperative or entity recognized by the
6    State Board as a special education cooperative,
7    State-approved charter school, or alternative learning
8    opportunities program that received direct funding from
9    the State Board during the 2016-2017 school year through
10    any of the funding sources included within the calculation
11    of the Base Funding Minimum or Glenwood Academy.
12        "Supplemental Grant Funding" means supplemental
13    general State aid funding received by an Organizational
14    Unit during the 2016-2017 school year pursuant to
15    subsection (H) of Section 18-8.05 of this Code (now
16    repealed).
17        "State Adequacy Level" is the sum of the Adequacy
18    Targets of all Organizational Units.
19        "State Board" means the State Board of Education.
20        "State Superintendent" means the State Superintendent
21    of Education.
22        "Statewide Weighted CWI" means a figure determined by
23    multiplying each Organizational Unit CWI times the ASE for
24    that Organizational Unit creating a weighted value,
25    summing all Organizational Units' weighted values, and
26    dividing by the total ASE of all Organizational Units,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 153 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    thereby creating an average weighted index.
2        "Student activities" means non-credit producing
3    after-school programs, including, but not limited to,
4    clubs, bands, sports, and other activities authorized by
5    the school board of the Organizational Unit.
6        "Substitute teacher" means an individual teacher or
7    teaching assistant who is employed by an Organizational
8    Unit and is temporarily serving the Organizational Unit on
9    a per diem or per period-assignment basis to replace
10    another staff member.
11        "Summer school" means academic and enrichment programs
12    provided to students during the summer months outside of
13    the regular school year.
14        "Supervisory aide" means a non-licensed staff member
15    who helps in supervising students of an Organizational
16    Unit, but does so outside of the classroom, in situations
17    such as, but not limited to, monitoring hallways and
18    playgrounds, supervising lunchrooms, or supervising
19    students when being transported in buses serving the
20    Organizational Unit.
21        "Target Ratio" is defined in paragraph (4) of
22    subsection (g).
23        "Tier 1", "Tier 2", "Tier 3", and "Tier 4" are defined
24    in paragraph (3) of subsection (g).
25        "Tier 1 Aggregate Funding", "Tier 2 Aggregate
26    Funding", "Tier 3 Aggregate Funding", and "Tier 4 Aggregate

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 154 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Funding" are defined in paragraph (1) of subsection (g).
2    (b) Adequacy Target calculation.
3        (1) Each Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target is the
4    sum of the Organizational Unit's cost of providing
5    Essential Elements, as calculated in accordance with this
6    subsection (b), with the salary amounts in the Essential
7    Elements multiplied by a Regionalization Factor calculated
8    pursuant to paragraph (3) of this subsection (b).
9        (2) The Essential Elements are attributable on a pro
10    rata basis related to defined subgroups of the ASE of each
11    Organizational Unit as specified in this paragraph (2),
12    with investments and FTE positions pro rata funded based on
13    ASE counts in excess of or less than the thresholds set
14    forth in this paragraph (2). The method for calculating
15    attributable pro rata costs and the defined subgroups
16    thereto are as follows:
17            (A) Core class size investments. Each
18        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding required
19        to support that number of FTE core teacher positions as
20        is needed to keep the respective class sizes of the
21        Organizational Unit to the following maximum numbers:
22                (i) For grades kindergarten through 3, the
23            Organizational Unit shall receive funding required
24            to support one FTE core teacher position for every
25            15 Low-Income Count students in those grades and
26            one FTE core teacher position for every 20

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 155 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            non-Low-Income Count students in those grades.
2                (ii) For grades 4 through 12, the
3            Organizational Unit shall receive funding required
4            to support one FTE core teacher position for every
5            20 Low-Income Count students in those grades and
6            one FTE core teacher position for every 25
7            non-Low-Income Count students in those grades.
8            The number of non-Low-Income Count students in a
9        grade shall be determined by subtracting the
10        Low-Income students in that grade from the ASE of the
11        Organizational Unit for that grade.
12            (B) Specialist teacher investments. Each
13        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
14        to cover that number of FTE specialist teacher
15        positions that correspond to the following
16        percentages:
17                (i) if the Organizational Unit operates an
18            elementary or middle school, then 20.00% of the
19            number of the Organizational Unit's core teachers,
20            as determined under subparagraph (A) of this
21            paragraph (2); and
22                (ii) if such Organizational Unit operates a
23            high school, then 33.33% of the number of the
24            Organizational Unit's core teachers.
25            (C) Instructional facilitator investments. Each
26        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 156 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        to cover one FTE instructional facilitator position
2        for every 200 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten
3        children with disabilities and all kindergarten
4        through grade 12 students of the Organizational Unit.
5            (D) Core intervention teacher (tutor) investments.
6        Each Organizational Unit shall receive the funding
7        needed to cover one FTE teacher position for each
8        prototypical elementary, middle, and high school.
9            (E) Substitute teacher investments. Each
10        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
11        to cover substitute teacher costs that is equal to
12        5.70% of the minimum pupil attendance days required
13        under Section 10-19 of this Code for all full-time
14        equivalent core, specialist, and intervention
15        teachers, school nurses, special education teachers
16        and instructional assistants, instructional
17        facilitators, and summer school and extended day
18        teacher positions, as determined under this paragraph
19        (2), at a salary rate of 33.33% of the average salary
20        for grade K through 12 teachers and 33.33% of the
21        average salary of each instructional assistant
22        position.
23            (F) Core guidance counselor investments. Each
24        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
25        to cover one FTE guidance counselor for each 450
26        combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 157 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 5
2        students, plus one FTE guidance counselor for each 250
3        grades 6 through 8 ASE middle school students, plus one
4        FTE guidance counselor for each 250 grades 9 through 12
5        ASE high school students.
6            (G) Nurse investments. Each Organizational Unit
7        shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE nurse
8        for each 750 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children
9        with disabilities and all kindergarten through grade
10        12 students across all grade levels it serves.
11            (H) Supervisory aide investments. Each
12        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
13        to cover one FTE for each 225 combined ASE of
14        pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all
15        kindergarten through grade 5 students, plus one FTE for
16        each 225 ASE middle school students, plus one FTE for
17        each 200 ASE high school students.
18            (I) Librarian investments. Each Organizational
19        Unit shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE
20        librarian for each prototypical elementary school,
21        middle school, and high school and one FTE aide or
22        media technician for every 300 combined ASE of
23        pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all
24        kindergarten through grade 12 students.
25            (J) Principal investments. Each Organizational
26        Unit shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 158 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        principal position for each prototypical elementary
2        school, plus one FTE principal position for each
3        prototypical middle school, plus one FTE principal
4        position for each prototypical high school.
5            (K) Assistant principal investments. Each
6        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
7        to cover one FTE assistant principal position for each
8        prototypical elementary school, plus one FTE assistant
9        principal position for each prototypical middle
10        school, plus one FTE assistant principal position for
11        each prototypical high school.
12            (L) School site staff investments. Each
13        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
14        for one FTE position for each 225 ASE of
15        pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all
16        kindergarten through grade 5 students, plus one FTE
17        position for each 225 ASE middle school students, plus
18        one FTE position for each 200 ASE high school students.
19            (M) Gifted investments. Each Organizational Unit
20        shall receive $40 per kindergarten through grade 12
21        ASE.
22            (N) Professional development investments. Each
23        Organizational Unit shall receive $125 per student of
24        the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
25        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
26        students for trainers and other professional

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 159 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        development-related expenses for supplies and
2        materials.
3            (O) Instructional material investments. Each
4        Organizational Unit shall receive $190 per student of
5        the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
6        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
7        students to cover instructional material costs.
8            (P) Assessment investments. Each Organizational
9        Unit shall receive $25 per student of the combined ASE
10        of pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all
11        kindergarten through grade 12 students to cover
12        assessment costs.
13            (Q) Computer technology and equipment investments.
14        Each Organizational Unit shall receive $285.50 per
15        student of the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten
16        children with disabilities and all kindergarten
17        through grade 12 students to cover computer technology
18        and equipment costs. For the 2018-2019 school year and
19        subsequent school years, Organizational Units assigned
20        to Tier 1 and Tier 2 in the prior school year shall
21        receive an additional $285.50 per student of the
22        combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
23        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
24        students to cover computer technology and equipment
25        costs in the Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target.
26        The State Board may establish additional requirements

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 160 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        for Organizational Unit expenditures of funds received
2        pursuant to this subparagraph (Q), including a
3        requirement that funds received pursuant to this
4        subparagraph (Q) may be used only for serving the
5        technology needs of the district. It is the intent of
6        Public Act 100-465 that all Tier 1 and Tier 2 districts
7        receive the addition to their Adequacy Target in the
8        following year, subject to compliance with the
9        requirements of the State Board.
10            (R) Student activities investments. Each
11        Organizational Unit shall receive the following
12        funding amounts to cover student activities: $100 per
13        kindergarten through grade 5 ASE student in elementary
14        school, plus $200 per ASE student in middle school,
15        plus $675 per ASE student in high school.
16            (S) Maintenance and operations investments. Each
17        Organizational Unit shall receive $1,038 per student
18        of the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
19        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
20        students for day-to-day maintenance and operations
21        expenditures, including salary, supplies, and
22        materials, as well as purchased services, but
23        excluding employee benefits. The proportion of salary
24        for the application of a Regionalization Factor and the
25        calculation of benefits is equal to $352.92.
26            (T) Central office investments. Each

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 161 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        Organizational Unit shall receive $742 per student of
2        the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
3        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
4        students to cover central office operations, including
5        administrators and classified personnel charged with
6        managing the instructional programs, business and
7        operations of the school district, and security
8        personnel. The proportion of salary for the
9        application of a Regionalization Factor and the
10        calculation of benefits is equal to $368.48.
11            (U) Employee benefit investments. Each
12        Organizational Unit shall receive 30% of the total of
13        all salary-calculated elements of the Adequacy Target,
14        excluding substitute teachers and student activities
15        investments, to cover benefit costs. For central
16        office and maintenance and operations investments, the
17        benefit calculation shall be based upon the salary
18        proportion of each investment. If at any time the
19        responsibility for funding the employer normal cost of
20        teacher pensions is assigned to school districts, then
21        that amount certified by the Teachers' Retirement
22        System of the State of Illinois to be paid by the
23        Organizational Unit for the preceding school year
24        shall be added to the benefit investment. For any
25        fiscal year in which a school district organized under
26        Article 34 of this Code is responsible for paying the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 162 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        employer normal cost of teacher pensions, then that
2        amount of its employer normal cost plus the amount for
3        retiree health insurance as certified by the Public
4        School Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of
5        Chicago to be paid by the school district for the
6        preceding school year that is statutorily required to
7        cover employer normal costs and the amount for retiree
8        health insurance shall be added to the 30% specified in
9        this subparagraph (U). The Teachers' Retirement System
10        of the State of Illinois and the Public School
11        Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of Chicago shall
12        submit such information as the State Superintendent
13        may require for the calculations set forth in this
14        subparagraph (U).
15            (V) Additional investments in low-income students.
16        In addition to and not in lieu of all other funding
17        under this paragraph (2), each Organizational Unit
18        shall receive funding based on the average teacher
19        salary for grades K through 12 to cover the costs of:
20                (i) one FTE intervention teacher (tutor)
21            position for every 125 Low-Income Count students;
22                (ii) one FTE pupil support staff position for
23            every 125 Low-Income Count students;
24                (iii) one FTE extended day teacher position
25            for every 120 Low-Income Count students; and
26                (iv) one FTE summer school teacher position

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 163 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            for every 120 Low-Income Count students.
2            (W) Additional investments in English learner
3        students. In addition to and not in lieu of all other
4        funding under this paragraph (2), each Organizational
5        Unit shall receive funding based on the average teacher
6        salary for grades K through 12 to cover the costs of:
7                (i) one FTE intervention teacher (tutor)
8            position for every 125 English learner students;
9                (ii) one FTE pupil support staff position for
10            every 125 English learner students;
11                (iii) one FTE extended day teacher position
12            for every 120 English learner students;
13                (iv) one FTE summer school teacher position
14            for every 120 English learner students; and
15                (v) one FTE core teacher position for every 100
16            English learner students.
17            (X) Special education investments. Each
18        Organizational Unit shall receive funding based on the
19        average teacher salary for grades K through 12 to cover
20        special education as follows:
21                (i) one FTE teacher position for every 141
22            combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
23            disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
24            students;
25                (ii) one FTE instructional assistant for every
26            141 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 164 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
2            students; and
3                (iii) one FTE psychologist position for every
4            1,000 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children
5            with disabilities and all kindergarten through
6            grade 12 students.
7            (Y) Anti-racism investment. In addition to and not
8        in lieu of all other funding under this paragraph (2),
9        an Organizational Unit shall receive funding in the
10        amount of $250 per African American student enrolled in
11        the Organizational Unit if 15% or more of the students
12        enrolled in the Organizational Unit are African
13        American. Funds received pursuant to this subparagraph
14        (Y) shall be utilized as set forth in Section 2-3.184
15        of this Code.
16        (3) For calculating the salaries included within the
17    Essential Elements, the State Superintendent shall
18    annually calculate average salaries to the nearest dollar
19    using the employment information system data maintained by
20    the State Board, limited to public schools only and
21    excluding special education and vocational cooperatives,
22    schools operated by the Department of Juvenile Justice, and
23    charter schools, for the following positions:
24            (A) Teacher for grades K through 8.
25            (B) Teacher for grades 9 through 12.
26            (C) Teacher for grades K through 12.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 165 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (D) Guidance counselor for grades K through 8.
2            (E) Guidance counselor for grades 9 through 12.
3            (F) Guidance counselor for grades K through 12.
4            (G) Social worker.
5            (H) Psychologist.
6            (I) Librarian.
7            (J) Nurse.
8            (K) Principal.
9            (L) Assistant principal.
10        For the purposes of this paragraph (3), "teacher"
11    includes core teachers, specialist and elective teachers,
12    instructional facilitators, tutors, special education
13    teachers, pupil support staff teachers, English learner
14    teachers, extended day teachers, and summer school
15    teachers. Where specific grade data is not required for the
16    Essential Elements, the average salary for corresponding
17    positions shall apply. For substitute teachers, the
18    average teacher salary for grades K through 12 shall apply.
19        For calculating the salaries included within the
20    Essential Elements for positions not included within EIS
21    Data, the following salaries shall be used in the first
22    year of implementation of Evidence-Based Funding:
23            (i) school site staff, $30,000; and
24            (ii) non-instructional assistant, instructional
25        assistant, library aide, library media tech, or
26        supervisory aide: $25,000.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 166 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        In the second and subsequent years of implementation of
2    Evidence-Based Funding, the amounts in items (i) and (ii)
3    of this paragraph (3) shall annually increase by the ECI.
4        The salary amounts for the Essential Elements
5    determined pursuant to subparagraphs (A) through (L), (S)
6    and (T), and (V) through (X) of paragraph (2) of subsection
7    (b) of this Section shall be multiplied by a
8    Regionalization Factor.
9    (c) Local Capacity calculation.
10        (1) Each Organizational Unit's Local Capacity
11    represents an amount of funding it is assumed to contribute
12    toward its Adequacy Target for purposes of the
13    Evidence-Based Funding formula calculation. "Local
14    Capacity" means either (i) the Organizational Unit's Local
15    Capacity Target as calculated in accordance with paragraph
16    (2) of this subsection (c) if its Real Receipts are equal
17    to or less than its Local Capacity Target or (ii) the
18    Organizational Unit's Adjusted Local Capacity, as
19    calculated in accordance with paragraph (3) of this
20    subsection (c) if Real Receipts are more than its Local
21    Capacity Target.
22        (2) "Local Capacity Target" means, for an
23    Organizational Unit, that dollar amount that is obtained by
24    multiplying its Adequacy Target by its Local Capacity
25    Ratio.
26            (A) An Organizational Unit's Local Capacity

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 167 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        Percentage is the conversion of the Organizational
2        Unit's Local Capacity Ratio, as such ratio is
3        determined in accordance with subparagraph (B) of this
4        paragraph (2), into a cumulative distribution
5        resulting in a percentile ranking to determine each
6        Organizational Unit's relative position to all other
7        Organizational Units in this State. The calculation of
8        Local Capacity Percentage is described in subparagraph
9        (C) of this paragraph (2).
10            (B) An Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio
11        in a given year is the percentage obtained by dividing
12        its Adjusted EAV or PTELL EAV, whichever is less, by
13        its Adequacy Target, with the resulting ratio further
14        adjusted as follows:
15                (i) for Organizational Units serving grades
16            kindergarten through 12 and Hybrid Districts, no
17            further adjustments shall be made;
18                (ii) for Organizational Units serving grades
19            kindergarten through 8, the ratio shall be
20            multiplied by 9/13;
21                (iii) for Organizational Units serving grades
22            9 through 12, the Local Capacity Ratio shall be
23            multiplied by 4/13; and
24                (iv) for an Organizational Unit with a
25            different grade configuration than those specified
26            in items (i) through (iii) of this subparagraph

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 168 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (B), the State Superintendent shall determine a
2            comparable adjustment based on the grades served.
3            (C) The Local Capacity Percentage is equal to the
4        percentile ranking of the district. Local Capacity
5        Percentage converts each Organizational Unit's Local
6        Capacity Ratio to a cumulative distribution resulting
7        in a percentile ranking to determine each
8        Organizational Unit's relative position to all other
9        Organizational Units in this State. The Local Capacity
10        Percentage cumulative distribution resulting in a
11        percentile ranking for each Organizational Unit shall
12        be calculated using the standard normal distribution
13        of the score in relation to the weighted mean and
14        weighted standard deviation and Local Capacity Ratios
15        of all Organizational Units. If the value assigned to
16        any Organizational Unit is in excess of 90%, the value
17        shall be adjusted to 90%. For Laboratory Schools, the
18        Local Capacity Percentage shall be set at 10% in
19        recognition of the absence of EAV and resources from
20        the public university that are allocated to the
21        Laboratory School. For programs operated by a regional
22        office of education or an intermediate service center,
23        the Local Capacity Percentage must be set at 10% in
24        recognition of the absence of EAV and resources from
25        school districts that are allocated to the regional
26        office of education or intermediate service center.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 169 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        The weighted mean for the Local Capacity Percentage
2        shall be determined by multiplying each Organizational
3        Unit's Local Capacity Ratio times the ASE for the unit
4        creating a weighted value, summing the weighted values
5        of all Organizational Units, and dividing by the total
6        ASE of all Organizational Units. The weighted standard
7        deviation shall be determined by taking the square root
8        of the weighted variance of all Organizational Units'
9        Local Capacity Ratio, where the variance is calculated
10        by squaring the difference between each unit's Local
11        Capacity Ratio and the weighted mean, then multiplying
12        the variance for each unit times the ASE for the unit
13        to create a weighted variance for each unit, then
14        summing all units' weighted variance and dividing by
15        the total ASE of all units.
16            (D) For any Organizational Unit, the
17        Organizational Unit's Adjusted Local Capacity Target
18        shall be reduced by either (i) the school board's
19        remaining contribution pursuant to paragraph (ii) of
20        subsection (b-4) of Section 16-158 of the Illinois
21        Pension Code in a given year or (ii) the board of
22        education's remaining contribution pursuant to
23        paragraph (iv) of subsection (b) of Section 17-129 of
24        the Illinois Pension Code absent the employer normal
25        cost portion of the required contribution and amount
26        allowed pursuant to subdivision (3) of Section

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 170 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        17-142.1 of the Illinois Pension Code in a given year.
2        In the preceding sentence, item (i) shall be certified
3        to the State Board of Education by the Teachers'
4        Retirement System of the State of Illinois and item
5        (ii) shall be certified to the State Board of Education
6        by the Public School Teachers' Pension and Retirement
7        Fund of the City of Chicago.
8        (3) If an Organizational Unit's Real Receipts are more
9    than its Local Capacity Target, then its Local Capacity
10    shall equal an Adjusted Local Capacity Target as calculated
11    in accordance with this paragraph (3). The Adjusted Local
12    Capacity Target is calculated as the sum of the
13    Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Target and its Real
14    Receipts Adjustment. The Real Receipts Adjustment equals
15    the Organizational Unit's Real Receipts less its Local
16    Capacity Target, with the resulting figure multiplied by
17    the Local Capacity Percentage.
18        As used in this paragraph (3), "Real Percent of
19    Adequacy" means the sum of an Organizational Unit's Real
20    Receipts, CPPRT, and Base Funding Minimum, with the
21    resulting figure divided by the Organizational Unit's
22    Adequacy Target.
23    (d) Calculation of Real Receipts, EAV, and Adjusted EAV for
24purposes of the Local Capacity calculation.
25        (1) An Organizational Unit's Real Receipts are the
26    product of its Applicable Tax Rate and its Adjusted EAV. An

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 171 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Organizational Unit's Applicable Tax Rate is its Adjusted
2    Operating Tax Rate for property within the Organizational
3    Unit.
4        (2) The State Superintendent shall calculate the
5    equalized assessed valuation, or EAV, of all taxable
6    property of each Organizational Unit as of September 30 of
7    the previous year in accordance with paragraph (3) of this
8    subsection (d). The State Superintendent shall then
9    determine the Adjusted EAV of each Organizational Unit in
10    accordance with paragraph (4) of this subsection (d), which
11    Adjusted EAV figure shall be used for the purposes of
12    calculating Local Capacity.
13        (3) To calculate Real Receipts and EAV, the Department
14    of Revenue shall supply to the State Superintendent the
15    value as equalized or assessed by the Department of Revenue
16    of all taxable property of every Organizational Unit,
17    together with (i) the applicable tax rate used in extending
18    taxes for the funds of the Organizational Unit as of
19    September 30 of the previous year and (ii) the limiting
20    rate for all Organizational Units subject to property tax
21    extension limitations as imposed under PTELL.
22            (A) The Department of Revenue shall add to the
23        equalized assessed value of all taxable property of
24        each Organizational Unit situated entirely or
25        partially within a county that is or was subject to the
26        provisions of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 172 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        Tax Code (i) an amount equal to the total amount by
2        which the homestead exemption allowed under Section
3        15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code for real
4        property situated in that Organizational Unit exceeds
5        the total amount that would have been allowed in that
6        Organizational Unit if the maximum reduction under
7        Section 15-176 was (I) $4,500 in Cook County or $3,500
8        in all other counties in tax year 2003 or (II) $5,000
9        in all counties in tax year 2004 and thereafter and
10        (ii) an amount equal to the aggregate amount for the
11        taxable year of all additional exemptions under
12        Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code for owners with
13        a household income of $30,000 or less. The county clerk
14        of any county that is or was subject to the provisions
15        of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code
16        shall annually calculate and certify to the Department
17        of Revenue for each Organizational Unit all homestead
18        exemption amounts under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the
19        Property Tax Code and all amounts of additional
20        exemptions under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax
21        Code for owners with a household income of $30,000 or
22        less. It is the intent of this subparagraph (A) that if
23        the general homestead exemption for a parcel of
24        property is determined under Section 15-176 or 15-177
25        of the Property Tax Code rather than Section 15-175,
26        then the calculation of EAV shall not be affected by

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 173 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        the difference, if any, between the amount of the
2        general homestead exemption allowed for that parcel of
3        property under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property
4        Tax Code and the amount that would have been allowed
5        had the general homestead exemption for that parcel of
6        property been determined under Section 15-175 of the
7        Property Tax Code. It is further the intent of this
8        subparagraph (A) that if additional exemptions are
9        allowed under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code
10        for owners with a household income of less than
11        $30,000, then the calculation of EAV shall not be
12        affected by the difference, if any, because of those
13        additional exemptions.
14            (B) With respect to any part of an Organizational
15        Unit within a redevelopment project area in respect to
16        which a municipality has adopted tax increment
17        allocation financing pursuant to the Tax Increment
18        Allocation Redevelopment Act, Division 74.4 of Article
19        11 of the Illinois Municipal Code, or the Industrial
20        Jobs Recovery Law, Division 74.6 of Article 11 of the
21        Illinois Municipal Code, no part of the current EAV of
22        real property located in any such project area that is
23        attributable to an increase above the total initial EAV
24        of such property shall be used as part of the EAV of
25        the Organizational Unit, until such time as all
26        redevelopment project costs have been paid, as

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 174 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        provided in Section 11-74.4-8 of the Tax Increment
2        Allocation Redevelopment Act or in Section 11-74.6-35
3        of the Industrial Jobs Recovery Law. For the purpose of
4        the EAV of the Organizational Unit, the total initial
5        EAV or the current EAV, whichever is lower, shall be
6        used until such time as all redevelopment project costs
7        have been paid.
8            (B-5) The real property equalized assessed
9        valuation for a school district shall be adjusted by
10        subtracting from the real property value, as equalized
11        or assessed by the Department of Revenue, for the
12        district an amount computed by dividing the amount of
13        any abatement of taxes under Section 18-170 of the
14        Property Tax Code by 3.00% for a district maintaining
15        grades kindergarten through 12, by 2.30% for a district
16        maintaining grades kindergarten through 8, or by 1.05%
17        for a district maintaining grades 9 through 12 and
18        adjusted by an amount computed by dividing the amount
19        of any abatement of taxes under subsection (a) of
20        Section 18-165 of the Property Tax Code by the same
21        percentage rates for district type as specified in this
22        subparagraph (B-5).
23            (C) For Organizational Units that are Hybrid
24        Districts, the State Superintendent shall use the
25        lesser of the adjusted equalized assessed valuation
26        for property within the partial elementary unit

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 175 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        district for elementary purposes, as defined in
2        Article 11E of this Code, or the adjusted equalized
3        assessed valuation for property within the partial
4        elementary unit district for high school purposes, as
5        defined in Article 11E of this Code.
6        (4) An Organizational Unit's Adjusted EAV shall be the
7    average of its EAV over the immediately preceding 3 years
8    or its EAV in the immediately preceding year if the EAV in
9    the immediately preceding year has declined by 10% or more
10    compared to the 3-year average. In the event of
11    Organizational Unit reorganization, consolidation, or
12    annexation, the Organizational Unit's Adjusted EAV for the
13    first 3 years after such change shall be as follows: the
14    most current EAV shall be used in the first year, the
15    average of a 2-year EAV or its EAV in the immediately
16    preceding year if the EAV declines by 10% or more compared
17    to the 2-year average for the second year, and a 3-year
18    average EAV or its EAV in the immediately preceding year if
19    the Adjusted EAV declines by 10% or more compared to the
20    3-year average for the third year. For any school district
21    whose EAV in the immediately preceding year is used in
22    calculations, in the following year, the Adjusted EAV shall
23    be the average of its EAV over the immediately preceding 2
24    years or the immediately preceding year if that year
25    represents a decline of 10% or more compared to the 2-year
26    average.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 176 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        "PTELL EAV" means a figure calculated by the State
2    Board for Organizational Units subject to PTELL as
3    described in this paragraph (4) for the purposes of
4    calculating an Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio.
5    Except as otherwise provided in this paragraph (4), the
6    PTELL EAV of an Organizational Unit shall be equal to the
7    product of the equalized assessed valuation last used in
8    the calculation of general State aid under Section 18-8.05
9    of this Code (now repealed) or Evidence-Based Funding under
10    this Section and the Organizational Unit's Extension
11    Limitation Ratio. If an Organizational Unit has approved or
12    does approve an increase in its limiting rate, pursuant to
13    Section 18-190 of the Property Tax Code, affecting the Base
14    Tax Year, the PTELL EAV shall be equal to the product of
15    the equalized assessed valuation last used in the
16    calculation of general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of
17    this Code (now repealed) or Evidence-Based Funding under
18    this Section multiplied by an amount equal to one plus the
19    percentage increase, if any, in the Consumer Price Index
20    for All Urban Consumers for all items published by the
21    United States Department of Labor for the 12-month calendar
22    year preceding the Base Tax Year, plus the equalized
23    assessed valuation of new property, annexed property, and
24    recovered tax increment value and minus the equalized
25    assessed valuation of disconnected property.
26        As used in this paragraph (4), "new property" and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 177 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    "recovered tax increment value" shall have the meanings set
2    forth in the Property Tax Extension Limitation Law.
3    (e) Base Funding Minimum calculation.
4        (1) For the 2017-2018 school year, the Base Funding
5    Minimum of an Organizational Unit or a Specially Funded
6    Unit shall be the amount of State funds distributed to the
7    Organizational Unit or Specially Funded Unit during the
8    2016-2017 school year prior to any adjustments and
9    specified appropriation amounts described in this
10    paragraph (1) from the following Sections, as calculated by
11    the State Superintendent: Section 18-8.05 of this Code (now
12    repealed); Section 5 of Article 224 of Public Act 99-524
13    (equity grants); Section 14-7.02b of this Code (funding for
14    children requiring special education services); Section
15    14-13.01 of this Code (special education facilities and
16    staffing), except for reimbursement of the cost of
17    transportation pursuant to Section 14-13.01; Section
18    14C-12 of this Code (English learners); and Section 18-4.3
19    of this Code (summer school), based on an appropriation
20    level of $13,121,600. For a school district organized under
21    Article 34 of this Code, the Base Funding Minimum also
22    includes (i) the funds allocated to the school district
23    pursuant to Section 1D-1 of this Code attributable to
24    funding programs authorized by the Sections of this Code
25    listed in the preceding sentence and (ii) the difference
26    between (I) the funds allocated to the school district

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 178 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    pursuant to Section 1D-1 of this Code attributable to the
2    funding programs authorized by Section 14-7.02 (non-public
3    special education reimbursement), subsection (b) of
4    Section 14-13.01 (special education transportation),
5    Section 29-5 (transportation), Section 2-3.80
6    (agricultural education), Section 2-3.66 (truants'
7    alternative education), Section 2-3.62 (educational
8    service centers), and Section 14-7.03 (special education -
9    orphanage) of this Code and Section 15 of the Childhood
10    Hunger Relief Act (free breakfast program) and (II) the
11    school district's actual expenditures for its non-public
12    special education, special education transportation,
13    transportation programs, agricultural education, truants'
14    alternative education, services that would otherwise be
15    performed by a regional office of education, special
16    education orphanage expenditures, and free breakfast, as
17    most recently calculated and reported pursuant to
18    subsection (f) of Section 1D-1 of this Code. The Base
19    Funding Minimum for Glenwood Academy shall be $625,500. For
20    programs operated by a regional office of education or an
21    intermediate service center, the Base Funding Minimum must
22    be the total amount of State funds allocated to those
23    programs in the 2018-2019 school year and amounts provided
24    pursuant to Article 34 of Public Act 100-586 and Section
25    3-16 of this Code. All programs established after June 5,
26    2019 (the effective date of Public Act 101-10) and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 179 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    administered by a regional office of education or an
2    intermediate service center must have an initial Base
3    Funding Minimum set to an amount equal to the first-year
4    ASE multiplied by the amount of per pupil funding received
5    in the previous school year by the lowest funded similar
6    existing program type. If the enrollment for a program
7    operated by a regional office of education or an
8    intermediate service center is zero, then it may not
9    receive Base Funding Minimum funds for that program in the
10    next fiscal year, and those funds must be distributed to
11    Organizational Units under subsection (g).
12        (2) For the 2018-2019 and subsequent school years, the
13    Base Funding Minimum of Organizational Units and Specially
14    Funded Units shall be the sum of (i) the amount of
15    Evidence-Based Funding for the prior school year, (ii) the
16    Base Funding Minimum for the prior school year, and (iii)
17    any amount received by a school district pursuant to
18    Section 7 of Article 97 of Public Act 100-21.
19        (3) Subject to approval by the General Assembly as
20    provided in this paragraph (3), an Organizational Unit that
21    meets all of the following criteria, as determined by the
22    State Board, shall have District Intervention Money added
23    to its Base Funding Minimum at the time the Base Funding
24    Minimum is calculated by the State Board:
25            (A) The Organizational Unit is operating under an
26        Independent Authority under Section 2-3.25f-5 of this

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 180 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        Code for a minimum of 4 school years or is subject to
2        the control of the State Board pursuant to a court
3        order for a minimum of 4 school years.
4            (B) The Organizational Unit was designated as a
5        Tier 1 or Tier 2 Organizational Unit in the previous
6        school year under paragraph (3) of subsection (g) of
7        this Section.
8            (C) The Organizational Unit demonstrates
9        sustainability through a 5-year financial and
10        strategic plan.
11            (D) The Organizational Unit has made sufficient
12        progress and achieved sufficient stability in the
13        areas of governance, academic growth, and finances.
14        As part of its determination under this paragraph (3),
15    the State Board may consider the Organizational Unit's
16    summative designation, any accreditations of the
17    Organizational Unit, or the Organizational Unit's
18    financial profile, as calculated by the State Board.
19        If the State Board determines that an Organizational
20    Unit has met the criteria set forth in this paragraph (3),
21    it must submit a report to the General Assembly, no later
22    than January 2 of the fiscal year in which the State Board
23    makes it determination, on the amount of District
24    Intervention Money to add to the Organizational Unit's Base
25    Funding Minimum. The General Assembly must review the State
26    Board's report and may approve or disapprove, by joint

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 181 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    resolution, the addition of District Intervention Money.
2    If the General Assembly fails to act on the report within
3    40 calendar days from the receipt of the report, the
4    addition of District Intervention Money is deemed
5    approved. If the General Assembly approves the amount of
6    District Intervention Money to be added to the
7    Organizational Unit's Base Funding Minimum, the District
8    Intervention Money must be added to the Base Funding
9    Minimum annually thereafter.
10        For the first 4 years following the initial year that
11    the State Board determines that an Organizational Unit has
12    met the criteria set forth in this paragraph (3) and has
13    received funding under this Section, the Organizational
14    Unit must annually submit to the State Board, on or before
15    November 30, a progress report regarding its financial and
16    strategic plan under subparagraph (C) of this paragraph
17    (3). The plan shall include the financial data from the
18    past 4 annual financial reports or financial audits that
19    must be presented to the State Board by November 15 of each
20    year and the approved budget financial data for the current
21    year. The plan shall be developed according to the
22    guidelines presented to the Organizational Unit by the
23    State Board. The plan shall further include financial
24    projections for the next 3 fiscal years and include a
25    discussion and financial summary of the Organizational
26    Unit's facility needs. If the Organizational Unit does not

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 182 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    demonstrate sufficient progress toward its 5-year plan or
2    if it has failed to file an annual financial report, an
3    annual budget, a financial plan, a deficit reduction plan,
4    or other financial information as required by law, the
5    State Board may establish a Financial Oversight Panel under
6    Article 1H of this Code. However, if the Organizational
7    Unit already has a Financial Oversight Panel, the State
8    Board may extend the duration of the Panel.
9    (f) Percent of Adequacy and Final Resources calculation.
10        (1) The Evidence-Based Funding formula establishes a
11    Percent of Adequacy for each Organizational Unit in order
12    to place such units into tiers for the purposes of the
13    funding distribution system described in subsection (g) of
14    this Section. Initially, an Organizational Unit's
15    Preliminary Resources and Preliminary Percent of Adequacy
16    are calculated pursuant to paragraph (2) of this subsection
17    (f). Then, an Organizational Unit's Final Resources and
18    Final Percent of Adequacy are calculated to account for the
19    Organizational Unit's poverty concentration levels
20    pursuant to paragraphs (3) and (4) of this subsection (f).
21        (2) An Organizational Unit's Preliminary Resources are
22    equal to the sum of its Local Capacity Target, CPPRT, and
23    Base Funding Minimum. An Organizational Unit's Preliminary
24    Percent of Adequacy is the lesser of (i) its Preliminary
25    Resources divided by its Adequacy Target or (ii) 100%.
26        (3) Except for Specially Funded Units, an

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 183 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Organizational Unit's Final Resources are equal to the sum
2    of its Local Capacity, CPPRT, and Adjusted Base Funding
3    Minimum. The Base Funding Minimum of each Specially Funded
4    Unit shall serve as its Final Resources, except that the
5    Base Funding Minimum for State-approved charter schools
6    shall not include any portion of general State aid
7    allocated in the prior year based on the per capita tuition
8    charge times the charter school enrollment.
9        (4) An Organizational Unit's Final Percent of Adequacy
10    is its Final Resources divided by its Adequacy Target. An
11    Organizational Unit's Adjusted Base Funding Minimum is
12    equal to its Base Funding Minimum less its Supplemental
13    Grant Funding, with the resulting figure added to the
14    product of its Supplemental Grant Funding and Preliminary
15    Percent of Adequacy.
16    (g) Evidence-Based Funding formula distribution system.
17        (1) In each school year under the Evidence-Based
18    Funding formula, each Organizational Unit receives funding
19    equal to the sum of its Base Funding Minimum and the unit's
20    allocation of New State Funds determined pursuant to this
21    subsection (g). To allocate New State Funds, the
22    Evidence-Based Funding formula distribution system first
23    places all Organizational Units into one of 4 tiers in
24    accordance with paragraph (3) of this subsection (g), based
25    on the Organizational Unit's Final Percent of Adequacy. New
26    State Funds are allocated to each of the 4 tiers as

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 184 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    follows: Tier 1 Aggregate Funding equals 50% of all New
2    State Funds, Tier 2 Aggregate Funding equals 49% of all New
3    State Funds, Tier 3 Aggregate Funding equals 0.9% of all
4    New State Funds, and Tier 4 Aggregate Funding equals 0.1%
5    of all New State Funds. Each Organizational Unit within
6    Tier 1 or Tier 2 receives an allocation of New State Funds
7    equal to its tier Funding Gap, as defined in the following
8    sentence, multiplied by the tier's Allocation Rate
9    determined pursuant to paragraph (4) of this subsection
10    (g). For Tier 1, an Organizational Unit's Funding Gap
11    equals the tier's Target Ratio, as specified in paragraph
12    (5) of this subsection (g), multiplied by the
13    Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target, with the resulting
14    amount reduced by the Organizational Unit's Final
15    Resources. For Tier 2, an Organizational Unit's Funding Gap
16    equals the tier's Target Ratio, as described in paragraph
17    (5) of this subsection (g), multiplied by the
18    Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target, with the resulting
19    amount reduced by the Organizational Unit's Final
20    Resources and its Tier 1 funding allocation. To determine
21    the Organizational Unit's Funding Gap, the resulting
22    amount is then multiplied by a factor equal to one minus
23    the Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Target
24    percentage. Each Organizational Unit within Tier 3 or Tier
25    4 receives an allocation of New State Funds equal to the
26    product of its Adequacy Target and the tier's Allocation

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 185 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Rate, as specified in paragraph (4) of this subsection (g).
2        (2) To ensure equitable distribution of dollars for all
3    Tier 2 Organizational Units, no Tier 2 Organizational Unit
4    shall receive fewer dollars per ASE than any Tier 3
5    Organizational Unit. Each Tier 2 and Tier 3 Organizational
6    Unit shall have its funding allocation divided by its ASE.
7    Any Tier 2 Organizational Unit with a funding allocation
8    per ASE below the greatest Tier 3 allocation per ASE shall
9    get a funding allocation equal to the greatest Tier 3
10    funding allocation per ASE multiplied by the
11    Organizational Unit's ASE. Each Tier 2 Organizational
12    Unit's Tier 2 funding allocation shall be multiplied by the
13    percentage calculated by dividing the original Tier 2
14    Aggregate Funding by the sum of all Tier 2 Organizational
15    Units' Tier 2 funding allocation after adjusting
16    districts' funding below Tier 3 levels.
17        (3) Organizational Units are placed into one of 4 tiers
18    as follows:
19            (A) Tier 1 consists of all Organizational Units,
20        except for Specially Funded Units, with a Percent of
21        Adequacy less than the Tier 1 Target Ratio. The Tier 1
22        Target Ratio is the ratio level that allows for Tier 1
23        Aggregate Funding to be distributed, with the Tier 1
24        Allocation Rate determined pursuant to paragraph (4)
25        of this subsection (g).
26            (B) Tier 2 consists of all Tier 1 Units and all

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 186 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        other Organizational Units, except for Specially
2        Funded Units, with a Percent of Adequacy of less than
3        0.90.
4            (C) Tier 3 consists of all Organizational Units,
5        except for Specially Funded Units, with a Percent of
6        Adequacy of at least 0.90 and less than 1.0.
7            (D) Tier 4 consists of all Organizational Units
8        with a Percent of Adequacy of at least 1.0.
9        (4) The Allocation Rates for Tiers 1 through 4 are
10    determined as follows:
11            (A) The Tier 1 Allocation Rate is 30%.
12            (B) The Tier 2 Allocation Rate is the result of the
13        following equation: Tier 2 Aggregate Funding, divided
14        by the sum of the Funding Gaps for all Tier 2
15        Organizational Units, unless the result of such
16        equation is higher than 1.0. If the result of such
17        equation is higher than 1.0, then the Tier 2 Allocation
18        Rate is 1.0.
19            (C) The Tier 3 Allocation Rate is the result of the
20        following equation: Tier 3 Aggregate Funding, divided
21        by the sum of the Adequacy Targets of all Tier 3
22        Organizational Units.
23            (D) The Tier 4 Allocation Rate is the result of the
24        following equation: Tier 4 Aggregate Funding, divided
25        by the sum of the Adequacy Targets of all Tier 4
26        Organizational Units.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 187 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (5) A tier's Target Ratio is determined as follows:
2            (A) The Tier 1 Target Ratio is the ratio level that
3        allows for Tier 1 Aggregate Funding to be distributed
4        with the Tier 1 Allocation Rate.
5            (B) The Tier 2 Target Ratio is 0.90.
6            (C) The Tier 3 Target Ratio is 1.0.
7        (6) If, at any point, the Tier 1 Target Ratio is
8    greater than 90%, then than all Tier 1 funding shall be
9    allocated to Tier 2 and no Tier 1 Organizational Unit's
10    funding may be identified.
11        (7) In the event that all Tier 2 Organizational Units
12    receive funding at the Tier 2 Target Ratio level, any
13    remaining New State Funds shall be allocated to Tier 3 and
14    Tier 4 Organizational Units.
15        (8) If any Specially Funded Units, excluding Glenwood
16    Academy, recognized by the State Board do not qualify for
17    direct funding following the implementation of Public Act
18    100-465 from any of the funding sources included within the
19    definition of Base Funding Minimum, the unqualified
20    portion of the Base Funding Minimum shall be transferred to
21    one or more appropriate Organizational Units as determined
22    by the State Superintendent based on the prior year ASE of
23    the Organizational Units.
24        (8.5) If a school district withdraws from a special
25    education cooperative, the portion of the Base Funding
26    Minimum that is attributable to the school district may be

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 188 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    redistributed to the school district upon withdrawal. The
2    school district and the cooperative must include the amount
3    of the Base Funding Minimum that is to be reapportioned in
4    their withdrawal agreement and notify the State Board of
5    the change with a copy of the agreement upon withdrawal.
6        (9) The Minimum Funding Level is intended to establish
7    a target for State funding that will keep pace with
8    inflation and continue to advance equity through the
9    Evidence-Based Funding formula. The target for State
10    funding of New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds is
11    $50,000,000 for State fiscal year 2019 and subsequent State
12    fiscal years. The Minimum Funding Level is equal to
13    $350,000,000 through State fiscal year 2021. The Minimum
14    Funding Level is equal to $420,000,000 for State fiscal
15    year 2022 and subsequent State fiscal years. In addition to
16    any New State Funds, no more than $50,000,000 New Property
17    Tax Relief Pool Funds may be counted toward the Minimum
18    Funding Level. If the sum of New State Funds and applicable
19    New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds are less than the
20    Minimum Funding Level, than funding for tiers shall be
21    reduced in the following manner:
22            (A) First, Tier 4 funding shall be reduced by an
23        amount equal to the difference between the Minimum
24        Funding Level and New State Funds until such time as
25        Tier 4 funding is exhausted.
26            (B) Next, Tier 3 funding shall be reduced by an

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 189 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        amount equal to the difference between the Minimum
2        Funding Level and New State Funds and the reduction in
3        Tier 4 funding until such time as Tier 3 funding is
4        exhausted.
5            (C) Next, Tier 2 funding shall be reduced by an
6        amount equal to the difference between the Minimum
7        Funding Level and New State Funds and the reduction in
8        Tier 4 and Tier 3.
9            (D) Finally, Tier 1 funding shall be reduced by an
10        amount equal to the difference between the Minimum
11        Funding level and New State Funds and the reduction in
12        Tier 2, 3, and 4 funding. In addition, the Allocation
13        Rate for Tier 1 shall be reduced to a percentage equal
14        to the Tier 1 Allocation Rate set by paragraph (4) of
15        this subsection (g), multiplied by the result of New
16        State Funds divided by the Minimum Funding Level.
17        (9.5) For State fiscal year 2019 through State fiscal
18    year 2021 and subsequent State fiscal years, if New State
19    Funds exceed $300,000,000, then any amount in excess of
20    $300,000,000 shall be dedicated for purposes of Section
21    2-3.170 of this Code up to a maximum of $50,000,000. For
22    State fiscal year 2022 and subsequent State fiscal years,
23    if New State Funds exceed $370,000,000, then any amount in
24    excess of $370,000,000 shall be dedicated for purposes of
25    Section 2-3.170 of this Code up to a maximum of
26    $50,000,000.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 190 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (10) In the event of a decrease in the amount of the
2    appropriation for this Section in any fiscal year after
3    implementation of this Section, the Organizational Units
4    receiving Tier 1 and Tier 2 funding, as determined under
5    paragraph (3) of this subsection (g), shall be held
6    harmless by establishing a Base Funding Guarantee equal to
7    the per pupil kindergarten through grade 12 funding
8    received in accordance with this Section in the prior
9    fiscal year. Reductions shall be made to the Base Funding
10    Minimum of Organizational Units in Tier 3 and Tier 4 on a
11    per pupil basis equivalent to the total number of the ASE
12    in Tier 3-funded and Tier 4-funded Organizational Units
13    divided by the total reduction in State funding. The Base
14    Funding Minimum as reduced shall continue to be applied to
15    Tier 3 and Tier 4 Organizational Units and adjusted by the
16    relative formula when increases in appropriations for this
17    Section resume. In no event may State funding reductions to
18    Organizational Units in Tier 3 or Tier 4 exceed an amount
19    that would be less than the Base Funding Minimum
20    established in the first year of implementation of this
21    Section. If additional reductions are required, all school
22    districts shall receive a reduction by a per pupil amount
23    equal to the aggregate additional appropriation reduction
24    divided by the total ASE of all Organizational Units.
25        (11) The State Superintendent shall make minor
26    adjustments to the distribution formula set forth in this

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 191 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    subsection (g) to account for the rounding of percentages
2    to the nearest tenth of a percentage and dollar amounts to
3    the nearest whole dollar.
4    (h) State Superintendent administration of funding and
5district submission requirements.
6        (1) The State Superintendent shall, in accordance with
7    appropriations made by the General Assembly, meet the
8    funding obligations created under this Section.
9        (2) The State Superintendent shall calculate the
10    Adequacy Target for each Organizational Unit and Net State
11    Contribution Target for each Organizational Unit under
12    this Section. No Evidence-Based Funding shall be
13    distributed within an Organizational Unit without the
14    approval of the unit's school board.
15        (3) Annually, the State Superintendent shall calculate
16    and report to each Organizational Unit the unit's aggregate
17    financial adequacy amount, which shall be the sum of the
18    Adequacy Target for each Organizational Unit. The State
19    Superintendent shall calculate and report separately for
20    each Organizational Unit the unit's total State funds
21    allocated for its students with disabilities. The State
22    Superintendent shall calculate and report separately for
23    each Organizational Unit the amount of funding and
24    applicable FTE calculated for each Essential Element of the
25    unit's Adequacy Target.
26        (4) Annually, the State Superintendent shall calculate

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 192 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    and report to each Organizational Unit the amount the unit
2    must expend on special education, and bilingual education,
3    anti-racism initiatives approved under Section 2-3.184 of
4    this Code, and computer technology and equipment for
5    Organizational Units assigned to Tier 1 or Tier 2 that
6    received an additional $285.50 per student computer
7    technology and equipment investment grant to their
8    Adequacy Target pursuant to the unit's Base Funding
9    Minimum, Special Education Allocation, Bilingual Education
10    Allocation, anti-racism investment allocation, and
11    computer technology and equipment investment allocation.
12        (5) Moneys distributed under this Section shall be
13    calculated on a school year basis, but paid on a fiscal
14    year basis, with payments beginning in August and extending
15    through June. Unless otherwise provided, the moneys
16    appropriated for each fiscal year shall be distributed in
17    22 equal payments at least 2 times monthly to each
18    Organizational Unit. If moneys appropriated for any fiscal
19    year are distributed other than monthly, the distribution
20    shall be on the same basis for each Organizational Unit.
21        (6) Any school district that fails, for any given
22    school year, to maintain school as required by law or to
23    maintain a recognized school is not eligible to receive
24    Evidence-Based Funding. In case of non-recognition of one
25    or more attendance centers in a school district otherwise
26    operating recognized schools, the claim of the district

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 193 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    shall be reduced in the proportion that the enrollment in
2    the attendance center or centers bears to the enrollment of
3    the school district. "Recognized school" means any public
4    school that meets the standards for recognition by the
5    State Board. A school district or attendance center not
6    having recognition status at the end of a school term is
7    entitled to receive State aid payments due upon a legal
8    claim that was filed while it was recognized.
9        (7) School district claims filed under this Section are
10    subject to Sections 18-9 and 18-12 of this Code, except as
11    otherwise provided in this Section.
12        (8) Each fiscal year, the State Superintendent shall
13    calculate for each Organizational Unit an amount of its
14    Base Funding Minimum and Evidence-Based Funding that shall
15    be deemed attributable to the provision of special
16    educational facilities and services, as defined in Section
17    14-1.08 of this Code, in a manner that ensures compliance
18    with maintenance of State financial support requirements
19    under the federal Individuals with Disabilities Education
20    Act. An Organizational Unit must use such funds only for
21    the provision of special educational facilities and
22    services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of this Code, and
23    must comply with any expenditure verification procedures
24    adopted by the State Board.
25        (9) All Organizational Units in this State must submit
26    annual spending plans by the end of September of each year

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 194 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    to the State Board as part of the annual budget process,
2    which shall describe how each Organizational Unit will
3    utilize the Base Funding Minimum and Evidence-Based
4    Funding it receives from this State under this Section with
5    specific identification of the intended utilization of
6    Low-Income, English learner, and special education
7    resources. Additionally, the annual spending plans of each
8    Organizational Unit shall describe how the Organizational
9    Unit expects to achieve student growth and how the
10    Organizational Unit will achieve State education goals, as
11    defined by the State Board. The State Superintendent may,
12    from time to time, identify additional requisites for
13    Organizational Units to satisfy when compiling the annual
14    spending plans required under this subsection (h). The
15    format and scope of annual spending plans shall be
16    developed by the State Superintendent and the State Board
17    of Education. School districts that serve students under
18    Article 14C of this Code shall continue to submit
19    information as required under Section 14C-12 of this Code.
20        (10) No later than January 1, 2018, the State
21    Superintendent shall develop a 5-year strategic plan for
22    all Organizational Units to help in planning for adequacy
23    funding under this Section. The State Superintendent shall
24    submit the plan to the Governor and the General Assembly,
25    as provided in Section 3.1 of the General Assembly
26    Organization Act. The plan shall include recommendations

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 195 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    for:
2            (A) a framework for collaborative, professional,
3        innovative, and 21st century learning environments
4        using the Evidence-Based Funding model;
5            (B) ways to prepare and support this State's
6        educators for successful instructional careers;
7            (C) application and enhancement of the current
8        financial accountability measures, the approved State
9        plan to comply with the federal Every Student Succeeds
10        Act, and the Illinois Balanced Accountability Measures
11        in relation to student growth and elements of the
12        Evidence-Based Funding model; and
13            (D) implementation of an effective school adequacy
14        funding system based on projected and recommended
15        funding levels from the General Assembly.
16        (11) On an annual basis, the State Superintendent must
17    recalibrate all of the following per pupil elements of the
18    Adequacy Target and applied to the formulas, based on the
19    study of average expenses and as reported in the most
20    recent annual financial report:
21            (A) Gifted under subparagraph (M) of paragraph (2)
22        of subsection (b).
23            (B) Instructional materials under subparagraph (O)
24        of paragraph (2) of subsection (b).
25            (C) Assessment under subparagraph (P) of paragraph
26        (2) of subsection (b).

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 196 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (D) Student activities under subparagraph (R) of
2        paragraph (2) of subsection (b).
3            (E) Maintenance and operations under subparagraph
4        (S) of paragraph (2) of subsection (b).
5            (F) Central office under subparagraph (T) of
6        paragraph (2) of subsection (b).
7    (i) Professional Review Panel.
8        (1) A Professional Review Panel is created to study and
9    review topics related to the implementation and effect of
10    Evidence-Based Funding, as assigned by a joint resolution
11    or Public Act of the General Assembly or a motion passed by
12    the State Board of Education. The Panel must provide
13    recommendations to and serve the Governor, the General
14    Assembly, and the State Board. The State Superintendent or
15    his or her designee must serve as a voting member and
16    chairperson of the Panel. The State Superintendent must
17    appoint a vice chairperson from the membership of the
18    Panel. The Panel must advance recommendations based on a
19    three-fifths majority vote of Panel members present and
20    voting. A minority opinion may also accompany any
21    recommendation of the Panel. The Panel shall be appointed
22    by the State Superintendent, except as otherwise provided
23    in paragraph (2) of this subsection (i) and include the
24    following members:
25            (A) Two appointees that represent district
26        superintendents, recommended by a statewide

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 197 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        organization that represents district superintendents.
2            (B) Two appointees that represent school boards,
3        recommended by a statewide organization that
4        represents school boards.
5            (C) Two appointees from districts that represent
6        school business officials, recommended by a statewide
7        organization that represents school business
8        officials.
9            (D) Two appointees that represent school
10        principals, recommended by a statewide organization
11        that represents school principals.
12            (E) Two appointees that represent teachers,
13        recommended by a statewide organization that
14        represents teachers.
15            (F) Two appointees that represent teachers,
16        recommended by another statewide organization that
17        represents teachers.
18            (G) Two appointees that represent regional
19        superintendents of schools, recommended by
20        organizations that represent regional superintendents.
21            (H) Two independent experts selected solely by the
22        State Superintendent.
23            (I) Two independent experts recommended by public
24        universities in this State.
25            (J) One member recommended by a statewide
26        organization that represents parents.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 198 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (K) Two representatives recommended by collective
2        impact organizations that represent major metropolitan
3        areas or geographic areas in Illinois.
4            (L) One member from a statewide organization
5        focused on research-based education policy to support
6        a school system that prepares all students for college,
7        a career, and democratic citizenship.
8            (M) One representative from a school district
9        organized under Article 34 of this Code.
10        The State Superintendent shall ensure that the
11    membership of the Panel includes representatives from
12    school districts and communities reflecting the
13    geographic, socio-economic, racial, and ethnic diversity
14    of this State. The State Superintendent shall additionally
15    ensure that the membership of the Panel includes
16    representatives with expertise in bilingual education and
17    special education. Staff from the State Board shall staff
18    the Panel.
19        (2) In addition to those Panel members appointed by the
20    State Superintendent, 4 members of the General Assembly
21    shall be appointed as follows: one member of the House of
22    Representatives appointed by the Speaker of the House of
23    Representatives, one member of the Senate appointed by the
24    President of the Senate, one member of the House of
25    Representatives appointed by the Minority Leader of the
26    House of Representatives, and one member of the Senate

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 199 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    appointed by the Minority Leader of the Senate. There shall
2    be one additional member appointed by the Governor. All
3    members appointed by legislative leaders or the Governor
4    shall be non-voting, ex officio members.
5        (3) The Panel must study topics at the direction of the
6    General Assembly or State Board of Education, as provided
7    under paragraph (1). The Panel may also study the following
8    topics at the direction of the chairperson:
9            (A) The format and scope of annual spending plans
10        referenced in paragraph (9) of subsection (h) of this
11        Section.
12            (B) The Comparable Wage Index under this Section.
13            (C) Maintenance and operations, including capital
14        maintenance and construction costs.
15            (D) "At-risk student" definition.
16            (E) Benefits.
17            (F) Technology.
18            (G) Local Capacity Target.
19            (H) Funding for Alternative Schools, Laboratory
20        Schools, safe schools, and alternative learning
21        opportunities programs.
22            (I) Funding for college and career acceleration
23        strategies.
24            (J) Special education investments.
25            (K) Early childhood investments, in collaboration
26        with the Illinois Early Learning Council.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 200 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (L) Anti-racism investments.
2        (4) (Blank).
3        (5) Within 5 years after the implementation of this
4    Section, and every 5 years thereafter, the Panel shall
5    complete an evaluative study of the entire Evidence-Based
6    Funding model, including an assessment of whether or not
7    the formula is achieving State goals. The Panel shall
8    report to the State Board, the General Assembly, and the
9    Governor on the findings of the study.
10        (6) (Blank).
11    (j) References. Beginning July 1, 2017, references in other
12laws to general State aid funds or calculations under Section
1318-8.05 of this Code (now repealed) shall be deemed to be
14references to evidence-based model formula funds or
15calculations under this Section.
16(Source: P.A. 100-465, eff. 8-31-17; 100-578, eff. 1-31-18;
17100-582, eff. 3-23-18; 101-10, eff. 6-5-19; 101-17, eff.
186-14-19; 101-643, eff. 6-18-20; revised 8-21-20.)
 
19
Article 60.

 
20    Section 5. The School Code is amended by adding Sections
212-3.185 and 27-23.15 and by changing Sections 10-17a, 18-8.15,
22and 27-22 as follows:
 
23    (105 ILCS 5/2-3.185 new)

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 201 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Sec. 2-3.185. Computer science standards and courses. On or
2before December 1, 2021, the State Board of Education shall:
3        (1) develop or adopt rigorous learning standards in the
4    area of computer science; and
5        (2) analyze and revise, if appropriate, existing
6    course titles dedicated to computer science or develop a
7    short list of existing course titles that are recommended
8    for computer science courses.
 
9    (105 ILCS 5/10-17a)  (from Ch. 122, par. 10-17a)
10    Sec. 10-17a. State, school district, and school report
11cards.
12    (1) By October 31, 2013 and October 31 of each subsequent
13school year, the State Board of Education, through the State
14Superintendent of Education, shall prepare a State report card,
15school district report cards, and school report cards, and
16shall by the most economic means provide to each school
17district in this State, including special charter districts and
18districts subject to the provisions of Article 34, the report
19cards for the school district and each of its schools.
20    (2) In addition to any information required by federal law,
21the State Superintendent shall determine the indicators and
22presentation of the school report card, which must include, at
23a minimum, the most current data collected and maintained by
24the State Board of Education related to the following:
25        (A) school characteristics and student demographics,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 202 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    including average class size, average teaching experience,
2    student racial/ethnic breakdown, and the percentage of
3    students classified as low-income; the percentage of
4    students classified as English learners; the percentage of
5    students who have individualized education plans or 504
6    plans that provide for special education services; the
7    number and percentage of all students who have been
8    assessed for placement in a gifted education or advanced
9    academic program and, of those students: (i) the racial and
10    ethnic breakdown, (ii) the percentage who are classified as
11    low-income, and (iii) the number and percentage of students
12    who received direct instruction from a teacher who holds a
13    gifted education endorsement and, of those students, the
14    percentage who are classified as low-income; the
15    percentage of students scoring at the "exceeds
16    expectations" level on the assessments required under
17    Section 2-3.64a-5 of this Code; the percentage of students
18    who annually transferred in or out of the school district;
19    average daily attendance; the per-pupil operating
20    expenditure of the school district; and the per-pupil State
21    average operating expenditure for the district type
22    (elementary, high school, or unit);
23        (B) curriculum information, including, where
24    applicable, Advanced Placement, International
25    Baccalaureate or equivalent courses, dual enrollment
26    courses, foreign language classes, computer science

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 203 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    courses, school personnel resources (including Career
2    Technical Education teachers), before and after school
3    programs, extracurricular activities, subjects in which
4    elective classes are offered, health and wellness
5    initiatives (including the average number of days of
6    Physical Education per week per student), approved
7    programs of study, awards received, community
8    partnerships, and special programs such as programming for
9    the gifted and talented, students with disabilities, and
10    work-study students;
11        (C) student outcomes, including, where applicable, the
12    percentage of students deemed proficient on assessments of
13    State standards, the percentage of students in the eighth
14    grade who pass Algebra, the percentage of students who
15    participated in workplace learning experiences, the
16    percentage of students enrolled in post-secondary
17    institutions (including colleges, universities, community
18    colleges, trade/vocational schools, and training programs
19    leading to career certification within 2 semesters of high
20    school graduation), the percentage of students graduating
21    from high school who are college and career ready, and the
22    percentage of graduates enrolled in community colleges,
23    colleges, and universities who are in one or more courses
24    that the community college, college, or university
25    identifies as a developmental course;
26        (D) student progress, including, where applicable, the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 204 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    percentage of students in the ninth grade who have earned 5
2    credits or more without failing more than one core class, a
3    measure of students entering kindergarten ready to learn, a
4    measure of growth, and the percentage of students who enter
5    high school on track for college and career readiness;
6        (E) the school environment, including, where
7    applicable, the percentage of students with less than 10
8    absences in a school year, the percentage of teachers with
9    less than 10 absences in a school year for reasons other
10    than professional development, leaves taken pursuant to
11    the federal Family Medical Leave Act of 1993, long-term
12    disability, or parental leaves, the 3-year average of the
13    percentage of teachers returning to the school from the
14    previous year, the number of different principals at the
15    school in the last 6 years, the number of teachers who hold
16    a gifted education endorsement, the process and criteria
17    used by the district to determine whether a student is
18    eligible for participation in a gifted education program or
19    advanced academic program and the manner in which parents
20    and guardians are made aware of the process and criteria, 2
21    or more indicators from any school climate survey selected
22    or approved by the State and administered pursuant to
23    Section 2-3.153 of this Code, with the same or similar
24    indicators included on school report cards for all surveys
25    selected or approved by the State pursuant to Section
26    2-3.153 of this Code, and the combined percentage of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 205 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    teachers rated as proficient or excellent in their most
2    recent evaluation;
3        (F) a school district's and its individual schools'
4    balanced accountability measure, in accordance with
5    Section 2-3.25a of this Code;
6        (G) the total and per pupil normal cost amount the
7    State contributed to the Teachers' Retirement System of the
8    State of Illinois in the prior fiscal year for the school's
9    employees, which shall be reported to the State Board of
10    Education by the Teachers' Retirement System of the State
11    of Illinois;
12        (H) for a school district organized under Article 34 of
13    this Code only, State contributions to the Public School
14    Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of Chicago and State
15    contributions for health care for employees of that school
16    district;
17        (I) a school district's Final Percent of Adequacy, as
18    defined in paragraph (4) of subsection (f) of Section
19    18-8.15 of this Code;
20        (J) a school district's Local Capacity Target, as
21    defined in paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of Section
22    18-8.15 of this Code, displayed as a percentage amount;
23        (K) a school district's Real Receipts, as defined in
24    paragraph (1) of subsection (d) of Section 18-8.15 of this
25    Code, divided by a school district's Adequacy Target, as
26    defined in paragraph (1) of subsection (b) of Section

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 206 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    18-8.15 of this Code, displayed as a percentage amount;
2        (L) a school district's administrative costs; and
3        (M) whether or not the school has participated in the
4    Illinois Youth Survey. In this paragraph (M), "Illinois
5    Youth Survey" means a self-report survey, administered in
6    school settings every 2 years, designed to gather
7    information about health and social indicators, including
8    substance abuse patterns and the attitudes of students in
9    grades 8, 10, and 12; and
10        (N) whether the school offered its students career and
11    technical education opportunities.
12    The school report card shall also provide information that
13allows for comparing the current outcome, progress, and
14environment data to the State average, to the school data from
15the past 5 years, and to the outcomes, progress, and
16environment of similar schools based on the type of school and
17enrollment of low-income students, special education students,
18and English learners.
19    As used in this subsection (2):
20    "Administrative costs" means costs associated with
21executive, administrative, or managerial functions within the
22school district that involve planning, organizing, managing,
23or directing the school district.
24    "Advanced academic program" means a course of study to
25which students are assigned based on advanced cognitive ability
26or advanced academic achievement compared to local age peers

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 207 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1and in which the curriculum is substantially differentiated
2from the general curriculum to provide appropriate challenge
3and pace.
4    "Computer science" means the study of computers and
5algorithms, including their principles, their hardware and
6software designs, their implementation, and their impact on
7society. "Computer science" does not include the study of
8everyday uses of computers and computer applications, such as
9keyboarding or accessing the Internet.
10    "Gifted education" means educational services, including
11differentiated curricula and instructional methods, designed
12to meet the needs of gifted children as defined in Article 14A
13of this Code.
14    For the purposes of paragraph (A) of this subsection (2),
15"average daily attendance" means the average of the actual
16number of attendance days during the previous school year for
17any enrolled student who is subject to compulsory attendance by
18Section 26-1 of this Code at each school and charter school.
19    (3) At the discretion of the State Superintendent, the
20school district report card shall include a subset of the
21information identified in paragraphs (A) through (E) of
22subsection (2) of this Section, as well as information relating
23to the operating expense per pupil and other finances of the
24school district, and the State report card shall include a
25subset of the information identified in paragraphs (A) through
26(E) and paragraph (N) of subsection (2) of this Section. The

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 208 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1school district report card shall include the average daily
2attendance, as that term is defined in subsection (2) of this
3Section, of students who have individualized education
4programs and students who have 504 plans that provide for
5special education services within the school district.
6    (4) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this
7Section, in consultation with key education stakeholders, the
8State Superintendent shall at any time have the discretion to
9amend or update any and all metrics on the school, district, or
10State report card.
11    (5) Annually, no more than 30 calendar days after receipt
12of the school district and school report cards from the State
13Superintendent of Education, each school district, including
14special charter districts and districts subject to the
15provisions of Article 34, shall present such report cards at a
16regular school board meeting subject to applicable notice
17requirements, post the report cards on the school district's
18Internet web site, if the district maintains an Internet web
19site, make the report cards available to a newspaper of general
20circulation serving the district, and, upon request, send the
21report cards home to a parent (unless the district does not
22maintain an Internet web site, in which case the report card
23shall be sent home to parents without request). If the district
24posts the report card on its Internet web site, the district
25shall send a written notice home to parents stating (i) that
26the report card is available on the web site, (ii) the address

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 209 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1of the web site, (iii) that a printed copy of the report card
2will be sent to parents upon request, and (iv) the telephone
3number that parents may call to request a printed copy of the
4report card.
5    (6) Nothing contained in Public Act 98-648 repeals,
6supersedes, invalidates, or nullifies final decisions in
7lawsuits pending on July 1, 2014 (the effective date of Public
8Act 98-648) in Illinois courts involving the interpretation of
9Public Act 97-8.
10(Source: P.A. 100-227, eff. 8-18-17; 100-364, eff. 1-1-18;
11100-448, eff. 7-1-19; 100-465, eff. 8-31-17; 100-807, eff.
128-10-18; 100-863, eff. 8-14-18; 100-1121, eff. 1-1-19; 101-68,
13eff. 1-1-20; 101-81, eff. 7-12-19; revised 9-9-19.)
 
14    (105 ILCS 5/18-8.15)
15    Sec. 18-8.15. Evidence-Based Funding for student success
16for the 2017-2018 and subsequent school years.
17    (a) General provisions.
18        (1) The purpose of this Section is to ensure that, by
19    June 30, 2027 and beyond, this State has a kindergarten
20    through grade 12 public education system with the capacity
21    to ensure the educational development of all persons to the
22    limits of their capacities in accordance with Section 1 of
23    Article X of the Constitution of the State of Illinois. To
24    accomplish that objective, this Section creates a method of
25    funding public education that is evidence-based; is

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 210 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    sufficient to ensure every student receives a meaningful
2    opportunity to learn irrespective of race, ethnicity,
3    sexual orientation, gender, or community-income level; and
4    is sustainable and predictable. When fully funded under
5    this Section, every school shall have the resources, based
6    on what the evidence indicates is needed, to:
7            (A) provide all students with a high quality
8        education that offers the academic, enrichment, social
9        and emotional support, technical, and career-focused
10        programs that will allow them to become competitive
11        workers, responsible parents, productive citizens of
12        this State, and active members of our national
13        democracy;
14            (B) ensure all students receive the education they
15        need to graduate from high school with the skills
16        required to pursue post-secondary education and
17        training for a rewarding career;
18            (C) reduce, with a goal of eliminating, the
19        achievement gap between at-risk and non-at-risk
20        students by raising the performance of at-risk
21        students and not by reducing standards; and
22            (D) ensure this State satisfies its obligation to
23        assume the primary responsibility to fund public
24        education and simultaneously relieve the
25        disproportionate burden placed on local property taxes
26        to fund schools.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 211 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (2) The Evidence-Based Funding formula under this
2    Section shall be applied to all Organizational Units in
3    this State. The Evidence-Based Funding formula outlined in
4    this Act is based on the formula outlined in Senate Bill 1
5    of the 100th General Assembly, as passed by both
6    legislative chambers. As further defined and described in
7    this Section, there are 4 major components of the
8    Evidence-Based Funding model:
9            (A) First, the model calculates a unique Adequacy
10        Target for each Organizational Unit in this State that
11        considers the costs to implement research-based
12        activities, the unit's student demographics, and
13        regional wage differences.
14            (B) Second, the model calculates each
15        Organizational Unit's Local Capacity, or the amount
16        each Organizational Unit is assumed to contribute
17        toward its Adequacy Target from local resources.
18            (C) Third, the model calculates how much funding
19        the State currently contributes to the Organizational
20        Unit and adds that to the unit's Local Capacity to
21        determine the unit's overall current adequacy of
22        funding.
23            (D) Finally, the model's distribution method
24        allocates new State funding to those Organizational
25        Units that are least well-funded, considering both
26        Local Capacity and State funding, in relation to their

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 212 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        Adequacy Target.
2        (3) An Organizational Unit receiving any funding under
3    this Section may apply those funds to any fund so received
4    for which that Organizational Unit is authorized to make
5    expenditures by law.
6        (4) As used in this Section, the following terms shall
7    have the meanings ascribed in this paragraph (4):
8        "Adequacy Target" is defined in paragraph (1) of
9    subsection (b) of this Section.
10        "Adjusted EAV" is defined in paragraph (4) of
11    subsection (d) of this Section.
12        "Adjusted Local Capacity Target" is defined in
13    paragraph (3) of subsection (c) of this Section.
14        "Adjusted Operating Tax Rate" means a tax rate for all
15    Organizational Units, for which the State Superintendent
16    shall calculate and subtract for the Operating Tax Rate a
17    transportation rate based on total expenses for
18    transportation services under this Code, as reported on the
19    most recent Annual Financial Report in Pupil
20    Transportation Services, function 2550 in both the
21    Education and Transportation funds and functions 4110 and
22    4120 in the Transportation fund, less any corresponding
23    fiscal year State of Illinois scheduled payments excluding
24    net adjustments for prior years for regular, vocational, or
25    special education transportation reimbursement pursuant to
26    Section 29-5 or subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of this

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 213 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Code divided by the Adjusted EAV. If an Organizational
2    Unit's corresponding fiscal year State of Illinois
3    scheduled payments excluding net adjustments for prior
4    years for regular, vocational, or special education
5    transportation reimbursement pursuant to Section 29-5 or
6    subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of this Code exceed the
7    total transportation expenses, as defined in this
8    paragraph, no transportation rate shall be subtracted from
9    the Operating Tax Rate.
10        "Allocation Rate" is defined in paragraph (3) of
11    subsection (g) of this Section.
12        "Alternative School" means a public school that is
13    created and operated by a regional superintendent of
14    schools and approved by the State Board.
15        "Applicable Tax Rate" is defined in paragraph (1) of
16    subsection (d) of this Section.
17        "Assessment" means any of those benchmark, progress
18    monitoring, formative, diagnostic, and other assessments,
19    in addition to the State accountability assessment, that
20    assist teachers' needs in understanding the skills and
21    meeting the needs of the students they serve.
22        "Assistant principal" means a school administrator
23    duly endorsed to be employed as an assistant principal in
24    this State.
25        "At-risk student" means a student who is at risk of not
26    meeting the Illinois Learning Standards or not graduating

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 214 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    from elementary or high school and who demonstrates a need
2    for vocational support or social services beyond that
3    provided by the regular school program. All students
4    included in an Organizational Unit's Low-Income Count, as
5    well as all English learner and disabled students attending
6    the Organizational Unit, shall be considered at-risk
7    students under this Section.
8        "Average Student Enrollment" or "ASE" for fiscal year
9    2018 means, for an Organizational Unit, the greater of the
10    average number of students (grades K through 12) reported
11    to the State Board as enrolled in the Organizational Unit
12    on October 1 in the immediately preceding school year, plus
13    the pre-kindergarten students who receive special
14    education services of 2 or more hours a day as reported to
15    the State Board on December 1 in the immediately preceding
16    school year, or the average number of students (grades K
17    through 12) reported to the State Board as enrolled in the
18    Organizational Unit on October 1, plus the
19    pre-kindergarten students who receive special education
20    services of 2 or more hours a day as reported to the State
21    Board on December 1, for each of the immediately preceding
22    3 school years. For fiscal year 2019 and each subsequent
23    fiscal year, "Average Student Enrollment" or "ASE" means,
24    for an Organizational Unit, the greater of the average
25    number of students (grades K through 12) reported to the
26    State Board as enrolled in the Organizational Unit on

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 215 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    October 1 and March 1 in the immediately preceding school
2    year, plus the pre-kindergarten students who receive
3    special education services as reported to the State Board
4    on October 1 and March 1 in the immediately preceding
5    school year, or the average number of students (grades K
6    through 12) reported to the State Board as enrolled in the
7    Organizational Unit on October 1 and March 1, plus the
8    pre-kindergarten students who receive special education
9    services as reported to the State Board on October 1 and
10    March 1, for each of the immediately preceding 3 school
11    years. For the purposes of this definition, "enrolled in
12    the Organizational Unit" means the number of students
13    reported to the State Board who are enrolled in schools
14    within the Organizational Unit that the student attends or
15    would attend if not placed or transferred to another school
16    or program to receive needed services. For the purposes of
17    calculating "ASE", all students, grades K through 12,
18    excluding those attending kindergarten for a half day and
19    students attending an alternative education program
20    operated by a regional office of education or intermediate
21    service center, shall be counted as 1.0. All students
22    attending kindergarten for a half day shall be counted as
23    0.5, unless in 2017 by June 15 or by March 1 in subsequent
24    years, the school district reports to the State Board of
25    Education the intent to implement full-day kindergarten
26    district-wide for all students, then all students

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 216 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    attending kindergarten shall be counted as 1.0. Special
2    education pre-kindergarten students shall be counted as
3    0.5 each. If the State Board does not collect or has not
4    collected both an October 1 and March 1 enrollment count by
5    grade or a December 1 collection of special education
6    pre-kindergarten students as of August 31, 2017 (the
7    effective date of Public Act 100-465), it shall establish
8    such collection for all future years. For any year in which
9    a count by grade level was collected only once, that count
10    shall be used as the single count available for computing a
11    3-year average ASE. Funding for programs operated by a
12    regional office of education or an intermediate service
13    center must be calculated using the Evidence-Based Funding
14    formula under this Section for the 2019-2020 school year
15    and each subsequent school year until separate adequacy
16    formulas are developed and adopted for each type of
17    program. ASE for a program operated by a regional office of
18    education or an intermediate service center must be
19    determined by the March 1 enrollment for the program. For
20    the 2019-2020 school year, the ASE used in the calculation
21    must be the first-year ASE and, in that year only, the
22    assignment of students served by a regional office of
23    education or intermediate service center shall not result
24    in a reduction of the March enrollment for any school
25    district. For the 2020-2021 school year, the ASE must be
26    the greater of the current-year ASE or the 2-year average

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 217 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    ASE. Beginning with the 2021-2022 school year, the ASE must
2    be the greater of the current-year ASE or the 3-year
3    average ASE. School districts shall submit the data for the
4    ASE calculation to the State Board within 45 days of the
5    dates required in this Section for submission of enrollment
6    data in order for it to be included in the ASE calculation.
7    For fiscal year 2018 only, the ASE calculation shall
8    include only enrollment taken on October 1.
9        "Base Funding Guarantee" is defined in paragraph (10)
10    of subsection (g) of this Section.
11        "Base Funding Minimum" is defined in subsection (e) of
12    this Section.
13        "Base Tax Year" means the property tax levy year used
14    to calculate the Budget Year allocation of primary State
15    aid.
16        "Base Tax Year's Extension" means the product of the
17    equalized assessed valuation utilized by the county clerk
18    in the Base Tax Year multiplied by the limiting rate as
19    calculated by the county clerk and defined in PTELL.
20        "Bilingual Education Allocation" means the amount of
21    an Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target
22    attributable to bilingual education divided by the
23    Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target, the product
24    of which shall be multiplied by the amount of new funding
25    received pursuant to this Section. An Organizational
26    Unit's final Adequacy Target attributable to bilingual

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 218 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    education shall include all additional investments in
2    English learner students' adequacy elements.
3        "Budget Year" means the school year for which primary
4    State aid is calculated and awarded under this Section.
5        "Central office" means individual administrators and
6    support service personnel charged with managing the
7    instructional programs, business and operations, and
8    security of the Organizational Unit.
9        "Comparable Wage Index" or "CWI" means a regional cost
10    differentiation metric that measures systemic, regional
11    variations in the salaries of college graduates who are not
12    educators. The CWI utilized for this Section shall, for the
13    first 3 years of Evidence-Based Funding implementation, be
14    the CWI initially developed by the National Center for
15    Education Statistics, as most recently updated by Texas A &
16    M University. In the fourth and subsequent years of
17    Evidence-Based Funding implementation, the State
18    Superintendent shall re-determine the CWI using a similar
19    methodology to that identified in the Texas A & M
20    University study, with adjustments made no less frequently
21    than once every 5 years.
22        "Computer technology and equipment" means computers
23    servers, notebooks, network equipment, copiers, printers,
24    instructional software, security software, curriculum
25    management courseware, and other similar materials and
26    equipment.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 219 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        "Computer technology and equipment investment
2    allocation" means the final Adequacy Target amount of an
3    Organizational Unit assigned to Tier 1 or Tier 2 in the
4    prior school year attributable to the additional $285.50
5    per student computer technology and equipment investment
6    grant divided by the Organizational Unit's final Adequacy
7    Target, the result of which shall be multiplied by the
8    amount of new funding received pursuant to this Section. An
9    Organizational Unit assigned to a Tier 1 or Tier 2 final
10    Adequacy Target attributable to the received computer
11    technology and equipment investment grant shall include
12    all additional investments in computer technology and
13    equipment adequacy elements.
14        "Core subject" means mathematics; science; reading,
15    English, writing, and language arts; history and social
16    studies; world languages; and subjects taught as Advanced
17    Placement in high schools.
18        "Core teacher" means a regular classroom teacher in
19    elementary schools and teachers of a core subject in middle
20    and high schools.
21        "Core Intervention teacher (tutor)" means a licensed
22    teacher providing one-on-one or small group tutoring to
23    students struggling to meet proficiency in core subjects.
24        "CPPRT" means corporate personal property replacement
25    tax funds paid to an Organizational Unit during the
26    calendar year one year before the calendar year in which a

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 220 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    school year begins, pursuant to "An Act in relation to the
2    abolition of ad valorem personal property tax and the
3    replacement of revenues lost thereby, and amending and
4    repealing certain Acts and parts of Acts in connection
5    therewith", certified August 14, 1979, as amended (Public
6    Act 81-1st S.S.-1).
7        "EAV" means equalized assessed valuation as defined in
8    paragraph (2) of subsection (d) of this Section and
9    calculated in accordance with paragraph (3) of subsection
10    (d) of this Section.
11        "ECI" means the Bureau of Labor Statistics' national
12    employment cost index for civilian workers in educational
13    services in elementary and secondary schools on a
14    cumulative basis for the 12-month calendar year preceding
15    the fiscal year of the Evidence-Based Funding calculation.
16        "EIS Data" means the employment information system
17    data maintained by the State Board on educators within
18    Organizational Units.
19        "Employee benefits" means health, dental, and vision
20    insurance offered to employees of an Organizational Unit,
21    the costs associated with the statutorily required payment
22    of the normal cost of the Organizational Unit's teacher
23    pensions, Social Security employer contributions, and
24    Illinois Municipal Retirement Fund employer contributions.
25        "English learner" or "EL" means a child included in the
26    definition of "English learners" under Section 14C-2 of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 221 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    this Code participating in a program of transitional
2    bilingual education or a transitional program of
3    instruction meeting the requirements and program
4    application procedures of Article 14C of this Code. For the
5    purposes of collecting the number of EL students enrolled,
6    the same collection and calculation methodology as defined
7    above for "ASE" shall apply to English learners, with the
8    exception that EL student enrollment shall include
9    students in grades pre-kindergarten through 12.
10        "Essential Elements" means those elements, resources,
11    and educational programs that have been identified through
12    academic research as necessary to improve student success,
13    improve academic performance, close achievement gaps, and
14    provide for other per student costs related to the delivery
15    and leadership of the Organizational Unit, as well as the
16    maintenance and operations of the unit, and which are
17    specified in paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this
18    Section.
19        "Evidence-Based Funding" means State funding provided
20    to an Organizational Unit pursuant to this Section.
21        "Extended day" means academic and enrichment programs
22    provided to students outside the regular school day before
23    and after school or during non-instructional times during
24    the school day.
25        "Extension Limitation Ratio" means a numerical ratio
26    in which the numerator is the Base Tax Year's Extension and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 222 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    the denominator is the Preceding Tax Year's Extension.
2        "Final Percent of Adequacy" is defined in paragraph (4)
3    of subsection (f) of this Section.
4        "Final Resources" is defined in paragraph (3) of
5    subsection (f) of this Section.
6        "Full-time equivalent" or "FTE" means the full-time
7    equivalency compensation for staffing the relevant
8    position at an Organizational Unit.
9        "Funding Gap" is defined in paragraph (1) of subsection
10    (g).
11        "Guidance counselor" means a licensed guidance
12    counselor who provides guidance and counseling support for
13    students within an Organizational Unit.
14        "Hybrid District" means a partial elementary unit
15    district created pursuant to Article 11E of this Code.
16        "Instructional assistant" means a core or special
17    education, non-licensed employee who assists a teacher in
18    the classroom and provides academic support to students.
19        "Instructional facilitator" means a qualified teacher
20    or licensed teacher leader who facilitates and coaches
21    continuous improvement in classroom instruction; provides
22    instructional support to teachers in the elements of
23    research-based instruction or demonstrates the alignment
24    of instruction with curriculum standards and assessment
25    tools; develops or coordinates instructional programs or
26    strategies; develops and implements training; chooses

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 223 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    standards-based instructional materials; provides teachers
2    with an understanding of current research; serves as a
3    mentor, site coach, curriculum specialist, or lead
4    teacher; or otherwise works with fellow teachers, in
5    collaboration, to use data to improve instructional
6    practice or develop model lessons.
7        "Instructional materials" means relevant instructional
8    materials for student instruction, including, but not
9    limited to, textbooks, consumable workbooks, laboratory
10    equipment, library books, and other similar materials.
11        "Laboratory School" means a public school that is
12    created and operated by a public university and approved by
13    the State Board.
14        "Librarian" means a teacher with an endorsement as a
15    library information specialist or another individual whose
16    primary responsibility is overseeing library resources
17    within an Organizational Unit.
18        "Limiting rate for Hybrid Districts" means the
19    combined elementary school and high school limiting rates.
20        "Local Capacity" is defined in paragraph (1) of
21    subsection (c) of this Section.
22        "Local Capacity Percentage" is defined in subparagraph
23    (A) of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of this Section.
24        "Local Capacity Ratio" is defined in subparagraph (B)
25    of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of this Section.
26        "Local Capacity Target" is defined in paragraph (2) of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 224 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    subsection (c) of this Section.
2        "Low-Income Count" means, for an Organizational Unit
3    in a fiscal year, the higher of the average number of
4    students for the prior school year or the immediately
5    preceding 3 school years who, as of July 1 of the
6    immediately preceding fiscal year (as determined by the
7    Department of Human Services), are eligible for at least
8    one of the following low-income programs: Medicaid, the
9    Children's Health Insurance Program, Temporary Assistance
10    for Needy Families (TANF), or the Supplemental Nutrition
11    Assistance Program, excluding pupils who are eligible for
12    services provided by the Department of Children and Family
13    Services. Until such time that grade level low-income
14    populations become available, grade level low-income
15    populations shall be determined by applying the low-income
16    percentage to total student enrollments by grade level. The
17    low-income percentage is determined by dividing the
18    Low-Income Count by the Average Student Enrollment. The
19    low-income percentage for programs operated by a regional
20    office of education or an intermediate service center must
21    be set to the weighted average of the low-income
22    percentages of all of the school districts in the service
23    region. The weighted low-income percentage is the result of
24    multiplying the low-income percentage of each school
25    district served by the regional office of education or
26    intermediate service center by each school district's

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 225 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Average Student Enrollment, summarizing those products and
2    dividing the total by the total Average Student Enrollment
3    for the service region.
4        "Maintenance and operations" means custodial services,
5    facility and ground maintenance, facility operations,
6    facility security, routine facility repairs, and other
7    similar services and functions.
8        "Minimum Funding Level" is defined in paragraph (9) of
9    subsection (g) of this Section.
10        "New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds" means, for any
11    given fiscal year, all State funds appropriated under
12    Section 2-3.170 of this the School Code.
13        "New State Funds" means, for a given school year, all
14    State funds appropriated for Evidence-Based Funding in
15    excess of the amount needed to fund the Base Funding
16    Minimum for all Organizational Units in that school year.
17        "Net State Contribution Target" means, for a given
18    school year, the amount of State funds that would be
19    necessary to fully meet the Adequacy Target of an
20    Operational Unit minus the Preliminary Resources available
21    to each unit.
22        "Nurse" means an individual licensed as a certified
23    school nurse, in accordance with the rules established for
24    nursing services by the State Board, who is an employee of
25    and is available to provide health care-related services
26    for students of an Organizational Unit.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 226 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        "Operating Tax Rate" means the rate utilized in the
2    previous year to extend property taxes for all purposes,
3    except Bond and Interest, Summer School, Rent, Capital
4    Improvement, and Vocational Education Building purposes.
5    For Hybrid Districts, the Operating Tax Rate shall be the
6    combined elementary and high school rates utilized in the
7    previous year to extend property taxes for all purposes,
8    except Bond and Interest, Summer School, Rent, Capital
9    Improvement, and Vocational Education Building purposes.
10        "Organizational Unit" means a Laboratory School or any
11    public school district that is recognized as such by the
12    State Board and that contains elementary schools typically
13    serving kindergarten through 5th grades, middle schools
14    typically serving 6th through 8th grades, high schools
15    typically serving 9th through 12th grades, a program
16    established under Section 2-3.66 or 2-3.41, or a program
17    operated by a regional office of education or an
18    intermediate service center under Article 13A or 13B. The
19    General Assembly acknowledges that the actual grade levels
20    served by a particular Organizational Unit may vary
21    slightly from what is typical.
22        "Organizational Unit CWI" is determined by calculating
23    the CWI in the region and original county in which an
24    Organizational Unit's primary administrative office is
25    located as set forth in this paragraph, provided that if
26    the Organizational Unit CWI as calculated in accordance

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 227 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    with this paragraph is less than 0.9, the Organizational
2    Unit CWI shall be increased to 0.9. Each county's current
3    CWI value shall be adjusted based on the CWI value of that
4    county's neighboring Illinois counties, to create a
5    "weighted adjusted index value". This shall be calculated
6    by summing the CWI values of all of a county's adjacent
7    Illinois counties and dividing by the number of adjacent
8    Illinois counties, then taking the weighted value of the
9    original county's CWI value and the adjacent Illinois
10    county average. To calculate this weighted value, if the
11    number of adjacent Illinois counties is greater than 2, the
12    original county's CWI value will be weighted at 0.25 and
13    the adjacent Illinois county average will be weighted at
14    0.75. If the number of adjacent Illinois counties is 2, the
15    original county's CWI value will be weighted at 0.33 and
16    the adjacent Illinois county average will be weighted at
17    0.66. The greater of the county's current CWI value and its
18    weighted adjusted index value shall be used as the
19    Organizational Unit CWI.
20        "Preceding Tax Year" means the property tax levy year
21    immediately preceding the Base Tax Year.
22        "Preceding Tax Year's Extension" means the product of
23    the equalized assessed valuation utilized by the county
24    clerk in the Preceding Tax Year multiplied by the Operating
25    Tax Rate.
26        "Preliminary Percent of Adequacy" is defined in

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 228 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    paragraph (2) of subsection (f) of this Section.
2        "Preliminary Resources" is defined in paragraph (2) of
3    subsection (f) of this Section.
4        "Principal" means a school administrator duly endorsed
5    to be employed as a principal in this State.
6        "Professional development" means training programs for
7    licensed staff in schools, including, but not limited to,
8    programs that assist in implementing new curriculum
9    programs, provide data focused or academic assessment data
10    training to help staff identify a student's weaknesses and
11    strengths, target interventions, improve instruction,
12    encompass instructional strategies for English learner,
13    gifted, or at-risk students, address inclusivity, cultural
14    sensitivity, or implicit bias, or otherwise provide
15    professional support for licensed staff.
16        "Prototypical" means 450 special education
17    pre-kindergarten and kindergarten through grade 5 students
18    for an elementary school, 450 grade 6 through 8 students
19    for a middle school, and 600 grade 9 through 12 students
20    for a high school.
21        "PTELL" means the Property Tax Extension Limitation
22    Law.
23        "PTELL EAV" is defined in paragraph (4) of subsection
24    (d) of this Section.
25        "Pupil support staff" means a nurse, psychologist,
26    social worker, family liaison personnel, or other staff

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 229 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    member who provides support to at-risk or struggling
2    students.
3        "Real Receipts" is defined in paragraph (1) of
4    subsection (d) of this Section.
5        "Regionalization Factor" means, for a particular
6    Organizational Unit, the figure derived by dividing the
7    Organizational Unit CWI by the Statewide Weighted CWI.
8        "School site staff" means the primary school secretary
9    and any additional clerical personnel assigned to a school.
10        "Special education" means special educational
11    facilities and services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of
12    this Code.
13        "Special Education Allocation" means the amount of an
14    Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target attributable
15    to special education divided by the Organizational Unit's
16    final Adequacy Target, the product of which shall be
17    multiplied by the amount of new funding received pursuant
18    to this Section. An Organizational Unit's final Adequacy
19    Target attributable to special education shall include all
20    special education investment adequacy elements.
21        "Specialist teacher" means a teacher who provides
22    instruction in subject areas not included in core subjects,
23    including, but not limited to, art, music, physical
24    education, health, driver education, career-technical
25    education, and such other subject areas as may be mandated
26    by State law or provided by an Organizational Unit.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 230 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        "Specially Funded Unit" means an Alternative School,
2    safe school, Department of Juvenile Justice school,
3    special education cooperative or entity recognized by the
4    State Board as a special education cooperative,
5    State-approved charter school, or alternative learning
6    opportunities program that received direct funding from
7    the State Board during the 2016-2017 school year through
8    any of the funding sources included within the calculation
9    of the Base Funding Minimum or Glenwood Academy.
10        "Supplemental Grant Funding" means supplemental
11    general State aid funding received by an Organizational
12    Unit during the 2016-2017 school year pursuant to
13    subsection (H) of Section 18-8.05 of this Code (now
14    repealed).
15        "State Adequacy Level" is the sum of the Adequacy
16    Targets of all Organizational Units.
17        "State Board" means the State Board of Education.
18        "State Superintendent" means the State Superintendent
19    of Education.
20        "Statewide Weighted CWI" means a figure determined by
21    multiplying each Organizational Unit CWI times the ASE for
22    that Organizational Unit creating a weighted value,
23    summing all Organizational Units' weighted values, and
24    dividing by the total ASE of all Organizational Units,
25    thereby creating an average weighted index.
26        "Student activities" means non-credit producing

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 231 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    after-school programs, including, but not limited to,
2    clubs, bands, sports, and other activities authorized by
3    the school board of the Organizational Unit.
4        "Substitute teacher" means an individual teacher or
5    teaching assistant who is employed by an Organizational
6    Unit and is temporarily serving the Organizational Unit on
7    a per diem or per period-assignment basis to replace
8    another staff member.
9        "Summer school" means academic and enrichment programs
10    provided to students during the summer months outside of
11    the regular school year.
12        "Supervisory aide" means a non-licensed staff member
13    who helps in supervising students of an Organizational
14    Unit, but does so outside of the classroom, in situations
15    such as, but not limited to, monitoring hallways and
16    playgrounds, supervising lunchrooms, or supervising
17    students when being transported in buses serving the
18    Organizational Unit.
19        "Target Ratio" is defined in paragraph (4) of
20    subsection (g).
21        "Tier 1", "Tier 2", "Tier 3", and "Tier 4" are defined
22    in paragraph (3) of subsection (g).
23        "Tier 1 Aggregate Funding", "Tier 2 Aggregate
24    Funding", "Tier 3 Aggregate Funding", and "Tier 4 Aggregate
25    Funding" are defined in paragraph (1) of subsection (g).
26    (b) Adequacy Target calculation.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 232 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (1) Each Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target is the
2    sum of the Organizational Unit's cost of providing
3    Essential Elements, as calculated in accordance with this
4    subsection (b), with the salary amounts in the Essential
5    Elements multiplied by a Regionalization Factor calculated
6    pursuant to paragraph (3) of this subsection (b).
7        (2) The Essential Elements are attributable on a pro
8    rata basis related to defined subgroups of the ASE of each
9    Organizational Unit as specified in this paragraph (2),
10    with investments and FTE positions pro rata funded based on
11    ASE counts in excess of or less than the thresholds set
12    forth in this paragraph (2). The method for calculating
13    attributable pro rata costs and the defined subgroups
14    thereto are as follows:
15            (A) Core class size investments. Each
16        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding required
17        to support that number of FTE core teacher positions as
18        is needed to keep the respective class sizes of the
19        Organizational Unit to the following maximum numbers:
20                (i) For grades kindergarten through 3, the
21            Organizational Unit shall receive funding required
22            to support one FTE core teacher position for every
23            15 Low-Income Count students in those grades and
24            one FTE core teacher position for every 20
25            non-Low-Income Count students in those grades.
26                (ii) For grades 4 through 12, the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 233 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            Organizational Unit shall receive funding required
2            to support one FTE core teacher position for every
3            20 Low-Income Count students in those grades and
4            one FTE core teacher position for every 25
5            non-Low-Income Count students in those grades.
6            The number of non-Low-Income Count students in a
7        grade shall be determined by subtracting the
8        Low-Income students in that grade from the ASE of the
9        Organizational Unit for that grade.
10            (B) Specialist teacher investments. Each
11        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
12        to cover that number of FTE specialist teacher
13        positions that correspond to the following
14        percentages:
15                (i) if the Organizational Unit operates an
16            elementary or middle school, then 20.00% of the
17            number of the Organizational Unit's core teachers,
18            as determined under subparagraph (A) of this
19            paragraph (2); and
20                (ii) if such Organizational Unit operates a
21            high school, then 33.33% of the number of the
22            Organizational Unit's core teachers.
23            (C) Instructional facilitator investments. Each
24        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
25        to cover one FTE instructional facilitator position
26        for every 200 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 234 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        children with disabilities and all kindergarten
2        through grade 12 students of the Organizational Unit.
3            (D) Core intervention teacher (tutor) investments.
4        Each Organizational Unit shall receive the funding
5        needed to cover one FTE teacher position for each
6        prototypical elementary, middle, and high school.
7            (E) Substitute teacher investments. Each
8        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
9        to cover substitute teacher costs that is equal to
10        5.70% of the minimum pupil attendance days required
11        under Section 10-19 of this Code for all full-time
12        equivalent core, specialist, and intervention
13        teachers, school nurses, special education teachers
14        and instructional assistants, instructional
15        facilitators, and summer school and extended day
16        teacher positions, as determined under this paragraph
17        (2), at a salary rate of 33.33% of the average salary
18        for grade K through 12 teachers and 33.33% of the
19        average salary of each instructional assistant
20        position.
21            (F) Core guidance counselor investments. Each
22        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
23        to cover one FTE guidance counselor for each 450
24        combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
25        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 5
26        students, plus one FTE guidance counselor for each 250

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 235 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        grades 6 through 8 ASE middle school students, plus one
2        FTE guidance counselor for each 250 grades 9 through 12
3        ASE high school students.
4            (G) Nurse investments. Each Organizational Unit
5        shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE nurse
6        for each 750 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children
7        with disabilities and all kindergarten through grade
8        12 students across all grade levels it serves.
9            (H) Supervisory aide investments. Each
10        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
11        to cover one FTE for each 225 combined ASE of
12        pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all
13        kindergarten through grade 5 students, plus one FTE for
14        each 225 ASE middle school students, plus one FTE for
15        each 200 ASE high school students.
16            (I) Librarian investments. Each Organizational
17        Unit shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE
18        librarian for each prototypical elementary school,
19        middle school, and high school and one FTE aide or
20        media technician for every 300 combined ASE of
21        pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all
22        kindergarten through grade 12 students.
23            (J) Principal investments. Each Organizational
24        Unit shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE
25        principal position for each prototypical elementary
26        school, plus one FTE principal position for each

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 236 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        prototypical middle school, plus one FTE principal
2        position for each prototypical high school.
3            (K) Assistant principal investments. Each
4        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
5        to cover one FTE assistant principal position for each
6        prototypical elementary school, plus one FTE assistant
7        principal position for each prototypical middle
8        school, plus one FTE assistant principal position for
9        each prototypical high school.
10            (L) School site staff investments. Each
11        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
12        for one FTE position for each 225 ASE of
13        pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all
14        kindergarten through grade 5 students, plus one FTE
15        position for each 225 ASE middle school students, plus
16        one FTE position for each 200 ASE high school students.
17            (M) Gifted investments. Each Organizational Unit
18        shall receive $40 per kindergarten through grade 12
19        ASE.
20            (N) Professional development investments. Each
21        Organizational Unit shall receive $125 per student of
22        the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
23        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
24        students for trainers and other professional
25        development-related expenses for supplies and
26        materials.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 237 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (O) Instructional material investments. Each
2        Organizational Unit shall receive $190 per student of
3        the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
4        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
5        students to cover instructional material costs.
6            (P) Assessment investments. Each Organizational
7        Unit shall receive $25 per student of the combined ASE
8        of pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all
9        kindergarten through grade 12 students to cover
10        assessment costs.
11            (Q) Computer technology and equipment investments.
12        Each Organizational Unit shall receive $285.50 per
13        student of the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten
14        children with disabilities and all kindergarten
15        through grade 12 students to cover computer technology
16        and equipment costs. For the 2018-2019 school year and
17        subsequent school years, Organizational Units assigned
18        to Tier 1 and Tier 2 in the prior school year shall
19        receive an additional $285.50 per student of the
20        combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
21        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
22        students to cover computer technology and equipment
23        costs in the Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target.
24        The State Board may establish additional requirements
25        for Organizational Unit expenditures of funds received
26        pursuant to this subparagraph (Q), including a

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 238 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        requirement that funds received pursuant to this
2        subparagraph (Q) may be used only for serving the
3        technology needs of the district. It is the intent of
4        Public Act 100-465 that all Tier 1 and Tier 2 districts
5        receive the addition to their Adequacy Target in the
6        following year, subject to compliance with the
7        requirements of the State Board, which shall include,
8        at a minimum, a requirement that each district submit
9        documentation on how developmentally appropriate
10        computer literacy instruction is embedded in the
11        district's curriculum at each grade level.
12            (R) Student activities investments. Each
13        Organizational Unit shall receive the following
14        funding amounts to cover student activities: $100 per
15        kindergarten through grade 5 ASE student in elementary
16        school, plus $200 per ASE student in middle school,
17        plus $675 per ASE student in high school.
18            (S) Maintenance and operations investments. Each
19        Organizational Unit shall receive $1,038 per student
20        of the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
21        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
22        students for day-to-day maintenance and operations
23        expenditures, including salary, supplies, and
24        materials, as well as purchased services, but
25        excluding employee benefits. The proportion of salary
26        for the application of a Regionalization Factor and the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 239 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        calculation of benefits is equal to $352.92.
2            (T) Central office investments. Each
3        Organizational Unit shall receive $742 per student of
4        the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
5        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
6        students to cover central office operations, including
7        administrators and classified personnel charged with
8        managing the instructional programs, business and
9        operations of the school district, and security
10        personnel. The proportion of salary for the
11        application of a Regionalization Factor and the
12        calculation of benefits is equal to $368.48.
13            (U) Employee benefit investments. Each
14        Organizational Unit shall receive 30% of the total of
15        all salary-calculated elements of the Adequacy Target,
16        excluding substitute teachers and student activities
17        investments, to cover benefit costs. For central
18        office and maintenance and operations investments, the
19        benefit calculation shall be based upon the salary
20        proportion of each investment. If at any time the
21        responsibility for funding the employer normal cost of
22        teacher pensions is assigned to school districts, then
23        that amount certified by the Teachers' Retirement
24        System of the State of Illinois to be paid by the
25        Organizational Unit for the preceding school year
26        shall be added to the benefit investment. For any

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 240 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        fiscal year in which a school district organized under
2        Article 34 of this Code is responsible for paying the
3        employer normal cost of teacher pensions, then that
4        amount of its employer normal cost plus the amount for
5        retiree health insurance as certified by the Public
6        School Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of
7        Chicago to be paid by the school district for the
8        preceding school year that is statutorily required to
9        cover employer normal costs and the amount for retiree
10        health insurance shall be added to the 30% specified in
11        this subparagraph (U). The Teachers' Retirement System
12        of the State of Illinois and the Public School
13        Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of Chicago shall
14        submit such information as the State Superintendent
15        may require for the calculations set forth in this
16        subparagraph (U).
17            (V) Additional investments in low-income students.
18        In addition to and not in lieu of all other funding
19        under this paragraph (2), each Organizational Unit
20        shall receive funding based on the average teacher
21        salary for grades K through 12 to cover the costs of:
22                (i) one FTE intervention teacher (tutor)
23            position for every 125 Low-Income Count students;
24                (ii) one FTE pupil support staff position for
25            every 125 Low-Income Count students;
26                (iii) one FTE extended day teacher position

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 241 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            for every 120 Low-Income Count students; and
2                (iv) one FTE summer school teacher position
3            for every 120 Low-Income Count students.
4            (W) Additional investments in English learner
5        students. In addition to and not in lieu of all other
6        funding under this paragraph (2), each Organizational
7        Unit shall receive funding based on the average teacher
8        salary for grades K through 12 to cover the costs of:
9                (i) one FTE intervention teacher (tutor)
10            position for every 125 English learner students;
11                (ii) one FTE pupil support staff position for
12            every 125 English learner students;
13                (iii) one FTE extended day teacher position
14            for every 120 English learner students;
15                (iv) one FTE summer school teacher position
16            for every 120 English learner students; and
17                (v) one FTE core teacher position for every 100
18            English learner students.
19            (X) Special education investments. Each
20        Organizational Unit shall receive funding based on the
21        average teacher salary for grades K through 12 to cover
22        special education as follows:
23                (i) one FTE teacher position for every 141
24            combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
25            disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
26            students;

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 242 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1                (ii) one FTE instructional assistant for every
2            141 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
3            disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
4            students; and
5                (iii) one FTE psychologist position for every
6            1,000 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children
7            with disabilities and all kindergarten through
8            grade 12 students.
9        (3) For calculating the salaries included within the
10    Essential Elements, the State Superintendent shall
11    annually calculate average salaries to the nearest dollar
12    using the employment information system data maintained by
13    the State Board, limited to public schools only and
14    excluding special education and vocational cooperatives,
15    schools operated by the Department of Juvenile Justice, and
16    charter schools, for the following positions:
17            (A) Teacher for grades K through 8.
18            (B) Teacher for grades 9 through 12.
19            (C) Teacher for grades K through 12.
20            (D) Guidance counselor for grades K through 8.
21            (E) Guidance counselor for grades 9 through 12.
22            (F) Guidance counselor for grades K through 12.
23            (G) Social worker.
24            (H) Psychologist.
25            (I) Librarian.
26            (J) Nurse.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 243 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (K) Principal.
2            (L) Assistant principal.
3        For the purposes of this paragraph (3), "teacher"
4    includes core teachers, specialist and elective teachers,
5    instructional facilitators, tutors, special education
6    teachers, pupil support staff teachers, English learner
7    teachers, extended day teachers, and summer school
8    teachers. Where specific grade data is not required for the
9    Essential Elements, the average salary for corresponding
10    positions shall apply. For substitute teachers, the
11    average teacher salary for grades K through 12 shall apply.
12        For calculating the salaries included within the
13    Essential Elements for positions not included within EIS
14    Data, the following salaries shall be used in the first
15    year of implementation of Evidence-Based Funding:
16            (i) school site staff, $30,000; and
17            (ii) non-instructional assistant, instructional
18        assistant, library aide, library media tech, or
19        supervisory aide: $25,000.
20        In the second and subsequent years of implementation of
21    Evidence-Based Funding, the amounts in items (i) and (ii)
22    of this paragraph (3) shall annually increase by the ECI.
23        The salary amounts for the Essential Elements
24    determined pursuant to subparagraphs (A) through (L), (S)
25    and (T), and (V) through (X) of paragraph (2) of subsection
26    (b) of this Section shall be multiplied by a

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 244 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Regionalization Factor.
2    (c) Local Capacity calculation.
3        (1) Each Organizational Unit's Local Capacity
4    represents an amount of funding it is assumed to contribute
5    toward its Adequacy Target for purposes of the
6    Evidence-Based Funding formula calculation. "Local
7    Capacity" means either (i) the Organizational Unit's Local
8    Capacity Target as calculated in accordance with paragraph
9    (2) of this subsection (c) if its Real Receipts are equal
10    to or less than its Local Capacity Target or (ii) the
11    Organizational Unit's Adjusted Local Capacity, as
12    calculated in accordance with paragraph (3) of this
13    subsection (c) if Real Receipts are more than its Local
14    Capacity Target.
15        (2) "Local Capacity Target" means, for an
16    Organizational Unit, that dollar amount that is obtained by
17    multiplying its Adequacy Target by its Local Capacity
18    Ratio.
19            (A) An Organizational Unit's Local Capacity
20        Percentage is the conversion of the Organizational
21        Unit's Local Capacity Ratio, as such ratio is
22        determined in accordance with subparagraph (B) of this
23        paragraph (2), into a cumulative distribution
24        resulting in a percentile ranking to determine each
25        Organizational Unit's relative position to all other
26        Organizational Units in this State. The calculation of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 245 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        Local Capacity Percentage is described in subparagraph
2        (C) of this paragraph (2).
3            (B) An Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio
4        in a given year is the percentage obtained by dividing
5        its Adjusted EAV or PTELL EAV, whichever is less, by
6        its Adequacy Target, with the resulting ratio further
7        adjusted as follows:
8                (i) for Organizational Units serving grades
9            kindergarten through 12 and Hybrid Districts, no
10            further adjustments shall be made;
11                (ii) for Organizational Units serving grades
12            kindergarten through 8, the ratio shall be
13            multiplied by 9/13;
14                (iii) for Organizational Units serving grades
15            9 through 12, the Local Capacity Ratio shall be
16            multiplied by 4/13; and
17                (iv) for an Organizational Unit with a
18            different grade configuration than those specified
19            in items (i) through (iii) of this subparagraph
20            (B), the State Superintendent shall determine a
21            comparable adjustment based on the grades served.
22            (C) The Local Capacity Percentage is equal to the
23        percentile ranking of the district. Local Capacity
24        Percentage converts each Organizational Unit's Local
25        Capacity Ratio to a cumulative distribution resulting
26        in a percentile ranking to determine each

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 246 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        Organizational Unit's relative position to all other
2        Organizational Units in this State. The Local Capacity
3        Percentage cumulative distribution resulting in a
4        percentile ranking for each Organizational Unit shall
5        be calculated using the standard normal distribution
6        of the score in relation to the weighted mean and
7        weighted standard deviation and Local Capacity Ratios
8        of all Organizational Units. If the value assigned to
9        any Organizational Unit is in excess of 90%, the value
10        shall be adjusted to 90%. For Laboratory Schools, the
11        Local Capacity Percentage shall be set at 10% in
12        recognition of the absence of EAV and resources from
13        the public university that are allocated to the
14        Laboratory School. For programs operated by a regional
15        office of education or an intermediate service center,
16        the Local Capacity Percentage must be set at 10% in
17        recognition of the absence of EAV and resources from
18        school districts that are allocated to the regional
19        office of education or intermediate service center.
20        The weighted mean for the Local Capacity Percentage
21        shall be determined by multiplying each Organizational
22        Unit's Local Capacity Ratio times the ASE for the unit
23        creating a weighted value, summing the weighted values
24        of all Organizational Units, and dividing by the total
25        ASE of all Organizational Units. The weighted standard
26        deviation shall be determined by taking the square root

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 247 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        of the weighted variance of all Organizational Units'
2        Local Capacity Ratio, where the variance is calculated
3        by squaring the difference between each unit's Local
4        Capacity Ratio and the weighted mean, then multiplying
5        the variance for each unit times the ASE for the unit
6        to create a weighted variance for each unit, then
7        summing all units' weighted variance and dividing by
8        the total ASE of all units.
9            (D) For any Organizational Unit, the
10        Organizational Unit's Adjusted Local Capacity Target
11        shall be reduced by either (i) the school board's
12        remaining contribution pursuant to paragraph (ii) of
13        subsection (b-4) of Section 16-158 of the Illinois
14        Pension Code in a given year or (ii) the board of
15        education's remaining contribution pursuant to
16        paragraph (iv) of subsection (b) of Section 17-129 of
17        the Illinois Pension Code absent the employer normal
18        cost portion of the required contribution and amount
19        allowed pursuant to subdivision (3) of Section
20        17-142.1 of the Illinois Pension Code in a given year.
21        In the preceding sentence, item (i) shall be certified
22        to the State Board of Education by the Teachers'
23        Retirement System of the State of Illinois and item
24        (ii) shall be certified to the State Board of Education
25        by the Public School Teachers' Pension and Retirement
26        Fund of the City of Chicago.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 248 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (3) If an Organizational Unit's Real Receipts are more
2    than its Local Capacity Target, then its Local Capacity
3    shall equal an Adjusted Local Capacity Target as calculated
4    in accordance with this paragraph (3). The Adjusted Local
5    Capacity Target is calculated as the sum of the
6    Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Target and its Real
7    Receipts Adjustment. The Real Receipts Adjustment equals
8    the Organizational Unit's Real Receipts less its Local
9    Capacity Target, with the resulting figure multiplied by
10    the Local Capacity Percentage.
11        As used in this paragraph (3), "Real Percent of
12    Adequacy" means the sum of an Organizational Unit's Real
13    Receipts, CPPRT, and Base Funding Minimum, with the
14    resulting figure divided by the Organizational Unit's
15    Adequacy Target.
16    (d) Calculation of Real Receipts, EAV, and Adjusted EAV for
17purposes of the Local Capacity calculation.
18        (1) An Organizational Unit's Real Receipts are the
19    product of its Applicable Tax Rate and its Adjusted EAV. An
20    Organizational Unit's Applicable Tax Rate is its Adjusted
21    Operating Tax Rate for property within the Organizational
22    Unit.
23        (2) The State Superintendent shall calculate the
24    equalized assessed valuation, or EAV, of all taxable
25    property of each Organizational Unit as of September 30 of
26    the previous year in accordance with paragraph (3) of this

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 249 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    subsection (d). The State Superintendent shall then
2    determine the Adjusted EAV of each Organizational Unit in
3    accordance with paragraph (4) of this subsection (d), which
4    Adjusted EAV figure shall be used for the purposes of
5    calculating Local Capacity.
6        (3) To calculate Real Receipts and EAV, the Department
7    of Revenue shall supply to the State Superintendent the
8    value as equalized or assessed by the Department of Revenue
9    of all taxable property of every Organizational Unit,
10    together with (i) the applicable tax rate used in extending
11    taxes for the funds of the Organizational Unit as of
12    September 30 of the previous year and (ii) the limiting
13    rate for all Organizational Units subject to property tax
14    extension limitations as imposed under PTELL.
15            (A) The Department of Revenue shall add to the
16        equalized assessed value of all taxable property of
17        each Organizational Unit situated entirely or
18        partially within a county that is or was subject to the
19        provisions of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property
20        Tax Code (i) an amount equal to the total amount by
21        which the homestead exemption allowed under Section
22        15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code for real
23        property situated in that Organizational Unit exceeds
24        the total amount that would have been allowed in that
25        Organizational Unit if the maximum reduction under
26        Section 15-176 was (I) $4,500 in Cook County or $3,500

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 250 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        in all other counties in tax year 2003 or (II) $5,000
2        in all counties in tax year 2004 and thereafter and
3        (ii) an amount equal to the aggregate amount for the
4        taxable year of all additional exemptions under
5        Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code for owners with
6        a household income of $30,000 or less. The county clerk
7        of any county that is or was subject to the provisions
8        of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code
9        shall annually calculate and certify to the Department
10        of Revenue for each Organizational Unit all homestead
11        exemption amounts under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the
12        Property Tax Code and all amounts of additional
13        exemptions under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax
14        Code for owners with a household income of $30,000 or
15        less. It is the intent of this subparagraph (A) that if
16        the general homestead exemption for a parcel of
17        property is determined under Section 15-176 or 15-177
18        of the Property Tax Code rather than Section 15-175,
19        then the calculation of EAV shall not be affected by
20        the difference, if any, between the amount of the
21        general homestead exemption allowed for that parcel of
22        property under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property
23        Tax Code and the amount that would have been allowed
24        had the general homestead exemption for that parcel of
25        property been determined under Section 15-175 of the
26        Property Tax Code. It is further the intent of this

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 251 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        subparagraph (A) that if additional exemptions are
2        allowed under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code
3        for owners with a household income of less than
4        $30,000, then the calculation of EAV shall not be
5        affected by the difference, if any, because of those
6        additional exemptions.
7            (B) With respect to any part of an Organizational
8        Unit within a redevelopment project area in respect to
9        which a municipality has adopted tax increment
10        allocation financing pursuant to the Tax Increment
11        Allocation Redevelopment Act, Division 74.4 of Article
12        11 of the Illinois Municipal Code, or the Industrial
13        Jobs Recovery Law, Division 74.6 of Article 11 of the
14        Illinois Municipal Code, no part of the current EAV of
15        real property located in any such project area that is
16        attributable to an increase above the total initial EAV
17        of such property shall be used as part of the EAV of
18        the Organizational Unit, until such time as all
19        redevelopment project costs have been paid, as
20        provided in Section 11-74.4-8 of the Tax Increment
21        Allocation Redevelopment Act or in Section 11-74.6-35
22        of the Industrial Jobs Recovery Law. For the purpose of
23        the EAV of the Organizational Unit, the total initial
24        EAV or the current EAV, whichever is lower, shall be
25        used until such time as all redevelopment project costs
26        have been paid.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 252 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (B-5) The real property equalized assessed
2        valuation for a school district shall be adjusted by
3        subtracting from the real property value, as equalized
4        or assessed by the Department of Revenue, for the
5        district an amount computed by dividing the amount of
6        any abatement of taxes under Section 18-170 of the
7        Property Tax Code by 3.00% for a district maintaining
8        grades kindergarten through 12, by 2.30% for a district
9        maintaining grades kindergarten through 8, or by 1.05%
10        for a district maintaining grades 9 through 12 and
11        adjusted by an amount computed by dividing the amount
12        of any abatement of taxes under subsection (a) of
13        Section 18-165 of the Property Tax Code by the same
14        percentage rates for district type as specified in this
15        subparagraph (B-5).
16            (C) For Organizational Units that are Hybrid
17        Districts, the State Superintendent shall use the
18        lesser of the adjusted equalized assessed valuation
19        for property within the partial elementary unit
20        district for elementary purposes, as defined in
21        Article 11E of this Code, or the adjusted equalized
22        assessed valuation for property within the partial
23        elementary unit district for high school purposes, as
24        defined in Article 11E of this Code.
25        (4) An Organizational Unit's Adjusted EAV shall be the
26    average of its EAV over the immediately preceding 3 years

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 253 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    or its EAV in the immediately preceding year if the EAV in
2    the immediately preceding year has declined by 10% or more
3    compared to the 3-year average. In the event of
4    Organizational Unit reorganization, consolidation, or
5    annexation, the Organizational Unit's Adjusted EAV for the
6    first 3 years after such change shall be as follows: the
7    most current EAV shall be used in the first year, the
8    average of a 2-year EAV or its EAV in the immediately
9    preceding year if the EAV declines by 10% or more compared
10    to the 2-year average for the second year, and a 3-year
11    average EAV or its EAV in the immediately preceding year if
12    the Adjusted EAV declines by 10% or more compared to the
13    3-year average for the third year. For any school district
14    whose EAV in the immediately preceding year is used in
15    calculations, in the following year, the Adjusted EAV shall
16    be the average of its EAV over the immediately preceding 2
17    years or the immediately preceding year if that year
18    represents a decline of 10% or more compared to the 2-year
19    average.
20        "PTELL EAV" means a figure calculated by the State
21    Board for Organizational Units subject to PTELL as
22    described in this paragraph (4) for the purposes of
23    calculating an Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio.
24    Except as otherwise provided in this paragraph (4), the
25    PTELL EAV of an Organizational Unit shall be equal to the
26    product of the equalized assessed valuation last used in

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 254 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    the calculation of general State aid under Section 18-8.05
2    of this Code (now repealed) or Evidence-Based Funding under
3    this Section and the Organizational Unit's Extension
4    Limitation Ratio. If an Organizational Unit has approved or
5    does approve an increase in its limiting rate, pursuant to
6    Section 18-190 of the Property Tax Code, affecting the Base
7    Tax Year, the PTELL EAV shall be equal to the product of
8    the equalized assessed valuation last used in the
9    calculation of general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of
10    this Code (now repealed) or Evidence-Based Funding under
11    this Section multiplied by an amount equal to one plus the
12    percentage increase, if any, in the Consumer Price Index
13    for All Urban Consumers for all items published by the
14    United States Department of Labor for the 12-month calendar
15    year preceding the Base Tax Year, plus the equalized
16    assessed valuation of new property, annexed property, and
17    recovered tax increment value and minus the equalized
18    assessed valuation of disconnected property.
19        As used in this paragraph (4), "new property" and
20    "recovered tax increment value" shall have the meanings set
21    forth in the Property Tax Extension Limitation Law.
22    (e) Base Funding Minimum calculation.
23        (1) For the 2017-2018 school year, the Base Funding
24    Minimum of an Organizational Unit or a Specially Funded
25    Unit shall be the amount of State funds distributed to the
26    Organizational Unit or Specially Funded Unit during the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 255 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    2016-2017 school year prior to any adjustments and
2    specified appropriation amounts described in this
3    paragraph (1) from the following Sections, as calculated by
4    the State Superintendent: Section 18-8.05 of this Code (now
5    repealed); Section 5 of Article 224 of Public Act 99-524
6    (equity grants); Section 14-7.02b of this Code (funding for
7    children requiring special education services); Section
8    14-13.01 of this Code (special education facilities and
9    staffing), except for reimbursement of the cost of
10    transportation pursuant to Section 14-13.01; Section
11    14C-12 of this Code (English learners); and Section 18-4.3
12    of this Code (summer school), based on an appropriation
13    level of $13,121,600. For a school district organized under
14    Article 34 of this Code, the Base Funding Minimum also
15    includes (i) the funds allocated to the school district
16    pursuant to Section 1D-1 of this Code attributable to
17    funding programs authorized by the Sections of this Code
18    listed in the preceding sentence and (ii) the difference
19    between (I) the funds allocated to the school district
20    pursuant to Section 1D-1 of this Code attributable to the
21    funding programs authorized by Section 14-7.02 (non-public
22    special education reimbursement), subsection (b) of
23    Section 14-13.01 (special education transportation),
24    Section 29-5 (transportation), Section 2-3.80
25    (agricultural education), Section 2-3.66 (truants'
26    alternative education), Section 2-3.62 (educational

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 256 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    service centers), and Section 14-7.03 (special education -
2    orphanage) of this Code and Section 15 of the Childhood
3    Hunger Relief Act (free breakfast program) and (II) the
4    school district's actual expenditures for its non-public
5    special education, special education transportation,
6    transportation programs, agricultural education, truants'
7    alternative education, services that would otherwise be
8    performed by a regional office of education, special
9    education orphanage expenditures, and free breakfast, as
10    most recently calculated and reported pursuant to
11    subsection (f) of Section 1D-1 of this Code. The Base
12    Funding Minimum for Glenwood Academy shall be $625,500. For
13    programs operated by a regional office of education or an
14    intermediate service center, the Base Funding Minimum must
15    be the total amount of State funds allocated to those
16    programs in the 2018-2019 school year and amounts provided
17    pursuant to Article 34 of Public Act 100-586 and Section
18    3-16 of this Code. All programs established after June 5,
19    2019 (the effective date of Public Act 101-10) and
20    administered by a regional office of education or an
21    intermediate service center must have an initial Base
22    Funding Minimum set to an amount equal to the first-year
23    ASE multiplied by the amount of per pupil funding received
24    in the previous school year by the lowest funded similar
25    existing program type. If the enrollment for a program
26    operated by a regional office of education or an

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 257 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    intermediate service center is zero, then it may not
2    receive Base Funding Minimum funds for that program in the
3    next fiscal year, and those funds must be distributed to
4    Organizational Units under subsection (g).
5        (2) For the 2018-2019 and subsequent school years, the
6    Base Funding Minimum of Organizational Units and Specially
7    Funded Units shall be the sum of (i) the amount of
8    Evidence-Based Funding for the prior school year, (ii) the
9    Base Funding Minimum for the prior school year, and (iii)
10    any amount received by a school district pursuant to
11    Section 7 of Article 97 of Public Act 100-21.
12        (3) Subject to approval by the General Assembly as
13    provided in this paragraph (3), an Organizational Unit that
14    meets all of the following criteria, as determined by the
15    State Board, shall have District Intervention Money added
16    to its Base Funding Minimum at the time the Base Funding
17    Minimum is calculated by the State Board:
18            (A) The Organizational Unit is operating under an
19        Independent Authority under Section 2-3.25f-5 of this
20        Code for a minimum of 4 school years or is subject to
21        the control of the State Board pursuant to a court
22        order for a minimum of 4 school years.
23            (B) The Organizational Unit was designated as a
24        Tier 1 or Tier 2 Organizational Unit in the previous
25        school year under paragraph (3) of subsection (g) of
26        this Section.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 258 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (C) The Organizational Unit demonstrates
2        sustainability through a 5-year financial and
3        strategic plan.
4            (D) The Organizational Unit has made sufficient
5        progress and achieved sufficient stability in the
6        areas of governance, academic growth, and finances.
7        As part of its determination under this paragraph (3),
8    the State Board may consider the Organizational Unit's
9    summative designation, any accreditations of the
10    Organizational Unit, or the Organizational Unit's
11    financial profile, as calculated by the State Board.
12        If the State Board determines that an Organizational
13    Unit has met the criteria set forth in this paragraph (3),
14    it must submit a report to the General Assembly, no later
15    than January 2 of the fiscal year in which the State Board
16    makes it determination, on the amount of District
17    Intervention Money to add to the Organizational Unit's Base
18    Funding Minimum. The General Assembly must review the State
19    Board's report and may approve or disapprove, by joint
20    resolution, the addition of District Intervention Money.
21    If the General Assembly fails to act on the report within
22    40 calendar days from the receipt of the report, the
23    addition of District Intervention Money is deemed
24    approved. If the General Assembly approves the amount of
25    District Intervention Money to be added to the
26    Organizational Unit's Base Funding Minimum, the District

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 259 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Intervention Money must be added to the Base Funding
2    Minimum annually thereafter.
3        For the first 4 years following the initial year that
4    the State Board determines that an Organizational Unit has
5    met the criteria set forth in this paragraph (3) and has
6    received funding under this Section, the Organizational
7    Unit must annually submit to the State Board, on or before
8    November 30, a progress report regarding its financial and
9    strategic plan under subparagraph (C) of this paragraph
10    (3). The plan shall include the financial data from the
11    past 4 annual financial reports or financial audits that
12    must be presented to the State Board by November 15 of each
13    year and the approved budget financial data for the current
14    year. The plan shall be developed according to the
15    guidelines presented to the Organizational Unit by the
16    State Board. The plan shall further include financial
17    projections for the next 3 fiscal years and include a
18    discussion and financial summary of the Organizational
19    Unit's facility needs. If the Organizational Unit does not
20    demonstrate sufficient progress toward its 5-year plan or
21    if it has failed to file an annual financial report, an
22    annual budget, a financial plan, a deficit reduction plan,
23    or other financial information as required by law, the
24    State Board may establish a Financial Oversight Panel under
25    Article 1H of this Code. However, if the Organizational
26    Unit already has a Financial Oversight Panel, the State

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 260 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Board may extend the duration of the Panel.
2    (f) Percent of Adequacy and Final Resources calculation.
3        (1) The Evidence-Based Funding formula establishes a
4    Percent of Adequacy for each Organizational Unit in order
5    to place such units into tiers for the purposes of the
6    funding distribution system described in subsection (g) of
7    this Section. Initially, an Organizational Unit's
8    Preliminary Resources and Preliminary Percent of Adequacy
9    are calculated pursuant to paragraph (2) of this subsection
10    (f). Then, an Organizational Unit's Final Resources and
11    Final Percent of Adequacy are calculated to account for the
12    Organizational Unit's poverty concentration levels
13    pursuant to paragraphs (3) and (4) of this subsection (f).
14        (2) An Organizational Unit's Preliminary Resources are
15    equal to the sum of its Local Capacity Target, CPPRT, and
16    Base Funding Minimum. An Organizational Unit's Preliminary
17    Percent of Adequacy is the lesser of (i) its Preliminary
18    Resources divided by its Adequacy Target or (ii) 100%.
19        (3) Except for Specially Funded Units, an
20    Organizational Unit's Final Resources are equal to the sum
21    of its Local Capacity, CPPRT, and Adjusted Base Funding
22    Minimum. The Base Funding Minimum of each Specially Funded
23    Unit shall serve as its Final Resources, except that the
24    Base Funding Minimum for State-approved charter schools
25    shall not include any portion of general State aid
26    allocated in the prior year based on the per capita tuition

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 261 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    charge times the charter school enrollment.
2        (4) An Organizational Unit's Final Percent of Adequacy
3    is its Final Resources divided by its Adequacy Target. An
4    Organizational Unit's Adjusted Base Funding Minimum is
5    equal to its Base Funding Minimum less its Supplemental
6    Grant Funding, with the resulting figure added to the
7    product of its Supplemental Grant Funding and Preliminary
8    Percent of Adequacy.
9    (g) Evidence-Based Funding formula distribution system.
10        (1) In each school year under the Evidence-Based
11    Funding formula, each Organizational Unit receives funding
12    equal to the sum of its Base Funding Minimum and the unit's
13    allocation of New State Funds determined pursuant to this
14    subsection (g). To allocate New State Funds, the
15    Evidence-Based Funding formula distribution system first
16    places all Organizational Units into one of 4 tiers in
17    accordance with paragraph (3) of this subsection (g), based
18    on the Organizational Unit's Final Percent of Adequacy. New
19    State Funds are allocated to each of the 4 tiers as
20    follows: Tier 1 Aggregate Funding equals 50% of all New
21    State Funds, Tier 2 Aggregate Funding equals 49% of all New
22    State Funds, Tier 3 Aggregate Funding equals 0.9% of all
23    New State Funds, and Tier 4 Aggregate Funding equals 0.1%
24    of all New State Funds. Each Organizational Unit within
25    Tier 1 or Tier 2 receives an allocation of New State Funds
26    equal to its tier Funding Gap, as defined in the following

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 262 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    sentence, multiplied by the tier's Allocation Rate
2    determined pursuant to paragraph (4) of this subsection
3    (g). For Tier 1, an Organizational Unit's Funding Gap
4    equals the tier's Target Ratio, as specified in paragraph
5    (5) of this subsection (g), multiplied by the
6    Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target, with the resulting
7    amount reduced by the Organizational Unit's Final
8    Resources. For Tier 2, an Organizational Unit's Funding Gap
9    equals the tier's Target Ratio, as described in paragraph
10    (5) of this subsection (g), multiplied by the
11    Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target, with the resulting
12    amount reduced by the Organizational Unit's Final
13    Resources and its Tier 1 funding allocation. To determine
14    the Organizational Unit's Funding Gap, the resulting
15    amount is then multiplied by a factor equal to one minus
16    the Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Target
17    percentage. Each Organizational Unit within Tier 3 or Tier
18    4 receives an allocation of New State Funds equal to the
19    product of its Adequacy Target and the tier's Allocation
20    Rate, as specified in paragraph (4) of this subsection (g).
21        (2) To ensure equitable distribution of dollars for all
22    Tier 2 Organizational Units, no Tier 2 Organizational Unit
23    shall receive fewer dollars per ASE than any Tier 3
24    Organizational Unit. Each Tier 2 and Tier 3 Organizational
25    Unit shall have its funding allocation divided by its ASE.
26    Any Tier 2 Organizational Unit with a funding allocation

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 263 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    per ASE below the greatest Tier 3 allocation per ASE shall
2    get a funding allocation equal to the greatest Tier 3
3    funding allocation per ASE multiplied by the
4    Organizational Unit's ASE. Each Tier 2 Organizational
5    Unit's Tier 2 funding allocation shall be multiplied by the
6    percentage calculated by dividing the original Tier 2
7    Aggregate Funding by the sum of all Tier 2 Organizational
8    Units' Tier 2 funding allocation after adjusting
9    districts' funding below Tier 3 levels.
10        (3) Organizational Units are placed into one of 4 tiers
11    as follows:
12            (A) Tier 1 consists of all Organizational Units,
13        except for Specially Funded Units, with a Percent of
14        Adequacy less than the Tier 1 Target Ratio. The Tier 1
15        Target Ratio is the ratio level that allows for Tier 1
16        Aggregate Funding to be distributed, with the Tier 1
17        Allocation Rate determined pursuant to paragraph (4)
18        of this subsection (g).
19            (B) Tier 2 consists of all Tier 1 Units and all
20        other Organizational Units, except for Specially
21        Funded Units, with a Percent of Adequacy of less than
22        0.90.
23            (C) Tier 3 consists of all Organizational Units,
24        except for Specially Funded Units, with a Percent of
25        Adequacy of at least 0.90 and less than 1.0.
26            (D) Tier 4 consists of all Organizational Units

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 264 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        with a Percent of Adequacy of at least 1.0.
2        (4) The Allocation Rates for Tiers 1 through 4 are
3    determined as follows:
4            (A) The Tier 1 Allocation Rate is 30%.
5            (B) The Tier 2 Allocation Rate is the result of the
6        following equation: Tier 2 Aggregate Funding, divided
7        by the sum of the Funding Gaps for all Tier 2
8        Organizational Units, unless the result of such
9        equation is higher than 1.0. If the result of such
10        equation is higher than 1.0, then the Tier 2 Allocation
11        Rate is 1.0.
12            (C) The Tier 3 Allocation Rate is the result of the
13        following equation: Tier 3 Aggregate Funding, divided
14        by the sum of the Adequacy Targets of all Tier 3
15        Organizational Units.
16            (D) The Tier 4 Allocation Rate is the result of the
17        following equation: Tier 4 Aggregate Funding, divided
18        by the sum of the Adequacy Targets of all Tier 4
19        Organizational Units.
20        (5) A tier's Target Ratio is determined as follows:
21            (A) The Tier 1 Target Ratio is the ratio level that
22        allows for Tier 1 Aggregate Funding to be distributed
23        with the Tier 1 Allocation Rate.
24            (B) The Tier 2 Target Ratio is 0.90.
25            (C) The Tier 3 Target Ratio is 1.0.
26        (6) If, at any point, the Tier 1 Target Ratio is

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 265 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    greater than 90%, then than all Tier 1 funding shall be
2    allocated to Tier 2 and no Tier 1 Organizational Unit's
3    funding may be identified.
4        (7) In the event that all Tier 2 Organizational Units
5    receive funding at the Tier 2 Target Ratio level, any
6    remaining New State Funds shall be allocated to Tier 3 and
7    Tier 4 Organizational Units.
8        (8) If any Specially Funded Units, excluding Glenwood
9    Academy, recognized by the State Board do not qualify for
10    direct funding following the implementation of Public Act
11    100-465 from any of the funding sources included within the
12    definition of Base Funding Minimum, the unqualified
13    portion of the Base Funding Minimum shall be transferred to
14    one or more appropriate Organizational Units as determined
15    by the State Superintendent based on the prior year ASE of
16    the Organizational Units.
17        (8.5) If a school district withdraws from a special
18    education cooperative, the portion of the Base Funding
19    Minimum that is attributable to the school district may be
20    redistributed to the school district upon withdrawal. The
21    school district and the cooperative must include the amount
22    of the Base Funding Minimum that is to be reapportioned in
23    their withdrawal agreement and notify the State Board of
24    the change with a copy of the agreement upon withdrawal.
25        (9) The Minimum Funding Level is intended to establish
26    a target for State funding that will keep pace with

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 266 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    inflation and continue to advance equity through the
2    Evidence-Based Funding formula. The target for State
3    funding of New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds is
4    $50,000,000 for State fiscal year 2019 and subsequent State
5    fiscal years. The Minimum Funding Level is equal to
6    $350,000,000. In addition to any New State Funds, no more
7    than $50,000,000 New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds may be
8    counted toward the Minimum Funding Level. If the sum of New
9    State Funds and applicable New Property Tax Relief Pool
10    Funds are less than the Minimum Funding Level, than funding
11    for tiers shall be reduced in the following manner:
12            (A) First, Tier 4 funding shall be reduced by an
13        amount equal to the difference between the Minimum
14        Funding Level and New State Funds until such time as
15        Tier 4 funding is exhausted.
16            (B) Next, Tier 3 funding shall be reduced by an
17        amount equal to the difference between the Minimum
18        Funding Level and New State Funds and the reduction in
19        Tier 4 funding until such time as Tier 3 funding is
20        exhausted.
21            (C) Next, Tier 2 funding shall be reduced by an
22        amount equal to the difference between the Minimum
23        Funding Level and New State Funds and the reduction in
24        Tier 4 and Tier 3.
25            (D) Finally, Tier 1 funding shall be reduced by an
26        amount equal to the difference between the Minimum

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 267 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        Funding level and New State Funds and the reduction in
2        Tier 2, 3, and 4 funding. In addition, the Allocation
3        Rate for Tier 1 shall be reduced to a percentage equal
4        to the Tier 1 Allocation Rate set by paragraph (4) of
5        this subsection (g), multiplied by the result of New
6        State Funds divided by the Minimum Funding Level.
7        (9.5) For State fiscal year 2019 and subsequent State
8    fiscal years, if New State Funds exceed $300,000,000, then
9    any amount in excess of $300,000,000 shall be dedicated for
10    purposes of Section 2-3.170 of this Code up to a maximum of
11    $50,000,000.
12        (10) In the event of a decrease in the amount of the
13    appropriation for this Section in any fiscal year after
14    implementation of this Section, the Organizational Units
15    receiving Tier 1 and Tier 2 funding, as determined under
16    paragraph (3) of this subsection (g), shall be held
17    harmless by establishing a Base Funding Guarantee equal to
18    the per pupil kindergarten through grade 12 funding
19    received in accordance with this Section in the prior
20    fiscal year. Reductions shall be made to the Base Funding
21    Minimum of Organizational Units in Tier 3 and Tier 4 on a
22    per pupil basis equivalent to the total number of the ASE
23    in Tier 3-funded and Tier 4-funded Organizational Units
24    divided by the total reduction in State funding. The Base
25    Funding Minimum as reduced shall continue to be applied to
26    Tier 3 and Tier 4 Organizational Units and adjusted by the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 268 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    relative formula when increases in appropriations for this
2    Section resume. In no event may State funding reductions to
3    Organizational Units in Tier 3 or Tier 4 exceed an amount
4    that would be less than the Base Funding Minimum
5    established in the first year of implementation of this
6    Section. If additional reductions are required, all school
7    districts shall receive a reduction by a per pupil amount
8    equal to the aggregate additional appropriation reduction
9    divided by the total ASE of all Organizational Units.
10        (11) The State Superintendent shall make minor
11    adjustments to the distribution formula set forth in this
12    subsection (g) to account for the rounding of percentages
13    to the nearest tenth of a percentage and dollar amounts to
14    the nearest whole dollar.
15    (h) State Superintendent administration of funding and
16district submission requirements.
17        (1) The State Superintendent shall, in accordance with
18    appropriations made by the General Assembly, meet the
19    funding obligations created under this Section.
20        (2) The State Superintendent shall calculate the
21    Adequacy Target for each Organizational Unit and Net State
22    Contribution Target for each Organizational Unit under
23    this Section. No Evidence-Based Funding shall be
24    distributed within an Organizational Unit without the
25    approval of the unit's school board.
26        (3) Annually, the State Superintendent shall calculate

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 269 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    and report to each Organizational Unit the unit's aggregate
2    financial adequacy amount, which shall be the sum of the
3    Adequacy Target for each Organizational Unit. The State
4    Superintendent shall calculate and report separately for
5    each Organizational Unit the unit's total State funds
6    allocated for its students with disabilities. The State
7    Superintendent shall calculate and report separately for
8    each Organizational Unit the amount of funding and
9    applicable FTE calculated for each Essential Element of the
10    unit's Adequacy Target.
11        (4) Annually, the State Superintendent shall calculate
12    and report to each Organizational Unit the amount the unit
13    must expend on special education and bilingual education
14    and computer technology and equipment for Organizational
15    Units assigned to Tier 1 or Tier 2 that received an
16    additional $285.50 per student computer technology and
17    equipment investment grant to their Adequacy Target
18    pursuant to the unit's Base Funding Minimum, Special
19    Education Allocation, Bilingual Education Allocation, and
20    computer technology and equipment investment allocation.
21        (5) Moneys distributed under this Section shall be
22    calculated on a school year basis, but paid on a fiscal
23    year basis, with payments beginning in August and extending
24    through June. Unless otherwise provided, the moneys
25    appropriated for each fiscal year shall be distributed in
26    22 equal payments at least 2 times monthly to each

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 270 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Organizational Unit. If moneys appropriated for any fiscal
2    year are distributed other than monthly, the distribution
3    shall be on the same basis for each Organizational Unit.
4        (6) Any school district that fails, for any given
5    school year, to maintain school as required by law or to
6    maintain a recognized school is not eligible to receive
7    Evidence-Based Funding. In case of non-recognition of one
8    or more attendance centers in a school district otherwise
9    operating recognized schools, the claim of the district
10    shall be reduced in the proportion that the enrollment in
11    the attendance center or centers bears to the enrollment of
12    the school district. "Recognized school" means any public
13    school that meets the standards for recognition by the
14    State Board. A school district or attendance center not
15    having recognition status at the end of a school term is
16    entitled to receive State aid payments due upon a legal
17    claim that was filed while it was recognized.
18        (7) School district claims filed under this Section are
19    subject to Sections 18-9 and 18-12 of this Code, except as
20    otherwise provided in this Section.
21        (8) Each fiscal year, the State Superintendent shall
22    calculate for each Organizational Unit an amount of its
23    Base Funding Minimum and Evidence-Based Funding that shall
24    be deemed attributable to the provision of special
25    educational facilities and services, as defined in Section
26    14-1.08 of this Code, in a manner that ensures compliance

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 271 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    with maintenance of State financial support requirements
2    under the federal Individuals with Disabilities Education
3    Act. An Organizational Unit must use such funds only for
4    the provision of special educational facilities and
5    services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of this Code, and
6    must comply with any expenditure verification procedures
7    adopted by the State Board.
8        (9) All Organizational Units in this State must submit
9    annual spending plans by the end of September of each year
10    to the State Board as part of the annual budget process,
11    which shall describe how each Organizational Unit will
12    utilize the Base Funding Minimum and Evidence-Based
13    Funding it receives from this State under this Section with
14    specific identification of the intended utilization of
15    Low-Income, English learner, and special education
16    resources. Additionally, the annual spending plans of each
17    Organizational Unit shall describe how the Organizational
18    Unit expects to achieve student growth and how the
19    Organizational Unit will achieve State education goals, as
20    defined by the State Board. The State Superintendent may,
21    from time to time, identify additional requisites for
22    Organizational Units to satisfy when compiling the annual
23    spending plans required under this subsection (h). The
24    format and scope of annual spending plans shall be
25    developed by the State Superintendent and the State Board
26    of Education. School districts that serve students under

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 272 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Article 14C of this Code shall continue to submit
2    information as required under Section 14C-12 of this Code.
3        (10) No later than January 1, 2018, the State
4    Superintendent shall develop a 5-year strategic plan for
5    all Organizational Units to help in planning for adequacy
6    funding under this Section. The State Superintendent shall
7    submit the plan to the Governor and the General Assembly,
8    as provided in Section 3.1 of the General Assembly
9    Organization Act. The plan shall include recommendations
10    for:
11            (A) a framework for collaborative, professional,
12        innovative, and 21st century learning environments
13        using the Evidence-Based Funding model;
14            (B) ways to prepare and support this State's
15        educators for successful instructional careers;
16            (C) application and enhancement of the current
17        financial accountability measures, the approved State
18        plan to comply with the federal Every Student Succeeds
19        Act, and the Illinois Balanced Accountability Measures
20        in relation to student growth and elements of the
21        Evidence-Based Funding model; and
22            (D) implementation of an effective school adequacy
23        funding system based on projected and recommended
24        funding levels from the General Assembly.
25        (11) On an annual basis, the State Superintendent must
26    recalibrate all of the following per pupil elements of the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 273 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Adequacy Target and applied to the formulas, based on the
2    study of average expenses and as reported in the most
3    recent annual financial report:
4            (A) Gifted under subparagraph (M) of paragraph (2)
5        of subsection (b).
6            (B) Instructional materials under subparagraph (O)
7        of paragraph (2) of subsection (b).
8            (C) Assessment under subparagraph (P) of paragraph
9        (2) of subsection (b).
10            (D) Student activities under subparagraph (R) of
11        paragraph (2) of subsection (b).
12            (E) Maintenance and operations under subparagraph
13        (S) of paragraph (2) of subsection (b).
14            (F) Central office under subparagraph (T) of
15        paragraph (2) of subsection (b).
16    (i) Professional Review Panel.
17        (1) A Professional Review Panel is created to study and
18    review topics related to the implementation and effect of
19    Evidence-Based Funding, as assigned by a joint resolution
20    or Public Act of the General Assembly or a motion passed by
21    the State Board of Education. The Panel must provide
22    recommendations to and serve the Governor, the General
23    Assembly, and the State Board. The State Superintendent or
24    his or her designee must serve as a voting member and
25    chairperson of the Panel. The State Superintendent must
26    appoint a vice chairperson from the membership of the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 274 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Panel. The Panel must advance recommendations based on a
2    three-fifths majority vote of Panel members present and
3    voting. A minority opinion may also accompany any
4    recommendation of the Panel. The Panel shall be appointed
5    by the State Superintendent, except as otherwise provided
6    in paragraph (2) of this subsection (i) and include the
7    following members:
8            (A) Two appointees that represent district
9        superintendents, recommended by a statewide
10        organization that represents district superintendents.
11            (B) Two appointees that represent school boards,
12        recommended by a statewide organization that
13        represents school boards.
14            (C) Two appointees from districts that represent
15        school business officials, recommended by a statewide
16        organization that represents school business
17        officials.
18            (D) Two appointees that represent school
19        principals, recommended by a statewide organization
20        that represents school principals.
21            (E) Two appointees that represent teachers,
22        recommended by a statewide organization that
23        represents teachers.
24            (F) Two appointees that represent teachers,
25        recommended by another statewide organization that
26        represents teachers.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 275 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (G) Two appointees that represent regional
2        superintendents of schools, recommended by
3        organizations that represent regional superintendents.
4            (H) Two independent experts selected solely by the
5        State Superintendent.
6            (I) Two independent experts recommended by public
7        universities in this State.
8            (J) One member recommended by a statewide
9        organization that represents parents.
10            (K) Two representatives recommended by collective
11        impact organizations that represent major metropolitan
12        areas or geographic areas in Illinois.
13            (L) One member from a statewide organization
14        focused on research-based education policy to support
15        a school system that prepares all students for college,
16        a career, and democratic citizenship.
17            (M) One representative from a school district
18        organized under Article 34 of this Code.
19        The State Superintendent shall ensure that the
20    membership of the Panel includes representatives from
21    school districts and communities reflecting the
22    geographic, socio-economic, racial, and ethnic diversity
23    of this State. The State Superintendent shall additionally
24    ensure that the membership of the Panel includes
25    representatives with expertise in bilingual education and
26    special education. Staff from the State Board shall staff

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 276 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    the Panel.
2        (2) In addition to those Panel members appointed by the
3    State Superintendent, 4 members of the General Assembly
4    shall be appointed as follows: one member of the House of
5    Representatives appointed by the Speaker of the House of
6    Representatives, one member of the Senate appointed by the
7    President of the Senate, one member of the House of
8    Representatives appointed by the Minority Leader of the
9    House of Representatives, and one member of the Senate
10    appointed by the Minority Leader of the Senate. There shall
11    be one additional member appointed by the Governor. All
12    members appointed by legislative leaders or the Governor
13    shall be non-voting, ex officio members.
14        (3) The Panel must study topics at the direction of the
15    General Assembly or State Board of Education, as provided
16    under paragraph (1). The Panel may also study the following
17    topics at the direction of the chairperson:
18            (A) The format and scope of annual spending plans
19        referenced in paragraph (9) of subsection (h) of this
20        Section.
21            (B) The Comparable Wage Index under this Section.
22            (C) Maintenance and operations, including capital
23        maintenance and construction costs.
24            (D) "At-risk student" definition.
25            (E) Benefits.
26            (F) Technology.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 277 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (G) Local Capacity Target.
2            (H) Funding for Alternative Schools, Laboratory
3        Schools, safe schools, and alternative learning
4        opportunities programs.
5            (I) Funding for college and career acceleration
6        strategies.
7            (J) Special education investments.
8            (K) Early childhood investments, in collaboration
9        with the Illinois Early Learning Council.
10        (4) (Blank).
11        (5) Within 5 years after the implementation of this
12    Section, and every 5 years thereafter, the Panel shall
13    complete an evaluative study of the entire Evidence-Based
14    Funding model, including an assessment of whether or not
15    the formula is achieving State goals. The Panel shall
16    report to the State Board, the General Assembly, and the
17    Governor on the findings of the study.
18        (6) (Blank).
19    (j) References. Beginning July 1, 2017, references in other
20laws to general State aid funds or calculations under Section
2118-8.05 of this Code (now repealed) shall be deemed to be
22references to evidence-based model formula funds or
23calculations under this Section.
24(Source: P.A. 100-465, eff. 8-31-17; 100-578, eff. 1-31-18;
25100-582, eff. 3-23-18; 101-10, eff. 6-5-19; 101-17, eff.
266-14-19; 101-643, eff. 6-18-20; revised 8-21-20.)
 

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 278 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (105 ILCS 5/27-22)  (from Ch. 122, par. 27-22)
2    Sec. 27-22. Required high school courses.
3    (a) (Blank).
4    (b) (Blank).
5    (c) (Blank).
6    (d) (Blank).
7    (e) As a prerequisite to receiving a high school diploma,
8each pupil entering the 9th grade must, in addition to other
9course requirements, successfully complete all of the
10following courses:
11        (1) Four years of language arts.
12        (2) Two years of writing intensive courses, one of
13    which must be English and the other of which may be English
14    or any other subject. When applicable, writing-intensive
15    courses may be counted towards the fulfillment of other
16    graduation requirements.
17        (3) Three years of mathematics, one of which must be
18    Algebra I, one of which must include geometry content, and
19    one of which may be an Advanced Placement computer science
20    course. A mathematics course that includes geometry
21    content may be offered as an integrated, applied,
22    interdisciplinary, or career and technical education
23    course that prepares a student for a career readiness path.
24        (3.5) For pupils entering the 9th grade in the
25    2021-2022 school year and each school year thereafter, one

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 279 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    year of a course that includes intensive instruction in
2    computer literacy, which may be English, social studies, or
3    any other subject and which may be counted toward the
4    fulfillment of other graduation requirements.
5        (4) Two years of science.
6        (5) Two years of social studies, of which at least one
7    year must be history of the United States or a combination
8    of history of the United States and American government
9    and, beginning with pupils entering the 9th grade in the
10    2016-2017 school year and each school year thereafter, at
11    least one semester must be civics, which shall help young
12    people acquire and learn to use the skills, knowledge, and
13    attitudes that will prepare them to be competent and
14    responsible citizens throughout their lives. Civics course
15    content shall focus on government institutions, the
16    discussion of current and controversial issues, service
17    learning, and simulations of the democratic process.
18    School districts may utilize private funding available for
19    the purposes of offering civics education.
20        (6) One year chosen from (A) music, (B) art, (C)
21    foreign language, which shall be deemed to include American
22    Sign Language, or (D) vocational education.
23    (f) The State Board of Education shall develop and inform
24school districts of standards for writing-intensive
25coursework.
26    (f-5) If a school district offers an Advanced Placement

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 280 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1computer science course to high school students, then the
2school board must designate that course as equivalent to a high
3school mathematics course and must denote on the student's
4transcript that the Advanced Placement computer science course
5qualifies as a mathematics-based, quantitative course for
6students in accordance with subdivision (3) of subsection (e)
7of this Section.
8    (g) This amendatory Act of 1983 does not apply to pupils
9entering the 9th grade in 1983-1984 school year and prior
10school years or to students with disabilities whose course of
11study is determined by an individualized education program.
12    This amendatory Act of the 94th General Assembly does not
13apply to pupils entering the 9th grade in the 2004-2005 school
14year or a prior school year or to students with disabilities
15whose course of study is determined by an individualized
16education program.
17    This amendatory Act of the 101st General Assembly does not
18apply to pupils entering the 9th grade in the 2020-2021 school
19year or a prior school year or to students with disabilities
20whose course of study is determined by an individualized
21education program.
22    (h) The provisions of this Section are subject to the
23provisions of Section 27-22.05 of this Code and the
24Postsecondary and Workforce Readiness Act.
25    (i) The State Board of Education may adopt rules to modify
26the requirements of this Section for any students enrolled in

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 281 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1grades 9 through 12 if the Governor has declared a disaster due
2to a public health emergency pursuant to Section 7 of the
3Illinois Emergency Management Agency Act.
4(Source: P.A. 100-443, eff. 8-25-17; 101-464, eff. 1-1-20;
5101-643, eff. 6-18-20.)
 
6    (105 ILCS 5/27-23.15 new)
7    Sec. 27-23.15. Computer science.
8    (a) In this Section, "computer science" means the study of
9computers and algorithms, including their principles, their
10hardware and software designs, their implementation, and their
11impact on society. "Computer science" does not include the
12study of everyday uses of computers and computer applications,
13such as keyboarding or accessing the Internet.
14    (b) Beginning with the 2022-2023 school year, the school
15board of a school district that maintains any of grades 9
16through 12 shall provide an opportunity for every high school
17student to take at least one computer science course aligned to
18rigorous learning standards of the State Board of Education.
 
19
Article 65.

 
20    Section 65-5. The School Code is amended by changing
21Sections 14A-10 and 14A-32 as follows:
 
22    (105 ILCS 5/14A-10)

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 282 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Sec. 14A-10. Legislative findings. The General Assembly
2finds the following:
3        (1) that gifted and talented children (i) exhibit high
4    performance capabilities in intellectual, creative, and
5    artistic areas, (ii) possess an exceptional leadership
6    potential, (iii) excel in specific academic fields, and
7    (iv) have the potential to be influential in business,
8    government, health care, the arts, and other critical
9    sectors of our economic and cultural environment;
10        (2) that gifted and talented children require services
11    and activities that are not ordinarily provided by schools;
12    and
13        (3) that outstanding talents are present in children
14    and youth from all cultural groups, across all economic
15    strata, and in all areas of human endeavor; and .
16        (4) that inequitable access to advanced coursework and
17    enrollment in accelerated placement programs exists
18    between children enrolled in different school districts
19    and even within the same school district and more must be
20    done to eliminate the barriers to access to advanced
21    coursework and enrollment in accelerated placement
22    programs for all children.
23(Source: P.A. 94-151, eff. 7-8-05; 94-410, eff. 8-2-05.)
 
24    (105 ILCS 5/14A-32)
25    Sec. 14A-32. Accelerated placement; school district

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 283 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1responsibilities.
2    (a) Each school district shall have a policy that allows
3for accelerated placement that includes or incorporates by
4reference the following components:
5        (1) a provision that provides that participation in
6    accelerated placement is not limited to those children who
7    have been identified as gifted and talented, but rather is
8    open to all children who demonstrate high ability and who
9    may benefit from accelerated placement;
10        (2) a fair and equitable decision-making process that
11    involves multiple persons and includes a student's parents
12    or guardians;
13        (3) procedures for notifying parents or guardians of a
14    child of a decision affecting that child's participation in
15    an accelerated placement program; and
16        (4) an assessment process that includes multiple
17    valid, reliable indicators.
18    (a-5) By no later than the beginning of the 2022-2023
19school year, a school district's accelerated placement policy
20shall allow for the automatic enrollment, in the following
21school term, of a high school student into the next level of
22advanced coursework offered by the high school if the student
23meets or exceeds State standards in English language arts,
24mathematics, or science on a State assessment administered
25under Section 2-3.64a-5 as follows:
26        (1) A student who meets or exceeds State standards in

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 284 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    English language arts shall be automatically enrolled into
2    the next level of advanced coursework in English, social
3    studies, humanities, or related subjects.
4        (2) A student who meets or exceeds State standards in
5    mathematics shall be automatically enrolled into the next
6    level of advanced coursework in mathematics.
7        (3) A student who meets or exceeds State standards in
8    science shall be automatically enrolled into the next level
9    of advanced coursework in science.
10    For a student entering grade 12, the next level of advanced
11coursework under this subsection (a-5) shall be a dual credit
12course, as defined in the Dual Credit Quality Act. For other
13high school grades, the next level of advanced coursework may
14include a dual credit course.
15    A school district may use the student's most recent State
16assessment results to determine whether a student meets or
17exceeds State standards. For a student entering grade 9,
18results from the State assessment taken in grades 6 through 8
19may be used. For other high school grades, the results from a
20locally selected, nationally normed assessment may be used
21instead of the State assessment if those results are the most
22recent.
23    A school district must provide the parent or guardian of a
24student eligible for automatic enrollment under this
25subsection (a-5) with the option to instead have the student
26enroll in alternative coursework that better aligns with the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 285 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1student's postsecondary education or career goals.
2    Nothing in this subsection (a-5) may be interpreted to
3preclude other students from enrolling in advanced coursework
4per the policy of a school district.
5    (b) Further, a school district's accelerated placement
6policy may include or incorporate by reference, but need not be
7limited to, the following components:
8        (1) procedures for annually informing the community
9    at-large, including parents or guardians, community-based
10    organizations, and providers of out-of-school programs,
11    about the accelerated placement program and the methods
12    used for the identification of children eligible for
13    accelerated placement, including strategies to reach
14    groups of students and families who have been historically
15    underrepresented in accelerated placement programs and
16    advanced coursework;
17        (2) a process for referral that allows for multiple
18    referrers, including a child's parents or guardians; other
19    referrers may include licensed education professionals,
20    the child, with the written consent of a parent or
21    guardian, a peer, through a licensed education
22    professional who has knowledge of the referred child's
23    abilities, or, in case of possible early entrance, a
24    preschool educator, pediatrician, or psychologist who
25    knows the child; and
26        (3) a provision that provides that children

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 286 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    participating in an accelerated placement program and
2    their parents or guardians will be provided a written plan
3    detailing the type of acceleration the child will receive
4    and strategies to support the child; .
5        (4) procedures to provide support and promote success
6    for students who are newly enrolled in an accelerated
7    placement program; and
8        (5) a process for the school district to review and
9    utilize disaggregated data on participation in an
10    accelerated placement program to address gaps among
11    demographic groups in accelerated placement opportunities.
12    (c) The State Board of Education shall adopt rules to
13determine data to be collected and disaggregated by demographic
14group regarding accelerated placement, including the rates of
15students who participate in and successfully complete advanced
16coursework, and a method of making the information available to
17the public.
18    (d) On or before November 1, 2021, following a review of
19disaggregated data on the participation and successful
20completion rates of students enrolled in an accelerated
21placement program, each school district shall develop a plan to
22expand access to its accelerated placement program and to
23ensure the teaching capacity necessary to meet the increased
24demand.
25(Source: P.A. 100-421, eff. 7-1-18.)
 

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 287 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1
Article 70.

 
2    Section 70-5. The School Code is amended by changing
3Section 22-45 as follows:
 
4    (105 ILCS 5/22-45)
5    Sec. 22-45. Illinois P-20 Council.
6    (a) The General Assembly finds that preparing Illinoisans
7for success in school and the workplace requires a continuum of
8quality education from preschool through graduate school. This
9State needs a framework to guide education policy and integrate
10education at every level. A statewide coordinating council to
11study and make recommendations concerning education at all
12levels can avoid fragmentation of policies, promote improved
13teaching and learning, and continue to cultivate and
14demonstrate strong accountability and efficiency. Establishing
15an Illinois P-20 Council will develop a statewide agenda that
16will move the State towards the common goals of improving
17academic achievement, increasing college access and success,
18improving use of existing data and measurements, developing
19improved accountability, fostering innovative approaches to
20education, promoting lifelong learning, easing the transition
21to college, and reducing remediation. A pre-kindergarten
22through grade 20 agenda will strengthen this State's economic
23competitiveness by producing a highly-skilled workforce. In
24addition, lifelong learning plans will enhance this State's

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 288 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1ability to leverage funding.
2    (b) There is created the Illinois P-20 Council. The
3Illinois P-20 Council shall include all of the following
4members:
5        (1) The Governor or his or her designee, to serve as
6    chairperson.
7        (2) Four members of the General Assembly, one appointed
8    by the Speaker of the House of Representatives, one
9    appointed by the Minority Leader of the House of
10    Representatives, one appointed by the President of the
11    Senate, and one appointed by the Minority Leader of the
12    Senate.
13        (3) Six at-large members appointed by the Governor as
14    follows, with 2 members being from the City of Chicago, 2
15    members being from Lake County, McHenry County, Kane
16    County, DuPage County, Will County, or that part of Cook
17    County outside of the City of Chicago, and 2 members being
18    from the remainder of the State:
19            (A) one representative of civic leaders;
20            (B) one representative of local government;
21            (C) one representative of trade unions;
22            (D) one representative of nonprofit organizations
23        or foundations;
24            (E) one representative of parents' organizations;
25        and
26            (F) one education research expert.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 289 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (4) Five members appointed by statewide business
2    organizations and business trade associations.
3        (5) Six members appointed by statewide professional
4    organizations and associations representing
5    pre-kindergarten through grade 20 teachers, community
6    college faculty, and public university faculty.
7        (6) Two members appointed by associations representing
8    local school administrators and school board members. One
9    of these members must be a special education administrator.
10        (7) One member representing community colleges,
11    appointed by the Illinois Council of Community College
12    Presidents.
13        (8) One member representing 4-year independent
14    colleges and universities, appointed by a statewide
15    organization representing private institutions of higher
16    learning.
17        (9) One member representing public 4-year
18    universities, appointed jointly by the university
19    presidents and chancellors.
20        (10) Ex-officio members as follows:
21            (A) The State Superintendent of Education or his or
22        her designee.
23            (B) The Executive Director of the Board of Higher
24        Education or his or her designee.
25            (C) The Executive Director of the Illinois
26        Community College Board or his or her designee.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 290 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (D) The Executive Director of the Illinois Student
2        Assistance Commission or his or her designee.
3            (E) The Co-chairpersons of the Illinois Workforce
4        Investment Board or their designee.
5            (F) The Director of Commerce and Economic
6        Opportunity or his or her designee.
7            (G) The Chairperson of the Illinois Early Learning
8        Council or his or her designee.
9            (H) The President of the Illinois Mathematics and
10        Science Academy or his or her designee.
11            (I) The president of an association representing
12        educators of adult learners or his or her designee.
13Ex-officio members shall have no vote on the Illinois P-20
14Council.
15    Appointed members shall serve for staggered terms expiring
16on July 1 of the first, second, or third calendar year
17following their appointments or until their successors are
18appointed and have qualified. Staggered terms shall be
19determined by lot at the organizing meeting of the Illinois
20P-20 Council.
21    Vacancies shall be filled in the same manner as original
22appointments, and any member so appointed shall serve during
23the remainder of the term for which the vacancy occurred.
24    (c) The Illinois P-20 Council shall be funded through State
25appropriations to support staff activities, research,
26data-collection, and dissemination. The Illinois P-20 Council

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 291 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1shall be staffed by the Office of the Governor, in coordination
2with relevant State agencies, boards, and commissions. The
3Illinois Education Research Council shall provide research and
4coordinate research collection activities for the Illinois
5P-20 Council.
6    (d) The Illinois P-20 Council shall have all of the
7following duties:
8        (1) To make recommendations to do all of the following:
9            (A) Coordinate pre-kindergarten through grade 20
10        (graduate school) education in this State through
11        working at the intersections of educational systems to
12        promote collaborative infrastructure.
13            (B) Coordinate and leverage strategies, actions,
14        legislation, policies, and resources of all
15        stakeholders to support fundamental and lasting
16        improvement in this State's public schools, community
17        colleges, and universities.
18            (C) Better align the high school curriculum with
19        postsecondary expectations.
20            (D) Better align assessments across all levels of
21        education.
22            (E) Reduce the need for students entering
23        institutions of higher education to take remedial
24        courses.
25            (F) Smooth the transition from high school to
26        college.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 292 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (G) Improve high school and college graduation
2        rates.
3            (H) Improve the rigor and relevance of academic
4        standards for college and workforce readiness.
5            (I) Better align college and university teaching
6        programs with the needs of Illinois schools.
7        (2) To advise the Governor, the General Assembly, the
8    State's education and higher education agencies, and the
9    State's workforce and economic development boards and
10    agencies on policies related to lifelong learning for
11    Illinois students and families.
12        (3) To articulate a framework for systemic educational
13    improvement and innovation that will enable every student
14    to meet or exceed Illinois learning standards and be
15    well-prepared to succeed in the workforce and community.
16        (4) To provide an estimated fiscal impact for
17    implementation of all Council recommendations.
18        (5) To make recommendations for short-term and
19    long-term learning recovery actions for public school
20    students in this State in the wake of the COVID-19
21    pandemic. The Illinois P-20 Council shall submit a report
22    with its recommendations for a multi-year recovery plan by
23    December 31, 2021 to the Governor, the State Board of
24    Education, the Board of Higher Education, the Illinois
25    Community College Board, and the General Assembly that
26    addresses all of the following:

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 293 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (A) Closing the digital divide for all students,
2        including access to devices, Internet connectivity,
3        and ensuring that educators have the necessary support
4        and training to provide high quality remote and blended
5        learning to students.
6            (B) Evaluating the academic growth and proficiency
7        of students in order to understand the impact of school
8        closures and remote and blended remote learning
9        conditions on student academic outcomes, including
10        disaggregating data by race, income, diverse learners,
11        and English learners, in ways that balance the need to
12        understand that impact with the need to support student
13        well-being and also take into consideration the
14        logistical constraints facing schools and districts.
15            (C) Establishing a system for the collection and
16        review of student data at the State level, including
17        data about prekindergarten through higher education
18        student attendance, engagement and participation,
19        discipline, and social-emotional and mental health
20        inputs and outcomes, in order to better understand the
21        full impact of disrupted learning.
22            (D) Providing students with resources and programs
23        for academic support, such as enrichment
24        opportunities, tutoring corps, summer bridge programs,
25        youth leadership and development programs, youth and
26        community-led restorative and transformative justice

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 294 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        programs, and youth internship and apprenticeship
2        programs.
3            (E) Providing students with resources and support
4        to ensure access to social-emotional learning, mental
5        health services, and trauma responsive, restorative
6        justice and anti-racist practices in order to support
7        the growth of the whole child, such as investing in
8        community schools and providing comprehensive
9        year-round services and support for both students and
10        their families.
11            (F) Ensuring more time for students' academic,
12        social-emotional, and mental health needs by
13        considering such strategies as: (i) extending planning
14        time for teachers, (ii) extending the school day and
15        school year, and (iii) transitioning to year-round
16        schooling.
17            (G) Strengthening the transition from secondary
18        education to postsecondary education in the wake of
19        threats to alignment and affordability created by the
20        pandemic and related conditions.
21    (e) The chairperson of the Illinois P-20 Council may
22authorize the creation of working groups focusing on areas of
23interest to Illinois educational and workforce development,
24including without limitation the following areas:
25        (1) Preparation, recruitment, and certification of
26    highly qualified teachers.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 295 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (2) Mentoring and induction of highly qualified
2    teachers.
3        (3) The diversity of highly qualified teachers.
4        (4) Funding for highly qualified teachers, including
5    developing a strategic and collaborative plan to seek
6    federal and private grants to support initiatives
7    targeting teacher preparation and its impact on student
8    achievement.
9        (5) Highly effective administrators.
10        (6) Illinois birth through age 3 education,
11    pre-kindergarten, and early childhood education.
12        (7) The assessment, alignment, outreach, and network
13    of college and workforce readiness efforts.
14        (8) Alternative routes to college access.
15        (9) Research data and accountability.
16        (10) Community schools, community participation, and
17    other innovative approaches to education that foster
18    community partnerships.
19        (11) Tuition, financial aid, and other issues related
20    to keeping postsecondary education affordable for Illinois
21    residents.
22        (12) Learning recovery in the wake of the COVID-19
23    pandemic.
24    The chairperson of the Illinois P-20 Council may designate
25Council members to serve as working group chairpersons. Working
26groups may invite organizations and individuals representing

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 296 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1pre-kindergarten through grade 20 interests to participate in
2discussions, data collection, and dissemination.
3(Source: P.A. 98-463, eff. 8-16-13; 98-719, eff. 1-1-15;
499-643, eff. 1-1-17.)
 
5
Article 75.

 
6    Section 75-5. The State Finance Act is amended by adding
7Section 5.935 as follows:
 
8    (30 ILCS 105/5.935 new)
9    Sec. 5.935. The Freedom Schools Fund.
 
10    Section 75-10. The School Code is amended by adding Section
112-3.186 as follows:
 
12    (105 ILCS 5/2-3.186 new)
13    Sec. 2-3.186. Freedom Schools; grant program.
14    (a) The General Assembly recognizes and values the
15contributions that Freedom Schools make to enhance the lives of
16Black students. The General Assembly makes all of the following
17findings:
18        (1) The fundamental goal of the Freedom Schools of the
19    1960s was to create Black political power to defend the
20    interests of the disempowered. The curriculum of Freedom
21    Schools allowed students of all ages to experience a new

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 297 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    and liberating form of education that directly related to
2    the imperatives of their lives, their communities, and the
3    Freedom Movement.
4        (2) Freedom Schools continue to demonstrate the proven
5    benefits of race modeling and intergenerational effects by
6    providing Black students with quality instruction that
7    fosters student confidence, resiliency, and social and
8    emotional development.
9        (3) Freedom Schools offer culturally relevant learning
10    opportunities with the academic and social supports that
11    Black children need by utilizing quality teaching,
12    challenging and engaging curricula, wrap-around supports,
13    a positive school climate, and strong ties to family and
14    community. Freedom Schools have a clear focus on results.
15        (4) Public schools serve a foundational role in the
16    education of over 2,000,000 students in this State.
17    (b) The State Board of Education shall establish Freedom
18Schools to supplement the learning taking place in public
19schools by expanding the teaching of Black history, developing
20leadership skills, and providing an understanding of the tenets
21of the civil rights movement. The teachers in Freedom Schools
22must be college students or recent high school graduates from
23the local community, with an emphasis on Black youth, so that
24(i) these individuals have access to summer jobs and teaching
25experiences that serve as a long-term pipeline to educational
26careers and the hiring of Black educators in public schools,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 298 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1(ii) these individuals are elevated as content experts and
2community leaders, and (iii) Freedom School students have
3access to both role models and education.
4    (c) A Freedom School shall intentionally and imaginatively
5implement strategies that focus on all of the following:
6        (1) Racial justice and equity.
7        (2) Transparency and building trusting relationships.
8        (3) Self-determination and governance.
9        (4) Building on community strengths and community
10    wisdom.
11        (5) Utilizing current data, best practices, and
12    evidence.
13        (6) Shared leadership and collaboration.
14        (7) A reflective learning culture.
15        (8) A whole-child approach to education.
16        (9) Literacy.
17    (d) The State Board of Education, in the establishment of
18Freedom Schools, shall strive for authentic parent and
19community engagement during the development of Freedom Schools
20and their curriculum. Authentic parent and community
21engagement includes all of the following:
22        (1) A shared responsibility that values equal
23    partnerships between families and professionals.
24        (2) Ensuring that students and families who are
25    directly impacted by Freedom School policies and practices
26    are the decision-makers in the creation, design,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 299 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    implementation, and assessment of those policies and
2    practices.
3        (3) Genuine respect for the culture and diversity of
4    families.
5        (4) Relationships that center around the goal of
6    supporting family well-being and children's development
7    and learning.
8    (e) Subject to appropriation, the State Board of Education
9shall establish and implement a grant program to provide grants
10to public schools, public community colleges, and
11not-for-profit, community-based organizations to facilitate
12improved educational outcomes for Black students in grades
13pre-kindergarten through 12. Grant recipients under the
14program may include, but are not limited to, entities that
15offer established programs with proven results and outcomes.
16The State Board of Education shall award grants to eligible
17entities that demonstrate a likelihood of reasonable success in
18achieving the goals identified in the grant application,
19including, but not limited to, all of the following:
20        (1) Engaging, culturally relevant, and challenging
21    curricula.
22        (2) High-quality teaching.
23        (3) Wrap-around supports and opportunities.
24        (4) Positive discipline practices, such as restorative
25    justice.
26        (5) Inclusive leadership.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 300 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (f) The Freedom Schools Fund is created as a special fund
2in the State treasury. the Fund shall consist of appropriations
3from the General Revenue Fund, grant funds from the federal
4government, and donations from educational and private
5foundations. All money in the Fund shall be used, subject to
6appropriation, by the State Board of Education for the purposes
7of this Section and to support related activities.
8    (g) The State Board of Education may adopt any rules
9necessary to implement this Section.
 
10
Article 80.

 
11    Section 80-5. The School Code is amended by changing
12Section 10-19 as follows:
 
13    (105 ILCS 5/10-19)  (from Ch. 122, par. 10-19)
14    Sec. 10-19. Length of school term; - experimental programs.
15Each school board shall annually prepare a calendar for the
16school term, specifying the opening and closing dates and
17providing a minimum term of at least 185 days to ensure insure
18176 days of actual pupil attendance, computable under Section
1910-19.05, except that for each of the 2021-2022, 2022-2023, and
202023-2024 school years, each school board, including a school
21board operating one or more schools on a full year school plan
22pursuant to Section 10-19.1, shall include in its calendar a
23minimum of an additional 15 days of actual pupil attendance and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 301 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

15 days of in-service training for teachers. A school board may
2choose how to reach the minimum of 15 additional days of actual
3pupil attendance for each of the 2021-2022, 2022-2023, and
42023-2024 school years by either extending the length of the
5school day or extending the length of the school term. During
6the 2021-2022 school year, if a school is closed for more than
75 days of actual pupil attendance because the Governor has
8declared a disaster due to a public health emergency pursuant
9to Section 7 of the Illinois Emergency Management Agency Act,
10the school board shall extend the length of the school day or
11extend the length of the school term during any of the
122021-2022, 2022-2023, and 2023-2024 school years by one
13additional day of actual pupil attendance for every 5 days of
14actual pupil attendance that are missed during the 2021-2022
15school year because of the public health emergency, unless the
16school board has decided at the beginning of the 2021-2022
17school year to implement a plan to use remote learning or
18blended remote learning under Section 10-30 or 34-18.66 for the
191980-1981 school year only 175 days of actual pupil attendance
20shall be required because of the closing of schools pursuant to
21Section 24-2 on January 29, 1981 upon the appointment by the
22President of that day as a day of thanksgiving for the freedom
23of the Americans who had been held hostage in Iran. Any days
24allowed by law for teachers' institutes but not used as such or
25used as parental institutes as provided in Section 10-22.18d
26shall increase the minimum term by the school days not so used.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 302 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1Except as provided in Section 10-19.1, the board may not extend
2the school term beyond the such closing date unless that
3extension of term is necessary to provide the minimum number of
4computable days. In case of such necessary extension, other
5than for the additional days of actual pupil attendance and
6in-service training for teachers required by this amendatory
7Act of the 101st General Assembly, school employees shall be
8paid for such additional time on the basis of their regular
9contracts. A school board may specify a closing date earlier
10than that set on the annual calendar when the schools of the
11district have provided the minimum number of computable days
12under this Section. Nothing in this Section prevents the board
13from employing superintendents of schools, principals and
14other nonteaching personnel for a period of 12 months, or in
15the case of superintendents for a period in accordance with
16Section 10-23.8, or prevents the board from employing other
17personnel before or after the regular school term with payment
18of salary proportionate to that received for comparable work
19during the school term. Remote learning days, blended remote
20learning days, and up to 5 remote and blended remote learning
21planning days established under Section 10-30 or 34-18.66 shall
22be deemed pupil attendance days for calculation of the length
23of a school term under this Section.
24    A school board may make such changes in its calendar for
25the school term as may be required by any changes in the legal
26school holidays prescribed in Section 24-2. A school board may

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 303 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1make changes in its calendar for the school term as may be
2necessary to reflect the utilization of teachers' institute
3days as parental institute days as provided in Section
410-22.18d.
5    The calendar for the school term and any changes must be
6submitted to and approved by the regional superintendent of
7schools before the calendar or changes may take effect.
8    With the prior approval of the State Board of Education and
9subject to review by the State Board of Education every 3
10years, any school board may, by resolution of its board and in
11agreement with affected exclusive collective bargaining
12agents, establish experimental educational programs, including
13but not limited to programs for e-learning days as authorized
14under Section 10-20.56 of this Code, self-directed learning, or
15outside of formal class periods, which programs when so
16approved shall be considered to comply with the requirements of
17this Section as respects numbers of days of actual pupil
18attendance and with the other requirements of this Code Act as
19respects courses of instruction.
20(Source: P.A. 100-465, eff. 8-31-17; 101-12, eff. 7-1-19;
21101-643, eff. 6-18-20.)
 
22
Article 85.

 
23    Section 85-5. The School Code is amended by changing
24Section 18-8.15 as follows:
 

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 304 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (105 ILCS 5/18-8.15)
2    Sec. 18-8.15. Evidence-Based Funding for student success
3for the 2017-2018 and subsequent school years.
4    (a) General provisions.
5        (1) The purpose of this Section is to ensure that, by
6    June 30, 2027 and beyond, this State has a kindergarten
7    through grade 12 public education system with the capacity
8    to ensure the educational development of all persons to the
9    limits of their capacities in accordance with Section 1 of
10    Article X of the Constitution of the State of Illinois. To
11    accomplish that objective, this Section creates a method of
12    funding public education that is evidence-based; is
13    sufficient to ensure every student receives a meaningful
14    opportunity to learn irrespective of race, ethnicity,
15    sexual orientation, gender, or community-income level; and
16    is sustainable and predictable. When fully funded under
17    this Section, every school shall have the resources, based
18    on what the evidence indicates is needed, to:
19            (A) provide all students with a high quality
20        education that offers the academic, enrichment, social
21        and emotional support, technical, and career-focused
22        programs that will allow them to become competitive
23        workers, responsible parents, productive citizens of
24        this State, and active members of our national
25        democracy;

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 305 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (B) ensure all students receive the education they
2        need to graduate from high school with the skills
3        required to pursue post-secondary education and
4        training for a rewarding career;
5            (C) reduce, with a goal of eliminating, the
6        achievement gap between at-risk and non-at-risk
7        students by raising the performance of at-risk
8        students and not by reducing standards; and
9            (D) ensure this State satisfies its obligation to
10        assume the primary responsibility to fund public
11        education and simultaneously relieve the
12        disproportionate burden placed on local property taxes
13        to fund schools.
14        (2) The Evidence-Based Funding formula under this
15    Section shall be applied to all Organizational Units in
16    this State. The Evidence-Based Funding formula outlined in
17    this Act is based on the formula outlined in Senate Bill 1
18    of the 100th General Assembly, as passed by both
19    legislative chambers. As further defined and described in
20    this Section, there are 4 major components of the
21    Evidence-Based Funding model:
22            (A) First, the model calculates a unique Adequacy
23        Target for each Organizational Unit in this State that
24        considers the costs to implement research-based
25        activities, the unit's student demographics, and
26        regional wage differences.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 306 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (B) Second, the model calculates each
2        Organizational Unit's Local Capacity, or the amount
3        each Organizational Unit is assumed to contribute
4        toward its Adequacy Target from local resources.
5            (C) Third, the model calculates how much funding
6        the State currently contributes to the Organizational
7        Unit and adds that to the unit's Local Capacity to
8        determine the unit's overall current adequacy of
9        funding.
10            (D) Finally, the model's distribution method
11        allocates new State funding to those Organizational
12        Units that are least well-funded, considering both
13        Local Capacity and State funding, in relation to their
14        Adequacy Target.
15        (3) An Organizational Unit receiving any funding under
16    this Section may apply those funds to any fund so received
17    for which that Organizational Unit is authorized to make
18    expenditures by law.
19        (4) As used in this Section, the following terms shall
20    have the meanings ascribed in this paragraph (4):
21        "Adequacy Target" is defined in paragraph (1) of
22    subsection (b) of this Section.
23        "Adjusted EAV" is defined in paragraph (4) of
24    subsection (d) of this Section.
25        "Adjusted Local Capacity Target" is defined in
26    paragraph (3) of subsection (c) of this Section.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 307 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        "Adjusted Operating Tax Rate" means a tax rate for all
2    Organizational Units, for which the State Superintendent
3    shall calculate and subtract for the Operating Tax Rate a
4    transportation rate based on total expenses for
5    transportation services under this Code, as reported on the
6    most recent Annual Financial Report in Pupil
7    Transportation Services, function 2550 in both the
8    Education and Transportation funds and functions 4110 and
9    4120 in the Transportation fund, less any corresponding
10    fiscal year State of Illinois scheduled payments excluding
11    net adjustments for prior years for regular, vocational, or
12    special education transportation reimbursement pursuant to
13    Section 29-5 or subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of this
14    Code divided by the Adjusted EAV. If an Organizational
15    Unit's corresponding fiscal year State of Illinois
16    scheduled payments excluding net adjustments for prior
17    years for regular, vocational, or special education
18    transportation reimbursement pursuant to Section 29-5 or
19    subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of this Code exceed the
20    total transportation expenses, as defined in this
21    paragraph, no transportation rate shall be subtracted from
22    the Operating Tax Rate.
23        "Allocation Rate" is defined in paragraph (3) of
24    subsection (g) of this Section.
25        "Alternative School" means a public school that is
26    created and operated by a regional superintendent of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 308 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    schools and approved by the State Board.
2        "Applicable Tax Rate" is defined in paragraph (1) of
3    subsection (d) of this Section.
4        "Assessment" means any of those benchmark, progress
5    monitoring, formative, diagnostic, and other assessments,
6    in addition to the State accountability assessment, that
7    assist teachers' needs in understanding the skills and
8    meeting the needs of the students they serve.
9        "Assistant principal" means a school administrator
10    duly endorsed to be employed as an assistant principal in
11    this State.
12        "At-risk student" means a student who is at risk of not
13    meeting the Illinois Learning Standards or not graduating
14    from elementary or high school and who demonstrates a need
15    for vocational support or social services beyond that
16    provided by the regular school program. All students
17    included in an Organizational Unit's Low-Income Count, as
18    well as all English learner and disabled students attending
19    the Organizational Unit, shall be considered at-risk
20    students under this Section.
21        "Average Student Enrollment" or "ASE" for fiscal year
22    2018 means, for an Organizational Unit, the greater of the
23    average number of students (grades K through 12) reported
24    to the State Board as enrolled in the Organizational Unit
25    on October 1 in the immediately preceding school year, plus
26    the pre-kindergarten students who receive special

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 309 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    education services of 2 or more hours a day as reported to
2    the State Board on December 1 in the immediately preceding
3    school year, or the average number of students (grades K
4    through 12) reported to the State Board as enrolled in the
5    Organizational Unit on October 1, plus the
6    pre-kindergarten students who receive special education
7    services of 2 or more hours a day as reported to the State
8    Board on December 1, for each of the immediately preceding
9    3 school years. For fiscal year 2019 and each subsequent
10    fiscal year, "Average Student Enrollment" or "ASE" means,
11    for an Organizational Unit, the greater of the average
12    number of students (grades K through 12) reported to the
13    State Board as enrolled in the Organizational Unit on
14    October 1 and March 1 in the immediately preceding school
15    year, plus the pre-kindergarten students who receive
16    special education services as reported to the State Board
17    on October 1 and March 1 in the immediately preceding
18    school year, or the average number of students (grades K
19    through 12) reported to the State Board as enrolled in the
20    Organizational Unit on October 1 and March 1, plus the
21    pre-kindergarten students who receive special education
22    services as reported to the State Board on October 1 and
23    March 1, for each of the immediately preceding 3 school
24    years. For the purposes of this definition, "enrolled in
25    the Organizational Unit" means the number of students
26    reported to the State Board who are enrolled in schools

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 310 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    within the Organizational Unit that the student attends or
2    would attend if not placed or transferred to another school
3    or program to receive needed services. For the purposes of
4    calculating "ASE", all students, grades K through 12,
5    excluding those attending kindergarten for a half day and
6    students attending an alternative education program
7    operated by a regional office of education or intermediate
8    service center, shall be counted as 1.0. All students
9    attending kindergarten for a half day shall be counted as
10    0.5, unless in 2017 by June 15 or by March 1 in subsequent
11    years, the school district reports to the State Board of
12    Education the intent to implement full-day kindergarten
13    district-wide for all students, then all students
14    attending kindergarten shall be counted as 1.0. Special
15    education pre-kindergarten students shall be counted as
16    0.5 each. If the State Board does not collect or has not
17    collected both an October 1 and March 1 enrollment count by
18    grade or a December 1 collection of special education
19    pre-kindergarten students as of August 31, 2017 (the
20    effective date of Public Act 100-465), it shall establish
21    such collection for all future years. For any year in which
22    a count by grade level was collected only once, that count
23    shall be used as the single count available for computing a
24    3-year average ASE. Funding for programs operated by a
25    regional office of education or an intermediate service
26    center must be calculated using the Evidence-Based Funding

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 311 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    formula under this Section for the 2019-2020 school year
2    and each subsequent school year until separate adequacy
3    formulas are developed and adopted for each type of
4    program. ASE for a program operated by a regional office of
5    education or an intermediate service center must be
6    determined by the March 1 enrollment for the program. For
7    the 2019-2020 school year, the ASE used in the calculation
8    must be the first-year ASE and, in that year only, the
9    assignment of students served by a regional office of
10    education or intermediate service center shall not result
11    in a reduction of the March enrollment for any school
12    district. For the 2020-2021 school year, the ASE must be
13    the greater of the current-year ASE or the 2-year average
14    ASE. Beginning with the 2021-2022 school year, the ASE must
15    be the greater of the current-year ASE or the 3-year
16    average ASE. School districts shall submit the data for the
17    ASE calculation to the State Board within 45 days of the
18    dates required in this Section for submission of enrollment
19    data in order for it to be included in the ASE calculation.
20    For fiscal year 2018 only, the ASE calculation shall
21    include only enrollment taken on October 1.
22        "Base Funding Guarantee" is defined in paragraph (10)
23    of subsection (g) of this Section.
24        "Base Funding Minimum" is defined in subsection (e) of
25    this Section.
26        "Base Tax Year" means the property tax levy year used

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 312 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    to calculate the Budget Year allocation of primary State
2    aid.
3        "Base Tax Year's Extension" means the product of the
4    equalized assessed valuation utilized by the county clerk
5    in the Base Tax Year multiplied by the limiting rate as
6    calculated by the county clerk and defined in PTELL.
7        "Bilingual Education Allocation" means the amount of
8    an Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target
9    attributable to bilingual education divided by the
10    Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target, the product
11    of which shall be multiplied by the amount of new funding
12    received pursuant to this Section. An Organizational
13    Unit's final Adequacy Target attributable to bilingual
14    education shall include all additional investments in
15    English learner students' adequacy elements.
16        "Budget Year" means the school year for which primary
17    State aid is calculated and awarded under this Section.
18        "Central office" means individual administrators and
19    support service personnel charged with managing the
20    instructional programs, business and operations, and
21    security of the Organizational Unit.
22        "Comparable Wage Index" or "CWI" means a regional cost
23    differentiation metric that measures systemic, regional
24    variations in the salaries of college graduates who are not
25    educators. The CWI utilized for this Section shall, for the
26    first 3 years of Evidence-Based Funding implementation, be

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 313 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    the CWI initially developed by the National Center for
2    Education Statistics, as most recently updated by Texas A &
3    M University. In the fourth and subsequent years of
4    Evidence-Based Funding implementation, the State
5    Superintendent shall re-determine the CWI using a similar
6    methodology to that identified in the Texas A & M
7    University study, with adjustments made no less frequently
8    than once every 5 years.
9        "Computer technology and equipment" means computers
10    servers, notebooks, network equipment, copiers, printers,
11    instructional software, security software, curriculum
12    management courseware, and other similar materials and
13    equipment.
14        "Computer technology and equipment investment
15    allocation" means the final Adequacy Target amount of an
16    Organizational Unit assigned to Tier 1 or Tier 2 in the
17    prior school year attributable to the additional $285.50
18    per student computer technology and equipment investment
19    grant divided by the Organizational Unit's final Adequacy
20    Target, the result of which shall be multiplied by the
21    amount of new funding received pursuant to this Section. An
22    Organizational Unit assigned to a Tier 1 or Tier 2 final
23    Adequacy Target attributable to the received computer
24    technology and equipment investment grant shall include
25    all additional investments in computer technology and
26    equipment adequacy elements.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 314 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        "Core subject" means mathematics; science; reading,
2    English, writing, and language arts; history and social
3    studies; world languages; and subjects taught as Advanced
4    Placement in high schools.
5        "Core teacher" means a regular classroom teacher in
6    elementary schools and teachers of a core subject in middle
7    and high schools.
8        "Core Intervention teacher (tutor)" means a licensed
9    teacher providing one-on-one or small group tutoring to
10    students struggling to meet proficiency in core subjects.
11        "CPPRT" means corporate personal property replacement
12    tax funds paid to an Organizational Unit during the
13    calendar year one year before the calendar year in which a
14    school year begins, pursuant to "An Act in relation to the
15    abolition of ad valorem personal property tax and the
16    replacement of revenues lost thereby, and amending and
17    repealing certain Acts and parts of Acts in connection
18    therewith", certified August 14, 1979, as amended (Public
19    Act 81-1st S.S.-1).
20        "EAV" means equalized assessed valuation as defined in
21    paragraph (2) of subsection (d) of this Section and
22    calculated in accordance with paragraph (3) of subsection
23    (d) of this Section.
24        "ECI" means the Bureau of Labor Statistics' national
25    employment cost index for civilian workers in educational
26    services in elementary and secondary schools on a

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 315 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    cumulative basis for the 12-month calendar year preceding
2    the fiscal year of the Evidence-Based Funding calculation.
3        "EIS Data" means the employment information system
4    data maintained by the State Board on educators within
5    Organizational Units.
6        "Employee benefits" means health, dental, and vision
7    insurance offered to employees of an Organizational Unit,
8    the costs associated with the statutorily required payment
9    of the normal cost of the Organizational Unit's teacher
10    pensions, Social Security employer contributions, and
11    Illinois Municipal Retirement Fund employer contributions.
12        "English learner" or "EL" means a child included in the
13    definition of "English learners" under Section 14C-2 of
14    this Code participating in a program of transitional
15    bilingual education or a transitional program of
16    instruction meeting the requirements and program
17    application procedures of Article 14C of this Code. For the
18    purposes of collecting the number of EL students enrolled,
19    the same collection and calculation methodology as defined
20    above for "ASE" shall apply to English learners, with the
21    exception that EL student enrollment shall include
22    students in grades pre-kindergarten through 12.
23        "Essential Elements" means those elements, resources,
24    and educational programs that have been identified through
25    academic research as necessary to improve student success,
26    improve academic performance, close achievement gaps, and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 316 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    provide for other per student costs related to the delivery
2    and leadership of the Organizational Unit, as well as the
3    maintenance and operations of the unit, and which are
4    specified in paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this
5    Section.
6        "Evidence-Based Funding" means State funding provided
7    to an Organizational Unit pursuant to this Section.
8        "Extended day" means academic and enrichment programs
9    provided to students outside the regular school day before
10    and after school or during non-instructional times during
11    the school day.
12        "Extension Limitation Ratio" means a numerical ratio
13    in which the numerator is the Base Tax Year's Extension and
14    the denominator is the Preceding Tax Year's Extension.
15        "Final Percent of Adequacy" is defined in paragraph (4)
16    of subsection (f) of this Section.
17        "Final Resources" is defined in paragraph (3) of
18    subsection (f) of this Section.
19        "Full-time equivalent" or "FTE" means the full-time
20    equivalency compensation for staffing the relevant
21    position at an Organizational Unit.
22        "Funding Gap" is defined in paragraph (1) of subsection
23    (g).
24        "Guidance counselor" means a licensed guidance
25    counselor who provides guidance and counseling support for
26    students within an Organizational Unit.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 317 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        "Hybrid District" means a partial elementary unit
2    district created pursuant to Article 11E of this Code.
3        "Instructional assistant" means a core or special
4    education, non-licensed employee who assists a teacher in
5    the classroom and provides academic support to students.
6        "Instructional facilitator" means a qualified teacher
7    or licensed teacher leader who facilitates and coaches
8    continuous improvement in classroom instruction; provides
9    instructional support to teachers in the elements of
10    research-based instruction or demonstrates the alignment
11    of instruction with curriculum standards and assessment
12    tools; develops or coordinates instructional programs or
13    strategies; develops and implements training; chooses
14    standards-based instructional materials; provides teachers
15    with an understanding of current research; serves as a
16    mentor, site coach, curriculum specialist, or lead
17    teacher; or otherwise works with fellow teachers, in
18    collaboration, to use data to improve instructional
19    practice or develop model lessons.
20        "Instructional materials" means relevant instructional
21    materials for student instruction, including, but not
22    limited to, textbooks, consumable workbooks, laboratory
23    equipment, library books, and other similar materials.
24        "Laboratory School" means a public school that is
25    created and operated by a public university and approved by
26    the State Board.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 318 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        "Librarian" means a teacher with an endorsement as a
2    library information specialist or another individual whose
3    primary responsibility is overseeing library resources
4    within an Organizational Unit.
5        "Limiting rate for Hybrid Districts" means the
6    combined elementary school and high school limiting rates.
7        "Local Capacity" is defined in paragraph (1) of
8    subsection (c) of this Section.
9        "Local Capacity Percentage" is defined in subparagraph
10    (A) of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of this Section.
11        "Local Capacity Ratio" is defined in subparagraph (B)
12    of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of this Section.
13        "Local Capacity Target" is defined in paragraph (2) of
14    subsection (c) of this Section.
15        "Low-Income Count" means, for an Organizational Unit
16    in a fiscal year, the higher of the average number of
17    students for the prior school year or the immediately
18    preceding 3 school years who, as of July 1 of the
19    immediately preceding fiscal year (as determined by the
20    Department of Human Services), are eligible for at least
21    one of the following low-income programs: Medicaid, the
22    Children's Health Insurance Program, Temporary Assistance
23    for Needy Families (TANF), or the Supplemental Nutrition
24    Assistance Program, excluding pupils who are eligible for
25    services provided by the Department of Children and Family
26    Services. Until such time that grade level low-income

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 319 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    populations become available, grade level low-income
2    populations shall be determined by applying the low-income
3    percentage to total student enrollments by grade level. The
4    low-income percentage is determined by dividing the
5    Low-Income Count by the Average Student Enrollment. The
6    low-income percentage for programs operated by a regional
7    office of education or an intermediate service center must
8    be set to the weighted average of the low-income
9    percentages of all of the school districts in the service
10    region. The weighted low-income percentage is the result of
11    multiplying the low-income percentage of each school
12    district served by the regional office of education or
13    intermediate service center by each school district's
14    Average Student Enrollment, summarizing those products and
15    dividing the total by the total Average Student Enrollment
16    for the service region.
17        "Maintenance and operations" means custodial services,
18    facility and ground maintenance, facility operations,
19    facility security, routine facility repairs, and other
20    similar services and functions.
21        "Minimum Funding Level" is defined in paragraph (9) of
22    subsection (g) of this Section.
23        "New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds" means, for any
24    given fiscal year, all State funds appropriated under
25    Section 2-3.170 of this the School Code.
26        "New State Funds" means, for a given school year, all

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 320 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    State funds appropriated for Evidence-Based Funding in
2    excess of the amount needed to fund the Base Funding
3    Minimum for all Organizational Units in that school year.
4        "Net State Contribution Target" means, for a given
5    school year, the amount of State funds that would be
6    necessary to fully meet the Adequacy Target of an
7    Operational Unit minus the Preliminary Resources available
8    to each unit.
9        "Nurse" means an individual licensed as a certified
10    school nurse, in accordance with the rules established for
11    nursing services by the State Board, who is an employee of
12    and is available to provide health care-related services
13    for students of an Organizational Unit.
14        "Operating Tax Rate" means the rate utilized in the
15    previous year to extend property taxes for all purposes,
16    except Bond and Interest, Summer School, Rent, Capital
17    Improvement, and Vocational Education Building purposes.
18    For Hybrid Districts, the Operating Tax Rate shall be the
19    combined elementary and high school rates utilized in the
20    previous year to extend property taxes for all purposes,
21    except Bond and Interest, Summer School, Rent, Capital
22    Improvement, and Vocational Education Building purposes.
23        "Organizational Unit" means a Laboratory School or any
24    public school district that is recognized as such by the
25    State Board and that contains elementary schools typically
26    serving kindergarten through 5th grades, middle schools

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 321 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    typically serving 6th through 8th grades, high schools
2    typically serving 9th through 12th grades, a program
3    established under Section 2-3.66 or 2-3.41, or a program
4    operated by a regional office of education or an
5    intermediate service center under Article 13A or 13B. The
6    General Assembly acknowledges that the actual grade levels
7    served by a particular Organizational Unit may vary
8    slightly from what is typical.
9        "Organizational Unit CWI" is determined by calculating
10    the CWI in the region and original county in which an
11    Organizational Unit's primary administrative office is
12    located as set forth in this paragraph, provided that if
13    the Organizational Unit CWI as calculated in accordance
14    with this paragraph is less than 0.9, the Organizational
15    Unit CWI shall be increased to 0.9. Each county's current
16    CWI value shall be adjusted based on the CWI value of that
17    county's neighboring Illinois counties, to create a
18    "weighted adjusted index value". This shall be calculated
19    by summing the CWI values of all of a county's adjacent
20    Illinois counties and dividing by the number of adjacent
21    Illinois counties, then taking the weighted value of the
22    original county's CWI value and the adjacent Illinois
23    county average. To calculate this weighted value, if the
24    number of adjacent Illinois counties is greater than 2, the
25    original county's CWI value will be weighted at 0.25 and
26    the adjacent Illinois county average will be weighted at

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 322 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    0.75. If the number of adjacent Illinois counties is 2, the
2    original county's CWI value will be weighted at 0.33 and
3    the adjacent Illinois county average will be weighted at
4    0.66. The greater of the county's current CWI value and its
5    weighted adjusted index value shall be used as the
6    Organizational Unit CWI.
7        "Preceding Tax Year" means the property tax levy year
8    immediately preceding the Base Tax Year.
9        "Preceding Tax Year's Extension" means the product of
10    the equalized assessed valuation utilized by the county
11    clerk in the Preceding Tax Year multiplied by the Operating
12    Tax Rate.
13        "Preliminary Percent of Adequacy" is defined in
14    paragraph (2) of subsection (f) of this Section.
15        "Preliminary Resources" is defined in paragraph (2) of
16    subsection (f) of this Section.
17        "Principal" means a school administrator duly endorsed
18    to be employed as a principal in this State.
19        "Professional development" means training programs for
20    licensed staff in schools, including, but not limited to,
21    programs that assist in implementing new curriculum
22    programs, provide data focused or academic assessment data
23    training to help staff identify a student's weaknesses and
24    strengths, target interventions, improve instruction,
25    encompass instructional strategies for English learner,
26    gifted, or at-risk students, address inclusivity, cultural

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 323 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    sensitivity, or implicit bias, or otherwise provide
2    professional support for licensed staff.
3        "Prototypical" means 450 special education
4    pre-kindergarten and kindergarten through grade 5 students
5    for an elementary school, 450 grade 6 through 8 students
6    for a middle school, and 600 grade 9 through 12 students
7    for a high school.
8        "PTELL" means the Property Tax Extension Limitation
9    Law.
10        "PTELL EAV" is defined in paragraph (4) of subsection
11    (d) of this Section.
12        "Pupil support staff" means a nurse, psychologist,
13    social worker, family liaison personnel, or other staff
14    member who provides support to at-risk or struggling
15    students.
16        "Real Receipts" is defined in paragraph (1) of
17    subsection (d) of this Section.
18        "Regionalization Factor" means, for a particular
19    Organizational Unit, the figure derived by dividing the
20    Organizational Unit CWI by the Statewide Weighted CWI.
21        "School site staff" means the primary school secretary
22    and any additional clerical personnel assigned to a school.
23        "Special education" means special educational
24    facilities and services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of
25    this Code.
26        "Special Education Allocation" means the amount of an

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 324 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target attributable
2    to special education divided by the Organizational Unit's
3    final Adequacy Target, the product of which shall be
4    multiplied by the amount of new funding received pursuant
5    to this Section. An Organizational Unit's final Adequacy
6    Target attributable to special education shall include all
7    special education investment adequacy elements.
8        "Specialist teacher" means a teacher who provides
9    instruction in subject areas not included in core subjects,
10    including, but not limited to, art, music, physical
11    education, health, driver education, career-technical
12    education, and such other subject areas as may be mandated
13    by State law or provided by an Organizational Unit.
14        "Specially Funded Unit" means an Alternative School,
15    safe school, Department of Juvenile Justice school,
16    special education cooperative or entity recognized by the
17    State Board as a special education cooperative,
18    State-approved charter school, or alternative learning
19    opportunities program that received direct funding from
20    the State Board during the 2016-2017 school year through
21    any of the funding sources included within the calculation
22    of the Base Funding Minimum or Glenwood Academy.
23        "Supplemental Grant Funding" means supplemental
24    general State aid funding received by an Organizational
25    Unit during the 2016-2017 school year pursuant to
26    subsection (H) of Section 18-8.05 of this Code (now

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 325 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    repealed).
2        "State Adequacy Level" is the sum of the Adequacy
3    Targets of all Organizational Units.
4        "State Board" means the State Board of Education.
5        "State Superintendent" means the State Superintendent
6    of Education.
7        "Statewide Weighted CWI" means a figure determined by
8    multiplying each Organizational Unit CWI times the ASE for
9    that Organizational Unit creating a weighted value,
10    summing all Organizational Units' weighted values, and
11    dividing by the total ASE of all Organizational Units,
12    thereby creating an average weighted index.
13        "Student activities" means non-credit producing
14    after-school programs, including, but not limited to,
15    clubs, bands, sports, and other activities authorized by
16    the school board of the Organizational Unit.
17        "Substitute teacher" means an individual teacher or
18    teaching assistant who is employed by an Organizational
19    Unit and is temporarily serving the Organizational Unit on
20    a per diem or per period-assignment basis to replace
21    another staff member.
22        "Summer school" means academic and enrichment programs
23    provided to students during the summer months outside of
24    the regular school year.
25        "Supervisory aide" means a non-licensed staff member
26    who helps in supervising students of an Organizational

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 326 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Unit, but does so outside of the classroom, in situations
2    such as, but not limited to, monitoring hallways and
3    playgrounds, supervising lunchrooms, or supervising
4    students when being transported in buses serving the
5    Organizational Unit.
6        "Target Ratio" is defined in paragraph (4) of
7    subsection (g).
8        "Tier 1", "Tier 2", "Tier 3", and "Tier 4" are defined
9    in paragraph (3) of subsection (g).
10        "Tier 1 Aggregate Funding", "Tier 2 Aggregate
11    Funding", "Tier 3 Aggregate Funding", and "Tier 4 Aggregate
12    Funding" are defined in paragraph (1) of subsection (g).
13    (b) Adequacy Target calculation.
14        (1) Each Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target is the
15    sum of the Organizational Unit's cost of providing
16    Essential Elements, as calculated in accordance with this
17    subsection (b), with the salary amounts in the Essential
18    Elements multiplied by a Regionalization Factor calculated
19    pursuant to paragraph (3) of this subsection (b).
20        (2) The Essential Elements are attributable on a pro
21    rata basis related to defined subgroups of the ASE of each
22    Organizational Unit as specified in this paragraph (2),
23    with investments and FTE positions pro rata funded based on
24    ASE counts in excess of or less than the thresholds set
25    forth in this paragraph (2). The method for calculating
26    attributable pro rata costs and the defined subgroups

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 327 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    thereto are as follows:
2            (A) Core class size investments. Each
3        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding required
4        to support that number of FTE core teacher positions as
5        is needed to keep the respective class sizes of the
6        Organizational Unit to the following maximum numbers:
7                (i) For grades kindergarten through 3, the
8            Organizational Unit shall receive funding required
9            to support one FTE core teacher position for every
10            15 Low-Income Count students in those grades and
11            one FTE core teacher position for every 20
12            non-Low-Income Count students in those grades.
13                (ii) For grades 4 through 12, the
14            Organizational Unit shall receive funding required
15            to support one FTE core teacher position for every
16            20 Low-Income Count students in those grades and
17            one FTE core teacher position for every 25
18            non-Low-Income Count students in those grades.
19            The number of non-Low-Income Count students in a
20        grade shall be determined by subtracting the
21        Low-Income students in that grade from the ASE of the
22        Organizational Unit for that grade.
23            (B) Specialist teacher investments. Each
24        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
25        to cover that number of FTE specialist teacher
26        positions that correspond to the following

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 328 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        percentages:
2                (i) if the Organizational Unit operates an
3            elementary or middle school, then 20.00% of the
4            number of the Organizational Unit's core teachers,
5            as determined under subparagraph (A) of this
6            paragraph (2); and
7                (ii) if such Organizational Unit operates a
8            high school, then 33.33% of the number of the
9            Organizational Unit's core teachers.
10            (C) Instructional facilitator investments. Each
11        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
12        to cover one FTE instructional facilitator position
13        for every 200 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten
14        children with disabilities and all kindergarten
15        through grade 12 students of the Organizational Unit.
16            (D) Core intervention teacher (tutor) investments.
17        Each Organizational Unit shall receive the funding
18        needed to cover one FTE teacher position for each
19        prototypical elementary, middle, and high school.
20            (E) Substitute teacher investments. Each
21        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
22        to cover substitute teacher costs that is equal to
23        5.70% of the minimum pupil attendance days required
24        under Section 10-19 of this Code for all full-time
25        equivalent core, specialist, and intervention
26        teachers, school nurses, special education teachers

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 329 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        and instructional assistants, instructional
2        facilitators, and summer school and extended day
3        teacher positions, as determined under this paragraph
4        (2), at a salary rate of 33.33% of the average salary
5        for grade K through 12 teachers and 33.33% of the
6        average salary of each instructional assistant
7        position.
8            (F) Core guidance counselor investments. Each
9        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
10        to cover one FTE guidance counselor for each 450
11        combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
12        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 5
13        students, plus one FTE guidance counselor for each 250
14        grades 6 through 8 ASE middle school students, plus one
15        FTE guidance counselor for each 250 grades 9 through 12
16        ASE high school students.
17            (G) Nurse investments. Each Organizational Unit
18        shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE nurse
19        for each 750 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children
20        with disabilities and all kindergarten through grade
21        12 students across all grade levels it serves.
22            (H) Supervisory aide investments. Each
23        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
24        to cover one FTE for each 225 combined ASE of
25        pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all
26        kindergarten through grade 5 students, plus one FTE for

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 330 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        each 225 ASE middle school students, plus one FTE for
2        each 200 ASE high school students.
3            (I) Librarian investments. Each Organizational
4        Unit shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE
5        librarian for each prototypical elementary school,
6        middle school, and high school and one FTE aide or
7        media technician for every 300 combined ASE of
8        pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all
9        kindergarten through grade 12 students.
10            (J) Principal investments. Each Organizational
11        Unit shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE
12        principal position for each prototypical elementary
13        school, plus one FTE principal position for each
14        prototypical middle school, plus one FTE principal
15        position for each prototypical high school.
16            (K) Assistant principal investments. Each
17        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
18        to cover one FTE assistant principal position for each
19        prototypical elementary school, plus one FTE assistant
20        principal position for each prototypical middle
21        school, plus one FTE assistant principal position for
22        each prototypical high school.
23            (L) School site staff investments. Each
24        Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed
25        for one FTE position for each 225 ASE of
26        pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 331 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        kindergarten through grade 5 students, plus one FTE
2        position for each 225 ASE middle school students, plus
3        one FTE position for each 200 ASE high school students.
4            (M) Gifted investments. Each Organizational Unit
5        shall receive $40 per kindergarten through grade 12
6        ASE.
7            (N) Professional development investments. Each
8        Organizational Unit shall receive $125 per student of
9        the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
10        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
11        students for trainers and other professional
12        development-related expenses for supplies and
13        materials.
14            (O) Instructional material investments. Each
15        Organizational Unit shall receive $190 per student of
16        the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
17        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
18        students to cover instructional material costs.
19            (P) Assessment investments. Each Organizational
20        Unit shall receive $25 per student of the combined ASE
21        of pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all
22        kindergarten through grade 12 students to cover
23        assessment costs.
24            (Q) Computer technology and equipment investments.
25        Each Organizational Unit shall receive $285.50 per
26        student of the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 332 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        children with disabilities and all kindergarten
2        through grade 12 students to cover computer technology
3        and equipment costs. For the 2018-2019 school year and
4        subsequent school years, Organizational Units assigned
5        to Tier 1 and Tier 2 in the prior school year shall
6        receive an additional $285.50 per student of the
7        combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
8        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
9        students to cover computer technology and equipment
10        costs in the Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target.
11        The State Board may establish additional requirements
12        for Organizational Unit expenditures of funds received
13        pursuant to this subparagraph (Q), including a
14        requirement that funds received pursuant to this
15        subparagraph (Q) may be used only for serving the
16        technology needs of the district. It is the intent of
17        Public Act 100-465 that all Tier 1 and Tier 2 districts
18        receive the addition to their Adequacy Target in the
19        following year, subject to compliance with the
20        requirements of the State Board.
21            (R) Student activities investments. Each
22        Organizational Unit shall receive the following
23        funding amounts to cover student activities: $100 per
24        kindergarten through grade 5 ASE student in elementary
25        school, plus $200 per ASE student in middle school,
26        plus $675 per ASE student in high school.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 333 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (S) Maintenance and operations investments. Each
2        Organizational Unit shall receive $1,038 per student
3        of the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
4        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
5        students for day-to-day maintenance and operations
6        expenditures, including salary, supplies, and
7        materials, as well as purchased services, but
8        excluding employee benefits. The proportion of salary
9        for the application of a Regionalization Factor and the
10        calculation of benefits is equal to $352.92.
11            (T) Central office investments. Each
12        Organizational Unit shall receive $742 per student of
13        the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
14        disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
15        students to cover central office operations, including
16        administrators and classified personnel charged with
17        managing the instructional programs, business and
18        operations of the school district, and security
19        personnel. The proportion of salary for the
20        application of a Regionalization Factor and the
21        calculation of benefits is equal to $368.48.
22            (U) Employee benefit investments. Each
23        Organizational Unit shall receive 30% of the total of
24        all salary-calculated elements of the Adequacy Target,
25        excluding substitute teachers and student activities
26        investments, to cover benefit costs. For central

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 334 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        office and maintenance and operations investments, the
2        benefit calculation shall be based upon the salary
3        proportion of each investment. If at any time the
4        responsibility for funding the employer normal cost of
5        teacher pensions is assigned to school districts, then
6        that amount certified by the Teachers' Retirement
7        System of the State of Illinois to be paid by the
8        Organizational Unit for the preceding school year
9        shall be added to the benefit investment. For any
10        fiscal year in which a school district organized under
11        Article 34 of this Code is responsible for paying the
12        employer normal cost of teacher pensions, then that
13        amount of its employer normal cost plus the amount for
14        retiree health insurance as certified by the Public
15        School Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of
16        Chicago to be paid by the school district for the
17        preceding school year that is statutorily required to
18        cover employer normal costs and the amount for retiree
19        health insurance shall be added to the 30% specified in
20        this subparagraph (U). The Teachers' Retirement System
21        of the State of Illinois and the Public School
22        Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of Chicago shall
23        submit such information as the State Superintendent
24        may require for the calculations set forth in this
25        subparagraph (U).
26            (V) Additional investments in low-income students.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 335 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        In addition to and not in lieu of all other funding
2        under this paragraph (2), each Organizational Unit
3        shall receive funding based on the average teacher
4        salary for grades K through 12 to cover the costs of:
5                (i) one FTE intervention teacher (tutor)
6            position for every 125 Low-Income Count students;
7                (ii) one FTE pupil support staff position for
8            every 125 Low-Income Count students;
9                (iii) one FTE extended day teacher position
10            for every 120 Low-Income Count students; and
11                (iv) one FTE summer school teacher position
12            for every 120 Low-Income Count students.
13            (W) Additional investments in English learner
14        students. In addition to and not in lieu of all other
15        funding under this paragraph (2), each Organizational
16        Unit shall receive funding based on the average teacher
17        salary for grades K through 12 to cover the costs of:
18                (i) one FTE intervention teacher (tutor)
19            position for every 125 English learner students;
20                (ii) one FTE pupil support staff position for
21            every 125 English learner students;
22                (iii) one FTE extended day teacher position
23            for every 120 English learner students;
24                (iv) one FTE summer school teacher position
25            for every 120 English learner students; and
26                (v) one FTE core teacher position for every 100

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 336 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            English learner students.
2            (X) Special education investments. Each
3        Organizational Unit shall receive funding based on the
4        average teacher salary for grades K through 12 to cover
5        special education as follows:
6                (i) one FTE teacher position for every 141
7            combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
8            disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
9            students;
10                (ii) one FTE instructional assistant for every
11            141 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with
12            disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12
13            students; and
14                (iii) one FTE psychologist position for every
15            1,000 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children
16            with disabilities and all kindergarten through
17            grade 12 students.
18        (3) For calculating the salaries included within the
19    Essential Elements, the State Superintendent shall
20    annually calculate average salaries to the nearest dollar
21    using the employment information system data maintained by
22    the State Board, limited to public schools only and
23    excluding special education and vocational cooperatives,
24    schools operated by the Department of Juvenile Justice, and
25    charter schools, for the following positions:
26            (A) Teacher for grades K through 8.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 337 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (B) Teacher for grades 9 through 12.
2            (C) Teacher for grades K through 12.
3            (D) Guidance counselor for grades K through 8.
4            (E) Guidance counselor for grades 9 through 12.
5            (F) Guidance counselor for grades K through 12.
6            (G) Social worker.
7            (H) Psychologist.
8            (I) Librarian.
9            (J) Nurse.
10            (K) Principal.
11            (L) Assistant principal.
12        For the purposes of this paragraph (3), "teacher"
13    includes core teachers, specialist and elective teachers,
14    instructional facilitators, tutors, special education
15    teachers, pupil support staff teachers, English learner
16    teachers, extended day teachers, and summer school
17    teachers. Where specific grade data is not required for the
18    Essential Elements, the average salary for corresponding
19    positions shall apply. For substitute teachers, the
20    average teacher salary for grades K through 12 shall apply.
21        For calculating the salaries included within the
22    Essential Elements for positions not included within EIS
23    Data, the following salaries shall be used in the first
24    year of implementation of Evidence-Based Funding:
25            (i) school site staff, $30,000; and
26            (ii) non-instructional assistant, instructional

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 338 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        assistant, library aide, library media tech, or
2        supervisory aide: $25,000.
3        In the second and subsequent years of implementation of
4    Evidence-Based Funding, the amounts in items (i) and (ii)
5    of this paragraph (3) shall annually increase by the ECI.
6        The salary amounts for the Essential Elements
7    determined pursuant to subparagraphs (A) through (L), (S)
8    and (T), and (V) through (X) of paragraph (2) of subsection
9    (b) of this Section shall be multiplied by a
10    Regionalization Factor.
11    (c) Local Capacity calculation.
12        (1) Each Organizational Unit's Local Capacity
13    represents an amount of funding it is assumed to contribute
14    toward its Adequacy Target for purposes of the
15    Evidence-Based Funding formula calculation. "Local
16    Capacity" means either (i) the Organizational Unit's Local
17    Capacity Target as calculated in accordance with paragraph
18    (2) of this subsection (c) if its Real Receipts are equal
19    to or less than its Local Capacity Target or (ii) the
20    Organizational Unit's Adjusted Local Capacity, as
21    calculated in accordance with paragraph (3) of this
22    subsection (c) if Real Receipts are more than its Local
23    Capacity Target.
24        (2) "Local Capacity Target" means, for an
25    Organizational Unit, that dollar amount that is obtained by
26    multiplying its Adequacy Target by its Local Capacity

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 339 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Ratio.
2            (A) An Organizational Unit's Local Capacity
3        Percentage is the conversion of the Organizational
4        Unit's Local Capacity Ratio, as such ratio is
5        determined in accordance with subparagraph (B) of this
6        paragraph (2), into a cumulative distribution
7        resulting in a percentile ranking to determine each
8        Organizational Unit's relative position to all other
9        Organizational Units in this State. The calculation of
10        Local Capacity Percentage is described in subparagraph
11        (C) of this paragraph (2).
12            (B) An Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio
13        in a given year is the percentage obtained by dividing
14        its Adjusted EAV or PTELL EAV, whichever is less, by
15        its Adequacy Target, with the resulting ratio further
16        adjusted as follows:
17                (i) for Organizational Units serving grades
18            kindergarten through 12 and Hybrid Districts, no
19            further adjustments shall be made;
20                (ii) for Organizational Units serving grades
21            kindergarten through 8, the ratio shall be
22            multiplied by 9/13;
23                (iii) for Organizational Units serving grades
24            9 through 12, the Local Capacity Ratio shall be
25            multiplied by 4/13; and
26                (iv) for an Organizational Unit with a

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 340 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            different grade configuration than those specified
2            in items (i) through (iii) of this subparagraph
3            (B), the State Superintendent shall determine a
4            comparable adjustment based on the grades served.
5            (C) The Local Capacity Percentage is equal to the
6        percentile ranking of the district. Local Capacity
7        Percentage converts each Organizational Unit's Local
8        Capacity Ratio to a cumulative distribution resulting
9        in a percentile ranking to determine each
10        Organizational Unit's relative position to all other
11        Organizational Units in this State. The Local Capacity
12        Percentage cumulative distribution resulting in a
13        percentile ranking for each Organizational Unit shall
14        be calculated using the standard normal distribution
15        of the score in relation to the weighted mean and
16        weighted standard deviation and Local Capacity Ratios
17        of all Organizational Units. If the value assigned to
18        any Organizational Unit is in excess of 90%, the value
19        shall be adjusted to 90%. For Laboratory Schools, the
20        Local Capacity Percentage shall be set at 10% in
21        recognition of the absence of EAV and resources from
22        the public university that are allocated to the
23        Laboratory School. For programs operated by a regional
24        office of education or an intermediate service center,
25        the Local Capacity Percentage must be set at 10% in
26        recognition of the absence of EAV and resources from

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 341 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        school districts that are allocated to the regional
2        office of education or intermediate service center.
3        The weighted mean for the Local Capacity Percentage
4        shall be determined by multiplying each Organizational
5        Unit's Local Capacity Ratio times the ASE for the unit
6        creating a weighted value, summing the weighted values
7        of all Organizational Units, and dividing by the total
8        ASE of all Organizational Units. The weighted standard
9        deviation shall be determined by taking the square root
10        of the weighted variance of all Organizational Units'
11        Local Capacity Ratio, where the variance is calculated
12        by squaring the difference between each unit's Local
13        Capacity Ratio and the weighted mean, then multiplying
14        the variance for each unit times the ASE for the unit
15        to create a weighted variance for each unit, then
16        summing all units' weighted variance and dividing by
17        the total ASE of all units.
18            (D) For any Organizational Unit, the
19        Organizational Unit's Adjusted Local Capacity Target
20        shall be reduced by either (i) the school board's
21        remaining contribution pursuant to paragraph (ii) of
22        subsection (b-4) of Section 16-158 of the Illinois
23        Pension Code in a given year or (ii) the board of
24        education's remaining contribution pursuant to
25        paragraph (iv) of subsection (b) of Section 17-129 of
26        the Illinois Pension Code absent the employer normal

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 342 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        cost portion of the required contribution and amount
2        allowed pursuant to subdivision (3) of Section
3        17-142.1 of the Illinois Pension Code in a given year.
4        In the preceding sentence, item (i) shall be certified
5        to the State Board of Education by the Teachers'
6        Retirement System of the State of Illinois and item
7        (ii) shall be certified to the State Board of Education
8        by the Public School Teachers' Pension and Retirement
9        Fund of the City of Chicago.
10        (3) If an Organizational Unit's Real Receipts are more
11    than its Local Capacity Target, then its Local Capacity
12    shall equal an Adjusted Local Capacity Target as calculated
13    in accordance with this paragraph (3). The Adjusted Local
14    Capacity Target is calculated as the sum of the
15    Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Target and its Real
16    Receipts Adjustment. The Real Receipts Adjustment equals
17    the Organizational Unit's Real Receipts less its Local
18    Capacity Target, with the resulting figure multiplied by
19    the Local Capacity Percentage.
20        As used in this paragraph (3), "Real Percent of
21    Adequacy" means the sum of an Organizational Unit's Real
22    Receipts, CPPRT, and Base Funding Minimum, with the
23    resulting figure divided by the Organizational Unit's
24    Adequacy Target.
25    (d) Calculation of Real Receipts, EAV, and Adjusted EAV for
26purposes of the Local Capacity calculation.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 343 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (1) An Organizational Unit's Real Receipts are the
2    product of its Applicable Tax Rate and its Adjusted EAV. An
3    Organizational Unit's Applicable Tax Rate is its Adjusted
4    Operating Tax Rate for property within the Organizational
5    Unit.
6        (2) The State Superintendent shall calculate the
7    equalized assessed valuation, or EAV, of all taxable
8    property of each Organizational Unit as of September 30 of
9    the previous year in accordance with paragraph (3) of this
10    subsection (d). The State Superintendent shall then
11    determine the Adjusted EAV of each Organizational Unit in
12    accordance with paragraph (4) of this subsection (d), which
13    Adjusted EAV figure shall be used for the purposes of
14    calculating Local Capacity.
15        (3) To calculate Real Receipts and EAV, the Department
16    of Revenue shall supply to the State Superintendent the
17    value as equalized or assessed by the Department of Revenue
18    of all taxable property of every Organizational Unit,
19    together with (i) the applicable tax rate used in extending
20    taxes for the funds of the Organizational Unit as of
21    September 30 of the previous year and (ii) the limiting
22    rate for all Organizational Units subject to property tax
23    extension limitations as imposed under PTELL.
24            (A) The Department of Revenue shall add to the
25        equalized assessed value of all taxable property of
26        each Organizational Unit situated entirely or

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 344 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        partially within a county that is or was subject to the
2        provisions of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property
3        Tax Code (i) an amount equal to the total amount by
4        which the homestead exemption allowed under Section
5        15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code for real
6        property situated in that Organizational Unit exceeds
7        the total amount that would have been allowed in that
8        Organizational Unit if the maximum reduction under
9        Section 15-176 was (I) $4,500 in Cook County or $3,500
10        in all other counties in tax year 2003 or (II) $5,000
11        in all counties in tax year 2004 and thereafter and
12        (ii) an amount equal to the aggregate amount for the
13        taxable year of all additional exemptions under
14        Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code for owners with
15        a household income of $30,000 or less. The county clerk
16        of any county that is or was subject to the provisions
17        of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code
18        shall annually calculate and certify to the Department
19        of Revenue for each Organizational Unit all homestead
20        exemption amounts under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the
21        Property Tax Code and all amounts of additional
22        exemptions under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax
23        Code for owners with a household income of $30,000 or
24        less. It is the intent of this subparagraph (A) that if
25        the general homestead exemption for a parcel of
26        property is determined under Section 15-176 or 15-177

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 345 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        of the Property Tax Code rather than Section 15-175,
2        then the calculation of EAV shall not be affected by
3        the difference, if any, between the amount of the
4        general homestead exemption allowed for that parcel of
5        property under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property
6        Tax Code and the amount that would have been allowed
7        had the general homestead exemption for that parcel of
8        property been determined under Section 15-175 of the
9        Property Tax Code. It is further the intent of this
10        subparagraph (A) that if additional exemptions are
11        allowed under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code
12        for owners with a household income of less than
13        $30,000, then the calculation of EAV shall not be
14        affected by the difference, if any, because of those
15        additional exemptions.
16            (B) With respect to any part of an Organizational
17        Unit within a redevelopment project area in respect to
18        which a municipality has adopted tax increment
19        allocation financing pursuant to the Tax Increment
20        Allocation Redevelopment Act, Division 74.4 of Article
21        11 of the Illinois Municipal Code, or the Industrial
22        Jobs Recovery Law, Division 74.6 of Article 11 of the
23        Illinois Municipal Code, no part of the current EAV of
24        real property located in any such project area that is
25        attributable to an increase above the total initial EAV
26        of such property shall be used as part of the EAV of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 346 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        the Organizational Unit, until such time as all
2        redevelopment project costs have been paid, as
3        provided in Section 11-74.4-8 of the Tax Increment
4        Allocation Redevelopment Act or in Section 11-74.6-35
5        of the Industrial Jobs Recovery Law. For the purpose of
6        the EAV of the Organizational Unit, the total initial
7        EAV or the current EAV, whichever is lower, shall be
8        used until such time as all redevelopment project costs
9        have been paid.
10            (B-5) The real property equalized assessed
11        valuation for a school district shall be adjusted by
12        subtracting from the real property value, as equalized
13        or assessed by the Department of Revenue, for the
14        district an amount computed by dividing the amount of
15        any abatement of taxes under Section 18-170 of the
16        Property Tax Code by 3.00% for a district maintaining
17        grades kindergarten through 12, by 2.30% for a district
18        maintaining grades kindergarten through 8, or by 1.05%
19        for a district maintaining grades 9 through 12 and
20        adjusted by an amount computed by dividing the amount
21        of any abatement of taxes under subsection (a) of
22        Section 18-165 of the Property Tax Code by the same
23        percentage rates for district type as specified in this
24        subparagraph (B-5).
25            (C) For Organizational Units that are Hybrid
26        Districts, the State Superintendent shall use the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 347 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        lesser of the adjusted equalized assessed valuation
2        for property within the partial elementary unit
3        district for elementary purposes, as defined in
4        Article 11E of this Code, or the adjusted equalized
5        assessed valuation for property within the partial
6        elementary unit district for high school purposes, as
7        defined in Article 11E of this Code.
8        (4) An Organizational Unit's Adjusted EAV shall be the
9    average of its EAV over the immediately preceding 3 years
10    or its EAV in the immediately preceding year if the EAV in
11    the immediately preceding year has declined by 10% or more
12    compared to the 3-year average. In the event of
13    Organizational Unit reorganization, consolidation, or
14    annexation, the Organizational Unit's Adjusted EAV for the
15    first 3 years after such change shall be as follows: the
16    most current EAV shall be used in the first year, the
17    average of a 2-year EAV or its EAV in the immediately
18    preceding year if the EAV declines by 10% or more compared
19    to the 2-year average for the second year, and a 3-year
20    average EAV or its EAV in the immediately preceding year if
21    the Adjusted EAV declines by 10% or more compared to the
22    3-year average for the third year. For any school district
23    whose EAV in the immediately preceding year is used in
24    calculations, in the following year, the Adjusted EAV shall
25    be the average of its EAV over the immediately preceding 2
26    years or the immediately preceding year if that year

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 348 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    represents a decline of 10% or more compared to the 2-year
2    average.
3        "PTELL EAV" means a figure calculated by the State
4    Board for Organizational Units subject to PTELL as
5    described in this paragraph (4) for the purposes of
6    calculating an Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio.
7    Except as otherwise provided in this paragraph (4), the
8    PTELL EAV of an Organizational Unit shall be equal to the
9    product of the equalized assessed valuation last used in
10    the calculation of general State aid under Section 18-8.05
11    of this Code (now repealed) or Evidence-Based Funding under
12    this Section and the Organizational Unit's Extension
13    Limitation Ratio. If an Organizational Unit has approved or
14    does approve an increase in its limiting rate, pursuant to
15    Section 18-190 of the Property Tax Code, affecting the Base
16    Tax Year, the PTELL EAV shall be equal to the product of
17    the equalized assessed valuation last used in the
18    calculation of general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of
19    this Code (now repealed) or Evidence-Based Funding under
20    this Section multiplied by an amount equal to one plus the
21    percentage increase, if any, in the Consumer Price Index
22    for All Urban Consumers for all items published by the
23    United States Department of Labor for the 12-month calendar
24    year preceding the Base Tax Year, plus the equalized
25    assessed valuation of new property, annexed property, and
26    recovered tax increment value and minus the equalized

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 349 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    assessed valuation of disconnected property.
2        As used in this paragraph (4), "new property" and
3    "recovered tax increment value" shall have the meanings set
4    forth in the Property Tax Extension Limitation Law.
5    (e) Base Funding Minimum calculation.
6        (1) For the 2017-2018 school year, the Base Funding
7    Minimum of an Organizational Unit or a Specially Funded
8    Unit shall be the amount of State funds distributed to the
9    Organizational Unit or Specially Funded Unit during the
10    2016-2017 school year prior to any adjustments and
11    specified appropriation amounts described in this
12    paragraph (1) from the following Sections, as calculated by
13    the State Superintendent: Section 18-8.05 of this Code (now
14    repealed); Section 5 of Article 224 of Public Act 99-524
15    (equity grants); Section 14-7.02b of this Code (funding for
16    children requiring special education services); Section
17    14-13.01 of this Code (special education facilities and
18    staffing), except for reimbursement of the cost of
19    transportation pursuant to Section 14-13.01; Section
20    14C-12 of this Code (English learners); and Section 18-4.3
21    of this Code (summer school), based on an appropriation
22    level of $13,121,600. For a school district organized under
23    Article 34 of this Code, the Base Funding Minimum also
24    includes (i) the funds allocated to the school district
25    pursuant to Section 1D-1 of this Code attributable to
26    funding programs authorized by the Sections of this Code

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 350 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    listed in the preceding sentence and (ii) the difference
2    between (I) the funds allocated to the school district
3    pursuant to Section 1D-1 of this Code attributable to the
4    funding programs authorized by Section 14-7.02 (non-public
5    special education reimbursement), subsection (b) of
6    Section 14-13.01 (special education transportation),
7    Section 29-5 (transportation), Section 2-3.80
8    (agricultural education), Section 2-3.66 (truants'
9    alternative education), Section 2-3.62 (educational
10    service centers), and Section 14-7.03 (special education -
11    orphanage) of this Code and Section 15 of the Childhood
12    Hunger Relief Act (free breakfast program) and (II) the
13    school district's actual expenditures for its non-public
14    special education, special education transportation,
15    transportation programs, agricultural education, truants'
16    alternative education, services that would otherwise be
17    performed by a regional office of education, special
18    education orphanage expenditures, and free breakfast, as
19    most recently calculated and reported pursuant to
20    subsection (f) of Section 1D-1 of this Code. The Base
21    Funding Minimum for Glenwood Academy shall be $625,500. For
22    programs operated by a regional office of education or an
23    intermediate service center, the Base Funding Minimum must
24    be the total amount of State funds allocated to those
25    programs in the 2018-2019 school year and amounts provided
26    pursuant to Article 34 of Public Act 100-586 and Section

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 351 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    3-16 of this Code. All programs established after June 5,
2    2019 (the effective date of Public Act 101-10) and
3    administered by a regional office of education or an
4    intermediate service center must have an initial Base
5    Funding Minimum set to an amount equal to the first-year
6    ASE multiplied by the amount of per pupil funding received
7    in the previous school year by the lowest funded similar
8    existing program type. If the enrollment for a program
9    operated by a regional office of education or an
10    intermediate service center is zero, then it may not
11    receive Base Funding Minimum funds for that program in the
12    next fiscal year, and those funds must be distributed to
13    Organizational Units under subsection (g).
14        (2) For the 2018-2019 and subsequent school years, the
15    Base Funding Minimum of Organizational Units and Specially
16    Funded Units shall be the sum of (i) the amount of
17    Evidence-Based Funding for the prior school year, (ii) the
18    Base Funding Minimum for the prior school year, and (iii)
19    any amount received by a school district pursuant to
20    Section 7 of Article 97 of Public Act 100-21.
21        (3) Subject to approval by the General Assembly as
22    provided in this paragraph (3), an Organizational Unit that
23    meets all of the following criteria, as determined by the
24    State Board, shall have District Intervention Money added
25    to its Base Funding Minimum at the time the Base Funding
26    Minimum is calculated by the State Board:

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 352 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (A) The Organizational Unit is operating under an
2        Independent Authority under Section 2-3.25f-5 of this
3        Code for a minimum of 4 school years or is subject to
4        the control of the State Board pursuant to a court
5        order for a minimum of 4 school years.
6            (B) The Organizational Unit was designated as a
7        Tier 1 or Tier 2 Organizational Unit in the previous
8        school year under paragraph (3) of subsection (g) of
9        this Section.
10            (C) The Organizational Unit demonstrates
11        sustainability through a 5-year financial and
12        strategic plan.
13            (D) The Organizational Unit has made sufficient
14        progress and achieved sufficient stability in the
15        areas of governance, academic growth, and finances.
16        As part of its determination under this paragraph (3),
17    the State Board may consider the Organizational Unit's
18    summative designation, any accreditations of the
19    Organizational Unit, or the Organizational Unit's
20    financial profile, as calculated by the State Board.
21        If the State Board determines that an Organizational
22    Unit has met the criteria set forth in this paragraph (3),
23    it must submit a report to the General Assembly, no later
24    than January 2 of the fiscal year in which the State Board
25    makes it determination, on the amount of District
26    Intervention Money to add to the Organizational Unit's Base

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 353 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Funding Minimum. The General Assembly must review the State
2    Board's report and may approve or disapprove, by joint
3    resolution, the addition of District Intervention Money.
4    If the General Assembly fails to act on the report within
5    40 calendar days from the receipt of the report, the
6    addition of District Intervention Money is deemed
7    approved. If the General Assembly approves the amount of
8    District Intervention Money to be added to the
9    Organizational Unit's Base Funding Minimum, the District
10    Intervention Money must be added to the Base Funding
11    Minimum annually thereafter.
12        For the first 4 years following the initial year that
13    the State Board determines that an Organizational Unit has
14    met the criteria set forth in this paragraph (3) and has
15    received funding under this Section, the Organizational
16    Unit must annually submit to the State Board, on or before
17    November 30, a progress report regarding its financial and
18    strategic plan under subparagraph (C) of this paragraph
19    (3). The plan shall include the financial data from the
20    past 4 annual financial reports or financial audits that
21    must be presented to the State Board by November 15 of each
22    year and the approved budget financial data for the current
23    year. The plan shall be developed according to the
24    guidelines presented to the Organizational Unit by the
25    State Board. The plan shall further include financial
26    projections for the next 3 fiscal years and include a

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 354 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    discussion and financial summary of the Organizational
2    Unit's facility needs. If the Organizational Unit does not
3    demonstrate sufficient progress toward its 5-year plan or
4    if it has failed to file an annual financial report, an
5    annual budget, a financial plan, a deficit reduction plan,
6    or other financial information as required by law, the
7    State Board may establish a Financial Oversight Panel under
8    Article 1H of this Code. However, if the Organizational
9    Unit already has a Financial Oversight Panel, the State
10    Board may extend the duration of the Panel.
11    (f) Percent of Adequacy and Final Resources calculation.
12        (1) The Evidence-Based Funding formula establishes a
13    Percent of Adequacy for each Organizational Unit in order
14    to place such units into tiers for the purposes of the
15    funding distribution system described in subsection (g) of
16    this Section. Initially, an Organizational Unit's
17    Preliminary Resources and Preliminary Percent of Adequacy
18    are calculated pursuant to paragraph (2) of this subsection
19    (f). Then, an Organizational Unit's Final Resources and
20    Final Percent of Adequacy are calculated to account for the
21    Organizational Unit's poverty concentration levels
22    pursuant to paragraphs (3) and (4) of this subsection (f).
23        (2) An Organizational Unit's Preliminary Resources are
24    equal to the sum of its Local Capacity Target, CPPRT, and
25    Base Funding Minimum. An Organizational Unit's Preliminary
26    Percent of Adequacy is the lesser of (i) its Preliminary

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 355 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Resources divided by its Adequacy Target or (ii) 100%.
2        (3) Except for Specially Funded Units, an
3    Organizational Unit's Final Resources are equal to the sum
4    of its Local Capacity, CPPRT, and Adjusted Base Funding
5    Minimum. The Base Funding Minimum of each Specially Funded
6    Unit shall serve as its Final Resources, except that the
7    Base Funding Minimum for State-approved charter schools
8    shall not include any portion of general State aid
9    allocated in the prior year based on the per capita tuition
10    charge times the charter school enrollment.
11        (4) An Organizational Unit's Final Percent of Adequacy
12    is its Final Resources divided by its Adequacy Target. An
13    Organizational Unit's Adjusted Base Funding Minimum is
14    equal to its Base Funding Minimum less its Supplemental
15    Grant Funding, with the resulting figure added to the
16    product of its Supplemental Grant Funding and Preliminary
17    Percent of Adequacy.
18    (g) Evidence-Based Funding formula distribution system.
19        (1) In each school year under the Evidence-Based
20    Funding formula, each Organizational Unit receives funding
21    equal to the sum of its Base Funding Minimum and the unit's
22    allocation of New State Funds determined pursuant to this
23    subsection (g). To allocate New State Funds, the
24    Evidence-Based Funding formula distribution system first
25    places all Organizational Units into one of 4 tiers in
26    accordance with paragraph (3) of this subsection (g), based

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 356 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    on the Organizational Unit's Final Percent of Adequacy. New
2    State Funds are allocated to each of the 4 tiers as
3    follows: Tier 1 Aggregate Funding equals 50% of all New
4    State Funds, Tier 2 Aggregate Funding equals 49% of all New
5    State Funds, Tier 3 Aggregate Funding equals 0.9% of all
6    New State Funds, and Tier 4 Aggregate Funding equals 0.1%
7    of all New State Funds. Each Organizational Unit within
8    Tier 1 or Tier 2 receives an allocation of New State Funds
9    equal to its tier Funding Gap, as defined in the following
10    sentence, multiplied by the tier's Allocation Rate
11    determined pursuant to paragraph (4) of this subsection
12    (g). For Tier 1, an Organizational Unit's Funding Gap
13    equals the tier's Target Ratio, as specified in paragraph
14    (5) of this subsection (g), multiplied by the
15    Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target, with the resulting
16    amount reduced by the Organizational Unit's Final
17    Resources. For Tier 2, an Organizational Unit's Funding Gap
18    equals the tier's Target Ratio, as described in paragraph
19    (5) of this subsection (g), multiplied by the
20    Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target, with the resulting
21    amount reduced by the Organizational Unit's Final
22    Resources and its Tier 1 funding allocation. To determine
23    the Organizational Unit's Funding Gap, the resulting
24    amount is then multiplied by a factor equal to one minus
25    the Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Target
26    percentage. Each Organizational Unit within Tier 3 or Tier

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 357 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    4 receives an allocation of New State Funds equal to the
2    product of its Adequacy Target and the tier's Allocation
3    Rate, as specified in paragraph (4) of this subsection (g).
4        (2) To ensure equitable distribution of dollars for all
5    Tier 2 Organizational Units, no Tier 2 Organizational Unit
6    shall receive fewer dollars per ASE than any Tier 3
7    Organizational Unit. Each Tier 2 and Tier 3 Organizational
8    Unit shall have its funding allocation divided by its ASE.
9    Any Tier 2 Organizational Unit with a funding allocation
10    per ASE below the greatest Tier 3 allocation per ASE shall
11    get a funding allocation equal to the greatest Tier 3
12    funding allocation per ASE multiplied by the
13    Organizational Unit's ASE. Each Tier 2 Organizational
14    Unit's Tier 2 funding allocation shall be multiplied by the
15    percentage calculated by dividing the original Tier 2
16    Aggregate Funding by the sum of all Tier 2 Organizational
17    Units' Tier 2 funding allocation after adjusting
18    districts' funding below Tier 3 levels.
19        (3) Organizational Units are placed into one of 4 tiers
20    as follows:
21            (A) Tier 1 consists of all Organizational Units,
22        except for Specially Funded Units, with a Percent of
23        Adequacy less than the Tier 1 Target Ratio. The Tier 1
24        Target Ratio is the ratio level that allows for Tier 1
25        Aggregate Funding to be distributed, with the Tier 1
26        Allocation Rate determined pursuant to paragraph (4)

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 358 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        of this subsection (g).
2            (B) Tier 2 consists of all Tier 1 Units and all
3        other Organizational Units, except for Specially
4        Funded Units, with a Percent of Adequacy of less than
5        0.90.
6            (C) Tier 3 consists of all Organizational Units,
7        except for Specially Funded Units, with a Percent of
8        Adequacy of at least 0.90 and less than 1.0.
9            (D) Tier 4 consists of all Organizational Units
10        with a Percent of Adequacy of at least 1.0.
11        (4) The Allocation Rates for Tiers 1 through 4 are
12    determined as follows:
13            (A) The Tier 1 Allocation Rate is 30%.
14            (B) The Tier 2 Allocation Rate is the result of the
15        following equation: Tier 2 Aggregate Funding, divided
16        by the sum of the Funding Gaps for all Tier 2
17        Organizational Units, unless the result of such
18        equation is higher than 1.0. If the result of such
19        equation is higher than 1.0, then the Tier 2 Allocation
20        Rate is 1.0.
21            (C) The Tier 3 Allocation Rate is the result of the
22        following equation: Tier 3 Aggregate Funding, divided
23        by the sum of the Adequacy Targets of all Tier 3
24        Organizational Units.
25            (D) The Tier 4 Allocation Rate is the result of the
26        following equation: Tier 4 Aggregate Funding, divided

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 359 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        by the sum of the Adequacy Targets of all Tier 4
2        Organizational Units.
3        (5) A tier's Target Ratio is determined as follows:
4            (A) The Tier 1 Target Ratio is the ratio level that
5        allows for Tier 1 Aggregate Funding to be distributed
6        with the Tier 1 Allocation Rate.
7            (B) The Tier 2 Target Ratio is 0.90.
8            (C) The Tier 3 Target Ratio is 1.0.
9        (6) If, at any point, the Tier 1 Target Ratio is
10    greater than 90%, then than all Tier 1 funding shall be
11    allocated to Tier 2 and no Tier 1 Organizational Unit's
12    funding may be identified.
13        (7) In the event that all Tier 2 Organizational Units
14    receive funding at the Tier 2 Target Ratio level, any
15    remaining New State Funds shall be allocated to Tier 3 and
16    Tier 4 Organizational Units.
17        (8) If any Specially Funded Units, excluding Glenwood
18    Academy, recognized by the State Board do not qualify for
19    direct funding following the implementation of Public Act
20    100-465 from any of the funding sources included within the
21    definition of Base Funding Minimum, the unqualified
22    portion of the Base Funding Minimum shall be transferred to
23    one or more appropriate Organizational Units as determined
24    by the State Superintendent based on the prior year ASE of
25    the Organizational Units.
26        (8.5) If a school district withdraws from a special

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 360 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    education cooperative, the portion of the Base Funding
2    Minimum that is attributable to the school district may be
3    redistributed to the school district upon withdrawal. The
4    school district and the cooperative must include the amount
5    of the Base Funding Minimum that is to be reapportioned in
6    their withdrawal agreement and notify the State Board of
7    the change with a copy of the agreement upon withdrawal.
8        (9) The Minimum Funding Level is intended to establish
9    a target for State funding that will keep pace with
10    inflation and continue to advance equity through the
11    Evidence-Based Funding formula. The target for State
12    funding of New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds is
13    $50,000,000 for State fiscal year 2019 and subsequent State
14    fiscal years. The Minimum Funding Level is equal to
15    $350,000,000. In addition to any New State Funds, no more
16    than $50,000,000 New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds may be
17    counted toward the Minimum Funding Level. If the sum of New
18    State Funds and applicable New Property Tax Relief Pool
19    Funds are less than the Minimum Funding Level, than funding
20    for tiers shall be reduced in the following manner:
21            (A) First, Tier 4 funding shall be reduced by an
22        amount equal to the difference between the Minimum
23        Funding Level and New State Funds until such time as
24        Tier 4 funding is exhausted.
25            (B) Next, Tier 3 funding shall be reduced by an
26        amount equal to the difference between the Minimum

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 361 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        Funding Level and New State Funds and the reduction in
2        Tier 4 funding until such time as Tier 3 funding is
3        exhausted.
4            (C) Next, Tier 2 funding shall be reduced by an
5        amount equal to the difference between the Minimum
6        Funding Level and New State Funds and the reduction in
7        Tier 4 and Tier 3.
8            (D) Finally, Tier 1 funding shall be reduced by an
9        amount equal to the difference between the Minimum
10        Funding level and New State Funds and the reduction in
11        Tier 2, 3, and 4 funding. In addition, the Allocation
12        Rate for Tier 1 shall be reduced to a percentage equal
13        to the Tier 1 Allocation Rate set by paragraph (4) of
14        this subsection (g), multiplied by the result of New
15        State Funds divided by the Minimum Funding Level.
16        (9.5) For State fiscal year 2019 and subsequent State
17    fiscal years, if New State Funds exceed $300,000,000, then
18    any amount in excess of $300,000,000 shall be dedicated for
19    purposes of Section 2-3.170 of this Code up to a maximum of
20    $50,000,000.
21        (10) In the event of a decrease in the amount of the
22    appropriation for this Section in any fiscal year after
23    implementation of this Section, the Organizational Units
24    receiving Tier 1 and Tier 2 funding, as determined under
25    paragraph (3) of this subsection (g), shall be held
26    harmless by establishing a Base Funding Guarantee equal to

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 362 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    the per pupil kindergarten through grade 12 funding
2    received in accordance with this Section in the prior
3    fiscal year. Reductions shall be made to the Base Funding
4    Minimum of Organizational Units in Tier 3 and Tier 4 on a
5    per pupil basis equivalent to the total number of the ASE
6    in Tier 3-funded and Tier 4-funded Organizational Units
7    divided by the total reduction in State funding. The Base
8    Funding Minimum as reduced shall continue to be applied to
9    Tier 3 and Tier 4 Organizational Units and adjusted by the
10    relative formula when increases in appropriations for this
11    Section resume. In no event may State funding reductions to
12    Organizational Units in Tier 3 or Tier 4 exceed an amount
13    that would be less than the Base Funding Minimum
14    established in the first year of implementation of this
15    Section. If additional reductions are required, all school
16    districts shall receive a reduction by a per pupil amount
17    equal to the aggregate additional appropriation reduction
18    divided by the total ASE of all Organizational Units.
19        (11) The State Superintendent shall make minor
20    adjustments to the distribution formula set forth in this
21    subsection (g) to account for the rounding of percentages
22    to the nearest tenth of a percentage and dollar amounts to
23    the nearest whole dollar.
24    (h) State Superintendent administration of funding and
25district submission requirements.
26        (1) The State Superintendent shall, in accordance with

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 363 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    appropriations made by the General Assembly, meet the
2    funding obligations created under this Section.
3        (2) The State Superintendent shall calculate the
4    Adequacy Target for each Organizational Unit and Net State
5    Contribution Target for each Organizational Unit under
6    this Section. No Evidence-Based Funding shall be
7    distributed within an Organizational Unit without the
8    approval of the unit's school board.
9        (3) Annually, the State Superintendent shall calculate
10    and report to each Organizational Unit the unit's aggregate
11    financial adequacy amount, which shall be the sum of the
12    Adequacy Target for each Organizational Unit. The State
13    Superintendent shall calculate and report separately for
14    each Organizational Unit the unit's total State funds
15    allocated for its students with disabilities. The State
16    Superintendent shall calculate and report separately for
17    each Organizational Unit the amount of funding and
18    applicable FTE calculated for each Essential Element of the
19    unit's Adequacy Target.
20        (4) Annually, the State Superintendent shall calculate
21    and report to each Organizational Unit the amount the unit
22    must expend on special education and bilingual education
23    and computer technology and equipment for Organizational
24    Units assigned to Tier 1 or Tier 2 that received an
25    additional $285.50 per student computer technology and
26    equipment investment grant to their Adequacy Target

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 364 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    pursuant to the unit's Base Funding Minimum, Special
2    Education Allocation, Bilingual Education Allocation, and
3    computer technology and equipment investment allocation.
4        (5) Moneys distributed under this Section shall be
5    calculated on a school year basis, but paid on a fiscal
6    year basis, with payments beginning in August and extending
7    through June. Unless otherwise provided, the moneys
8    appropriated for each fiscal year shall be distributed in
9    22 equal payments at least 2 times monthly to each
10    Organizational Unit. If moneys appropriated for any fiscal
11    year are distributed other than monthly, the distribution
12    shall be on the same basis for each Organizational Unit.
13        (6) Any school district that fails, for any given
14    school year, to maintain school as required by law or to
15    maintain a recognized school is not eligible to receive
16    Evidence-Based Funding. In case of non-recognition of one
17    or more attendance centers in a school district otherwise
18    operating recognized schools, the claim of the district
19    shall be reduced in the proportion that the enrollment in
20    the attendance center or centers bears to the enrollment of
21    the school district. "Recognized school" means any public
22    school that meets the standards for recognition by the
23    State Board. A school district or attendance center not
24    having recognition status at the end of a school term is
25    entitled to receive State aid payments due upon a legal
26    claim that was filed while it was recognized.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 365 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (7) School district claims filed under this Section are
2    subject to Sections 18-9 and 18-12 of this Code, except as
3    otherwise provided in this Section.
4        (8) Each fiscal year, the State Superintendent shall
5    calculate for each Organizational Unit an amount of its
6    Base Funding Minimum and Evidence-Based Funding that shall
7    be deemed attributable to the provision of special
8    educational facilities and services, as defined in Section
9    14-1.08 of this Code, in a manner that ensures compliance
10    with maintenance of State financial support requirements
11    under the federal Individuals with Disabilities Education
12    Act. An Organizational Unit must use such funds only for
13    the provision of special educational facilities and
14    services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of this Code, and
15    must comply with any expenditure verification procedures
16    adopted by the State Board.
17        (9) All Organizational Units in this State must submit
18    annual spending plans by the end of September of each year
19    to the State Board as part of the annual budget process,
20    which shall describe how each Organizational Unit will
21    utilize the Base Funding Minimum and Evidence-Based
22    Funding it receives from this State under this Section with
23    specific identification of the intended utilization of
24    Low-Income, English learner, and special education
25    resources. Additionally, the annual spending plans of each
26    Organizational Unit shall describe how the Organizational

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 366 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Unit expects to achieve student growth and how the
2    Organizational Unit will achieve State education goals, as
3    defined by the State Board. The State Superintendent may,
4    from time to time, identify additional requisites for
5    Organizational Units to satisfy when compiling the annual
6    spending plans required under this subsection (h). The
7    format and scope of annual spending plans shall be
8    developed by the State Superintendent and the State Board
9    of Education. School districts that serve students under
10    Article 14C of this Code shall continue to submit
11    information as required under Section 14C-12 of this Code.
12        (10) No later than January 1, 2018, the State
13    Superintendent shall develop a 5-year strategic plan for
14    all Organizational Units to help in planning for adequacy
15    funding under this Section. The State Superintendent shall
16    submit the plan to the Governor and the General Assembly,
17    as provided in Section 3.1 of the General Assembly
18    Organization Act. The plan shall include recommendations
19    for:
20            (A) a framework for collaborative, professional,
21        innovative, and 21st century learning environments
22        using the Evidence-Based Funding model;
23            (B) ways to prepare and support this State's
24        educators for successful instructional careers;
25            (C) application and enhancement of the current
26        financial accountability measures, the approved State

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 367 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        plan to comply with the federal Every Student Succeeds
2        Act, and the Illinois Balanced Accountability Measures
3        in relation to student growth and elements of the
4        Evidence-Based Funding model; and
5            (D) implementation of an effective school adequacy
6        funding system based on projected and recommended
7        funding levels from the General Assembly.
8        (11) On an annual basis, the State Superintendent must
9    recalibrate all of the following per pupil elements of the
10    Adequacy Target and applied to the formulas, based on the
11    study of average expenses and as reported in the most
12    recent annual financial report:
13            (A) Gifted under subparagraph (M) of paragraph (2)
14        of subsection (b).
15            (B) Instructional materials under subparagraph (O)
16        of paragraph (2) of subsection (b).
17            (C) Assessment under subparagraph (P) of paragraph
18        (2) of subsection (b).
19            (D) Student activities under subparagraph (R) of
20        paragraph (2) of subsection (b).
21            (E) Maintenance and operations under subparagraph
22        (S) of paragraph (2) of subsection (b).
23            (F) Central office under subparagraph (T) of
24        paragraph (2) of subsection (b).
25    (i) Professional Review Panel.
26        (1) A Professional Review Panel is created to study and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 368 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    review topics related to the implementation and effect of
2    Evidence-Based Funding, as assigned by a joint resolution
3    or Public Act of the General Assembly or a motion passed by
4    the State Board of Education. The Panel must provide
5    recommendations to and serve the Governor, the General
6    Assembly, and the State Board. The State Superintendent or
7    his or her designee must serve as a voting member and
8    chairperson of the Panel. The State Superintendent must
9    appoint a vice chairperson from the membership of the
10    Panel. The Panel must advance recommendations based on a
11    three-fifths majority vote of Panel members present and
12    voting. A minority opinion may also accompany any
13    recommendation of the Panel. The Panel shall be appointed
14    by the State Superintendent, except as otherwise provided
15    in paragraph (2) of this subsection (i) and include the
16    following members:
17            (A) Two appointees that represent district
18        superintendents, recommended by a statewide
19        organization that represents district superintendents.
20            (B) Two appointees that represent school boards,
21        recommended by a statewide organization that
22        represents school boards.
23            (C) Two appointees from districts that represent
24        school business officials, recommended by a statewide
25        organization that represents school business
26        officials.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 369 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (D) Two appointees that represent school
2        principals, recommended by a statewide organization
3        that represents school principals.
4            (E) Two appointees that represent teachers,
5        recommended by a statewide organization that
6        represents teachers.
7            (F) Two appointees that represent teachers,
8        recommended by another statewide organization that
9        represents teachers.
10            (G) Two appointees that represent regional
11        superintendents of schools, recommended by
12        organizations that represent regional superintendents.
13            (H) Two independent experts selected solely by the
14        State Superintendent.
15            (I) Two independent experts recommended by public
16        universities in this State.
17            (J) One member recommended by a statewide
18        organization that represents parents.
19            (K) Two representatives recommended by collective
20        impact organizations that represent major metropolitan
21        areas or geographic areas in Illinois.
22            (L) One member from a statewide organization
23        focused on research-based education policy to support
24        a school system that prepares all students for college,
25        a career, and democratic citizenship.
26            (M) One representative from a school district

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 370 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        organized under Article 34 of this Code.
2        The State Superintendent shall ensure that the
3    membership of the Panel includes representatives from
4    school districts and communities reflecting the
5    geographic, socio-economic, racial, and ethnic diversity
6    of this State. The State Superintendent shall additionally
7    ensure that the membership of the Panel includes
8    representatives with expertise in bilingual education and
9    special education. Staff from the State Board shall staff
10    the Panel.
11        (2) In addition to those Panel members appointed by the
12    State Superintendent, 4 members of the General Assembly
13    shall be appointed as follows: one member of the House of
14    Representatives appointed by the Speaker of the House of
15    Representatives, one member of the Senate appointed by the
16    President of the Senate, one member of the House of
17    Representatives appointed by the Minority Leader of the
18    House of Representatives, and one member of the Senate
19    appointed by the Minority Leader of the Senate. There shall
20    be one additional member appointed by the Governor. All
21    members appointed by legislative leaders or the Governor
22    shall be non-voting, ex officio members.
23        (3) The Panel must study topics at the direction of the
24    General Assembly or State Board of Education, as provided
25    under paragraph (1). The Panel may also study the following
26    topics at the direction of the chairperson:

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 371 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (A) The format and scope of annual spending plans
2        referenced in paragraph (9) of subsection (h) of this
3        Section.
4            (B) The Comparable Wage Index under this Section.
5            (C) Maintenance and operations, including capital
6        maintenance and construction costs.
7            (D) "At-risk student" definition.
8            (E) Benefits.
9            (F) Technology.
10            (G) Local Capacity Target.
11            (H) Funding for Alternative Schools, Laboratory
12        Schools, safe schools, and alternative learning
13        opportunities programs.
14            (I) Funding for college and career acceleration
15        strategies.
16            (J) Special education investments.
17            (K) Early childhood investments, in collaboration
18        with the Illinois Early Learning Council.
19        (4) (Blank).
20        (5) Within 5 years after the implementation of this
21    Section, and every 5 years thereafter, the Panel shall
22    complete an evaluative study of the entire Evidence-Based
23    Funding model, including an assessment of whether or not
24    the formula is achieving State goals. The Panel shall
25    report to the State Board, the General Assembly, and the
26    Governor on the findings of the study.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 372 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (6) (Blank).
2        (7) To ensure that (i) the Adequacy Target calculation
3    under subsection (b) accurately reflects the needs of
4    students living in poverty or attending schools located in
5    areas of high poverty, (ii) racial equity within the
6    Evidence-Based Funding formula is explicitly explored and
7    advanced, and (iii) the funding goals of the formula
8    distribution system established under this Section are
9    sufficient to provide adequate funding for every student
10    and to fully fund every school in this State, the Panel
11    shall review the Essential Elements under paragraph (2) of
12    subsection (b). The Panel shall consider all of the
13    following in its review:
14            (A) The financial ability of school districts to
15        provide instruction in a foreign language to every
16        student and whether an additional Essential Element
17        should be added to the formula to ensure that every
18        student has access to instruction in a foreign
19        language.
20            (B) The adult-to-student ratio for each Essential
21        Element in which a ratio is identified. The Panel shall
22        consider whether the ratio accurately reflects the
23        staffing needed to support students living in poverty
24        or who have traumatic backgrounds.
25            (C) Changes to the Essential Elements that may be
26        required to better promote racial equity and eliminate

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 373 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        structural racism within schools.
2            (D) The impact of investing $350,000,000 in
3        additional funds each year under this Section and an
4        estimate of when the school system will become fully
5        funded under this level of appropriation.
6            (E) Provide an overview of alternative funding
7        structures that would enable the State to become fully
8        funded at an earlier date.
9            (F) The potential to increase efficiency and to
10        find cost savings within the school system to expedite
11        the journey to a fully funded system.
12        On or before April 1, 2021, the Panel shall report to
13    the State Board, the General Assembly, and the Governor on
14    the findings of its review. This paragraph (7) is
15    inoperative on and after April 1, 2022.
16    (j) References. Beginning July 1, 2017, references in other
17laws to general State aid funds or calculations under Section
1818-8.05 of this Code (now repealed) shall be deemed to be
19references to evidence-based model formula funds or
20calculations under this Section.
21(Source: P.A. 100-465, eff. 8-31-17; 100-578, eff. 1-31-18;
22100-582, eff. 3-23-18; 101-10, eff. 6-5-19; 101-17, eff.
236-14-19; 101-643, eff. 6-18-20; revised 8-21-20.)
 
24
Article 90.

 

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 374 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Section 90-5. The Department of Human Services Act is
2amended by adding Section 10-75 as follows:
 
3    (20 ILCS 1305/10-75 new)
4    Sec. 10-75. Findings; compensation; barriers.
5    (a) The General Assembly makes all of the following
6findings:
7        (1) Research demonstrates that the effectiveness of an
8    early childhood teacher is a predictor for the positive
9    developmental and academic outcomes for children.
10        (2) The work of early childhood educators is
11    sophisticated and central to the healthy learning and
12    development of young children and takes place in diverse
13    settings, including schools, community-based centers, and
14    homes.
15        (3) It is critically important for children's outcome
16    to have educators that reflect the diversity of the
17    families and communities they serve.
18        (4) The early childhood workforce is more racially
19    diverse than the K-12 workforce and its members hold
20    degrees, have earned credentials, and have years of
21    experience in the field of early childhood education.
22        (5) The early childhood workforce, particularly those
23    members who work in community-based settings and those who
24    work with infants and toddlers, are often not paid wages
25    that are aligned with the sophistication of their work and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 375 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    their level of education.
2        (6) All regions and settings have difficulty in finding
3    qualified teachers.
4        (7) A disproportionate number of Black and Latinx women
5    serve in essential, frontline positions, but are
6    underrepresented as lead teachers and in program
7    leadership where credentials and degrees are required.
8        (8) Members of the early childhood workforce face
9    multiple barriers that prevent them from attaining the
10    additional credentials and degrees required for career
11    advancement and higher levels of compensation.
12    (b) The Department of Human Services shall conduct an
13analysis of the data relating to teachers that is available in
14the Gateways to Opportunity Registry under the Gateways to
15Opportunity program established in Section 10-70 of this Act to
16ascertain those individuals who are participating in the
17Gateways to Opportunity program and who are close to attaining
18a higher credential lever or degree. If the following
19information is available in the Gateways to Opportunity
20Registry, the analysis of data about an identified individual
21shall include the individual's geographic location,
22demographic information, work setting, and the age groups of
23the children for which the individual is responsible.
24    (c) The Department of Human Services shall conduct outreach
25and provide targeted coaching and access to financial support
26that shall include, but is not limited to, scholarships and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 376 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1debt relief, to members of the early childhood workforce in a
2manner that must prioritize (i) increasing the diversity of the
3teacher pipeline, (ii) the regions in the State that have the
4greatest need, and (iii) those children in age groups who are
5experiencing the greatest shortage of teachers.
6    (d) The State Board of Education, in cooperation with the
7Department of Human Services, shall provide additional
8financial support to members of the early childhood workforce
9regardless of the setting in which they work and the
10credentials they seek. The State Board of Education shall
11prioritize potential candidates for assistance under this
12Section by those individuals who have the greatest need in the
13field of early childhood education.
14    (e) The Department of Human Services shall prepare and
15submit reports annually to the General Assembly disclosing the
16individuals who received financial assistance, scholarships,
17or other types of financial support provided through or
18administered by the Department of Human Services or by the
19State Board of Education. If the following information is
20available in the Gateways to Opportunity Registry, the analysis
21of data about the recipients of financial assistance shall
22include the geographic location, demographic information, work
23setting, the age groups of the children for which a recipient
24is responsible, and the degrees or credentials a recipient has
25attained.
26    (f) In cooperation with the Department of Human Services,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 377 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1the Board of Higher Education in the course of their strategic
2planning process shall review the barriers to higher education
3and career advancement experienced by the early childhood
4workforce and by teachers of color. The Board of Higher
5Education shall place particular focus on the barriers
6experienced by the early childhood workforce and by teachers of
7color in accessing and completing the required coursework
8needed to attain additional credentials and degrees. The Board
9of Higher Education shall make policy recommendations and
10recommendations for the changes in practices to better meet the
11needs of the early childhood workforce that is largely
12comprised of non-traditional students and women of color.
13    (g) Subject to appropriation, the Department of Human
14Services and the State Board of Education shall prioritize
15reducing the compensation disparities that exist between
16members of the early childhood workforce and their K-12
17workforce counterparts and the disparities that exist within
18the early childhood workforce between the settings and the age
19groups of children in which they work.
 
20
Article 95.

 
21    Section 95-1. Short title. This Article may be cited as the
22Equity in Higher Education Act. References in this Article to
23"this Act" mean this Article.
 

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 378 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Section 95-5. Findings; policies.
2    (a) The General Assembly finds the following:
3        (1) Historic and continuous systemic racism has
4    created significant disparities in college access,
5    affordability, and completion for Black, Latinx,
6    low-income, and other underrepresented and historically
7    underserved students.
8        (2) Higher education is examining its role as a
9    contributor to systemic racism, while recognizing its
10    place in providing opportunity and upward mobility, and its
11    role as a powerful actor in dismantling systemic racism.
12        (3) Chicago State University has created the Equity
13    Working Group, which includes statewide representation of
14    private, community, and public sector stakeholders, to
15    create an action plan for employers, the secondary and
16    postsecondary education systems, philanthropic
17    organizations, community-based organizations, and our
18    executive and legislative bodies to improve college
19    access, completion, and post-graduation outcomes for Black
20    college students in Illinois.
21        (4) Despite similar numbers of Black high school
22    graduates, Illinois saw about 25,000 fewer Black enrollees
23    in Illinois higher education in 2018 compared to 2008.
24        (5) Illinois must address wide disparities in degree
25    completion at Illinois community colleges, which currently
26    graduate Black and Latinx students at a rate of 14% and 26%

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 379 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    respectively compared to the rate of 38% for White
2    students, as well as at public universities, which
3    currently graduate Black and Latinx students at a rate of
4    34% and 49% respectively compared to 66% of White students,
5    within 6 years.
6        (6) The State of Illinois benefits from a diverse
7    public higher education system that includes universities
8    and community colleges with different missions and scopes
9    that maximize college enrollment, persistence, and
10    completion of underrepresented and historically
11    underserved students, including Black and Latinx students
12    and students from low-income families.
13        (7) Illinois has a moral obligation and an economic
14    interest in dismantling and reforming structures that
15    create or exacerbate racial and socioeconomic inequities
16    in K-12 and higher education.
17        (8) The Board of Higher Education has a statutory
18    obligation to create a strategic plan for higher education
19    and has adopted core principles to guide this plan.
20        (9) The Board of Higher Education has included among
21    its core principles designed to guide the strategic plan
22    the assumption that excellence coupled with equity should
23    drive the higher education system and that the higher
24    education system will make equity-driven decisions,
25    elevating the voices of those who have been underserved,
26    and actively identify and remove systemic barriers that

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 380 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    have prevented students of color, first generation college
2    students, low-income students, adult learners, and rural
3    students from accessing and succeeding in higher
4    education; access and affordability as well as high quality
5    are embedded in the definition of equity.
6    (b) The General Assembly supports all of the following work
7and goals of the Board of Higher Education:
8        (1) Its work on the strategic plan for higher education
9    and the vision it has set forth that over the next 10 years
10    Illinois will have an equitable, accessible, innovative,
11    nimble, and aligned higher education ecosystem that
12    ensures individuals, families, and communities across the
13    state thrive.
14        (2) Its goal to close equity gaps in higher education
15    in Illinois and that the strategic plan will identify
16    multiple strategies to achieve this goal.
17        (3) Its goal to increase postsecondary
18    credential/degree attainment and develop talent to drive
19    the economy of Illinois and that the strategic plan will
20    identify strategies to achieve this goal, including
21    embedding equity in the State's attainment goal.
22        (4) Its goal to improve higher education
23    affordability, increase access, and manage costs and the
24    expectation that the strategic plan will identify
25    strategies for stakeholders to achieve these goals,
26    including opportunities to improve efficiency and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 381 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    principles for equitable and adequate ways to fund higher
2    education.
3    (c) The General Assembly encourages the Board of Higher
4Education to prepare an array of policy, practice, and proposed
5legislative changes required to implement the strategic plan,
6along with an implementation process and timeline by May 1,
72021 and to regularly evaluate the impact of the implementation
8of the strategic plan and publicly report the evaluation to
9ensure that the goals are achieved as intended and lead to a
10high-quality, equitable, and diverse higher education system
11in Illinois.
 
12
Article 100.

 
13    Section 100-1. Short title. This Act may be cited as the
14Developmental Education Reform Act. References in this Article
15to "this Act" mean this Article.
 
16    Section 100-5. Findings. The General Assembly makes all of
17the following findings:
18        (1) Nearly 50% of this State's high school graduates
19    who enroll full-time in a community college are placed in
20    developmental education coursework in at least one
21    subject. Community colleges place nearly 71% of Black
22    students in developmental education courses compared to
23    42% of white students.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 382 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (2) Traditional developmental education courses cost
2    students' time and money and expend their financial aid
3    because a student does not receive college credit for the
4    successful completion of a traditional developmental
5    education course. This can be a barrier to enrollment,
6    persistence, and certificate or degree completion.
7        (3) Developmental education courses can exacerbate
8    inequities in higher education. Community colleges
9    graduate Black students who are placed in developmental
10    education courses at a rate of approximately 8% compared to
11    a graduation rate of 26% for white students who are placed
12    in developmental education courses.
13        (4) A history of inconsistent and inadequate
14    approaches to student placement in community college
15    coursework, such as the reliance on standardized test
16    scores, has resulted in too many students being placed in
17    developmental education coursework who could otherwise
18    succeed in introductory college-level coursework or
19    introductory college-level coursework with concurrent
20    support.
21        (5) Public institutions of higher education and State
22    agencies have undertaken voluntary efforts and committed
23    resources to improve placement and to address disparities
24    in the successful completion of introductory college-level
25    coursework.
26        (6) The Illinois Council of Community College

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 383 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Presidents, the Illinois Community College Chief Academic
2    Officers Commission, the Illinois Community College Chief
3    Student Services Officers Commission, and the Illinois
4    Mathematics Association of Community Colleges have already
5    developed and approved a more equitable, multiple measures
6    framework for placement in coursework that is currently
7    implemented at many but not all community colleges.
8        (7) In 2019, members of the General Assembly, faculty
9    and administrators from public institutions of higher
10    education, board trustees from community college
11    districts, representatives from the Board of Higher
12    Education, the Illinois Community College Board, and other
13    appointed stakeholders convened a task force to inventory
14    and study developmental education models employed by
15    public community colleges and universities in this State
16    and to submit a detailed plan for scaling developmental
17    education reforms in which all students who are placed in
18    developmental education coursework are enrolled in an
19    evidence-based developmental education model that
20    maximizes a student's likelihood of completing an
21    introductory college-level course within his or her first 2
22    semesters at an institution of higher education. The data
23    released by the task force indicates all of the following:
24            (A) Despite more effective developmental education
25        models, community colleges and universities use the
26        traditional developmental education model for 77% of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 384 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        students who place in a developmental education
2        mathematics course and for 67% of students who place in
3        a developmental English language course.
4            (B) In a 2017 cohort study, only 25% of the
5        students who were placed in traditional developmental
6        education mathematics courses and only 42% of students
7        who were placed in traditional developmental English
8        language courses completed the developmental education
9        courses and introductory college-level courses with a
10        grade of "C" or better within 2 years compared to the
11        completion rate of 65% of students who were placed
12        directly in introductory college-level mathematics
13        courses with concurrent support and 75% of students who
14        were placed directly in introductory college-level
15        English language courses with concurrent support.
16            (C) Improved policies, programs, and practices are
17        essential to address the systemic inequities that
18        exist in postsecondary education in this State, such as
19        the disproportionate enrollment of Black students in
20        developmental education courses.
 
21    Section 100-10. Definitions. In this Act:
22    "College-level English language or mathematics course" or
23"college-level English language or mathematics coursework"
24means a course that bears credit and fulfills English language
25or mathematics credit requirements for a baccalaureate degree,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 385 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1a certificate, or an associate degree from a postsecondary
2educational institution.
3    "Community college" means a public community college in
4this State.
5    "Developmental education" means instruction through which
6a high school graduate who applies to a college credit program
7may attain the communication and computation skills necessary
8to successfully complete college-level coursework.
9    "Developmental education course" or "developmental
10education coursework" means a course or a category of courses
11in which students are placed based on an institution's finding
12that a student does not have the proficiency necessary to
13succeed in an introductory college-level English language or
14mathematics course.
15    "Institution of higher education" or "institution" means a
16public community college or university in this State.
17    "University" means a public university in this State.
 
18    Section 100-15. Placement measures.
19    (a) On or before May 1, 2022, a community college shall use
20each of the following measures, as appropriate, to determine
21the placement of a student in introductory college-level
22English language or mathematics coursework and shall use the
23scores set forth in recommendations approved by the Illinois
24Council of Community College Presidents on June 1, 2018:
25        (1) A student's cumulative high school grade point

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 386 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    average.
2        (2) A student's successful completion of an
3    appropriate high school transition course in mathematics
4    or English.
5        (3) A student's successful completion of an
6    appropriate developmental education or introductory
7    college-level English language or mathematics course at
8    another regionally accredited postsecondary educational
9    institution.
10    (b) In determining the placement of a student in
11introductory college-level English language or mathematics
12coursework, a community college shall consider the
13standardized test scores provided by the student for placement
14in an introductory college-level English language or
15mathematics course.
16    In addition, a community college is encouraged to use the
17scores set forth in recommendations approved by the Illinois
18Council of Community College Presidents on June 1, 2018 and
19should also consider other individual measures for placement in
20an introductory college-level English language or mathematics
21course, as set forth in recommendations approved by the
22Illinois Council of Community College Presidents on June 1,
232018, and the scores set forth in those recommendations.
24    In its discretion, a community college may accept a lower
25score on individual placement measures or accept lower scores
26in combination with other placement measures than those set

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 387 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1forth in the recommendations.
2    (c) If a student qualifies for placement in an introductory
3college-level English language or mathematics course using a
4single measure under subsection (a) or (b), no additional
5measures need to be considered for placement of the student in
6the introductory college-level English language or mathematics
7course.
 
8    Section 100-20. Recommendations of Illinois Council of
9Community College Presidents; revisions. If the Illinois
10Council of Community College Presidents approves any revised
11recommendations for determining the placement of students in
12introductory college-level English language or mathematics
13courses in response to changes in scoring systems, the
14introduction and use of additional measures, or evidence that
15demonstrates the inaccuracy in the use of scores in previous
16recommendations, then, within one year after the date of the
17adoption of those revised recommendations, references in this
18Act to recommendations approved by the Illinois Council of
19Community College Presidents on June 1, 2018 shall mean the
20revised recommendations. The General Assembly may request that
21the Illinois Council of Community College Presidents provide to
22the General Assembly the rationale and supporting evidence for
23any revision to the Council's recommendations.
 
24    Section 100-25. Placement policy; report.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 388 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (a) Each institution of higher education shall publicly
2post its placement policy in a manner that is easily accessible
3to both students and prospective students.
4    (b) On or before July 1, 2023, the Illinois Community
5College Board shall issue a report, which shall be made
6available to the public on its Internet website, concerning
7each community college's developmental education and
8college-level coursework placement policy and the policy's
9outcomes. The data disclosed in the report must be consistent
10with the Illinois Community College Board's requirements for
11data collection and must be disaggregated by developmental
12education course model, as defined by the Illinois Community
13College Board, and by gender, race and ethnicity, and federal
14Pell Grant status.
 
15    Section 100-30. Institutional plans; report.
16    (a) On or before January 1, 2022, each university shall
17submit to the Board of Higher Education and each community
18college shall submit to the Illinois Community College Board
19its institutional plan for scaling evidence-based
20developmental education reforms to maximize the probability
21that a student will be placed in and successfully complete
22introductory college-level English language or mathematics
23coursework within 2 semesters at the institution. At a minimum,
24a plan submitted by an institution shall include all of the
25following:

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 389 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (1) A description of the current developmental
2    education models offered by the institution. If the
3    institution does not currently offer developmental
4    education coursework, it must provide details regarding
5    its decision not to offer developmental education
6    coursework and the pathways that are available to students
7    deemed to be insufficiently prepared for introductory
8    college-level English language or mathematics coursework.
9        (2) A description of the developmental education
10    models that will be implemented and scaled and the basis of
11    the evidence and associated data that the institution
12    considered in making the decision to scale each model.
13        (3) Baseline data and benchmarks for progress,
14    including, but not limited to, (i) enrollment in
15    credit-bearing English language or mathematics courses,
16    (ii) rates of successful completion of introductory
17    college-level English language or mathematics courses, and
18    (iii) college-credit accumulation.
19        (4) Detailed plans for scaling reforms and improving
20    outcomes for all students placed in traditional
21    developmental education models or models with comparable
22    introductory college-level course completion rates. The
23    plan shall provide details about the expected improvements
24    in educational outcomes for Black students as result of the
25    proposed reforms.
26    (b) On or before January 1, 2023 and each year thereafter,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 390 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1the Board of Higher Education and Illinois Community College
2Board shall collect data and report to the General Assembly and
3the public the status of developmental education reforms at
4institutions. The report must include data on the progress of
5the developmental education reforms, including, but not
6limited to, (i) enrollment in credit-bearing English language
7or mathematics courses, (ii) rates of successful completion of
8introductory college-level English language or mathematics
9courses, and (iii) college-credit accumulation. The data must
10be disaggregated by gender, race and ethnicity, federal Pell
11Grant status, and other variables of interest to the Board of
12Higher Education and the Illinois Community College Board.
13    (c) On or before January 1, 2024 and each year thereafter,
14the Board of Higher Education and Illinois Community College
15Board, in consultation with institutions of higher education
16and other stakeholders, shall consider additional data
17reporting requirements to facilitate the rigorous and
18continuous evaluation of each institution's implementation
19plan and its impact on improving outcomes for students in
20developmental education, particularly for Black students.
 
21    Section 100-90. Family Educational Rights and Privacy Act
22of 1974. Nothing in this Act supersedes the federal Family
23Educational Rights and Privacy Act of 1974 or rules adopted
24pursuant to the federal Family Educational Rights and Privacy
25Act of 1974.
 

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 391 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1
Article 105.

 
2    Section 105-5. The Illinois Administrative Procedure Act
3is amended by adding Section 5-45.8 as follows:
 
4    (5 ILCS 100/5-45.8 new)
5    Sec. 5-45.8. Emergency rulemaking. To provide for the
6expeditious and timely implementation of this amendatory Act of
7the 101st General Assembly, emergency rules implementing this
8amendatory Act of the 101st General Assembly may be adopted in
9accordance with Section 5-45 to implement this amendatory Act
10of the 101st General Assembly. The adoption of emergency rules
11authorized by Section 5-45 and this Section is deemed to be
12necessary for the public interest, safety, and welfare.
13    This Section is repealed on January 1, 2026.
 
14    Section 105-10. The Invest in Kids Act is amended by
15changing Sections 5, 10, 40, and 45 and by adding Section 7.5
16as follows:
 
17    (35 ILCS 40/5)
18    (Section scheduled to be repealed on January 1, 2024)
19    Sec. 5. Definitions. As used in this Act:
20    "Authorized contribution" means the contribution amount
21that is listed on the contribution authorization certificate

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 392 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1issued to the taxpayer.
2    "Board" means the State Board of Education.
3    "Contribution" means a donation made by the taxpayer during
4the taxable year for providing scholarships as provided in this
5Act.
6    "Custodian" means, with respect to eligible students, an
7Illinois resident who is a parent or legal guardian of the
8eligible student or students.
9    "Department" means the Department of Revenue.
10    "Eligible student" means a child who:
11        (1) is a member of a household whose federal adjusted
12    gross income the year before he or she initially receives a
13    scholarship under this program, as determined by the
14    Department, does not exceed 300% of the federal poverty
15    level and, once the child receives a scholarship, does not
16    exceed 400% of the federal poverty level;
17        (2) is eligible to attend a public elementary school or
18    high school in Illinois in the semester immediately
19    preceding the semester for which he or she first receives a
20    scholarship or is starting school in Illinois for the first
21    time when he or she first receives a scholarship; and
22        (3) resides in Illinois while receiving a scholarship.
23    "Family member" means a parent, child, or sibling, whether
24by whole blood, half blood, or adoption; spouse; or stepchild.
25    "Focus district" means a school district which has a school
26that is either (i) a school that has one or more subgroups in

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 393 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1which the average student performance is at or below the State
2average for the lowest 10% of student performance in that
3subgroup or (ii) a school with an average graduation rate of
4less than 60% and not identified for priority.
5    "Jointly-administered CTE program" means a program or set
6of programs within a non-public school located in Illinois, as
7determined by the Department of Labor pursuant to Section 7.5
8of this Act.
9    "Necessary costs and fees" includes the customary charge
10for instruction and use of facilities in general and the
11additional fixed fees charged for specified purposes that are
12required generally of non-scholarship recipients for each
13academic period for which the scholarship applicant actually
14enrolls, including costs associated with student assessments,
15but does not include fees payable only once and other
16contingent deposits that are refundable in whole or in part.
17The Board may prescribe, by rules consistent with this Act,
18detailed provisions concerning the computation of necessary
19costs and fees.
20    "Scholarship granting organization" means an entity that:
21        (1) is exempt from taxation under Section 501(c)(3) of
22    the Internal Revenue Code;
23        (2) uses at least 95% of the qualified contributions
24    received during a taxable year for scholarships;
25        (3) provides scholarships to students according to the
26    guidelines of this Act;

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 394 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (4) deposits and holds qualified contributions and any
2    income derived from qualified contributions in an account
3    that is separate from the organization's operating fund or
4    other funds until such qualified contributions or income
5    are withdrawn for use; and
6        (5) is approved to issue certificates of receipt.
7    "Qualified contribution" means the authorized contribution
8made by a taxpayer to a scholarship granting organization for
9which the taxpayer has received a certificate of receipt from
10such organization.
11    "Qualified school" means a non-public school located in
12Illinois and recognized by the Board pursuant to Section
132-3.25o of the School Code.
14    "Scholarship" means an educational scholarship awarded to
15an eligible student to attend a qualified school of their
16custodians' choice in an amount not exceeding the necessary
17costs and fees to attend that school.
18    "Taxpayer" means any individual, corporation, partnership,
19trust, or other entity subject to the Illinois income tax. For
20the purposes of this Act, 2 individuals filing a joint return
21shall be considered one taxpayer.
22    "Technical academy" means a non-public school located in
23Illinois that (i) registers with the Board pursuant to Section
242-3.25o of the School Code and (ii) operates or will operate a
25jointly-administered CTE program as the primary focus of the
26school. To maintain its status as a technical academy, the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 395 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1non-public school must obtain recognition from the Board
2pursuant to Section 2-3.25o of the School Code within 2
3calendar years of its registration with the Board.
4(Source: P.A. 100-465, eff. 8-31-17.)
 
5    (35 ILCS 40/7.5 new)
6    Sec. 7.5. Determination of jointly-administered CTE
7programs.
8    (a) Upon its own motion, or petition from a qualified
9school or technical academy, the Department of Labor shall
10determine whether a program or set of programs offered or
11proposed by a qualified school or technical academy provides
12coursework and training in career and technical education
13pathways aligned to industry-recognized certifications and
14credentials. The Department of Labor shall make that
15determination based upon whether the industry-recognized
16certifications or credentials that are the focus of a qualified
17school or technical academy's coursework and training program
18or set of programs (i) are associated with an occupation
19determined to fall under the LEADING or EMERGING priority
20sectors as determined through Illinois' Workforce Innovation
21and Opportunity Act Unified State Plan, and (ii) provide wages
22that are at least 70% of the average annual wage in the State
23as determined by the United States Bureau of Labor Statistics.
24    The Department of Labor shall publish a list of approved
25jointly-administered programs on its website and otherwise

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 396 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1make such list available to the public.
2    (b) A qualified school or technical academy may petition
3the Department of Labor to obtain a determination that a
4proposed program or set of programs that it seeks to offer
5qualifies as a jointly-administered CTE program under
6subsection (a) of this Section. A petitioner shall file one
7original petition in the format provided by the Department of
8Labor and in the manner specified by the Department of Labor.
9The petitioner may withdraw his or her petition by submitting a
10written statement to the Department indicating withdrawal. The
11Department shall approve or deny a petition within 180 days of
12its submission, and, upon approval, shall proceed to add the
13program or set of programs to the list of approved
14jointly-administered CTE programs. The approval or denial of
15any petition is a final decision of the Department, subject to
16judicial review under the Administrative Review Law.
17Jurisdiction and venue are vested in the circuit court.
18    (c) The Department of Labor shall evaluate the approved
19jointly-administered CTE programs under this Section once
20every 5 years. At this time, the Department shall determine
21whether these programs continue to meet the requirements set
22forth in subsection (a) of this Section.
 
23    (35 ILCS 40/10)
24    (Section scheduled to be repealed on January 1, 2024)
25    Sec. 10. Credit awards.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 397 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (a) The Department shall award credits against the tax
2imposed under subsections (a) and (b) of Section 201 of the
3Illinois Income Tax Act to taxpayers who make qualified
4contributions. For contributions made under this Act, the
5credit shall be equal to % 75% of the total amount of qualified
6contributions made by the taxpayer during a taxable year, not
7to exceed a credit of $1,333,333 $1,000,000 per taxpayer.
8    (b) The aggregate amount of all credits the Department may
9award under this Act in any calendar year may not exceed
10$,000,000 $75,000,000. The aggregate credit cap under this
11subsection (b) shall be increased by 20% beginning on the first
12day of a calendar year if, in at least 2 of the previous 3
13calendar years, the applicable aggregate credit cap was
14reached.
15    (c) Contributions made by corporations (including
16Subchapter S corporations), partnerships, and trusts under
17this Act may not be directed to a particular subset of schools
18or , a particular school, but may not be directed to a
19particular group of students, or a particular student.
20Contributions made by individuals under this Act may be
21directed to a particular subset of schools or a particular
22school but may not be directed to a particular group of
23students or a particular student.
24    (d) No credit shall be taken under this Act for any
25qualified contribution for which the taxpayer claims a federal
26income tax deduction.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 398 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (e) Credits shall be awarded in a manner, as determined by
2the Department, that is geographically proportionate to
3enrollment in recognized non-public schools in Illinois. If the
4cap on the aggregate credits that may be awarded by the
5Department is not reached by April 1 June 1 of a given year,
6the Department shall award remaining credits on a first-come,
7first-served basis, without regard to the limitation of this
8subsection.
9    (f) Credits awarded for donations made to a technical
10academy shall be awarded without regard to subsection (e), but
11shall not exceed 15% of the annual statewide program cap. For
12the purposes of this subsection, "technical academy" means a
13technical academy that is registered with the Board within 30
14days after the effective date of this amendatory Act of the
15101st General Assembly.
16(Source: P.A. 100-465, eff. 8-31-17.)
 
17    (35 ILCS 40/40)
18    (Section scheduled to be repealed on January 1, 2024)
19    Sec. 40. Scholarship granting organization
20responsibilities.
21    (a) Before granting a scholarship for an academic year, all
22scholarship granting organizations shall assess and document
23each student's eligibility for the academic year.
24    (b) A scholarship granting organization shall grant
25scholarships only to eligible students.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 399 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (c) A scholarship granting organization shall allow an
2eligible student to attend any qualified school of the
3student's choosing, subject to the availability of funds.
4    (d) In granting scholarships, beginning in the 2022-2023
5school year and each school year thereafter, a scholarship
6granting organization shall give first priority to eligible
7students who received a scholarship from a scholarship granting
8organization during the previous school year. Second priority
9shall be given to the following priority groups:
10        (1) (blank); eligible students who received a
11    scholarship from a scholarship granting organization
12    during the previous school year;
13        (2) eligible students who are members of a household
14    whose previous year's total annual income does not exceed
15    185% of the federal poverty level;
16        (3) eligible students who reside within a focus
17    district; and
18        (4) eligible students who are siblings of students
19    currently receiving a scholarship.
20    (d-5) A scholarship granting organization shall begin
21granting scholarships no later than February 1 preceding the
22school year for which the scholarship is sought. Each The
23priority group groups identified in subsection (d) of this
24Section shall be eligible to receive scholarships on a
25first-come, first-served basis until the April 1 immediately
26preceding the school year for which the scholarship is sought

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 400 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1starting with the first priority group identified in subsection
2(d) of this Section. Applications for scholarships for eligible
3students meeting the qualifications of one or more priority
4groups that are received before April 1 must be either approved
5or denied within 10 business days after receipt. Beginning
6April 1, all eligible students shall be eligible to receive
7scholarships without regard to the priority groups identified
8in subsection (d) of this Section.
9    (e) Except as provided in subsection (e-5) of this Section,
10scholarships shall not exceed the lesser of (i) the statewide
11average operational expense per student among public schools or
12(ii) the necessary costs and fees for attendance at the
13qualified school. Scholarships shall be prorated as follows:
14        (1) for eligible students whose household income is
15    less than 185% of the federal poverty level, the
16    scholarship shall be 100% of the amount determined pursuant
17    to this subsection (e) and subsection (e-5) of this
18    Section;
19        (2) for eligible students whose household income is
20    185% or more of the federal poverty level but less than
21    250% of the federal poverty level, the average of
22    scholarships shall be 75% of the amount determined pursuant
23    to this subsection (e) and subsection (e-5) of this
24    Section; and
25        (3) for eligible students whose household income is
26    250% or more of the federal poverty level, the average of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 401 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    scholarships shall be 50% of the amount determined pursuant
2    to this subsection (e) and subsection (e-5) of this
3    Section.
4    (e-5) The statewide average operational expense per
5student among public schools shall be multiplied by the
6following factors:
7        (1) for students determined eligible to receive
8    services under the federal Individuals with Disabilities
9    Education Act, 2;
10        (2) for students who are English learners, as defined
11    in subsection (d) of Section 14C-2 of the School Code, 1.2;
12    and
13        (3) for students who are gifted and talented children,
14    as defined in Section 14A-20 of the School Code, 1.1; and .
15        (4) for students enrolled in a jointly-administered
16    CTE program, 1.5.
17    (f) A scholarship granting organization shall distribute
18scholarship payments to the participating school where the
19student is enrolled.
20    (g) Beginning in For the 2018-2019 school year through the
212021-2022 school year, each scholarship granting organization
22shall expend no less than 75% of the qualified contributions
23received during the calendar year in which the qualified
24contributions were received. No more than 25% of the qualified
25contributions may be carried forward to the following calendar
26year.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 402 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (h) In determining compliance with subsection (g), a
2scholarship granting organization may exempt a portion of
3donations directed to a technical academy operating in the
4first two calendar years in which the school is eligible to
5receive donations. For purposes of determining compliance with
6subsection (g) the sum of exempted donations per technical
7academy shall not exceed $3,000,000 over the 2-calendar year
8period. Not more than one scholarship granting organization
9shall exempt a portion of directed donations per technical
10academy. For the 2022-2023 school year, each scholarship
11granting organization shall expend all qualified contributions
12received during the calendar year in which the qualified
13contributions were received. No qualified contributions may be
14carried forward to the following calendar year.
15    (i) A scholarship granting organization shall allow an
16eligible student to transfer a scholarship during a school year
17to any other participating school of the custodian's choice.
18Such scholarships shall be prorated.
19    (j) With the prior approval of the Department, a
20scholarship granting organization may transfer funds to
21another scholarship granting organization if additional funds
22are required to meet scholarship demands at the receiving
23scholarship granting organization. All transferred funds must
24be deposited by the receiving scholarship granting
25organization into its scholarship accounts. All transferred
26amounts received by any scholarship granting organization must

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 403 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1be separately disclosed to the Department.
2    (k) If the approval of a scholarship granting organization
3is revoked as provided in Section 20 of this Act or the
4scholarship granting organization is dissolved, all remaining
5qualified contributions of the scholarship granting
6organization shall be transferred to another scholarship
7granting organization. All transferred funds must be deposited
8by the receiving scholarship granting organization into its
9scholarship accounts.
10    (l) Scholarship granting organizations shall make
11reasonable efforts to advertise the availability of
12scholarships to eligible students.
13(Source: P.A. 100-465, eff. 8-31-17.)
 
14    (35 ILCS 40/45)
15    (Section scheduled to be repealed on January 1, 2024)
16    Sec. 45. State Board responsibilities.
17    (a) Beginning in the 2019-2020 school year, students who
18have been granted a scholarship under this Act shall be
19annually assessed at the qualified school where the student
20attends school in the same manner in which students that attend
21public schools are annually assessed pursuant to Section
222-3.64a-5 of the School Code. Such qualified school shall pay
23costs associated with this requirement.
24    (b) The Board shall select an independent research
25organization, which may be a public or private entity or

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 404 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1university, to which participating qualified schools must
2report the scores of students who are receiving scholarships
3and are assessed pursuant to subsection (a) of this Section.
4Costs associated with the independent research organization
5shall be paid by the scholarship granting organizations on a
6per-pupil basis or by gifts, grants, or donations received by
7the Board under subsection (d) of this Section, as determined
8by the Board. The independent research organization must
9annually report to the Board on the year-to-year learning gains
10of students receiving scholarships on a statewide basis. The
11report shall also include, to the extent possible, a comparison
12of these learning gains to the statewide learning gains of
13public school students with socioeconomic backgrounds similar
14to those of students receiving scholarships. The annual report
15shall be delivered to the Board and published on its website.
16    (c) Beginning within 120 days after the Board first
17receives the annual report by the independent research
18organization as provided in subsection (b) of this Section and
19on an annual basis thereafter, the Board shall submit a written
20report to the Governor, the President of the Senate, the
21Speaker of the House of Representatives, the Minority Leader of
22the Senate, and the Minority Leader of the House of
23Representatives regarding this Act. Such report shall include
24an evaluation of the academic performance of students receiving
25scholarships and recommendations for improving student
26performance.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 405 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (d) Subject to the State Officials and Employees Ethics
2Act, the Board may receive and expend gifts, grants, and
3donations of any kind from any public or private entity to
4carry out the purposes of this Section, subject to the terms
5and conditions under which the gifts are given, provided that
6all such terms and conditions are permissible under law.
7    (e) The sharing and reporting of student assessment
8learning gain data under this Section must be in accordance
9with requirements of the Family Educational Rights and Privacy
10Act and the Illinois School Student Records Act. All parties
11must preserve the confidentiality of such information as
12required by law. The annual report must not disaggregate data
13to a level that will disclose the academic level of individual
14students.
15(Source: P.A. 100-465, eff. 8-31-17.)
 
16    (35 ILCS 40/65 rep.)
17    (35 ILCS 40/995 rep.)
18    Section 105-15. The Invest in Kids Act is amended by
19repealing Sections 65 and 995.
 
20
Article 110.

 
21    Section 110-5. The Illinois Vehicle Code is amended by
22changing Sections 6-209.1, 11-208.3, 11-208.6, 11-208.8,
2311-208.9, and 11-1201.1 as follows:
 

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 406 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (625 ILCS 5/6-209.1)
2    Sec. 6-209.1. Restoration of driving privileges;
3revocation; suspension; cancellation.
4    (a) The Secretary shall rescind the suspension or
5cancellation of a person's driver's license that has been
6suspended or canceled before July 1, 2020 (the effective date
7of Public Act 101-623) this amendatory Act of the 101st General
8Assembly due to:
9        (1) the person being convicted of theft of motor fuel
10    under Section Sections 16-25 or 16K-15 of the Criminal Code
11    of 1961 or the Criminal Code of 2012;
12        (2) the person, since the issuance of the driver's
13    license, being adjudged to be afflicted with or suffering
14    from any mental disability or disease;
15        (3) a violation of Section 6-16 of the Liquor Control
16    Act of 1934 or a similar provision of a local ordinance;
17        (4) the person being convicted of a violation of
18    Section 6-20 of the Liquor Control Act of 1934 or a similar
19    provision of a local ordinance, if the person presents a
20    certified copy of a court order that includes a finding
21    that the person was not an occupant of a motor vehicle at
22    the time of the violation;
23        (5) the person receiving a disposition of court
24    supervision for a violation of subsection subsections (a),
25    (d), or (e) of Section 6-20 of the Liquor Control Act of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 407 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    1934 or a similar provision of a local ordinance, if the
2    person presents a certified copy of a court order that
3    includes a finding that the person was not an occupant of a
4    motor vehicle at the time of the violation;
5        (6) the person failing to pay any fine or penalty due
6    or owing as a result of 10 or more violations of a
7    municipality's or county's vehicular standing, parking, or
8    compliance regulations established by ordinance under
9    Section 11-208.3 of this Code;
10        (7) the person failing to satisfy any fine or penalty
11    resulting from a final order issued by the Illinois State
12    Toll Highway Authority relating directly or indirectly to 5
13    or more toll violations, toll evasions, or both;
14        (8) the person being convicted of a violation of
15    Section 4-102 of this Code, if the person presents a
16    certified copy of a court order that includes a finding
17    that the person did not exercise actual physical control of
18    the vehicle at the time of the violation; or
19        (9) the person being convicted of criminal trespass to
20    vehicles under Section 21-2 of the Criminal Code of 2012,
21    if the person presents a certified copy of a court order
22    that includes a finding that the person did not exercise
23    actual physical control of the vehicle at the time of the
24    violation.
25    (b) As soon as practicable and no later than July 1, 2021,
26the Secretary shall rescind the suspension, cancellation, or

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 408 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1prohibition of renewal of a person's driver's license that has
2been suspended, canceled, or whose renewal has been prohibited
3before the effective date of this amendatory Act of the 101st
4General Assembly due to the person having failed to pay any
5fine or penalty as a result of 5 offenses for automated traffic
6law enforcement system violations under Sections 11-208.6,
711-208.8, 11-208.9, and 11-1201.1.
8(Source: P.A. 101-623, eff. 7-1-20; revised 8-18-20.)
 
9    (625 ILCS 5/11-208.3)  (from Ch. 95 1/2, par. 11-208.3)
10    Sec. 11-208.3. Administrative adjudication of violations
11of traffic regulations concerning the standing, parking, or
12condition of vehicles, automated traffic law violations, and
13automated speed enforcement system violations.
14    (a) Any municipality or county may provide by ordinance for
15a system of administrative adjudication of vehicular standing
16and parking violations and vehicle compliance violations as
17described in this subsection, automated traffic law violations
18as defined in Section 11-208.6, 11-208.9, or 11-1201.1, and
19automated speed enforcement system violations as defined in
20Section 11-208.8. The administrative system shall have as its
21purpose the fair and efficient enforcement of municipal or
22county regulations through the administrative adjudication of
23automated speed enforcement system or automated traffic law
24violations and violations of municipal or county ordinances
25regulating the standing and parking of vehicles, the condition

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 409 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1and use of vehicle equipment, and the display of municipal or
2county wheel tax licenses within the municipality's or county's
3borders. The administrative system shall only have authority to
4adjudicate civil offenses carrying fines not in excess of $500
5or requiring the completion of a traffic education program, or
6both, that occur after the effective date of the ordinance
7adopting such a system under this Section. For purposes of this
8Section, "compliance violation" means a violation of a
9municipal or county regulation governing the condition or use
10of equipment on a vehicle or governing the display of a
11municipal or county wheel tax license.
12    (b) Any ordinance establishing a system of administrative
13adjudication under this Section shall provide for:
14        (1) A traffic compliance administrator authorized to
15    adopt, distribute, and process parking, compliance, and
16    automated speed enforcement system or automated traffic
17    law violation notices and other notices required by this
18    Section, collect money paid as fines and penalties for
19    violation of parking and compliance ordinances and
20    automated speed enforcement system or automated traffic
21    law violations, and operate an administrative adjudication
22    system. The traffic compliance administrator also may make
23    a certified report to the Secretary of State under Section
24    6-306.5.
25        (2) A parking, standing, compliance, automated speed
26    enforcement system, or automated traffic law violation

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 410 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    notice that shall specify or include the date, time, and
2    place of violation of a parking, standing, compliance,
3    automated speed enforcement system, or automated traffic
4    law regulation; the particular regulation violated; any
5    requirement to complete a traffic education program; the
6    fine and any penalty that may be assessed for late payment
7    or failure to complete a required traffic education
8    program, or both, when so provided by ordinance; the
9    vehicle make or a photograph of the vehicle; the state
10    registration number of the vehicle; and the identification
11    number of the person issuing the notice. With regard to
12    automated speed enforcement system or automated traffic
13    law violations, vehicle make shall be specified on the
14    automated speed enforcement system or automated traffic
15    law violation notice if the notice does not include a
16    photograph of the vehicle and the make is available and
17    readily discernible. With regard to municipalities or
18    counties with a population of 1 million or more, it shall
19    be grounds for dismissal of a parking violation if the
20    state registration number or vehicle make specified is
21    incorrect. The violation notice shall state that the
22    completion of any required traffic education program, the
23    payment of any indicated fine, and the payment of any
24    applicable penalty for late payment or failure to complete
25    a required traffic education program, or both, shall
26    operate as a final disposition of the violation. The notice

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 411 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    also shall contain information as to the availability of a
2    hearing in which the violation may be contested on its
3    merits. The violation notice shall specify the time and
4    manner in which a hearing may be had.
5        (3) Service of a parking, standing, or compliance
6    violation notice by: (i) affixing the original or a
7    facsimile of the notice to an unlawfully parked or standing
8    vehicle; (ii) handing the notice to the operator of a
9    vehicle if he or she is present; or (iii) mailing the
10    notice to the address of the registered owner or lessee of
11    the cited vehicle as recorded with the Secretary of State
12    or the lessor of the motor vehicle within 30 days after the
13    Secretary of State or the lessor of the motor vehicle
14    notifies the municipality or county of the identity of the
15    owner or lessee of the vehicle, but not later than 90 days
16    after the date of the violation, except that in the case of
17    a lessee of a motor vehicle, service of a parking,
18    standing, or compliance violation notice may occur no later
19    than 210 days after the violation; and service of an
20    automated speed enforcement system or automated traffic
21    law violation notice by mail to the address of the
22    registered owner or lessee of the cited vehicle as recorded
23    with the Secretary of State or the lessor of the motor
24    vehicle within 30 days after the Secretary of State or the
25    lessor of the motor vehicle notifies the municipality or
26    county of the identity of the owner or lessee of the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 412 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    vehicle, but not later than 90 days after the violation,
2    except that in the case of a lessee of a motor vehicle,
3    service of an automated traffic law violation notice may
4    occur no later than 210 days after the violation. A person
5    authorized by ordinance to issue and serve parking,
6    standing, and compliance violation notices shall certify
7    as to the correctness of the facts entered on the violation
8    notice by signing his or her name to the notice at the time
9    of service or, in the case of a notice produced by a
10    computerized device, by signing a single certificate to be
11    kept by the traffic compliance administrator attesting to
12    the correctness of all notices produced by the device while
13    it was under his or her control. In the case of an
14    automated traffic law violation, the ordinance shall
15    require a determination by a technician employed or
16    contracted by the municipality or county that, based on
17    inspection of recorded images, the motor vehicle was being
18    operated in violation of Section 11-208.6, 11-208.9, or
19    11-1201.1 or a local ordinance. If the technician
20    determines that the vehicle entered the intersection as
21    part of a funeral procession or in order to yield the
22    right-of-way to an emergency vehicle, a citation shall not
23    be issued. In municipalities with a population of less than
24    1,000,000 inhabitants and counties with a population of
25    less than 3,000,000 inhabitants, the automated traffic law
26    ordinance shall require that all determinations by a

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 413 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    technician that a motor vehicle was being operated in
2    violation of Section 11-208.6, 11-208.9, or 11-1201.1 or a
3    local ordinance must be reviewed and approved by a law
4    enforcement officer or retired law enforcement officer of
5    the municipality or county issuing the violation. In
6    municipalities with a population of 1,000,000 or more
7    inhabitants and counties with a population of 3,000,000 or
8    more inhabitants, the automated traffic law ordinance
9    shall require that all determinations by a technician that
10    a motor vehicle was being operated in violation of Section
11    11-208.6, 11-208.9, or 11-1201.1 or a local ordinance must
12    be reviewed and approved by a law enforcement officer or
13    retired law enforcement officer of the municipality or
14    county issuing the violation or by an additional fully
15    trained fully-trained reviewing technician who is not
16    employed by the contractor who employs the technician who
17    made the initial determination. In the case of an automated
18    speed enforcement system violation, the ordinance shall
19    require a determination by a technician employed by the
20    municipality, based upon an inspection of recorded images,
21    video or other documentation, including documentation of
22    the speed limit and automated speed enforcement signage,
23    and documentation of the inspection, calibration, and
24    certification of the speed equipment, that the vehicle was
25    being operated in violation of Article VI of Chapter 11 of
26    this Code or a similar local ordinance. If the technician

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 414 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    determines that the vehicle speed was not determined by a
2    calibrated, certified speed equipment device based upon
3    the speed equipment documentation, or if the vehicle was an
4    emergency vehicle, a citation may not be issued. The
5    automated speed enforcement ordinance shall require that
6    all determinations by a technician that a violation
7    occurred be reviewed and approved by a law enforcement
8    officer or retired law enforcement officer of the
9    municipality issuing the violation or by an additional
10    fully trained reviewing technician who is not employed by
11    the contractor who employs the technician who made the
12    initial determination. Routine and independent calibration
13    of the speeds produced by automated speed enforcement
14    systems and equipment shall be conducted annually by a
15    qualified technician. Speeds produced by an automated
16    speed enforcement system shall be compared with speeds
17    produced by lidar or other independent equipment. Radar or
18    lidar equipment shall undergo an internal validation test
19    no less frequently than once each week. Qualified
20    technicians shall test loop-based loop based equipment no
21    less frequently than once a year. Radar equipment shall be
22    checked for accuracy by a qualified technician when the
23    unit is serviced, when unusual or suspect readings persist,
24    or when deemed necessary by a reviewing technician. Radar
25    equipment shall be checked with the internal frequency
26    generator and the internal circuit test whenever the radar

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 415 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    is turned on. Technicians must be alert for any unusual or
2    suspect readings, and if unusual or suspect readings of a
3    radar unit persist, that unit shall immediately be removed
4    from service and not returned to service until it has been
5    checked by a qualified technician and determined to be
6    functioning properly. Documentation of the annual
7    calibration results, including the equipment tested, test
8    date, technician performing the test, and test results,
9    shall be maintained and available for use in the
10    determination of an automated speed enforcement system
11    violation and issuance of a citation. The technician
12    performing the calibration and testing of the automated
13    speed enforcement equipment shall be trained and certified
14    in the use of equipment for speed enforcement purposes.
15    Training on the speed enforcement equipment may be
16    conducted by law enforcement, civilian, or manufacturer's
17    personnel and if applicable may be equivalent to the
18    equipment use and operations training included in the Speed
19    Measuring Device Operator Program developed by the
20    National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA).
21    The vendor or technician who performs the work shall keep
22    accurate records on each piece of equipment the technician
23    calibrates and tests. As used in this paragraph, "fully
24    trained fully-trained reviewing technician" means a person
25    who has received at least 40 hours of supervised training
26    in subjects which shall include image inspection and

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 416 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    interpretation, the elements necessary to prove a
2    violation, license plate identification, and traffic
3    safety and management. In all municipalities and counties,
4    the automated speed enforcement system or automated
5    traffic law ordinance shall require that no additional fee
6    shall be charged to the alleged violator for exercising his
7    or her right to an administrative hearing, and persons
8    shall be given at least 25 days following an administrative
9    hearing to pay any civil penalty imposed by a finding that
10    Section 11-208.6, 11-208.8, 11-208.9, or 11-1201.1 or a
11    similar local ordinance has been violated. The original or
12    a facsimile of the violation notice or, in the case of a
13    notice produced by a computerized device, a printed record
14    generated by the device showing the facts entered on the
15    notice, shall be retained by the traffic compliance
16    administrator, and shall be a record kept in the ordinary
17    course of business. A parking, standing, compliance,
18    automated speed enforcement system, or automated traffic
19    law violation notice issued, signed, and served in
20    accordance with this Section, a copy of the notice, or the
21    computer-generated computer generated record shall be
22    prima facie correct and shall be prima facie evidence of
23    the correctness of the facts shown on the notice. The
24    notice, copy, or computer-generated computer generated
25    record shall be admissible in any subsequent
26    administrative or legal proceedings.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 417 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (4) An opportunity for a hearing for the registered
2    owner of the vehicle cited in the parking, standing,
3    compliance, automated speed enforcement system, or
4    automated traffic law violation notice in which the owner
5    may contest the merits of the alleged violation, and during
6    which formal or technical rules of evidence shall not
7    apply; provided, however, that under Section 11-1306 of
8    this Code the lessee of a vehicle cited in the violation
9    notice likewise shall be provided an opportunity for a
10    hearing of the same kind afforded the registered owner. The
11    hearings shall be recorded, and the person conducting the
12    hearing on behalf of the traffic compliance administrator
13    shall be empowered to administer oaths and to secure by
14    subpoena both the attendance and testimony of witnesses and
15    the production of relevant books and papers. Persons
16    appearing at a hearing under this Section may be
17    represented by counsel at their expense. The ordinance may
18    also provide for internal administrative review following
19    the decision of the hearing officer.
20        (5) Service of additional notices, sent by first class
21    United States mail, postage prepaid, to the address of the
22    registered owner of the cited vehicle as recorded with the
23    Secretary of State or, if any notice to that address is
24    returned as undeliverable, to the last known address
25    recorded in a United States Post Office approved database,
26    or, under Section 11-1306 or subsection (p) of Section

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 418 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    11-208.6 or 11-208.9, or subsection (p) of Section 11-208.8
2    of this Code, to the lessee of the cited vehicle at the
3    last address known to the lessor of the cited vehicle at
4    the time of lease or, if any notice to that address is
5    returned as undeliverable, to the last known address
6    recorded in a United States Post Office approved database.
7    The service shall be deemed complete as of the date of
8    deposit in the United States mail. The notices shall be in
9    the following sequence and shall include, but not be
10    limited to, the information specified herein:
11            (i) A second notice of parking, standing, or
12        compliance violation if the first notice of the
13        violation was issued by affixing the original or a
14        facsimile of the notice to the unlawfully parked
15        vehicle or by handing the notice to the operator. This
16        notice shall specify or include the date and location
17        of the violation cited in the parking, standing, or
18        compliance violation notice, the particular regulation
19        violated, the vehicle make or a photograph of the
20        vehicle, the state registration number of the vehicle,
21        any requirement to complete a traffic education
22        program, the fine and any penalty that may be assessed
23        for late payment or failure to complete a traffic
24        education program, or both, when so provided by
25        ordinance, the availability of a hearing in which the
26        violation may be contested on its merits, and the time

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 419 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        and manner in which the hearing may be had. The notice
2        of violation shall also state that failure to complete
3        a required traffic education program, to pay the
4        indicated fine and any applicable penalty, or to appear
5        at a hearing on the merits in the time and manner
6        specified, will result in a final determination of
7        violation liability for the cited violation in the
8        amount of the fine or penalty indicated, and that, upon
9        the occurrence of a final determination of violation
10        liability for the failure, and the exhaustion of, or
11        failure to exhaust, available administrative or
12        judicial procedures for review, any incomplete traffic
13        education program or any unpaid fine or penalty, or
14        both, will constitute a debt due and owing the
15        municipality or county.
16            (ii) A notice of final determination of parking,
17        standing, compliance, automated speed enforcement
18        system, or automated traffic law violation liability.
19        This notice shall be sent following a final
20        determination of parking, standing, compliance,
21        automated speed enforcement system, or automated
22        traffic law violation liability and the conclusion of
23        judicial review procedures taken under this Section.
24        The notice shall state that the incomplete traffic
25        education program or the unpaid fine or penalty, or
26        both, is a debt due and owing the municipality or

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 420 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        county. The notice shall contain warnings that failure
2        to complete any required traffic education program or
3        to pay any fine or penalty due and owing the
4        municipality or county, or both, within the time
5        specified may result in the municipality's or county's
6        filing of a petition in the Circuit Court to have the
7        incomplete traffic education program or unpaid fine or
8        penalty, or both, rendered a judgment as provided by
9        this Section, or, where applicable, may result in
10        suspension of the person's driver's drivers license
11        for failure to complete a traffic education program or
12        to pay fines or penalties, or both, for 5 or more
13        automated traffic law violations under Section
14        11-208.6 or 11-208.9 or automated speed enforcement
15        system violations under Section 11-208.8.
16        (6) A notice of impending driver's drivers license
17    suspension. This notice shall be sent to the person liable
18    for failure to complete a required traffic education
19    program or to pay any fine or penalty that remains due and
20    owing, or both, on 5 or more unpaid automated speed
21    enforcement system or automated traffic law violations.
22    The notice shall state that failure to complete a required
23    traffic education program or to pay the fine or penalty
24    owing, or both, within 45 days of the notice's date will
25    result in the municipality or county notifying the
26    Secretary of State that the person is eligible for

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 421 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    initiation of suspension proceedings under Section 6-306.5
2    of this Code. The notice shall also state that the person
3    may obtain a photostatic copy of an original ticket
4    imposing a fine or penalty by sending a self-addressed self
5    addressed, stamped envelope to the municipality or county
6    along with a request for the photostatic copy. The notice
7    of impending driver's drivers license suspension shall be
8    sent by first class United States mail, postage prepaid, to
9    the address recorded with the Secretary of State or, if any
10    notice to that address is returned as undeliverable, to the
11    last known address recorded in a United States Post Office
12    approved database.
13        (7) Final determinations of violation liability. A
14    final determination of violation liability shall occur
15    following failure to complete the required traffic
16    education program or to pay the fine or penalty, or both,
17    after a hearing officer's determination of violation
18    liability and the exhaustion of or failure to exhaust any
19    administrative review procedures provided by ordinance.
20    Where a person fails to appear at a hearing to contest the
21    alleged violation in the time and manner specified in a
22    prior mailed notice, the hearing officer's determination
23    of violation liability shall become final: (A) upon denial
24    of a timely petition to set aside that determination, or
25    (B) upon expiration of the period for filing the petition
26    without a filing having been made.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 422 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (8) A petition to set aside a determination of parking,
2    standing, compliance, automated speed enforcement system,
3    or automated traffic law violation liability that may be
4    filed by a person owing an unpaid fine or penalty. A
5    petition to set aside a determination of liability may also
6    be filed by a person required to complete a traffic
7    education program. The petition shall be filed with and
8    ruled upon by the traffic compliance administrator in the
9    manner and within the time specified by ordinance. The
10    grounds for the petition may be limited to: (A) the person
11    not having been the owner or lessee of the cited vehicle on
12    the date the violation notice was issued, (B) the person
13    having already completed the required traffic education
14    program or paid the fine or penalty, or both, for the
15    violation in question, and (C) excusable failure to appear
16    at or request a new date for a hearing. With regard to
17    municipalities or counties with a population of 1 million
18    or more, it shall be grounds for dismissal of a parking
19    violation if the state registration number or vehicle make,
20    only if specified in the violation notice, is incorrect.
21    After the determination of parking, standing, compliance,
22    automated speed enforcement system, or automated traffic
23    law violation liability has been set aside upon a showing
24    of just cause, the registered owner shall be provided with
25    a hearing on the merits for that violation.
26        (9) Procedures for non-residents. Procedures by which

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 423 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    persons who are not residents of the municipality or county
2    may contest the merits of the alleged violation without
3    attending a hearing.
4        (10) A schedule of civil fines for violations of
5    vehicular standing, parking, compliance, automated speed
6    enforcement system, or automated traffic law regulations
7    enacted by ordinance pursuant to this Section, and a
8    schedule of penalties for late payment of the fines or
9    failure to complete required traffic education programs,
10    provided, however, that the total amount of the fine and
11    penalty for any one violation shall not exceed $250, except
12    as provided in subsection (c) of Section 11-1301.3 of this
13    Code.
14        (11) Other provisions as are necessary and proper to
15    carry into effect the powers granted and purposes stated in
16    this Section.
17    (c) Any municipality or county establishing vehicular
18standing, parking, compliance, automated speed enforcement
19system, or automated traffic law regulations under this Section
20may also provide by ordinance for a program of vehicle
21immobilization for the purpose of facilitating enforcement of
22those regulations. The program of vehicle immobilization shall
23provide for immobilizing any eligible vehicle upon the public
24way by presence of a restraint in a manner to prevent operation
25of the vehicle. Any ordinance establishing a program of vehicle
26immobilization under this Section shall provide:

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 424 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1        (1) Criteria for the designation of vehicles eligible
2    for immobilization. A vehicle shall be eligible for
3    immobilization when the registered owner of the vehicle has
4    accumulated the number of incomplete traffic education
5    programs or unpaid final determinations of parking,
6    standing, compliance, automated speed enforcement system,
7    or automated traffic law violation liability, or both, as
8    determined by ordinance.
9        (2) A notice of impending vehicle immobilization and a
10    right to a hearing to challenge the validity of the notice
11    by disproving liability for the incomplete traffic
12    education programs or unpaid final determinations of
13    parking, standing, compliance, automated speed enforcement
14    system, or automated traffic law violation liability, or
15    both, listed on the notice.
16        (3) The right to a prompt hearing after a vehicle has
17    been immobilized or subsequently towed without the
18    completion of the required traffic education program or
19    payment of the outstanding fines and penalties on parking,
20    standing, compliance, automated speed enforcement system,
21    or automated traffic law violations, or both, for which
22    final determinations have been issued. An order issued
23    after the hearing is a final administrative decision within
24    the meaning of Section 3-101 of the Code of Civil
25    Procedure.
26        (4) A post immobilization and post-towing notice

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 425 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    advising the registered owner of the vehicle of the right
2    to a hearing to challenge the validity of the impoundment.
3    (d) Judicial review of final determinations of parking,
4standing, compliance, automated speed enforcement system, or
5automated traffic law violations and final administrative
6decisions issued after hearings regarding vehicle
7immobilization and impoundment made under this Section shall be
8subject to the provisions of the Administrative Review Law.
9    (e) Any fine, penalty, incomplete traffic education
10program, or part of any fine or any penalty remaining unpaid
11after the exhaustion of, or the failure to exhaust,
12administrative remedies created under this Section and the
13conclusion of any judicial review procedures shall be a debt
14due and owing the municipality or county and, as such, may be
15collected in accordance with applicable law. Completion of any
16required traffic education program and payment in full of any
17fine or penalty resulting from a standing, parking, compliance,
18automated speed enforcement system, or automated traffic law
19violation shall constitute a final disposition of that
20violation.
21    (f) After the expiration of the period within which
22judicial review may be sought for a final determination of
23parking, standing, compliance, automated speed enforcement
24system, or automated traffic law violation, the municipality or
25county may commence a proceeding in the Circuit Court for
26purposes of obtaining a judgment on the final determination of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 426 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1violation. Nothing in this Section shall prevent a municipality
2or county from consolidating multiple final determinations of
3parking, standing, compliance, automated speed enforcement
4system, or automated traffic law violations against a person in
5a proceeding. Upon commencement of the action, the municipality
6or county shall file a certified copy or record of the final
7determination of parking, standing, compliance, automated
8speed enforcement system, or automated traffic law violation,
9which shall be accompanied by a certification that recites
10facts sufficient to show that the final determination of
11violation was issued in accordance with this Section and the
12applicable municipal or county ordinance. Service of the
13summons and a copy of the petition may be by any method
14provided by Section 2-203 of the Code of Civil Procedure or by
15certified mail, return receipt requested, provided that the
16total amount of fines and penalties for final determinations of
17parking, standing, compliance, automated speed enforcement
18system, or automated traffic law violations does not exceed
19$2500. If the court is satisfied that the final determination
20of parking, standing, compliance, automated speed enforcement
21system, or automated traffic law violation was entered in
22accordance with the requirements of this Section and the
23applicable municipal or county ordinance, and that the
24registered owner or the lessee, as the case may be, had an
25opportunity for an administrative hearing and for judicial
26review as provided in this Section, the court shall render

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 427 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1judgment in favor of the municipality or county and against the
2registered owner or the lessee for the amount indicated in the
3final determination of parking, standing, compliance,
4automated speed enforcement system, or automated traffic law
5violation, plus costs. The judgment shall have the same effect
6and may be enforced in the same manner as other judgments for
7the recovery of money.
8    (g) The fee for participating in a traffic education
9program under this Section shall not exceed $25.
10    A low-income individual required to complete a traffic
11education program under this Section who provides proof of
12eligibility for the federal earned income tax credit under
13Section 32 of the Internal Revenue Code or the Illinois earned
14income tax credit under Section 212 of the Illinois Income Tax
15Act shall not be required to pay any fee for participating in a
16required traffic education program.
17(Source: P.A. 101-32, eff. 6-28-19; 101-623, eff. 7-1-20;
18revised 12-21-20.)
 
19    (625 ILCS 5/11-208.6)
20    Sec. 11-208.6. Automated traffic law enforcement system.
21    (a) As used in this Section, "automated traffic law
22enforcement system" means a device with one or more motor
23vehicle sensors working in conjunction with a red light signal
24to produce recorded images of motor vehicles entering an
25intersection against a red signal indication in violation of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 428 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1Section 11-306 of this Code or a similar provision of a local
2ordinance.
3    An automated traffic law enforcement system is a system, in
4a municipality or county operated by a governmental agency,
5that produces a recorded image of a motor vehicle's violation
6of a provision of this Code or a local ordinance and is
7designed to obtain a clear recorded image of the vehicle and
8the vehicle's license plate. The recorded image must also
9display the time, date, and location of the violation.
10    (b) As used in this Section, "recorded images" means images
11recorded by an automated traffic law enforcement system on:
12        (1) 2 or more photographs;
13        (2) 2 or more microphotographs;
14        (3) 2 or more electronic images; or
15        (4) a video recording showing the motor vehicle and, on
16    at least one image or portion of the recording, clearly
17    identifying the registration plate or digital registration
18    plate number of the motor vehicle.
19    (b-5) A municipality or county that produces a recorded
20image of a motor vehicle's violation of a provision of this
21Code or a local ordinance must make the recorded images of a
22violation accessible to the alleged violator by providing the
23alleged violator with a website address, accessible through the
24Internet.
25    (c) Except as provided under Section 11-208.8 of this Code,
26a county or municipality, including a home rule county or

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 429 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1municipality, may not use an automated traffic law enforcement
2system to provide recorded images of a motor vehicle for the
3purpose of recording its speed. Except as provided under
4Section 11-208.8 of this Code, the regulation of the use of
5automated traffic law enforcement systems to record vehicle
6speeds is an exclusive power and function of the State. This
7subsection (c) is a denial and limitation of home rule powers
8and functions under subsection (h) of Section 6 of Article VII
9of the Illinois Constitution.
10    (c-5) A county or municipality, including a home rule
11county or municipality, may not use an automated traffic law
12enforcement system to issue violations in instances where the
13motor vehicle comes to a complete stop and does not enter the
14intersection, as defined by Section 1-132 of this Code, during
15the cycle of the red signal indication unless one or more
16pedestrians or bicyclists are present, even if the motor
17vehicle stops at a point past a stop line or crosswalk where a
18driver is required to stop, as specified in subsection (c) of
19Section 11-306 of this Code or a similar provision of a local
20ordinance.
21    (c-6) A county, or a municipality with less than 2,000,000
22inhabitants, including a home rule county or municipality, may
23not use an automated traffic law enforcement system to issue
24violations in instances where a motorcyclist enters an
25intersection against a red signal indication when the red
26signal fails to change to a green signal within a reasonable

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 430 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1period of time not less than 120 seconds because of a signal
2malfunction or because the signal has failed to detect the
3arrival of the motorcycle due to the motorcycle's size or
4weight.
5    (d) For each violation of a provision of this Code or a
6local ordinance recorded by an automatic traffic law
7enforcement system, the county or municipality having
8jurisdiction shall issue a written notice of the violation to
9the registered owner of the vehicle as the alleged violator.
10The notice shall be delivered to the registered owner of the
11vehicle, by mail, within 30 days after the Secretary of State
12notifies the municipality or county of the identity of the
13owner of the vehicle, but in no event later than 90 days after
14the violation.
15    The notice shall include:
16        (1) the name and address of the registered owner of the
17    vehicle;
18        (2) the registration number of the motor vehicle
19    involved in the violation;
20        (3) the violation charged;
21        (4) the location where the violation occurred;
22        (5) the date and time of the violation;
23        (6) a copy of the recorded images;
24        (7) the amount of the civil penalty imposed and the
25    requirements of any traffic education program imposed and
26    the date by which the civil penalty should be paid and the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 431 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    traffic education program should be completed;
2        (8) a statement that recorded images are evidence of a
3    violation of a red light signal;
4        (9) a warning that failure to pay the civil penalty, to
5    complete a required traffic education program, or to
6    contest liability in a timely manner is an admission of
7    liability and may result in a suspension of the driving
8    privileges of the registered owner of the vehicle;
9        (10) a statement that the person may elect to proceed
10    by:
11            (A) paying the fine, completing a required traffic
12        education program, or both; or
13            (B) challenging the charge in court, by mail, or by
14        administrative hearing; and
15        (11) a website address, accessible through the
16    Internet, where the person may view the recorded images of
17    the violation.
18    (e) (Blank). If a person charged with a traffic violation,
19as a result of an automated traffic law enforcement system,
20does not pay the fine or complete a required traffic education
21program, or both, or successfully contest the civil penalty
22resulting from that violation, the Secretary of State shall
23suspend the driving privileges of the registered owner of the
24vehicle under Section 6-306.5 of this Code for failing to
25complete a required traffic education program or to pay any
26fine or penalty due and owing, or both, as a result of a

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 432 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1combination of 5 violations of the automated traffic law
2enforcement system or the automated speed enforcement system
3under Section 11-208.8 of this Code.
4    (f) Based on inspection of recorded images produced by an
5automated traffic law enforcement system, a notice alleging
6that the violation occurred shall be evidence of the facts
7contained in the notice and admissible in any proceeding
8alleging a violation under this Section.
9    (g) Recorded images made by an automatic traffic law
10enforcement system are confidential and shall be made available
11only to the alleged violator and governmental and law
12enforcement agencies for purposes of adjudicating a violation
13of this Section, for statistical purposes, or for other
14governmental purposes. Any recorded image evidencing a
15violation of this Section, however, may be admissible in any
16proceeding resulting from the issuance of the citation.
17    (h) The court or hearing officer may consider in defense of
18a violation:
19        (1) that the motor vehicle or registration plates or
20    digital registration plates of the motor vehicle were
21    stolen before the violation occurred and not under the
22    control of or in the possession of the owner at the time of
23    the violation;
24        (2) that the driver of the vehicle passed through the
25    intersection when the light was red either (i) in order to
26    yield the right-of-way to an emergency vehicle or (ii) as

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 433 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    part of a funeral procession; and
2        (3) any other evidence or issues provided by municipal
3    or county ordinance.
4    (i) To demonstrate that the motor vehicle or the
5registration plates or digital registration plates were stolen
6before the violation occurred and were not under the control or
7possession of the owner at the time of the violation, the owner
8must submit proof that a report concerning the stolen motor
9vehicle or registration plates was filed with a law enforcement
10agency in a timely manner.
11    (j) Unless the driver of the motor vehicle received a
12Uniform Traffic Citation from a police officer at the time of
13the violation, the motor vehicle owner is subject to a civil
14penalty not exceeding $100 or the completion of a traffic
15education program, or both, plus an additional penalty of not
16more than $100 for failure to pay the original penalty or to
17complete a required traffic education program, or both, in a
18timely manner, if the motor vehicle is recorded by an automated
19traffic law enforcement system. A violation for which a civil
20penalty is imposed under this Section is not a violation of a
21traffic regulation governing the movement of vehicles and may
22not be recorded on the driving record of the owner of the
23vehicle.
24    (j-3) A registered owner who is a holder of a valid
25commercial driver's license is not required to complete a
26traffic education program.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 434 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (j-5) For purposes of the required traffic education
2program only, a registered owner may submit an affidavit to the
3court or hearing officer swearing that at the time of the
4alleged violation, the vehicle was in the custody and control
5of another person. The affidavit must identify the person in
6custody and control of the vehicle, including the person's name
7and current address. The person in custody and control of the
8vehicle at the time of the violation is required to complete
9the required traffic education program. If the person in
10custody and control of the vehicle at the time of the violation
11completes the required traffic education program, the
12registered owner of the vehicle is not required to complete a
13traffic education program.
14    (k) An intersection equipped with an automated traffic law
15enforcement system must be posted with a sign visible to
16approaching traffic indicating that the intersection is being
17monitored by an automated traffic law enforcement system.
18    (k-3) A municipality or county that has one or more
19intersections equipped with an automated traffic law
20enforcement system must provide notice to drivers by posting
21the locations of automated traffic law systems on the
22municipality or county website.
23    (k-5) An intersection equipped with an automated traffic
24law enforcement system must have a yellow change interval that
25conforms with the Illinois Manual on Uniform Traffic Control
26Devices (IMUTCD) published by the Illinois Department of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 435 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1Transportation.
2    (k-7) A municipality or county operating an automated
3traffic law enforcement system shall conduct a statistical
4analysis to assess the safety impact of each automated traffic
5law enforcement system at an intersection following
6installation of the system. The statistical analysis shall be
7based upon the best available crash, traffic, and other data,
8and shall cover a period of time before and after installation
9of the system sufficient to provide a statistically valid
10comparison of safety impact. The statistical analysis shall be
11consistent with professional judgment and acceptable industry
12practice. The statistical analysis also shall be consistent
13with the data required for valid comparisons of before and
14after conditions and shall be conducted within a reasonable
15period following the installation of the automated traffic law
16enforcement system. The statistical analysis required by this
17subsection (k-7) shall be made available to the public and
18shall be published on the website of the municipality or
19county. If the statistical analysis for the 36 month period
20following installation of the system indicates that there has
21been an increase in the rate of accidents at the approach to
22the intersection monitored by the system, the municipality or
23county shall undertake additional studies to determine the
24cause and severity of the accidents, and may take any action
25that it determines is necessary or appropriate to reduce the
26number or severity of the accidents at that intersection.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 436 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (l) The compensation paid for an automated traffic law
2enforcement system must be based on the value of the equipment
3or the services provided and may not be based on the number of
4traffic citations issued or the revenue generated by the
5system.
6    (m) This Section applies only to the counties of Cook,
7DuPage, Kane, Lake, Madison, McHenry, St. Clair, and Will and
8to municipalities located within those counties.
9    (n) The fee for participating in a traffic education
10program under this Section shall not exceed $25.
11    A low-income individual required to complete a traffic
12education program under this Section who provides proof of
13eligibility for the federal earned income tax credit under
14Section 32 of the Internal Revenue Code or the Illinois earned
15income tax credit under Section 212 of the Illinois Income Tax
16Act shall not be required to pay any fee for participating in a
17required traffic education program.
18    (o) (Blank). A municipality or county shall make a
19certified report to the Secretary of State pursuant to Section
206-306.5 of this Code whenever a registered owner of a vehicle
21has failed to pay any fine or penalty due and owing as a result
22of a combination of 5 offenses for automated traffic law or
23speed enforcement system violations.
24    (p) No person who is the lessor of a motor vehicle pursuant
25to a written lease agreement shall be liable for an automated
26speed or traffic law enforcement system violation involving

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 437 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1such motor vehicle during the period of the lease; provided
2that upon the request of the appropriate authority received
3within 120 days after the violation occurred, the lessor
4provides within 60 days after such receipt the name and address
5of the lessee. The drivers license number of a lessee may be
6subsequently individually requested by the appropriate
7authority if needed for enforcement of this Section.
8    Upon the provision of information by the lessor pursuant to
9this subsection, the county or municipality may issue the
10violation to the lessee of the vehicle in the same manner as it
11would issue a violation to a registered owner of a vehicle
12pursuant to this Section, and the lessee may be held liable for
13the violation.
14(Source: P.A. 101-395, eff. 8-16-19.)
 
15    (625 ILCS 5/11-208.8)
16    Sec. 11-208.8. Automated speed enforcement systems in
17safety zones.
18    (a) As used in this Section:
19    "Automated speed enforcement system" means a photographic
20device, radar device, laser device, or other electrical or
21mechanical device or devices installed or utilized in a safety
22zone and designed to record the speed of a vehicle and obtain a
23clear photograph or other recorded image of the vehicle and the
24vehicle's registration plate or digital registration plate
25while the driver is violating Article VI of Chapter 11 of this

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 438 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1Code or a similar provision of a local ordinance.
2    An automated speed enforcement system is a system, located
3in a safety zone which is under the jurisdiction of a
4municipality, that produces a recorded image of a motor
5vehicle's violation of a provision of this Code or a local
6ordinance and is designed to obtain a clear recorded image of
7the vehicle and the vehicle's license plate. The recorded image
8must also display the time, date, and location of the
9violation.
10    "Owner" means the person or entity to whom the vehicle is
11registered.
12    "Recorded image" means images recorded by an automated
13speed enforcement system on:
14        (1) 2 or more photographs;
15        (2) 2 or more microphotographs;
16        (3) 2 or more electronic images; or
17        (4) a video recording showing the motor vehicle and, on
18    at least one image or portion of the recording, clearly
19    identifying the registration plate or digital registration
20    plate number of the motor vehicle.
21    "Safety zone" means an area that is within one-eighth of a
22mile from the nearest property line of any public or private
23elementary or secondary school, or from the nearest property
24line of any facility, area, or land owned by a school district
25that is used for educational purposes approved by the Illinois
26State Board of Education, not including school district

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 439 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1headquarters or administrative buildings. A safety zone also
2includes an area that is within one-eighth of a mile from the
3nearest property line of any facility, area, or land owned by a
4park district used for recreational purposes. However, if any
5portion of a roadway is within either one-eighth mile radius,
6the safety zone also shall include the roadway extended to the
7furthest portion of the next furthest intersection. The term
8"safety zone" does not include any portion of the roadway known
9as Lake Shore Drive or any controlled access highway with 8 or
10more lanes of traffic.
11    (a-5) The automated speed enforcement system shall be
12operational and violations shall be recorded only at the
13following times:
14        (i) if the safety zone is based upon the property line
15    of any facility, area, or land owned by a school district,
16    only on school days and no earlier than 6 a.m. and no later
17    than 8:30 p.m. if the school day is during the period of
18    Monday through Thursday, or 9 p.m. if the school day is a
19    Friday; and
20        (ii) if the safety zone is based upon the property line
21    of any facility, area, or land owned by a park district, no
22    earlier than one hour prior to the time that the facility,
23    area, or land is open to the public or other patrons, and
24    no later than one hour after the facility, area, or land is
25    closed to the public or other patrons.
26    (b) A municipality that produces a recorded image of a

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 440 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1motor vehicle's violation of a provision of this Code or a
2local ordinance must make the recorded images of a violation
3accessible to the alleged violator by providing the alleged
4violator with a website address, accessible through the
5Internet.
6    (c) Notwithstanding any penalties for any other violations
7of this Code, the owner of a motor vehicle used in a traffic
8violation recorded by an automated speed enforcement system
9shall be subject to the following penalties:
10        (1) if the recorded speed is no less than 6 miles per
11    hour and no more than 10 miles per hour over the legal
12    speed limit, a civil penalty not exceeding $50, plus an
13    additional penalty of not more than $50 for failure to pay
14    the original penalty in a timely manner; or
15        (2) if the recorded speed is more than 10 miles per
16    hour over the legal speed limit, a civil penalty not
17    exceeding $100, plus an additional penalty of not more than
18    $100 for failure to pay the original penalty in a timely
19    manner.
20    A penalty may not be imposed under this Section if the
21driver of the motor vehicle received a Uniform Traffic Citation
22from a police officer for a speeding violation occurring within
23one-eighth of a mile and 15 minutes of the violation that was
24recorded by the system. A violation for which a civil penalty
25is imposed under this Section is not a violation of a traffic
26regulation governing the movement of vehicles and may not be

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 441 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1recorded on the driving record of the owner of the vehicle. A
2law enforcement officer is not required to be present or to
3witness the violation. No penalty may be imposed under this
4Section if the recorded speed of a vehicle is 5 miles per hour
5or less over the legal speed limit. The municipality may send,
6in the same manner that notices are sent under this Section, a
7speed violation warning notice where the violation involves a
8speed of 5 miles per hour or less above the legal speed limit.
9    (d) The net proceeds that a municipality receives from
10civil penalties imposed under an automated speed enforcement
11system, after deducting all non-personnel and personnel costs
12associated with the operation and maintenance of such system,
13shall be expended or obligated by the municipality for the
14following purposes:
15        (i) public safety initiatives to ensure safe passage
16    around schools, and to provide police protection and
17    surveillance around schools and parks, including but not
18    limited to: (1) personnel costs; and (2) non-personnel
19    costs such as construction and maintenance of public safety
20    infrastructure and equipment;
21        (ii) initiatives to improve pedestrian and traffic
22    safety;
23        (iii) construction and maintenance of infrastructure
24    within the municipality, including but not limited to roads
25    and bridges; and
26        (iv) after school programs.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 442 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (e) For each violation of a provision of this Code or a
2local ordinance recorded by an automated speed enforcement
3system, the municipality having jurisdiction shall issue a
4written notice of the violation to the registered owner of the
5vehicle as the alleged violator. The notice shall be delivered
6to the registered owner of the vehicle, by mail, within 30 days
7after the Secretary of State notifies the municipality of the
8identity of the owner of the vehicle, but in no event later
9than 90 days after the violation.
10    (f) The notice required under subsection (e) of this
11Section shall include:
12        (1) the name and address of the registered owner of the
13    vehicle;
14        (2) the registration number of the motor vehicle
15    involved in the violation;
16        (3) the violation charged;
17        (4) the date, time, and location where the violation
18    occurred;
19        (5) a copy of the recorded image or images;
20        (6) the amount of the civil penalty imposed and the
21    date by which the civil penalty should be paid;
22        (7) a statement that recorded images are evidence of a
23    violation of a speed restriction;
24        (8) a warning that failure to pay the civil penalty or
25    to contest liability in a timely manner is an admission of
26    liability and may result in a suspension of the driving

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 443 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    privileges of the registered owner of the vehicle;
2        (9) a statement that the person may elect to proceed
3    by:
4            (A) paying the fine; or
5            (B) challenging the charge in court, by mail, or by
6        administrative hearing; and
7        (10) a website address, accessible through the
8    Internet, where the person may view the recorded images of
9    the violation.
10    (g) (Blank). If a person charged with a traffic violation,
11as a result of an automated speed enforcement system, does not
12pay the fine or successfully contest the civil penalty
13resulting from that violation, the Secretary of State shall
14suspend the driving privileges of the registered owner of the
15vehicle under Section 6-306.5 of this Code for failing to pay
16any fine or penalty due and owing, or both, as a result of a
17combination of 5 violations of the automated speed enforcement
18system or the automated traffic law under Section 11-208.6 of
19this Code.
20    (h) Based on inspection of recorded images produced by an
21automated speed enforcement system, a notice alleging that the
22violation occurred shall be evidence of the facts contained in
23the notice and admissible in any proceeding alleging a
24violation under this Section.
25    (i) Recorded images made by an automated speed enforcement
26system are confidential and shall be made available only to the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 444 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1alleged violator and governmental and law enforcement agencies
2for purposes of adjudicating a violation of this Section, for
3statistical purposes, or for other governmental purposes. Any
4recorded image evidencing a violation of this Section, however,
5may be admissible in any proceeding resulting from the issuance
6of the citation.
7    (j) The court or hearing officer may consider in defense of
8a violation:
9        (1) that the motor vehicle or registration plates or
10    digital registration plates of the motor vehicle were
11    stolen before the violation occurred and not under the
12    control or in the possession of the owner at the time of
13    the violation;
14        (2) that the driver of the motor vehicle received a
15    Uniform Traffic Citation from a police officer for a
16    speeding violation occurring within one-eighth of a mile
17    and 15 minutes of the violation that was recorded by the
18    system; and
19        (3) any other evidence or issues provided by municipal
20    ordinance.
21    (k) To demonstrate that the motor vehicle or the
22registration plates or digital registration plates were stolen
23before the violation occurred and were not under the control or
24possession of the owner at the time of the violation, the owner
25must submit proof that a report concerning the stolen motor
26vehicle or registration plates was filed with a law enforcement

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 445 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1agency in a timely manner.
2    (l) A roadway equipped with an automated speed enforcement
3system shall be posted with a sign conforming to the national
4Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices that is visible to
5approaching traffic stating that vehicle speeds are being
6photo-enforced and indicating the speed limit. The
7municipality shall install such additional signage as it
8determines is necessary to give reasonable notice to drivers as
9to where automated speed enforcement systems are installed.
10    (m) A roadway where a new automated speed enforcement
11system is installed shall be posted with signs providing 30
12days notice of the use of a new automated speed enforcement
13system prior to the issuance of any citations through the
14automated speed enforcement system.
15    (n) The compensation paid for an automated speed
16enforcement system must be based on the value of the equipment
17or the services provided and may not be based on the number of
18traffic citations issued or the revenue generated by the
19system.
20    (o) (Blank). A municipality shall make a certified report
21to the Secretary of State pursuant to Section 6-306.5 of this
22Code whenever a registered owner of a vehicle has failed to pay
23any fine or penalty due and owing as a result of a combination
24of 5 offenses for automated speed or traffic law enforcement
25system violations.
26    (p) No person who is the lessor of a motor vehicle pursuant

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 446 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1to a written lease agreement shall be liable for an automated
2speed or traffic law enforcement system violation involving
3such motor vehicle during the period of the lease; provided
4that upon the request of the appropriate authority received
5within 120 days after the violation occurred, the lessor
6provides within 60 days after such receipt the name and address
7of the lessee. The drivers license number of a lessee may be
8subsequently individually requested by the appropriate
9authority if needed for enforcement of this Section.
10    Upon the provision of information by the lessor pursuant to
11this subsection, the municipality may issue the violation to
12the lessee of the vehicle in the same manner as it would issue
13a violation to a registered owner of a vehicle pursuant to this
14Section, and the lessee may be held liable for the violation.
15    (q) A municipality using an automated speed enforcement
16system must provide notice to drivers by publishing the
17locations of all safety zones where system equipment is
18installed on the website of the municipality.
19    (r) A municipality operating an automated speed
20enforcement system shall conduct a statistical analysis to
21assess the safety impact of the system. The statistical
22analysis shall be based upon the best available crash, traffic,
23and other data, and shall cover a period of time before and
24after installation of the system sufficient to provide a
25statistically valid comparison of safety impact. The
26statistical analysis shall be consistent with professional

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 447 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1judgment and acceptable industry practice. The statistical
2analysis also shall be consistent with the data required for
3valid comparisons of before and after conditions and shall be
4conducted within a reasonable period following the
5installation of the automated traffic law enforcement system.
6The statistical analysis required by this subsection shall be
7made available to the public and shall be published on the
8website of the municipality.
9    (s) This Section applies only to municipalities with a
10population of 1,000,000 or more inhabitants.
11(Source: P.A. 101-395, eff. 8-16-19.)
 
12    (625 ILCS 5/11-208.9)
13    Sec. 11-208.9. Automated traffic law enforcement system;
14approaching, overtaking, and passing a school bus.
15    (a) As used in this Section, "automated traffic law
16enforcement system" means a device with one or more motor
17vehicle sensors working in conjunction with the visual signals
18on a school bus, as specified in Sections 12-803 and 12-805 of
19this Code, to produce recorded images of motor vehicles that
20fail to stop before meeting or overtaking, from either
21direction, any school bus stopped at any location for the
22purpose of receiving or discharging pupils in violation of
23Section 11-1414 of this Code or a similar provision of a local
24ordinance.
25    An automated traffic law enforcement system is a system, in

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 448 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1a municipality or county operated by a governmental agency,
2that produces a recorded image of a motor vehicle's violation
3of a provision of this Code or a local ordinance and is
4designed to obtain a clear recorded image of the vehicle and
5the vehicle's license plate. The recorded image must also
6display the time, date, and location of the violation.
7    (b) As used in this Section, "recorded images" means images
8recorded by an automated traffic law enforcement system on:
9        (1) 2 or more photographs;
10        (2) 2 or more microphotographs;
11        (3) 2 or more electronic images; or
12        (4) a video recording showing the motor vehicle and, on
13    at least one image or portion of the recording, clearly
14    identifying the registration plate or digital registration
15    plate number of the motor vehicle.
16    (c) A municipality or county that produces a recorded image
17of a motor vehicle's violation of a provision of this Code or a
18local ordinance must make the recorded images of a violation
19accessible to the alleged violator by providing the alleged
20violator with a website address, accessible through the
21Internet.
22    (d) For each violation of a provision of this Code or a
23local ordinance recorded by an automated traffic law
24enforcement system, the county or municipality having
25jurisdiction shall issue a written notice of the violation to
26the registered owner of the vehicle as the alleged violator.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 449 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1The notice shall be delivered to the registered owner of the
2vehicle, by mail, within 30 days after the Secretary of State
3notifies the municipality or county of the identity of the
4owner of the vehicle, but in no event later than 90 days after
5the violation.
6    (e) The notice required under subsection (d) shall include:
7        (1) the name and address of the registered owner of the
8    vehicle;
9        (2) the registration number of the motor vehicle
10    involved in the violation;
11        (3) the violation charged;
12        (4) the location where the violation occurred;
13        (5) the date and time of the violation;
14        (6) a copy of the recorded images;
15        (7) the amount of the civil penalty imposed and the
16    date by which the civil penalty should be paid;
17        (8) a statement that recorded images are evidence of a
18    violation of overtaking or passing a school bus stopped for
19    the purpose of receiving or discharging pupils;
20        (9) a warning that failure to pay the civil penalty or
21    to contest liability in a timely manner is an admission of
22    liability and may result in a suspension of the driving
23    privileges of the registered owner of the vehicle;
24        (10) a statement that the person may elect to proceed
25    by:
26            (A) paying the fine; or

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 450 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (B) challenging the charge in court, by mail, or by
2        administrative hearing; and
3        (11) a website address, accessible through the
4    Internet, where the person may view the recorded images of
5    the violation.
6    (f) (Blank). If a person charged with a traffic violation,
7as a result of an automated traffic law enforcement system
8under this Section, does not pay the fine or successfully
9contest the civil penalty resulting from that violation, the
10Secretary of State shall suspend the driving privileges of the
11registered owner of the vehicle under Section 6-306.5 of this
12Code for failing to pay any fine or penalty due and owing as a
13result of a combination of 5 violations of the automated
14traffic law enforcement system or the automated speed
15enforcement system under Section 11-208.8 of this Code.
16    (g) Based on inspection of recorded images produced by an
17automated traffic law enforcement system, a notice alleging
18that the violation occurred shall be evidence of the facts
19contained in the notice and admissible in any proceeding
20alleging a violation under this Section.
21    (h) Recorded images made by an automated traffic law
22enforcement system are confidential and shall be made available
23only to the alleged violator and governmental and law
24enforcement agencies for purposes of adjudicating a violation
25of this Section, for statistical purposes, or for other
26governmental purposes. Any recorded image evidencing a

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 451 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1violation of this Section, however, may be admissible in any
2proceeding resulting from the issuance of the citation.
3    (i) The court or hearing officer may consider in defense of
4a violation:
5        (1) that the motor vehicle or registration plates or
6    digital registration plates of the motor vehicle were
7    stolen before the violation occurred and not under the
8    control of or in the possession of the owner at the time of
9    the violation;
10        (2) that the driver of the motor vehicle received a
11    Uniform Traffic Citation from a police officer for a
12    violation of Section 11-1414 of this Code within one-eighth
13    of a mile and 15 minutes of the violation that was recorded
14    by the system;
15        (3) that the visual signals required by Sections 12-803
16    and 12-805 of this Code were damaged, not activated, not
17    present in violation of Sections 12-803 and 12-805, or
18    inoperable; and
19        (4) any other evidence or issues provided by municipal
20    or county ordinance.
21    (j) To demonstrate that the motor vehicle or the
22registration plates or digital registration plates were stolen
23before the violation occurred and were not under the control or
24possession of the owner at the time of the violation, the owner
25must submit proof that a report concerning the stolen motor
26vehicle or registration plates was filed with a law enforcement

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 452 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1agency in a timely manner.
2    (k) Unless the driver of the motor vehicle received a
3Uniform Traffic Citation from a police officer at the time of
4the violation, the motor vehicle owner is subject to a civil
5penalty not exceeding $150 for a first time violation or $500
6for a second or subsequent violation, plus an additional
7penalty of not more than $100 for failure to pay the original
8penalty in a timely manner, if the motor vehicle is recorded by
9an automated traffic law enforcement system. A violation for
10which a civil penalty is imposed under this Section is not a
11violation of a traffic regulation governing the movement of
12vehicles and may not be recorded on the driving record of the
13owner of the vehicle, but may be recorded by the municipality
14or county for the purpose of determining if a person is subject
15to the higher fine for a second or subsequent offense.
16    (l) A school bus equipped with an automated traffic law
17enforcement system must be posted with a sign indicating that
18the school bus is being monitored by an automated traffic law
19enforcement system.
20    (m) A municipality or county that has one or more school
21buses equipped with an automated traffic law enforcement system
22must provide notice to drivers by posting a list of school
23districts using school buses equipped with an automated traffic
24law enforcement system on the municipality or county website.
25School districts that have one or more school buses equipped
26with an automated traffic law enforcement system must provide

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 453 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1notice to drivers by posting that information on their
2websites.
3    (n) A municipality or county operating an automated traffic
4law enforcement system shall conduct a statistical analysis to
5assess the safety impact in each school district using school
6buses equipped with an automated traffic law enforcement system
7following installation of the system. The statistical analysis
8shall be based upon the best available crash, traffic, and
9other data, and shall cover a period of time before and after
10installation of the system sufficient to provide a
11statistically valid comparison of safety impact. The
12statistical analysis shall be consistent with professional
13judgment and acceptable industry practice. The statistical
14analysis also shall be consistent with the data required for
15valid comparisons of before and after conditions and shall be
16conducted within a reasonable period following the
17installation of the automated traffic law enforcement system.
18The statistical analysis required by this subsection shall be
19made available to the public and shall be published on the
20website of the municipality or county. If the statistical
21analysis for the 36-month period following installation of the
22system indicates that there has been an increase in the rate of
23accidents at the approach to school buses monitored by the
24system, the municipality or county shall undertake additional
25studies to determine the cause and severity of the accidents,
26and may take any action that it determines is necessary or

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 454 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1appropriate to reduce the number or severity of the accidents
2involving school buses equipped with an automated traffic law
3enforcement system.
4    (o) The compensation paid for an automated traffic law
5enforcement system must be based on the value of the equipment
6or the services provided and may not be based on the number of
7traffic citations issued or the revenue generated by the
8system.
9    (p) No person who is the lessor of a motor vehicle pursuant
10to a written lease agreement shall be liable for an automated
11speed or traffic law enforcement system violation involving
12such motor vehicle during the period of the lease; provided
13that upon the request of the appropriate authority received
14within 120 days after the violation occurred, the lessor
15provides within 60 days after such receipt the name and address
16of the lessee. The drivers license number of a lessee may be
17subsequently individually requested by the appropriate
18authority if needed for enforcement of this Section.
19    Upon the provision of information by the lessor pursuant to
20this subsection, the county or municipality may issue the
21violation to the lessee of the vehicle in the same manner as it
22would issue a violation to a registered owner of a vehicle
23pursuant to this Section, and the lessee may be held liable for
24the violation.
25    (q) (Blank). A municipality or county shall make a
26certified report to the Secretary of State pursuant to Section

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 455 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

16-306.5 of this Code whenever a registered owner of a vehicle
2has failed to pay any fine or penalty due and owing as a result
3of a combination of 5 offenses for automated traffic law or
4speed enforcement system violations.
5    (r) After a municipality or county enacts an ordinance
6providing for automated traffic law enforcement systems under
7this Section, each school district within that municipality or
8county's jurisdiction may implement an automated traffic law
9enforcement system under this Section. The elected school board
10for that district must approve the implementation of an
11automated traffic law enforcement system. The school district
12shall be responsible for entering into a contract, approved by
13the elected school board of that district, with vendors for the
14installation, maintenance, and operation of the automated
15traffic law enforcement system. The school district must enter
16into an intergovernmental agreement, approved by the elected
17school board of that district, with the municipality or county
18with jurisdiction over that school district for the
19administration of the automated traffic law enforcement
20system. The proceeds from a school district's automated traffic
21law enforcement system's fines shall be divided equally between
22the school district and the municipality or county
23administering the automated traffic law enforcement system.
24(Source: P.A. 101-395, eff. 8-16-19.)
 
25    (625 ILCS 5/11-1201.1)

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 456 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Sec. 11-1201.1. Automated Railroad Crossing Enforcement
2System.
3    (a) For the purposes of this Section, an automated railroad
4grade crossing enforcement system is a system in a municipality
5or county operated by a governmental agency that produces a
6recorded image of a motor vehicle's violation of a provision of
7this Code or local ordinance and is designed to obtain a clear
8recorded image of the vehicle and vehicle's license plate. The
9recorded image must also display the time, date, and location
10of the violation.
11    As used in this Section, "recorded images" means images
12recorded by an automated railroad grade crossing enforcement
13system on:
14        (1) 2 or more photographs;
15        (2) 2 or more microphotographs;
16        (3) 2 or more electronic images; or
17        (4) a video recording showing the motor vehicle and, on
18    at least one image or portion of the recording, clearly
19    identifying the registration plate or digital registration
20    plate number of the motor vehicle.
21    (b) The Illinois Commerce Commission may, in cooperation
22with a local law enforcement agency, establish in any county or
23municipality an automated railroad grade crossing enforcement
24system at any railroad grade crossing equipped with a crossing
25gate designated by local authorities. Local authorities
26desiring the establishment of an automated railroad crossing

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 457 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1enforcement system must initiate the process by enacting a
2local ordinance requesting the creation of such a system. After
3the ordinance has been enacted, and before any additional steps
4toward the establishment of the system are undertaken, the
5local authorities and the Commission must agree to a plan for
6obtaining, from any combination of federal, State, and local
7funding sources, the moneys required for the purchase and
8installation of any necessary equipment.
9    (b-1) (Blank.)
10    (c) For each violation of Section 11-1201 of this Code or a
11local ordinance recorded by an automated railroad grade
12crossing enforcement system, the county or municipality having
13jurisdiction shall issue a written notice of the violation to
14the registered owner of the vehicle as the alleged violator.
15The notice shall be delivered to the registered owner of the
16vehicle, by mail, no later than 90 days after the violation.
17    The notice shall include:
18        (1) the name and address of the registered owner of the
19    vehicle;
20        (2) the registration number of the motor vehicle
21    involved in the violation;
22        (3) the violation charged;
23        (4) the location where the violation occurred;
24        (5) the date and time of the violation;
25        (6) a copy of the recorded images;
26        (7) the amount of the civil penalty imposed and the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 458 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    date by which the civil penalty should be paid;
2        (8) a statement that recorded images are evidence of a
3    violation of a railroad grade crossing;
4        (9) a warning that failure to pay the civil penalty or
5    to contest liability in a timely manner is an admission of
6    liability and may result in a suspension of the driving
7    privileges of the registered owner of the vehicle; and
8        (10) a statement that the person may elect to proceed
9    by:
10            (A) paying the fine; or
11            (B) challenging the charge in court, by mail, or by
12        administrative hearing.
13    (d) (Blank). If a person charged with a traffic violation,
14as a result of an automated railroad grade crossing enforcement
15system, does not pay or successfully contest the civil penalty
16resulting from that violation, the Secretary of State shall
17suspend the driving privileges of the registered owner of the
18vehicle under Section 6-306.5 of this Code for failing to pay
19any fine or penalty due and owing as a result of 5 violations
20of the automated railroad grade crossing enforcement system.
21    (d-1) (Blank.)
22    (d-2) (Blank.)
23    (e) Based on inspection of recorded images produced by an
24automated railroad grade crossing enforcement system, a notice
25alleging that the violation occurred shall be evidence of the
26facts contained in the notice and admissible in any proceeding

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 459 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1alleging a violation under this Section.
2    (e-1) Recorded images made by an automated railroad grade
3crossing enforcement system are confidential and shall be made
4available only to the alleged violator and governmental and law
5enforcement agencies for purposes of adjudicating a violation
6of this Section, for statistical purposes, or for other
7governmental purposes. Any recorded image evidencing a
8violation of this Section, however, may be admissible in any
9proceeding resulting from the issuance of the citation.
10    (e-2) The court or hearing officer may consider the
11following in the defense of a violation:
12        (1) that the motor vehicle or registration plates or
13    digital registration plates of the motor vehicle were
14    stolen before the violation occurred and not under the
15    control of or in the possession of the owner at the time of
16    the violation;
17        (2) that the driver of the motor vehicle received a
18    Uniform Traffic Citation from a police officer at the time
19    of the violation for the same offense;
20        (3) any other evidence or issues provided by municipal
21    or county ordinance.
22    (e-3) To demonstrate that the motor vehicle or the
23registration plates or digital registration plates were stolen
24before the violation occurred and were not under the control or
25possession of the owner at the time of the violation, the owner
26must submit proof that a report concerning the stolen motor

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 460 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1vehicle or registration plates was filed with a law enforcement
2agency in a timely manner.
3    (f) Rail crossings equipped with an automatic railroad
4grade crossing enforcement system shall be posted with a sign
5visible to approaching traffic stating that the railroad grade
6crossing is being monitored, that citations will be issued, and
7the amount of the fine for violation.
8    (g) The compensation paid for an automated railroad grade
9crossing enforcement system must be based on the value of the
10equipment or the services provided and may not be based on the
11number of citations issued or the revenue generated by the
12system.
13    (h) (Blank.)
14    (i) If any part or parts of this Section are held by a
15court of competent jurisdiction to be unconstitutional, the
16unconstitutionality shall not affect the validity of the
17remaining parts of this Section. The General Assembly hereby
18declares that it would have passed the remaining parts of this
19Section if it had known that the other part or parts of this
20Section would be declared unconstitutional.
21    (j) Penalty. A civil fine of $250 shall be imposed for a
22first violation of this Section, and a civil fine of $500 shall
23be imposed for a second or subsequent violation of this
24Section.
25(Source: P.A. 101-395, eff. 8-16-19.)
 

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 461 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1
Article 115.

 
2    Section 115-5. The School Code is amended by changing
3Section 21B-50 as follows:
 
4    (105 ILCS 5/21B-50)
5    Sec. 21B-50. Alternative Educator Licensure Program.
6    (a) There is established an alternative educator licensure
7program, to be known as the Alternative Educator Licensure
8Program for Teachers.
9    (b) The Alternative Educator Licensure Program for
10Teachers may be offered by a recognized institution approved to
11offer educator preparation programs by the State Board of
12Education, in consultation with the State Educator Preparation
13and Licensure Board.
14    The program shall be comprised of 4 phases:
15        (1) A course of study that at a minimum includes
16    instructional planning; instructional strategies,
17    including special education, reading, and English language
18    learning; classroom management; and the assessment of
19    students and use of data to drive instruction.
20        (2) A year of residency, which is a candidate's
21    assignment to a full-time teaching position or as a
22    co-teacher for one full school year. An individual must
23    hold an Educator License with Stipulations with an
24    alternative provisional educator endorsement in order to

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 462 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    enter the residency and must complete additional program
2    requirements that address required State and national
3    standards, pass the State Board's teacher performance
4    assessment no later than the end of the first semester of
5    the second year of residency, as required under phase (3)
6    of this subsection (b), and be recommended by the principal
7    or qualified equivalent of a principal, as required under
8    subsection (d) of this Section, and the program coordinator
9    to continue with the second year of the residency.
10        (3) A second year of residency, which shall include the
11    candidate's assignment to a full-time teaching position
12    for one school year. The candidate must be assigned an
13    experienced teacher to act as a mentor and coach the
14    candidate through the second year of residency.
15        (4) A comprehensive assessment of the candidate's
16    teaching effectiveness, as evaluated by the principal or
17    qualified equivalent of a principal, as required under
18    subsection (d) of this Section, and the program
19    coordinator, at the end of the second year of residency. If
20    there is disagreement between the 2 evaluators about the
21    candidate's teaching effectiveness, the candidate may
22    complete one additional year of residency teaching under a
23    professional development plan developed by the principal
24    or qualified equivalent and the preparation program. At the
25    completion of the third year, a candidate must have
26    positive evaluations and a recommendation for full

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 463 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    licensure from both the principal or qualified equivalent
2    and the program coordinator or no Professional Educator
3    License shall be issued.
4    Successful completion of the program shall be deemed to
5satisfy any other practice or student teaching and content
6matter requirements established by law.
7    (c) An alternative provisional educator endorsement on an
8Educator License with Stipulations is valid for 2 years of
9teaching in the public schools, including without limitation a
10preschool educational program under Section 2-3.71 of this Code
11or charter school, or in a State-recognized nonpublic school in
12which the chief administrator is required to have the licensure
13necessary to be a principal in a public school in this State
14and in which a majority of the teachers are required to have
15the licensure necessary to be instructors in a public school in
16this State, but may be renewed for a third year if needed to
17complete the Alternative Educator Licensure Program for
18Teachers. The endorsement shall be issued only once to an
19individual who meets all of the following requirements:
20        (1) Has graduated from a regionally accredited college
21    or university with a bachelor's degree or higher.
22        (2) (Blank). Has a cumulative grade point average of
23    3.0 or greater on a 4.0 scale or its equivalent on another
24    scale.
25        (3) Has completed a major in the content area if
26    seeking a middle or secondary level endorsement or, if

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 464 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    seeking an early childhood, elementary, or special
2    education endorsement, has completed a major in the content
3    area of reading, English/language arts, mathematics, or
4    one of the sciences. If the individual does not have a
5    major in a content area for any level of teaching, he or
6    she must submit transcripts to the State Board of Education
7    to be reviewed for equivalency.
8        (4) Has successfully completed phase (1) of subsection
9    (b) of this Section.
10        (5) Has passed a content area test required for the
11    specific endorsement for admission into the program, as
12    required under Section 21B-30 of this Code.
13    A candidate possessing the alternative provisional
14educator endorsement may receive a salary, benefits, and any
15other terms of employment offered to teachers in the school who
16are members of an exclusive bargaining representative, if any,
17but a school is not required to provide these benefits during
18the years of residency if the candidate is serving only as a
19co-teacher. If the candidate is serving as the teacher of
20record, the candidate must receive a salary, benefits, and any
21other terms of employment. Residency experiences must not be
22counted towards tenure.
23    (d) The recognized institution offering the Alternative
24Educator Licensure Program for Teachers must partner with a
25school district, including without limitation a preschool
26educational program under Section 2-3.71 of this Code or

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 465 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1charter school, or a State-recognized, nonpublic school in this
2State in which the chief administrator is required to have the
3licensure necessary to be a principal in a public school in
4this State and in which a majority of the teachers are required
5to have the licensure necessary to be instructors in a public
6school in this State. A recognized institution that partners
7with a public school district administering a preschool
8educational program under Section 2-3.71 of this Code must
9require a principal to recommend or evaluate candidates in the
10program. A recognized institution that partners with an
11eligible entity administering a preschool educational program
12under Section 2-3.71 of this Code and that is not a public
13school district must require a principal or qualified
14equivalent of a principal to recommend or evaluate candidates
15in the program. The program presented for approval by the State
16Board of Education must demonstrate the supports that are to be
17provided to assist the provisional teacher during the 2-year
18residency period. These supports must provide additional
19contact hours with mentors during the first year of residency.
20    (e) Upon completion of the 4 phases outlined in subsection
21(b) of this Section and all assessments required under Section
2221B-30 of this Code, an individual shall receive a Professional
23Educator License.
24    (f) The State Board of Education, in consultation with the
25State Educator Preparation and Licensure Board, may adopt such
26rules as may be necessary to establish and implement the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 466 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1Alternative Educator Licensure Program for Teachers.
2(Source: P.A. 100-596, eff. 7-1-18; 100-822, eff. 1-1-19;
3101-220, eff. 8-7-19; 101-570, eff. 8-23-19; 101-643, eff.
46-18-20.)
 
5
Article 120.

 
6    Section 120-5. The Higher Education Student Assistance Act
7is amended by changing Section 50 as follows:
 
8    (110 ILCS 947/50)
9    Sec. 50. Minority Teachers of Illinois scholarship
10program.
11    (a) As used in this Section:
12        "Eligible applicant" means a minority student who has
13    graduated from high school or has received a high school
14    equivalency certificate and has maintained a cumulative
15    grade point average of no less than 2.5 on a 4.0 scale, and
16    who by reason thereof is entitled to apply for scholarships
17    to be awarded under this Section.
18        "Minority student" means a student who is any of the
19    following:
20            (1) American Indian or Alaska Native (a person
21        having origins in any of the original peoples of North
22        and South America, including Central America, and who
23        maintains tribal affiliation or community attachment).

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 467 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1            (2) Asian (a person having origins in any of the
2        original peoples of the Far East, Southeast Asia, or
3        the Indian subcontinent, including, but not limited
4        to, Cambodia, China, India, Japan, Korea, Malaysia,
5        Pakistan, the Philippine Islands, Thailand, and
6        Vietnam).
7            (3) Black or African American (a person having
8        origins in any of the black racial groups of Africa).
9        Terms such as "Haitian" or "Negro" can be used in
10        addition to "Black or African American".
11            (4) Hispanic or Latino (a person of Cuban, Mexican,
12        Puerto Rican, South or Central American, or other
13        Spanish culture or origin, regardless of race).
14            (5) Native Hawaiian or Other Pacific Islander (a
15        person having origins in any of the original peoples of
16        Hawaii, Guam, Samoa, or other Pacific Islands).
17        "Qualified bilingual minority applicant" means a
18    minority student who demonstrates proficiency in a
19    language other than English by (i) receiving a State Seal
20    of Biliteracy from the State Board of Education or (ii)
21    receiving a passing score on an educator licensure target
22    language proficiency test.
23        "Qualified student" means a person (i) who is a
24    resident of this State and eligible for State financial aid
25    under Section 15 of the Retention of Illinois Students and
26    Equity Act a citizen or permanent resident of the United

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 468 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    States; (ii) who is a minority student, as defined in this
2    Section; (iii) who, as an eligible applicant, has made a
3    timely application for a minority teaching scholarship
4    under this Section; (iv) who is enrolled on at least a
5    half-time basis at a qualified Illinois institution of
6    higher learning; (v) who is enrolled in a course of study
7    leading to teacher licensure, including alternative
8    teacher licensure, or, if the student is already licensed
9    to teach, in a course of study leading to an additional
10    teaching endorsement or a master's degree in an academic
11    field in which he or she is teaching or plans to teach or
12    who has received one or more College and Career Pathway
13    Endorsements pursuant to Section 80 of the Postsecondary
14    and Workforce Readiness Act and commits to enrolling in a
15    course of study leading to teacher licensure, including
16    alternative teacher licensure; (vi) who maintains a grade
17    point average of no less than 2.5 on a 4.0 scale; and (vii)
18    who continues to advance satisfactorily toward the
19    attainment of a degree.
20    (b) In order to encourage academically talented Illinois
21minority students to pursue teaching careers at the preschool
22or elementary or secondary school level, each qualified student
23shall be awarded a minority teacher scholarship to any
24qualified Illinois institution of higher learning. However,
25preference may be given to qualified applicants enrolled at or
26above the junior level.

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 469 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    (c) Each minority teacher scholarship awarded under this
2Section shall be in an amount sufficient to pay the tuition and
3fees and room and board costs of the qualified Illinois
4institution of higher learning at which the recipient is
5enrolled, up to an annual maximum of $5,000; except that in the
6case of a recipient who does not reside on-campus at the
7institution at which he or she is enrolled, the amount of the
8scholarship shall be sufficient to pay tuition and fee expenses
9and a commuter allowance, up to an annual maximum of $5,000.
10However, if at least $2,850,000 is appropriated in a given
11fiscal year for the Minority Teachers of Illinois scholarship
12program, then, in each fiscal year thereafter, each scholarship
13awarded under this Section shall be in an amount sufficient to
14pay the tuition and fees and room and board costs of the
15qualified Illinois institution of higher learning at which the
16recipient is enrolled, up to an annual maximum of $7,500;
17except that in the case of a recipient who does not reside
18on-campus at the institution at which he or she is enrolled,
19the amount of the scholarship shall be sufficient to pay
20tuition and fee expenses and a commuter allowance, up to an
21annual maximum of $7,500.
22    (d) The total amount of minority teacher scholarship
23assistance awarded by the Commission under this Section to an
24individual in any given fiscal year, when added to other
25financial assistance awarded to that individual for that year,
26shall not exceed the cost of attendance at the institution at

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 470 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1which the student is enrolled. If the amount of minority
2teacher scholarship to be awarded to a qualified student as
3provided in subsection (c) of this Section exceeds the cost of
4attendance at the institution at which the student is enrolled,
5the minority teacher scholarship shall be reduced by an amount
6equal to the amount by which the combined financial assistance
7available to the student exceeds the cost of attendance.
8    (e) The maximum number of academic terms for which a
9qualified student can receive minority teacher scholarship
10assistance shall be 8 semesters or 12 quarters.
11    (f) In any academic year for which an eligible applicant
12under this Section accepts financial assistance through the
13Paul Douglas Teacher Scholarship Program, as authorized by
14Section 551 et seq. of the Higher Education Act of 1965, the
15applicant shall not be eligible for scholarship assistance
16awarded under this Section.
17    (g) All applications for minority teacher scholarships to
18be awarded under this Section shall be made to the Commission
19on forms which the Commission shall provide for eligible
20applicants. The form of applications and the information
21required to be set forth therein shall be determined by the
22Commission, and the Commission shall require eligible
23applicants to submit with their applications such supporting
24documents or recommendations as the Commission deems
25necessary.
26    (h) Subject to a separate appropriation for such purposes,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 471 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1payment of any minority teacher scholarship awarded under this
2Section shall be determined by the Commission. All scholarship
3funds distributed in accordance with this subsection shall be
4paid to the institution and used only for payment of the
5tuition and fee and room and board expenses incurred by the
6student in connection with his or her attendance at a qualified
7Illinois institution of higher learning. Any minority teacher
8scholarship awarded under this Section shall be applicable to 2
9semesters or 3 quarters of enrollment. If a qualified student
10withdraws from enrollment prior to completion of the first
11semester or quarter for which the minority teacher scholarship
12is applicable, the school shall refund to the Commission the
13full amount of the minority teacher scholarship.
14    (i) The Commission shall administer the minority teacher
15scholarship aid program established by this Section and shall
16make all necessary and proper rules not inconsistent with this
17Section for its effective implementation.
18    (j) When an appropriation to the Commission for a given
19fiscal year is insufficient to provide scholarships to all
20qualified students, the Commission shall allocate the
21appropriation in accordance with this subsection. If funds are
22insufficient to provide all qualified students with a
23scholarship as authorized by this Section, the Commission shall
24allocate the available scholarship funds for that fiscal year
25to qualified students who submit a complete application form on
26or before a date specified by the Commission based on the

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 472 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1following order of priority:
2        (1) To students who received a scholarship under this
3    Section in the prior academic year and who remain eligible
4    for a minority teacher scholarship under this Section.
5        (2) Except as otherwise provided in subsection (k), to
6    students who demonstrate financial need, as determined by
7    the Commission. on the basis of the date the Commission
8    receives a complete application form.
9    (k) Notwithstanding paragraph (2) of the provisions of
10subsection (j) or any other provision of this Section, at least
1135% 30% of the funds appropriated for scholarships awarded
12under this Section in each fiscal year shall be reserved for
13qualified male minority applicants, with priority being given
14to qualified Black male applicants beginning with fiscal year
152023. If the Commission does not receive enough applications
16from qualified male minorities on or before January 1 of each
17fiscal year to award 35% 30% of the funds appropriated for
18these scholarships to qualified male minority applicants, then
19the Commission may award a portion of the reserved funds to
20qualified female minority applicants in accordance with
21subsection (j).
22    Beginning with fiscal year 2023, if at least $2,850,000 but
23less than $4,200,000 is appropriated in a given fiscal year for
24scholarships awarded under this Section, then at least 10% of
25the funds appropriated shall be reserved for qualified
26bilingual minority applicants, with priority being given to

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 473 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1qualified bilingual minority applicants who are enrolled in an
2educator preparation program with a concentration in
3bilingual, bicultural education. Beginning with fiscal year
42023, if at least $4,200,000 is appropriated in a given fiscal
5year for the Minority Teachers of Illinois scholarship program,
6then at least 30% of the funds appropriated shall be reserved
7for qualified bilingual minority applicants, with priority
8being given to qualified bilingual minority applicants who are
9enrolled in an educator preparation program with a
10concentration in bilingual, bicultural education. Beginning
11with fiscal year 2023, if at least $2,850,000 is appropriated
12in a given fiscal year for scholarships awarded under this
13Section but the Commission does not receive enough applications
14from qualified bilingual minority applicants on or before
15January 1 of that fiscal year to award at least 10% of the
16funds appropriated to qualified bilingual minority applicants,
17then the Commission may, in its discretion, award a portion of
18the reserved funds to other qualified students in accordance
19with subsection (j).
20    (l) Prior to receiving scholarship assistance for any
21academic year, each recipient of a minority teacher scholarship
22awarded under this Section shall be required by the Commission
23to sign an agreement under which the recipient pledges that,
24within the one-year period following the termination of the
25program for which the recipient was awarded a minority teacher
26scholarship, the recipient (i) shall begin teaching for a

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 474 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1period of not less than one year for each year of scholarship
2assistance he or she was awarded under this Section; and (ii)
3shall fulfill this teaching obligation at a nonprofit Illinois
4public, private, or parochial preschool, elementary school, or
5secondary school at which no less than 30% of the enrolled
6students are minority students in the year during which the
7recipient begins teaching at the school or may instead, if the
8recipient received a scholarship as a qualified bilingual
9minority applicant, fulfill this teaching obligation in a
10program in transitional bilingual education pursuant to
11Article 14C of the School Code or in a school in which 20 or
12more English learner students in the same language
13classification are enrolled; and (iii) shall, upon request by
14the Commission, provide the Commission with evidence that he or
15she is fulfilling or has fulfilled the terms of the teaching
16agreement provided for in this subsection.
17    (m) If a recipient of a minority teacher scholarship
18awarded under this Section fails to fulfill the teaching
19obligation set forth in subsection (l) of this Section, the
20Commission shall require the recipient to repay the amount of
21the scholarships received, prorated according to the fraction
22of the teaching obligation not completed, at a rate of interest
23equal to 5%, and, if applicable, reasonable collection fees.
24The Commission is authorized to establish rules relating to its
25collection activities for repayment of scholarships under this
26Section. All repayments collected under this Section shall be

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 475 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1forwarded to the State Comptroller for deposit into the State's
2General Revenue Fund.
3    (n) A recipient of minority teacher scholarship shall not
4be considered in violation of the agreement entered into
5pursuant to subsection (l) if the recipient (i) enrolls on a
6full time basis as a graduate student in a course of study
7related to the field of teaching at a qualified Illinois
8institution of higher learning; (ii) is serving, not in excess
9of 3 years, as a member of the armed services of the United
10States; (iii) is a person with a temporary total disability for
11a period of time not to exceed 3 years as established by sworn
12affidavit of a qualified physician; (iv) is seeking and unable
13to find full time employment as a teacher at an Illinois
14public, private, or parochial preschool or elementary or
15secondary school that satisfies the criteria set forth in
16subsection (l) of this Section and is able to provide evidence
17of that fact; (v) becomes a person with a permanent total
18disability as established by sworn affidavit of a qualified
19physician; (vi) is taking additional courses, on at least a
20half-time basis, needed to obtain licensure as a teacher in
21Illinois; or (vii) is fulfilling teaching requirements
22associated with other programs administered by the Commission
23and cannot concurrently fulfill them under this Section in a
24period of time equal to the length of the teaching obligation.
25    (o) Scholarship recipients under this Section who withdraw
26from a program of teacher education but remain enrolled in

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 476 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1school to continue their postsecondary studies in another
2academic discipline shall not be required to commence repayment
3of their Minority Teachers of Illinois scholarship so long as
4they remain enrolled in school on a full-time basis or if they
5can document for the Commission special circumstances that
6warrant extension of repayment.
7    (p) If the Minority Teachers of Illinois scholarship
8program does not expend at least 90% of the amount appropriated
9for the program in a given fiscal year for 3 consecutive fiscal
10years and the Commission does not receive enough applications
11from the groups identified in subsection (k) on or before
12January 1 in each of those fiscal years to meet the percentage
13reserved for those groups under subsection (k), then up to 3%
14of amount appropriated for the program for each of next 3
15fiscal years shall be allocated to increasing awareness of the
16program and for the recruitment of Black male applicants. The
17Commission shall make a recommendation to the General Assembly
18by January 1 of the year immediately following the end of that
19third fiscal year regarding whether the amount allocated to
20increasing awareness and recruitment should continue.
21    (q) Each qualified Illinois institution of higher learning
22that receives funds from the Minority Teachers of Illinois
23scholarship program shall host an annual information session at
24the institution about the program for teacher candidates of
25color in accordance with rules adopted by the Commission.
26Additionally, the institution shall ensure that each

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 477 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1scholarship recipient enrolled at the institution meets with an
2academic advisor at least once per academic year to facilitate
3on-time completion of the recipient's educator preparation
4program.
5(Source: P.A. 99-143, eff. 7-27-15; 100-235, eff. 6-1-18.)
 
6
Article 125.

 
7    Section 125-5. The Higher Education Student Assistance Act
8is amended by changing Section 65.100 as follows:
 
9    (110 ILCS 947/65.100)
10    (Section scheduled to be repealed on October 1, 2024)
11    Sec. 65.100. AIM HIGH Grant Pilot Program.
12    (a) The General Assembly makes all of the following
13findings:
14        (1) Both access and affordability are important
15    aspects of the Illinois Public Agenda for College and
16    Career Success report.
17        (2) This State is in the top quartile with respect to
18    the percentage of family income needed to pay for college.
19        (3) Research suggests that as loan amounts increase,
20    rather than an increase in grant amounts, the probability
21    of college attendance decreases.
22        (4) There is further research indicating that
23    socioeconomic status may affect the willingness of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 478 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    students to use loans to attend college.
2        (5) Strategic use of tuition discounting can decrease
3    the amount of loans that students must use to pay for
4    tuition.
5        (6) A modest, individually tailored tuition discount
6    can make the difference in a student choosing to attend
7    college and enhance college access for low-income and
8    middle-income families.
9        (7) Even if the federally calculated financial need for
10    college attendance is met, the federally determined
11    Expected Family Contribution can still be a daunting
12    amount.
13        (8) This State is the second largest exporter of
14    students in the country.
15        (9) When talented Illinois students attend
16    universities in this State, the State and those
17    universities benefit.
18        (10) State universities in other states have adopted
19    pricing and incentives that allow many Illinois residents
20    to pay less to attend an out-of-state university than to
21    remain in this State for college.
22        (11) Supporting Illinois student attendance at
23    Illinois public universities can assist in State efforts to
24    maintain and educate a highly trained workforce.
25        (12) Modest tuition discounts that are individually
26    targeted and tailored can result in enhanced revenue for

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 479 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    public universities.
2        (13) By increasing a public university's capacity to
3    strategically use tuition discounting, the public
4    university will be capable of creating enhanced tuition
5    revenue by increasing enrollment yields.
6    (b) In this Section:
7    "Eligible applicant" means a student from any high school
8in this State, whether or not recognized by the State Board of
9Education, who is engaged in a program of study that in due
10course will be completed by the end of the school year and who
11meets all of the qualifications and requirements under this
12Section.
13    "Tuition and other necessary fees" includes the customary
14charge for instruction and use of facilities in general and the
15additional fixed fees charged for specified purposes that are
16required generally of non-grant recipients for each academic
17period for which the grant applicant actually enrolls, but does
18not include fees payable only once or breakage fees and other
19contingent deposits that are refundable in whole or in part.
20The Commission may adopt, by rule not inconsistent with this
21Section, detailed provisions concerning the computation of
22tuition and other necessary fees.
23    (c) Beginning with the 2019-2020 academic year, each public
24university may establish a merit-based scholarship pilot
25program known as the AIM HIGH Grant Pilot Program. Each year,
26the Commission shall receive and consider applications from

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 480 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1public universities under this Section. Subject to
2appropriation and any tuition waiver limitation established by
3the Board of Higher Education, a public university campus may
4award a grant to a student under this Section if it finds that
5the applicant meets all of the following criteria:
6        (1) He or she is a resident of this State and a citizen
7    or eligible noncitizen of the United States.
8        (2) He or she files a Free Application for Federal
9    Student Aid and demonstrates financial need with a
10    household income no greater than 6 times the poverty
11    guidelines updated periodically in the Federal Register by
12    the U.S. Department of Health and Human Services under the
13    authority of 42 U.S.C. 9902(2). The household income of the
14    applicant at the time of initial application shall be
15    deemed to be the household income of the applicant for the
16    duration of the pilot program.
17        (3) He or she meets the minimum cumulative grade point
18    average or ACT or SAT college admissions test score, as
19    determined by the public university campus.
20        (4) He or she is enrolled in a public university as an
21    undergraduate student on a full-time basis.
22        (5) He or she has not yet received a baccalaureate
23    degree or the equivalent of 135 semester credit hours.
24        (6) He or she is not incarcerated.
25        (7) He or she is not in default on any student loan or
26    does not owe a refund or repayment on any State or federal

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 481 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    grant or scholarship.
2        (8) Any other reasonable criteria, as determined by the
3    public university campus.
4    (d) Each public university campus shall determine grant
5renewal criteria consistent with the requirements under this
6Section.
7    (e) Each participating public university campus shall post
8on its Internet website criteria and eligibility requirements
9for receiving awards that use funds under this Section that
10include a range in the sizes of these individual awards. The
11criteria and amounts must also be reported to the Commission
12and the Board of Higher Education, who shall post the
13information on their respective Internet websites.
14    (f) After enactment of an appropriation for this Program,
15the Commission shall determine an allocation of funds to each
16public university in an amount proportionate to the number of
17undergraduate students who are residents of this State and
18citizens or eligible noncitizens of the United States and who
19were enrolled at each public university campus in the previous
20academic year. All applications must be made to the Commission
21on or before a date determined by the Commission and on forms
22that the Commission shall provide to each public university
23campus. The form of the application and the information
24required shall be determined by the Commission and shall
25include, without limitation, the total public university
26campus funds used to match funds received from the Commission

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 482 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1in the previous academic year under this Section, if any, the
2total enrollment of undergraduate students who are residents of
3this State from the previous academic year, and any supporting
4documents as the Commission deems necessary. Each public
5university campus shall match the amount of funds received by
6the Commission with financial aid for eligible students.
7    A public university that has reported to the Commission
8that at least 49% of its student body received financial aid
9under the federal Pell Grant program for the previous academic
10year shall match 20% of the amount of funds received from the
11Commission for financial aid for eligible students.
12    A public university that has reported to the Commission
13that less than 49% of its student body received financial aid
14under the federal Pell Grant program for the previous academic
15year shall match 60% of the amount of funds received from the
16Commission for financial aid for eligible students.
17    A public university campus is not required to claim its
18entire allocation. The Commission shall make available to all
19public universities, on a date determined by the Commission,
20any unclaimed funds and the funds must be made available to
21those public university campuses in the proportion determined
22under this subsection (f), excluding from the calculation those
23public university campuses not claiming their full
24allocations.
25    Each public university campus may determine the award
26amounts for eligible students on an individual or broad basis,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 483 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1but, subject to renewal eligibility, each renewed award may not
2be less than the amount awarded to the eligible student in his
3or her first year attending the public university campus.
4Notwithstanding this limitation, a renewal grant may be reduced
5due to changes in the student's cost of attendance, including,
6but not limited to, if a student reduces the number of credit
7hours in which he or she is enrolled, but remains a full-time
8student, or switches to a course of study with a lower tuition
9rate.
10    An eligible applicant awarded grant assistance under this
11Section is eligible to receive other financial aid. Total grant
12aid to the student from all sources may not exceed the total
13cost of attendance at the public university campus.
14    (g) All money allocated to a public university campus under
15this Section may be used only for financial aid purposes for
16students attending the public university campus during the
17academic year, not including summer terms. Notwithstanding any
18other provision of law to the contrary, any funds received by a
19public university campus under this Section that are not
20granted to students in the academic year for which the funds
21are received may be retained by the public university campus
22for expenditure on students participating in the Program or
23students eligible to participate in the Program.
24    (h) Each public university campus that establishes a
25Program under this Section must annually report to the
26Commission, on or before a date determined by the Commission,

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 484 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1the number of undergraduate students enrolled at that campus
2who are residents of this State.
3    (i) Each public university campus must report to the
4Commission the total non-loan financial aid amount given by the
5public university campus to undergraduate students in the
62017-2018 academic year, not including the summer term. To be
7eligible to receive funds under the Program, a public
8university campus may not decrease the total amount of non-loan
9financial aid it gives to undergraduate students, not including
10any funds received from the Commission under this Section or
11any funds used to match grant awards under this Section, to an
12amount lower than the reported amount for the 2017-2018
13academic year, not including the summer term.
14    (j) On or before a date determined by the Commission, each
15public university campus that participates in the Program under
16this Section shall annually submit a report to the Commission
17with all of the following information:
18        (1) The Program's impact on tuition revenue and
19    enrollment goals and increase in access and affordability
20    at the public university campus.
21        (2) Total funds received by the public university
22    campus under the Program.
23        (3) Total non-loan financial aid awarded to
24    undergraduate students attending the public university
25    campus.
26        (4) Total amount of funds matched by the public

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 485 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    university campus.
2        (5) Total amount of claimed and unexpended funds
3    retained by the public university campus.
4        (6) The percentage of total financial aid distributed
5    under the Program by the public university campus.
6        (7) The total number of students receiving grants from
7    the public university campus under the Program and those
8    students' grade level, race, gender, income level, family
9    size, Monetary Award Program eligibility, Pell Grant
10    eligibility, and zip code of residence and the amount of
11    each grant award. This information shall include unit
12    record data on those students regarding variables
13    associated with the parameters of the public university's
14    Program, including, but not limited to, a student's ACT or
15    SAT college admissions test score, high school or
16    university cumulative grade point average, or program of
17    study.
18    On or before October 1, 2020 and annually on or before
19October 1 thereafter, the Commission shall submit a report with
20the findings under this subsection (j) and any other
21information regarding the AIM HIGH Grant Pilot Program to (i)
22the Governor, (ii) the Speaker of the House of Representatives,
23(iii) the Minority Leader of the House of Representatives, (iv)
24the President of the Senate, and (v) the Minority Leader of the
25Senate. The reports to the General Assembly shall be filed with
26the Clerk of the House of Representatives and the Secretary of

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 486 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1the Senate in electronic form only, in the manner that the
2Clerk and the Secretary shall direct. The Commission's report
3may not disaggregate data to a level that may disclose
4personally identifying information of individual students.
5    The sharing and reporting of student data under this
6subsection (j) must be in accordance with the requirements
7under the federal Family Educational Rights and Privacy Act of
81974 and the Illinois School Student Records Act. All parties
9must preserve the confidentiality of the information as
10required by law. The names of the grant recipients under this
11Section are not subject to disclosure under the Freedom of
12Information Act.
13    Public university campuses that fail to submit a report
14under this subsection (j) or that fail to adhere to any other
15requirements under this Section may not be eligible for
16distribution of funds under the Program for the next academic
17year, but may be eligible for distribution of funds for each
18academic year thereafter.
19    (k) The Commission shall adopt rules to implement this
20Section.
21    (l) This Section is repealed on October 1, 2024.
22(Source: P.A. 100-587, eff. 6-4-18; 100-1015, eff. 8-21-18;
23100-1183, eff. 4-4-19; 101-81, eff. 7-12-19; 101-613, eff.
246-1-20; 101-643, eff. 6-18-20.)
 
25
Article 130.

 

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 487 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Section 130-1. Short title. This Article may be cited as
2the Transitions in Education Act. References in this Article to
3"this Act" mean this Article.
 
4    Section 130-5. Findings; policies.
5    (a) The General Assembly finds the following:
6        (1) Teachers are the single most important in-school
7    factor in supporting student outcomes and success; yet,
8    Illinois is suffering from a profound teacher shortage
9    across the State.
10        (2) To reverse this shortage, Illinois needs to develop
11    and invest in a robust and diverse educator pipeline,
12    addressing any barriers or gaps that limit high quality
13    candidates, particularly candidates of color, from
14    becoming teachers.
15        (3) Illinois loses many high quality, diverse educator
16    candidates in postsecondary programs due to confusion or
17    lack of course transfer credits and course articulation
18    from Illinois's 2-year to 4-year institutions.
19        (4) Lack of alignment and transferability of course
20    credits may often force candidates to spend additional time
21    and money to earn a degree or lead to an inability to
22    complete a degree.
23        (5) In 1993, the Board of Higher Education, the
24    Illinois Community College Board, and the Transfer

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 488 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    Coordinators of Illinois Colleges and Universities brought
2    together faculty from public and independent, associate,
3    and baccalaureate degree-granting institutions across the
4    State to develop the Illinois Articulation Initiative
5    (IAI).
6        (6) The goal of IAI is to facilitate the transfer of
7    courses from one participating college or university to
8    another in order to complete a baccalaureate degree.
9        (7) The Student Transfer Achievement Reform (STAR)
10    Act, as mandated by subsection (b) of Section 25 of the
11    Act, is designed to facilitate transfer among Illinois
12    public institutions, particularly for students with a
13    completed Associate of Arts or an Associate of Science
14    degree.
15        (8) While Illinois is a leading state for college
16    completion rates for adult learners and transfer students
17    from community colleges, it needs to increase the number of
18    high-quality postsecondary teaching credentials to meet
19    the demands of our schools and education workforce.
20        (9) With the rising costs of higher education for
21    Illinois students and families, the State needs to ensure
22    to the maximize extent possible that community college
23    courses will transfer with full credit for the student and
24    be accepted at an Illinois public or private institution as
25    they pursue a baccalaureate degree in education.
26        (10) Illinois can do this by improving transitions all

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 489 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1    along the education pipeline; for postsecondary education,
2    this means strengthening articulation through stable
3    funding and the expansion of transfer tools, such as
4    Transferology and the IAI through development of an
5    objective measure of transfer and acceptance of credits in
6    education degrees.
7        (11) The IAI Education Pathway can be modeled off of
8    existing IAI major pathways like Early Childhood Education
9    and Criminal Justice.
10    (b) The General Assembly encourages the Board of Higher
11Education, the State Board of Education, and the Illinois
12Community College Board, as part of the IAI, to do all of the
13following:
14        (1) To jointly establish a task force for a Major Panel
15    in Education and identify respective recommended major
16    courses that would be accepted as credit toward the
17    education major at the receiving institutions.
18        (2) As part of the report on the status of the Illinois
19    Articulation Initiative pursuant to Section 25 of the
20    Illinois Articulation Initiative Act, the Board of Higher
21    Education and the Illinois Community College Board are
22    encourage to include in the annual report to the General
23    Assembly, the Governor, and the Illinois P-20 Council the
24    progress made on the task force on the Education Major
25    Panel.
 

 

 

10100HB2170sam001- 490 -LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a

1
Article 999.

 
2    Section 999-999. Effective date. This Act takes effect upon
3becoming law, except that Article 115 takes effect July 1,
42021.".